diff --git a/include/DLL_VERSION.H b/include/DLL_VERSION.H index 60cf90d..5063a5c 100644 --- a/include/DLL_VERSION.H +++ b/include/DLL_VERSION.H @@ -3,7 +3,7 @@ #define TBF_MAJOR 0 #define TBF_MINOR 3 -#define TBF_BUILD 2 +#define TBF_BUILD 3 #define TBF_REV 0 diff --git a/include/config.h b/include/config.h index 5bfc9aa..0648d79 100644 --- a/include/config.h +++ b/include/config.h @@ -73,6 +73,7 @@ struct tbf_config_t float lod_bias = -0.2666f; int32_t max_cache_in_mib = 2048L; int32_t worker_threads = 6; + bool show_loading_text = false; } textures; struct { diff --git a/include/imgui/imgui_internal.h b/include/imgui/imgui_internal.h deleted file mode 100644 index 2155826..0000000 --- a/include/imgui/imgui_internal.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,776 +0,0 @@ -// dear imgui, v1.50 WIP -// (internals) - -// You may use this file to debug, understand or extend ImGui features but we don't provide any guarantee of forward compatibility! -// Implement maths operators for ImVec2 (disabled by default to not collide with using IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA along with your own math types+operators) -// #define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS - -#pragma once - -#ifndef IMGUI_VERSION -#error Must include imgui.h before imgui_internal.h -#endif - -#include // FILE* -#include // sqrtf, fabsf, fmodf, powf, floorf, ceilf, cosf, sinf - -#ifdef _MSC_VER -#pragma warning (push) -#pragma warning (disable: 4251) // class 'xxx' needs to have dll-interface to be used by clients of struct 'xxx' // when IMGUI_API is set to__declspec(dllexport) -#endif - -#ifdef __clang__ -#pragma clang diagnostic push -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-function" // for stb_textedit.h -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wmissing-prototypes" // for stb_textedit.h -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" -#endif - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Forward Declarations -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -struct ImRect; -struct ImGuiColMod; -struct ImGuiStyleMod; -struct ImGuiGroupData; -struct ImGuiSimpleColumns; -struct ImGuiDrawContext; -struct ImGuiTextEditState; -struct ImGuiIniData; -struct ImGuiMouseCursorData; -struct ImGuiPopupRef; -struct ImGuiWindow; - -typedef int ImGuiLayoutType; // enum ImGuiLayoutType_ -typedef int ImGuiButtonFlags; // enum ImGuiButtonFlags_ -typedef int ImGuiTreeNodeFlags; // enum ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_ -typedef int ImGuiSliderFlags; // enum ImGuiSliderFlags_ - -//------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// STB libraries -//------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -namespace ImGuiStb -{ - -#undef STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING -#undef STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING ImGuiTextEditState -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_CHARTYPE ImWchar -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE -1.0f -#include - -} // namespace ImGuiStb - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Context -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -#ifndef GImGui -extern IMGUI_API ImGuiContext* GImGui; // Current implicit ImGui context pointer -#endif - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Helpers -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -#define IM_ARRAYSIZE(_ARR) ((int)(sizeof(_ARR)/sizeof(*_ARR))) -#define IM_PI 3.14159265358979323846f -#define IM_OFFSETOF(_TYPE,_ELM) ((size_t)&(((_TYPE*)0)->_ELM)) - -// Helpers: UTF-8 <> wchar -IMGUI_API int ImTextStrToUtf8(char* buf, int buf_size, const ImWchar* in_text, const ImWchar* in_text_end); // return output UTF-8 bytes count -IMGUI_API int ImTextCharFromUtf8(unsigned int* out_char, const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end); // return input UTF-8 bytes count -IMGUI_API int ImTextStrFromUtf8(ImWchar* buf, int buf_size, const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end, const char** in_remaining = NULL); // return input UTF-8 bytes count -IMGUI_API int ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end); // return number of UTF-8 code-points (NOT bytes count) -IMGUI_API int ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(const ImWchar* in_text, const ImWchar* in_text_end); // return number of bytes to express string as UTF-8 code-points - -// Helpers: Misc -IMGUI_API ImU32 ImHash(const void* data, int data_size, ImU32 seed = 0); // Pass data_size==0 for zero-terminated strings -IMGUI_API void* ImFileLoadToMemory(const char* filename, const char* file_open_mode, int* out_file_size = NULL, int padding_bytes = 0); -IMGUI_API FILE* ImFileOpen(const char* filename, const char* file_open_mode); -IMGUI_API bool ImIsPointInTriangle(const ImVec2& p, const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c); -static inline bool ImCharIsSpace(int c) { return c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == 0x3000; } -static inline int ImUpperPowerOfTwo(int v) { v--; v |= v >> 1; v |= v >> 2; v |= v >> 4; v |= v >> 8; v |= v >> 16; v++; return v; } - -// Helpers: String -IMGUI_API int ImStricmp(const char* str1, const char* str2); -IMGUI_API int ImStrnicmp(const char* str1, const char* str2, int count); -IMGUI_API char* ImStrdup(const char* str); -IMGUI_API int ImStrlenW(const ImWchar* str); -IMGUI_API const ImWchar*ImStrbolW(const ImWchar* buf_mid_line, const ImWchar* buf_begin); // Find beginning-of-line -IMGUI_API const char* ImStristr(const char* haystack, const char* haystack_end, const char* needle, const char* needle_end); -IMGUI_API int ImFormatString(char* buf, int buf_size, const char* fmt, ...) IM_PRINTFARGS(3); -IMGUI_API int ImFormatStringV(char* buf, int buf_size, const char* fmt, va_list args); - -// Helpers: Math -// We are keeping those not leaking to the user by default, in the case the user has implicit cast operators between ImVec2 and its own types (when IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA is defined) -#ifdef IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS -static inline ImVec2 operator*(const ImVec2& lhs, const float rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x*rhs, lhs.y*rhs); } -static inline ImVec2 operator/(const ImVec2& lhs, const float rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x/rhs, lhs.y/rhs); } -static inline ImVec2 operator+(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x+rhs.x, lhs.y+rhs.y); } -static inline ImVec2 operator-(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x-rhs.x, lhs.y-rhs.y); } -static inline ImVec2 operator*(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x*rhs.x, lhs.y*rhs.y); } -static inline ImVec2 operator/(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(lhs.x/rhs.x, lhs.y/rhs.y); } -static inline ImVec2& operator+=(ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { lhs.x += rhs.x; lhs.y += rhs.y; return lhs; } -static inline ImVec2& operator-=(ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { lhs.x -= rhs.x; lhs.y -= rhs.y; return lhs; } -static inline ImVec2& operator*=(ImVec2& lhs, const float rhs) { lhs.x *= rhs; lhs.y *= rhs; return lhs; } -static inline ImVec2& operator/=(ImVec2& lhs, const float rhs) { lhs.x /= rhs; lhs.y /= rhs; return lhs; } -static inline ImVec4 operator-(const ImVec4& lhs, const ImVec4& rhs) { return ImVec4(lhs.x-rhs.x, lhs.y-rhs.y, lhs.z-rhs.z, lhs.w-rhs.w); } -#endif - -static inline int ImMin(int lhs, int rhs) { return lhs < rhs ? lhs : rhs; } -static inline int ImMax(int lhs, int rhs) { return lhs >= rhs ? lhs : rhs; } -static inline float ImMin(float lhs, float rhs) { return lhs < rhs ? lhs : rhs; } -static inline float ImMax(float lhs, float rhs) { return lhs >= rhs ? lhs : rhs; } -static inline ImVec2 ImMin(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(ImMin(lhs.x,rhs.x), ImMin(lhs.y,rhs.y)); } -static inline ImVec2 ImMax(const ImVec2& lhs, const ImVec2& rhs) { return ImVec2(ImMax(lhs.x,rhs.x), ImMax(lhs.y,rhs.y)); } -static inline int ImClamp(int v, int mn, int mx) { return (v < mn) ? mn : (v > mx) ? mx : v; } -static inline float ImClamp(float v, float mn, float mx) { return (v < mn) ? mn : (v > mx) ? mx : v; } -static inline ImVec2 ImClamp(const ImVec2& f, const ImVec2& mn, ImVec2 mx) { return ImVec2(ImClamp(f.x,mn.x,mx.x), ImClamp(f.y,mn.y,mx.y)); } -static inline float ImSaturate(float f) { return (f < 0.0f) ? 0.0f : (f > 1.0f) ? 1.0f : f; } -static inline float ImLerp(float a, float b, float t) { return a + (b - a) * t; } -static inline ImVec2 ImLerp(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& t) { return ImVec2(a.x + (b.x - a.x) * t.x, a.y + (b.y - a.y) * t.y); } -static inline float ImLengthSqr(const ImVec2& lhs) { return lhs.x*lhs.x + lhs.y*lhs.y; } -static inline float ImLengthSqr(const ImVec4& lhs) { return lhs.x*lhs.x + lhs.y*lhs.y + lhs.z*lhs.z + lhs.w*lhs.w; } -static inline float ImInvLength(const ImVec2& lhs, float fail_value) { float d = lhs.x*lhs.x + lhs.y*lhs.y; if (d > 0.0f) return 1.0f / sqrtf(d); return fail_value; } -static inline float ImFloor(float f) { return (float)(int)f; } -static inline ImVec2 ImFloor(ImVec2 v) { return ImVec2((float)(int)v.x, (float)(int)v.y); } - -// We call C++ constructor on own allocated memory via the placement "new(ptr) Type()" syntax. -// Defining a custom placement new() with a dummy parameter allows us to bypass including which on some platforms complains when user has disabled exceptions. -#ifdef IMGUI_DEFINE_PLACEMENT_NEW -struct ImPlacementNewDummy {}; -inline void* operator new(size_t, ImPlacementNewDummy, void* ptr) { return ptr; } -inline void operator delete(void*, ImPlacementNewDummy, void*) {} -#define IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(_PTR) new(ImPlacementNewDummy(), _PTR) -#endif - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Types -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -enum ImGuiButtonFlags_ -{ - ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat = 1 << 0, // hold to repeat - ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease = 1 << 1, // (default) return pressed on click+release on same item (default if no PressedOn** flag is set) - ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick = 1 << 2, // return pressed on click (default requires click+release) - ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease = 1 << 3, // return pressed on release (default requires click+release) - ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick = 1 << 4, // return pressed on double-click (default requires click+release) - ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChilds = 1 << 5, // allow interaction even if a child window is overlapping - ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups = 1 << 6, // disable automatically closing parent popup on press - ImGuiButtonFlags_Disabled = 1 << 7, // disable interaction - ImGuiButtonFlags_AlignTextBaseLine = 1 << 8, // vertically align button to match text baseline - ButtonEx() only - ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers = 1 << 9, // disable interaction if a key modifier is held - ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowOverlapMode = 1 << 10 // require previous frame HoveredId to either match id or be null before being usable -}; - -enum ImGuiSliderFlags_ -{ - ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical = 1 << 0 -}; - -enum ImGuiSelectableFlagsPrivate_ -{ - // NB: need to be in sync with last value of ImGuiSelectableFlags_ - ImGuiSelectableFlags_Menu = 1 << 3, - ImGuiSelectableFlags_MenuItem = 1 << 4, - ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled = 1 << 5, - ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawFillAvailWidth = 1 << 6 -}; - -// FIXME: this is in development, not exposed/functional as a generic feature yet. -enum ImGuiLayoutType_ -{ - ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical, - ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal -}; - -enum ImGuiPlotType -{ - ImGuiPlotType_Lines, - ImGuiPlotType_Histogram -}; - -enum ImGuiDataType -{ - ImGuiDataType_Int, - ImGuiDataType_Float, - ImGuiDataType_Float2, -}; - -enum ImGuiCorner -{ - ImGuiCorner_TopLeft = 1 << 0, // 1 - ImGuiCorner_TopRight = 1 << 1, // 2 - ImGuiCorner_BottomRight = 1 << 2, // 4 - ImGuiCorner_BottomLeft = 1 << 3, // 8 - ImGuiCorner_All = 0x0F -}; - -// 2D axis aligned bounding-box -// NB: we can't rely on ImVec2 math operators being available here -struct IMGUI_API ImRect -{ - ImVec2 Min; // Upper-left - ImVec2 Max; // Lower-right - - ImRect() : Min(FLT_MAX,FLT_MAX), Max(-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX) {} - ImRect(const ImVec2& min, const ImVec2& max) : Min(min), Max(max) {} - ImRect(const ImVec4& v) : Min(v.x, v.y), Max(v.z, v.w) {} - ImRect(float x1, float y1, float x2, float y2) : Min(x1, y1), Max(x2, y2) {} - - ImVec2 GetCenter() const { return ImVec2((Min.x+Max.x)*0.5f, (Min.y+Max.y)*0.5f); } - ImVec2 GetSize() const { return ImVec2(Max.x-Min.x, Max.y-Min.y); } - float GetWidth() const { return Max.x-Min.x; } - float GetHeight() const { return Max.y-Min.y; } - ImVec2 GetTL() const { return Min; } // Top-left - ImVec2 GetTR() const { return ImVec2(Max.x, Min.y); } // Top-right - ImVec2 GetBL() const { return ImVec2(Min.x, Max.y); } // Bottom-left - ImVec2 GetBR() const { return Max; } // Bottom-right - bool Contains(const ImVec2& p) const { return p.x >= Min.x && p.y >= Min.y && p.x < Max.x && p.y < Max.y; } - bool Contains(const ImRect& r) const { return r.Min.x >= Min.x && r.Min.y >= Min.y && r.Max.x < Max.x && r.Max.y < Max.y; } - bool Overlaps(const ImRect& r) const { return r.Min.y < Max.y && r.Max.y > Min.y && r.Min.x < Max.x && r.Max.x > Min.x; } - void Add(const ImVec2& rhs) { if (Min.x > rhs.x) Min.x = rhs.x; if (Min.y > rhs.y) Min.y = rhs.y; if (Max.x < rhs.x) Max.x = rhs.x; if (Max.y < rhs.y) Max.y = rhs.y; } - void Add(const ImRect& rhs) { if (Min.x > rhs.Min.x) Min.x = rhs.Min.x; if (Min.y > rhs.Min.y) Min.y = rhs.Min.y; if (Max.x < rhs.Max.x) Max.x = rhs.Max.x; if (Max.y < rhs.Max.y) Max.y = rhs.Max.y; } - void Expand(const float amount) { Min.x -= amount; Min.y -= amount; Max.x += amount; Max.y += amount; } - void Expand(const ImVec2& amount) { Min.x -= amount.x; Min.y -= amount.y; Max.x += amount.x; Max.y += amount.y; } - void Reduce(const ImVec2& amount) { Min.x += amount.x; Min.y += amount.y; Max.x -= amount.x; Max.y -= amount.y; } - void Clip(const ImRect& clip) { if (Min.x < clip.Min.x) Min.x = clip.Min.x; if (Min.y < clip.Min.y) Min.y = clip.Min.y; if (Max.x > clip.Max.x) Max.x = clip.Max.x; if (Max.y > clip.Max.y) Max.y = clip.Max.y; } - void Floor() { Min.x = (float)(int)Min.x; Min.y = (float)(int)Min.y; Max.x = (float)(int)Max.x; Max.y = (float)(int)Max.y; } - ImVec2 GetClosestPoint(ImVec2 p, bool on_edge) const - { - if (!on_edge && Contains(p)) - return p; - if (p.x > Max.x) p.x = Max.x; - else if (p.x < Min.x) p.x = Min.x; - if (p.y > Max.y) p.y = Max.y; - else if (p.y < Min.y) p.y = Min.y; - return p; - } -}; - -// Stacked color modifier, backup of modified data so we can restore it -struct ImGuiColMod -{ - ImGuiCol Col; - ImVec4 BackupValue; -}; - -// Stacked style modifier, backup of modified data so we can restore it. Data type inferred from the variable. -struct ImGuiStyleMod -{ - ImGuiStyleVar VarIdx; - union { int BackupInt[2]; float BackupFloat[2]; }; - ImGuiStyleMod(ImGuiStyleVar idx, int v) { VarIdx = idx; BackupInt[0] = v; } - ImGuiStyleMod(ImGuiStyleVar idx, float v) { VarIdx = idx; BackupFloat[0] = v; } - ImGuiStyleMod(ImGuiStyleVar idx, ImVec2 v) { VarIdx = idx; BackupFloat[0] = v.x; BackupFloat[1] = v.y; } -}; - -// Stacked data for BeginGroup()/EndGroup() -struct ImGuiGroupData -{ - ImVec2 BackupCursorPos; - ImVec2 BackupCursorMaxPos; - float BackupIndentX; - float BackupGroupOffsetX; - float BackupCurrentLineHeight; - float BackupCurrentLineTextBaseOffset; - float BackupLogLinePosY; - bool BackupActiveIdIsAlive; - bool AdvanceCursor; -}; - -// Per column data for Columns() -struct ImGuiColumnData -{ - float OffsetNorm; // Column start offset, normalized 0.0 (far left) -> 1.0 (far right) - //float IndentX; -}; - -// Simple column measurement currently used for MenuItem() only. This is very short-sighted/throw-away code and NOT a generic helper. -struct IMGUI_API ImGuiSimpleColumns -{ - int Count; - float Spacing; - float Width, NextWidth; - float Pos[8], NextWidths[8]; - - ImGuiSimpleColumns(); - void Update(int count, float spacing, bool clear); - float DeclColumns(float w0, float w1, float w2); - float CalcExtraSpace(float avail_w); -}; - -// Internal state of the currently focused/edited text input box -struct IMGUI_API ImGuiTextEditState -{ - ImGuiID Id; // widget id owning the text state - ImVector Text; // edit buffer, we need to persist but can't guarantee the persistence of the user-provided buffer. so we copy into own buffer. - ImVector InitialText; // backup of end-user buffer at the time of focus (in UTF-8, unaltered) - ImVector TempTextBuffer; - int CurLenA, CurLenW; // we need to maintain our buffer length in both UTF-8 and wchar format. - int BufSizeA; // end-user buffer size - float ScrollX; - ImGuiStb::STB_TexteditState StbState; - float CursorAnim; - bool CursorFollow; - bool SelectedAllMouseLock; - - ImGuiTextEditState() { memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); } - void CursorAnimReset() { CursorAnim = -0.30f; } // After a user-input the cursor stays on for a while without blinking - void CursorClamp() { StbState.cursor = ImMin(StbState.cursor, CurLenW); StbState.select_start = ImMin(StbState.select_start, CurLenW); StbState.select_end = ImMin(StbState.select_end, CurLenW); } - bool HasSelection() const { return StbState.select_start != StbState.select_end; } - void ClearSelection() { StbState.select_start = StbState.select_end = StbState.cursor; } - void SelectAll() { StbState.select_start = 0; StbState.select_end = CurLenW; StbState.cursor = StbState.select_end; StbState.has_preferred_x = false; } - void OnKeyPressed(int key); -}; - -// Data saved in imgui.ini file -struct ImGuiIniData -{ - char* Name; - ImGuiID Id; - ImVec2 Pos; - ImVec2 Size; - bool Collapsed; -}; - -// Mouse cursor data (used when io.MouseDrawCursor is set) -struct ImGuiMouseCursorData -{ - ImGuiMouseCursor Type; - ImVec2 HotOffset; - ImVec2 Size; - ImVec2 TexUvMin[2]; - ImVec2 TexUvMax[2]; -}; - -// Storage for current popup stack -struct ImGuiPopupRef -{ - ImGuiID PopupId; // Set on OpenPopup() - ImGuiWindow* Window; // Resolved on BeginPopup() - may stay unresolved if user never calls OpenPopup() - ImGuiWindow* ParentWindow; // Set on OpenPopup() - ImGuiID ParentMenuSet; // Set on OpenPopup() - ImVec2 MousePosOnOpen; // Copy of mouse position at the time of opening popup - - ImGuiPopupRef(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindow* parent_window, ImGuiID parent_menu_set, const ImVec2& mouse_pos) { PopupId = id; Window = NULL; ParentWindow = parent_window; ParentMenuSet = parent_menu_set; MousePosOnOpen = mouse_pos; } -}; - -// Main state for ImGui -struct ImGuiContext -{ - bool Initialized; - ImGuiIO IO; - ImGuiStyle Style; - ImFont* Font; // (Shortcut) == FontStack.empty() ? IO.Font : FontStack.back() - float FontSize; // (Shortcut) == FontBaseSize * g.CurrentWindow->FontWindowScale == window->FontSize() - float FontBaseSize; // (Shortcut) == IO.FontGlobalScale * Font->Scale * Font->FontSize. Size of characters. - ImVec2 FontTexUvWhitePixel; // (Shortcut) == Font->TexUvWhitePixel - - float Time; - int FrameCount; - int FrameCountEnded; - int FrameCountRendered; - ImVector Windows; - ImVector WindowsSortBuffer; - ImGuiWindow* CurrentWindow; // Being drawn into - ImVector CurrentWindowStack; - ImGuiWindow* FocusedWindow; // Will catch keyboard inputs - ImGuiWindow* HoveredWindow; // Will catch mouse inputs - ImGuiWindow* HoveredRootWindow; // Will catch mouse inputs (for focus/move only) - ImGuiID HoveredId; // Hovered widget - bool HoveredIdAllowOverlap; - ImGuiID HoveredIdPreviousFrame; - ImGuiID ActiveId; // Active widget - ImGuiID ActiveIdPreviousFrame; - bool ActiveIdIsAlive; - bool ActiveIdIsJustActivated; // Set at the time of activation for one frame - bool ActiveIdAllowOverlap; // Set only by active widget - ImVec2 ActiveIdClickOffset; // Clicked offset from upper-left corner, if applicable (currently only set by ButtonBehavior) - ImGuiWindow* ActiveIdWindow; - ImGuiWindow* MovedWindow; // Track the child window we clicked on to move a window. - ImGuiID MovedWindowMoveId; // == MovedWindow->RootWindow->MoveId - ImVector Settings; // .ini Settings - float SettingsDirtyTimer; // Save .ini Settings on disk when time reaches zero - ImVector ColorModifiers; // Stack for PushStyleColor()/PopStyleColor() - ImVector StyleModifiers; // Stack for PushStyleVar()/PopStyleVar() - ImVector FontStack; // Stack for PushFont()/PopFont() - ImVector OpenPopupStack; // Which popups are open (persistent) - ImVector CurrentPopupStack; // Which level of BeginPopup() we are in (reset every frame) - - // Storage for SetNexWindow** and SetNextTreeNode*** functions - ImVec2 SetNextWindowPosVal; - ImVec2 SetNextWindowSizeVal; - ImVec2 SetNextWindowContentSizeVal; - bool SetNextWindowCollapsedVal; - ImGuiSetCond SetNextWindowPosCond; - ImGuiSetCond SetNextWindowSizeCond; - ImGuiSetCond SetNextWindowContentSizeCond; - ImGuiSetCond SetNextWindowCollapsedCond; - ImRect SetNextWindowSizeConstraintRect; // Valid if 'SetNextWindowSizeConstraint' is true - ImGuiSizeConstraintCallback SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallback; - void* SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallbackUserData; - bool SetNextWindowSizeConstraint; - bool SetNextWindowFocus; - bool SetNextTreeNodeOpenVal; - ImGuiSetCond SetNextTreeNodeOpenCond; - - // Render - ImDrawData RenderDrawData; // Main ImDrawData instance to pass render information to the user - ImVector RenderDrawLists[3]; - float ModalWindowDarkeningRatio; - ImDrawList OverlayDrawList; // Optional software render of mouse cursors, if io.MouseDrawCursor is set + a few debug overlays - ImGuiMouseCursor MouseCursor; - ImGuiMouseCursorData MouseCursorData[ImGuiMouseCursor_Count_]; - - // Widget state - ImGuiTextEditState InputTextState; - ImFont InputTextPasswordFont; - ImGuiID ScalarAsInputTextId; // Temporary text input when CTRL+clicking on a slider, etc. - ImGuiStorage ColorEditModeStorage; // Store user selection of color edit mode - float DragCurrentValue; // Currently dragged value, always float, not rounded by end-user precision settings - ImVec2 DragLastMouseDelta; - float DragSpeedDefaultRatio; // If speed == 0.0f, uses (max-min) * DragSpeedDefaultRatio - float DragSpeedScaleSlow; - float DragSpeedScaleFast; - ImVec2 ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter; // Distance between mouse and center of grab box, normalized in parent space. Use storage? - char Tooltip[1024]; - char* PrivateClipboard; // If no custom clipboard handler is defined - ImVec2 OsImePosRequest, OsImePosSet; // Cursor position request & last passed to the OS Input Method Editor - - // Logging - bool LogEnabled; - FILE* LogFile; // If != NULL log to stdout/ file - ImGuiTextBuffer* LogClipboard; // Else log to clipboard. This is pointer so our GImGui static constructor doesn't call heap allocators. - int LogStartDepth; - int LogAutoExpandMaxDepth; - - // Misc - float FramerateSecPerFrame[120]; // calculate estimate of framerate for user - int FramerateSecPerFrameIdx; - float FramerateSecPerFrameAccum; - int CaptureMouseNextFrame; // explicit capture via CaptureInputs() sets those flags - int CaptureKeyboardNextFrame; - char TempBuffer[1024*3+1]; // temporary text buffer - - ImGuiContext() - { - Initialized = false; - Font = NULL; - FontSize = FontBaseSize = 0.0f; - FontTexUvWhitePixel = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - - Time = 0.0f; - FrameCount = 0; - FrameCountEnded = FrameCountRendered = -1; - CurrentWindow = NULL; - FocusedWindow = NULL; - HoveredWindow = NULL; - HoveredRootWindow = NULL; - HoveredId = 0; - HoveredIdAllowOverlap = false; - HoveredIdPreviousFrame = 0; - ActiveId = 0; - ActiveIdPreviousFrame = 0; - ActiveIdIsAlive = false; - ActiveIdIsJustActivated = false; - ActiveIdAllowOverlap = false; - ActiveIdClickOffset = ImVec2(-1,-1); - ActiveIdWindow = NULL; - MovedWindow = NULL; - MovedWindowMoveId = 0; - SettingsDirtyTimer = 0.0f; - - SetNextWindowPosVal = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - SetNextWindowSizeVal = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - SetNextWindowCollapsedVal = false; - SetNextWindowPosCond = 0; - SetNextWindowSizeCond = 0; - SetNextWindowContentSizeCond = 0; - SetNextWindowCollapsedCond = 0; - SetNextWindowSizeConstraintRect = ImRect(); - SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallback = NULL; - SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallbackUserData = NULL; - SetNextWindowSizeConstraint = false; - SetNextWindowFocus = false; - SetNextTreeNodeOpenVal = false; - SetNextTreeNodeOpenCond = 0; - - ScalarAsInputTextId = 0; - DragCurrentValue = 0.0f; - DragLastMouseDelta = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - DragSpeedDefaultRatio = 1.0f / 100.0f; - DragSpeedScaleSlow = 0.01f; - DragSpeedScaleFast = 10.0f; - ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - memset(Tooltip, 0, sizeof(Tooltip)); - PrivateClipboard = NULL; - OsImePosRequest = OsImePosSet = ImVec2(-1.0f, -1.0f); - - ModalWindowDarkeningRatio = 0.0f; - OverlayDrawList._OwnerName = "##Overlay"; // Give it a name for debugging - MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow; - memset(MouseCursorData, 0, sizeof(MouseCursorData)); - - LogEnabled = false; - LogFile = NULL; - LogClipboard = NULL; - LogStartDepth = 0; - LogAutoExpandMaxDepth = 2; - - memset(FramerateSecPerFrame, 0, sizeof(FramerateSecPerFrame)); - FramerateSecPerFrameIdx = 0; - FramerateSecPerFrameAccum = 0.0f; - CaptureMouseNextFrame = CaptureKeyboardNextFrame = -1; - memset(TempBuffer, 0, sizeof(TempBuffer)); - } -}; - -// Transient per-window data, reset at the beginning of the frame -// FIXME: That's theory, in practice the delimitation between ImGuiWindow and ImGuiDrawContext is quite tenuous and could be reconsidered. -struct IMGUI_API ImGuiDrawContext -{ - ImVec2 CursorPos; - ImVec2 CursorPosPrevLine; - ImVec2 CursorStartPos; - ImVec2 CursorMaxPos; // Implicitly calculate the size of our contents, always extending. Saved into window->SizeContents at the end of the frame - float CurrentLineHeight; - float CurrentLineTextBaseOffset; - float PrevLineHeight; - float PrevLineTextBaseOffset; - float LogLinePosY; - int TreeDepth; - ImGuiID LastItemId; - ImRect LastItemRect; - bool LastItemHoveredAndUsable; // Item rectangle is hovered, and its window is currently interactable with (not blocked by a popup preventing access to the window) - bool LastItemHoveredRect; // Item rectangle is hovered, but its window may or not be currently interactable with (might be blocked by a popup preventing access to the window) - bool MenuBarAppending; - float MenuBarOffsetX; - ImVector ChildWindows; - ImGuiStorage* StateStorage; - ImGuiLayoutType LayoutType; - - // We store the current settings outside of the vectors to increase memory locality (reduce cache misses). The vectors are rarely modified. Also it allows us to not heap allocate for short-lived windows which are not using those settings. - float ItemWidth; // == ItemWidthStack.back(). 0.0: default, >0.0: width in pixels, <0.0: align xx pixels to the right of window - float TextWrapPos; // == TextWrapPosStack.back() [empty == -1.0f] - bool AllowKeyboardFocus; // == AllowKeyboardFocusStack.back() [empty == true] - bool ButtonRepeat; // == ButtonRepeatStack.back() [empty == false] - ImVector ItemWidthStack; - ImVector TextWrapPosStack; - ImVector AllowKeyboardFocusStack; - ImVector ButtonRepeatStack; - ImVectorGroupStack; - ImGuiColorEditMode ColorEditMode; - int StackSizesBackup[6]; // Store size of various stacks for asserting - - float IndentX; // Indentation / start position from left of window (increased by TreePush/TreePop, etc.) - float GroupOffsetX; - float ColumnsOffsetX; // Offset to the current column (if ColumnsCurrent > 0). FIXME: This and the above should be a stack to allow use cases like Tree->Column->Tree. Need revamp columns API. - int ColumnsCurrent; - int ColumnsCount; - float ColumnsMinX; - float ColumnsMaxX; - float ColumnsStartPosY; - float ColumnsCellMinY; - float ColumnsCellMaxY; - bool ColumnsShowBorders; - ImGuiID ColumnsSetId; - ImVector ColumnsData; - - ImGuiDrawContext() - { - CursorPos = CursorPosPrevLine = CursorStartPos = CursorMaxPos = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - CurrentLineHeight = PrevLineHeight = 0.0f; - CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = PrevLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f; - LogLinePosY = -1.0f; - TreeDepth = 0; - LastItemId = 0; - LastItemRect = ImRect(0.0f,0.0f,0.0f,0.0f); - LastItemHoveredAndUsable = LastItemHoveredRect = false; - MenuBarAppending = false; - MenuBarOffsetX = 0.0f; - StateStorage = NULL; - LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical; - ItemWidth = 0.0f; - ButtonRepeat = false; - AllowKeyboardFocus = true; - TextWrapPos = -1.0f; - ColorEditMode = ImGuiColorEditMode_RGB; - memset(StackSizesBackup, 0, sizeof(StackSizesBackup)); - - IndentX = 0.0f; - GroupOffsetX = 0.0f; - ColumnsOffsetX = 0.0f; - ColumnsCurrent = 0; - ColumnsCount = 1; - ColumnsMinX = ColumnsMaxX = 0.0f; - ColumnsStartPosY = 0.0f; - ColumnsCellMinY = ColumnsCellMaxY = 0.0f; - ColumnsShowBorders = true; - ColumnsSetId = 0; - } -}; - -// Windows data -struct IMGUI_API ImGuiWindow -{ - char* Name; - ImGuiID ID; // == ImHash(Name) - ImGuiWindowFlags Flags; // See enum ImGuiWindowFlags_ - int IndexWithinParent; // Order within immediate parent window, if we are a child window. Otherwise 0. - ImVec2 PosFloat; - ImVec2 Pos; // Position rounded-up to nearest pixel - ImVec2 Size; // Current size (==SizeFull or collapsed title bar size) - ImVec2 SizeFull; // Size when non collapsed - ImVec2 SizeContents; // Size of contents (== extents reach of the drawing cursor) from previous frame - ImVec2 SizeContentsExplicit; // Size of contents explicitly set by the user via SetNextWindowContentSize() - ImRect ContentsRegionRect; // Maximum visible content position in window coordinates. ~~ (SizeContentsExplicit ? SizeContentsExplicit : Size - ScrollbarSizes) - CursorStartPos, per axis - ImVec2 WindowPadding; // Window padding at the time of begin. We need to lock it, in particular manipulation of the ShowBorder would have an effect - ImGuiID MoveId; // == window->GetID("#MOVE") - ImVec2 Scroll; - ImVec2 ScrollTarget; // target scroll position. stored as cursor position with scrolling canceled out, so the highest point is always 0.0f. (FLT_MAX for no change) - ImVec2 ScrollTargetCenterRatio; // 0.0f = scroll so that target position is at top, 0.5f = scroll so that target position is centered - bool ScrollbarX, ScrollbarY; - ImVec2 ScrollbarSizes; - float BorderSize; - bool Active; // Set to true on Begin() - bool WasActive; - bool Accessed; // Set to true when any widget access the current window - bool Collapsed; // Set when collapsing window to become only title-bar - bool SkipItems; // == Visible && !Collapsed - int BeginCount; // Number of Begin() during the current frame (generally 0 or 1, 1+ if appending via multiple Begin/End pairs) - ImGuiID PopupId; // ID in the popup stack when this window is used as a popup/menu (because we use generic Name/ID for recycling) - int AutoFitFramesX, AutoFitFramesY; - bool AutoFitOnlyGrows; - int AutoPosLastDirection; - int HiddenFrames; - int SetWindowPosAllowFlags; // bit ImGuiSetCond_*** specify if SetWindowPos() call will succeed with this particular flag. - int SetWindowSizeAllowFlags; // bit ImGuiSetCond_*** specify if SetWindowSize() call will succeed with this particular flag. - int SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags; // bit ImGuiSetCond_*** specify if SetWindowCollapsed() call will succeed with this particular flag. - bool SetWindowPosCenterWanted; - - ImGuiDrawContext DC; // Temporary per-window data, reset at the beginning of the frame - ImVector IDStack; // ID stack. ID are hashes seeded with the value at the top of the stack - ImRect ClipRect; // = DrawList->clip_rect_stack.back(). Scissoring / clipping rectangle. x1, y1, x2, y2. - ImRect WindowRectClipped; // = WindowRect just after setup in Begin(). == window->Rect() for root window. - int LastFrameActive; - float ItemWidthDefault; - ImGuiSimpleColumns MenuColumns; // Simplified columns storage for menu items - ImGuiStorage StateStorage; - float FontWindowScale; // Scale multiplier per-window - ImDrawList* DrawList; - ImGuiWindow* RootWindow; // If we are a child window, this is pointing to the first non-child parent window. Else point to ourself. - ImGuiWindow* RootNonPopupWindow; // If we are a child window, this is pointing to the first non-child non-popup parent window. Else point to ourself. - ImGuiWindow* ParentWindow; // If we are a child window, this is pointing to our parent window. Else point to NULL. - - // Navigation / Focus - int FocusIdxAllCounter; // Start at -1 and increase as assigned via FocusItemRegister() - int FocusIdxTabCounter; // (same, but only count widgets which you can Tab through) - int FocusIdxAllRequestCurrent; // Item being requested for focus - int FocusIdxTabRequestCurrent; // Tab-able item being requested for focus - int FocusIdxAllRequestNext; // Item being requested for focus, for next update (relies on layout to be stable between the frame pressing TAB and the next frame) - int FocusIdxTabRequestNext; // " - -public: - ImGuiWindow(const char* name); - ~ImGuiWindow(); - - ImGuiID GetID(const char* str, const char* str_end = NULL); - ImGuiID GetID(const void* ptr); - ImGuiID GetIDNoKeepAlive(const char* str, const char* str_end = NULL); - - ImRect Rect() const { return ImRect(Pos.x, Pos.y, Pos.x+Size.x, Pos.y+Size.y); } - float CalcFontSize() const { return GImGui->FontBaseSize * FontWindowScale; } - float TitleBarHeight() const { return (Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) ? 0.0f : CalcFontSize() + GImGui->Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f; } - ImRect TitleBarRect() const { return ImRect(Pos, ImVec2(Pos.x + SizeFull.x, Pos.y + TitleBarHeight())); } - float MenuBarHeight() const { return (Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) ? CalcFontSize() + GImGui->Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f : 0.0f; } - ImRect MenuBarRect() const { float y1 = Pos.y + TitleBarHeight(); return ImRect(Pos.x, y1, Pos.x + SizeFull.x, y1 + MenuBarHeight()); } -}; - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Internal API -// No guarantee of forward compatibility here. -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -namespace ImGui -{ - // We should always have a CurrentWindow in the stack (there is an implicit "Debug" window) - // If this ever crash because g.CurrentWindow is NULL it means that either - // - ImGui::NewFrame() has never been called, which is illegal. - // - You are calling ImGui functions after ImGui::Render() and before the next ImGui::NewFrame(), which is also illegal. - inline ImGuiWindow* GetCurrentWindowRead() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; return g.CurrentWindow; } - inline ImGuiWindow* GetCurrentWindow() { ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; g.CurrentWindow->Accessed = true; return g.CurrentWindow; } - IMGUI_API ImGuiWindow* GetParentWindow(); - IMGUI_API ImGuiWindow* FindWindowByName(const char* name); - IMGUI_API void FocusWindow(ImGuiWindow* window); - - IMGUI_API void EndFrame(); // Ends the ImGui frame. Automatically called by Render()! you most likely don't need to ever call that yourself directly. If you don't need to render you can call EndFrame() but you'll have wasted CPU already. If you don't need to render, don't create any windows instead! - - IMGUI_API void SetActiveID(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindow* window); - IMGUI_API void ClearActiveID(); - IMGUI_API void SetHoveredID(ImGuiID id); - IMGUI_API void KeepAliveID(ImGuiID id); - - IMGUI_API void ItemSize(const ImVec2& size, float text_offset_y = 0.0f); - IMGUI_API void ItemSize(const ImRect& bb, float text_offset_y = 0.0f); - IMGUI_API bool ItemAdd(const ImRect& bb, const ImGuiID* id); - IMGUI_API bool IsClippedEx(const ImRect& bb, const ImGuiID* id, bool clip_even_when_logged); - IMGUI_API bool IsHovered(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool flatten_childs = false); - IMGUI_API bool FocusableItemRegister(ImGuiWindow* window, bool is_active, bool tab_stop = true); // Return true if focus is requested - IMGUI_API void FocusableItemUnregister(ImGuiWindow* window); - IMGUI_API ImVec2 CalcItemSize(ImVec2 size, float default_x, float default_y); - IMGUI_API float CalcWrapWidthForPos(const ImVec2& pos, float wrap_pos_x); - - IMGUI_API void OpenPopupEx(const char* str_id, bool reopen_existing); - - // NB: All position are in absolute pixels coordinates (not window coordinates) - // FIXME: All those functions are a mess and needs to be refactored into something decent. AVOID USING OUTSIDE OF IMGUI.CPP! NOT FOR PUBLIC CONSUMPTION. - // We need: a sort of symbol library, preferably baked into font atlas when possible + decent text rendering helpers. - IMGUI_API void RenderText(ImVec2 pos, const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL, bool hide_text_after_hash = true); - IMGUI_API void RenderTextWrapped(ImVec2 pos, const char* text, const char* text_end, float wrap_width); - IMGUI_API void RenderTextClipped(const ImVec2& pos_min, const ImVec2& pos_max, const char* text, const char* text_end, const ImVec2* text_size_if_known, const ImVec2& align = ImVec2(0,0), const ImRect* clip_rect = NULL); - IMGUI_API void RenderFrame(ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, ImU32 fill_col, bool border = true, float rounding = 0.0f); - IMGUI_API void RenderCollapseTriangle(ImVec2 pos, bool is_open, float scale = 1.0f); - IMGUI_API void RenderBullet(ImVec2 pos); - IMGUI_API void RenderCheckMark(ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col); - IMGUI_API const char* FindRenderedTextEnd(const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL); // Find the optional ## from which we stop displaying text. - - IMGUI_API bool ButtonBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool* out_hovered, bool* out_held, ImGuiButtonFlags flags = 0); - IMGUI_API bool ButtonEx(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg = ImVec2(0,0), ImGuiButtonFlags flags = 0); - IMGUI_API bool CloseButton(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& pos, float radius); - - IMGUI_API bool SliderBehavior(const ImRect& frame_bb, ImGuiID id, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, float power, int decimal_precision, ImGuiSliderFlags flags = 0); - IMGUI_API bool SliderFloatN(const char* label, float* v, int components, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power); - IMGUI_API bool SliderIntN(const char* label, int* v, int components, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format); - - IMGUI_API bool DragBehavior(const ImRect& frame_bb, ImGuiID id, float* v, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, int decimal_precision, float power); - IMGUI_API bool DragFloatN(const char* label, float* v, int components, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power); - IMGUI_API bool DragIntN(const char* label, int* v, int components, float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format); - - IMGUI_API bool InputTextEx(const char* label, char* buf, int buf_size, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback = NULL, void* user_data = NULL); - IMGUI_API bool InputFloatN(const char* label, float* v, int components, int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags); - IMGUI_API bool InputIntN(const char* label, int* v, int components, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags); - IMGUI_API bool InputScalarEx(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, void* step_ptr, void* step_fast_ptr, const char* scalar_format, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags); - IMGUI_API bool InputScalarAsWidgetReplacement(const ImRect& aabb, const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, ImGuiID id, int decimal_precision); - - IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* label, const char* label_end = NULL); - IMGUI_API bool TreeNodeBehaviorIsOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags = 0); // Consume previous SetNextTreeNodeOpened() data, if any. May return true when logging - IMGUI_API void TreePushRawID(ImGuiID id); - - IMGUI_API void PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType plot_type, const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size); - - IMGUI_API int ParseFormatPrecision(const char* fmt, int default_value); - IMGUI_API float RoundScalar(float value, int decimal_precision); - -} // namespace ImGui - -#ifdef __clang__ -#pragma clang diagnostic pop -#endif - -#ifdef _MSC_VER -#pragma warning (pop) -#endif diff --git a/src/config.cpp b/src/config.cpp index faca1bd..2723f95 100644 --- a/src/config.cpp +++ b/src/config.cpp @@ -78,6 +78,7 @@ struct { tbf::ParameterBool* dump; tbf::ParameterInt* cache_size; tbf::ParameterInt* worker_threads; + tbf::ParameterBool* show_loading_text; } textures; @@ -251,6 +252,16 @@ TBF_LoadConfig (std::wstring name) L"Texture.System", L"WorkerThreads" ); + textures.show_loading_text = + static_cast + (g_ParameterFactory.create_parameter ( + L"Show a loading indicator in OSD") + ); + textures.show_loading_text->register_to_ini ( + render_ini, + L"Texture.System", + L"ShowLoadingIndicator" ); + render.dump_shaders = static_cast @@ -354,7 +365,7 @@ TBF_LoadConfig (std::wstring name) render_ini->parse (); } - input.gamepad.texture_set->load (config.input.gamepad.texture_set); + input.gamepad.texture_set->load (config.input.gamepad.texture_set); render.rescale_shadows->load (config.render.shadow_rescale); render.rescale_env_shadows->load (config.render.env_shadow_rescale); @@ -363,13 +374,14 @@ TBF_LoadConfig (std::wstring name) framerate.replace_limiter->load (config.framerate.replace_limiter); - textures.remaster->load (config.textures.remaster); - textures.uncompressed->load (config.textures.uncompressed); - textures.lod_bias->load (config.textures.lod_bias); - textures.cache->load (config.textures.cache); - textures.dump->load (config.textures.dump); - textures.cache_size->load (config.textures.max_cache_in_mib); - textures.worker_threads->load (config.textures.worker_threads); + textures.remaster->load (config.textures.remaster); + textures.uncompressed->load (config.textures.uncompressed); + textures.lod_bias->load (config.textures.lod_bias); + textures.cache->load (config.textures.cache); + textures.dump->load (config.textures.dump); + textures.cache_size->load (config.textures.max_cache_in_mib); + textures.worker_threads->load (config.textures.worker_threads); + textures.show_loading_text->load (config.textures.show_loading_text); if (empty) return false; @@ -392,13 +404,14 @@ TBF_SaveConfig (std::wstring name, bool close_config) render.rescale_shadows->store (config.render.shadow_rescale); render.rescale_env_shadows->store (config.render.env_shadow_rescale); - textures.remaster->store (config.textures.remaster); - textures.uncompressed->store (config.textures.uncompressed); - textures.lod_bias->store (config.textures.lod_bias); - textures.cache->store (config.textures.cache); - textures.dump->store (config.textures.dump); - textures.cache_size->store (config.textures.max_cache_in_mib); - textures.worker_threads->store (config.textures.worker_threads); + textures.remaster->store (config.textures.remaster); + textures.uncompressed->store (config.textures.uncompressed); + textures.lod_bias->store (config.textures.lod_bias); + textures.cache->store (config.textures.cache); + textures.dump->store (config.textures.dump); + textures.cache_size->store (config.textures.max_cache_in_mib); + textures.worker_threads->store (config.textures.worker_threads); + textures.show_loading_text->store (config.textures.show_loading_text); input.gamepad.texture_set->store (config.input.gamepad.texture_set); diff --git a/src/imgui/LICENSE b/src/imgui/LICENSE deleted file mode 100644 index b28ef22..0000000 --- a/src/imgui/LICENSE +++ /dev/null @@ -1,21 +0,0 @@ -The MIT License (MIT) - -Copyright (c) 2014-2015 Omar Cornut and ImGui contributors - -Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy -of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal -in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the rights -to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell -copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is -furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions: - -The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all -copies or substantial portions of the Software. - -THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR -IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, -FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE -AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER -LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, -OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE -SOFTWARE. diff --git a/src/imgui/imgui.cpp b/src/imgui/imgui.cpp deleted file mode 100644 index 1790760..0000000 --- a/src/imgui/imgui.cpp +++ /dev/null @@ -1,9856 +0,0 @@ -// dear imgui, v1.50 WIP -// (main code and documentation) - -// See ImGui::ShowTestWindow() in imgui_demo.cpp for demo code. -// Newcomers, read 'Programmer guide' below for notes on how to setup ImGui in your codebase. -// Get latest version at https://github.com/ocornut/imgui -// Releases change-log at https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/releases -// Gallery (please post your screenshots/video there!): https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/772 -// Developed by Omar Cornut and every direct or indirect contributors to the GitHub. -// This library is free but I need your support to sustain development and maintenance. -// If you work for a company, please consider financial support, e.g: https://www.patreon.com/imgui - -/* - - Index - - MISSION STATEMENT - - END-USER GUIDE - - PROGRAMMER GUIDE (read me!) - - API BREAKING CHANGES (read me when you update!) - - FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS (FAQ), TIPS - - How can I help? - - How do I update to a newer version of ImGui? - - What is ImTextureID and how do I display an image? - - I integrated ImGui in my engine and the text or lines are blurry.. - - I integrated ImGui in my engine and some elements are clipping or disappearing when I move windows around.. - - How can I have multiple widgets with the same label? Can I have widget without a label? (Yes). A primer on the purpose of labels/IDs. - - How can I tell when ImGui wants my mouse/keyboard inputs and when I can pass them to my application? - - How can I load a different font than the default? - - How can I easily use icons in my application? - - How can I load multiple fonts? - - How can I display and input non-latin characters such as Chinese, Japanese, Korean, Cyrillic? - - How can I use the drawing facilities without an ImGui window? (using ImDrawList API) - - ISSUES & TODO-LIST - - CODE - - - MISSION STATEMENT - ================= - - - easy to use to create code-driven and data-driven tools - - easy to use to create ad hoc short-lived tools and long-lived, more elaborate tools - - easy to hack and improve - - minimize screen real-estate usage - - minimize setup and maintenance - - minimize state storage on user side - - portable, minimize dependencies, run on target (consoles, phones, etc.) - - efficient runtime (NB- we do allocate when "growing" content - creating a window / opening a tree node for the first time, etc. - but a typical frame won't allocate anything) - - read about immediate-mode gui principles @ http://mollyrocket.com/861, http://mollyrocket.com/forums/index.html - - Designed for developers and content-creators, not the typical end-user! Some of the weaknesses includes: - - doesn't look fancy, doesn't animate - - limited layout features, intricate layouts are typically crafted in code - - occasionally uses statically sized buffers for string manipulations - won't crash, but some very long pieces of text may be clipped. functions like ImGui::TextUnformatted() don't have such restriction. - - - END-USER GUIDE - ============== - - - double-click title bar to collapse window - - click upper right corner to close a window, available when 'bool* p_open' is passed to ImGui::Begin() - - click and drag on lower right corner to resize window - - click and drag on any empty space to move window - - double-click/double-tap on lower right corner grip to auto-fit to content - - TAB/SHIFT+TAB to cycle through keyboard editable fields - - use mouse wheel to scroll - - use CTRL+mouse wheel to zoom window contents (if IO.FontAllowScaling is true) - - CTRL+Click on a slider or drag box to input value as text - - text editor: - - Hold SHIFT or use mouse to select text. - - CTRL+Left/Right to word jump - - CTRL+Shift+Left/Right to select words - - CTRL+A our Double-Click to select all - - CTRL+X,CTRL+C,CTRL+V to use OS clipboard - - CTRL+Z,CTRL+Y to undo/redo - - ESCAPE to revert text to its original value - - You can apply arithmetic operators +,*,/ on numerical values. Use +- to subtract (because - would set a negative value!) - - - PROGRAMMER GUIDE - ================ - - - read the FAQ below this section! - - your code creates the UI, if your code doesn't run the UI is gone! == very dynamic UI, no construction/destructions steps, less data retention on your side, no state duplication, less sync, less bugs. - - call and read ImGui::ShowTestWindow() for demo code demonstrating most features. - - see examples/ folder for standalone sample applications. Prefer reading examples/opengl2_example/ first as it is the simplest. - you may be able to grab and copy a ready made imgui_impl_*** file from the examples/. - - customization: PushStyleColor()/PushStyleVar() or the style editor to tweak the look of the interface (e.g. if you want a more compact UI or a different color scheme). - - - getting started: - - init: call ImGui::GetIO() to retrieve the ImGuiIO structure and fill the fields marked 'Settings'. - - init: call io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32(...) and load the font texture pixels into graphics memory. - - every frame: - 1/ in your mainloop or right after you got your keyboard/mouse info, call ImGui::GetIO() and fill the fields marked 'Input' - 2/ call ImGui::NewFrame() as early as you can! - 3/ use any ImGui function you want between NewFrame() and Render() - 4/ call ImGui::Render() as late as you can to end the frame and finalize render data. it will call your RenderDrawListFn handler that you set in the IO structure. - (if you don't need to render, you still need to call Render() and ignore the callback, or call EndFrame() instead. if you call neither some aspects of windows focusing/moving will appear broken.) - - all rendering information are stored into command-lists until ImGui::Render() is called. - - ImGui never touches or know about your GPU state. the only function that knows about GPU is the RenderDrawListFn handler that you provide. - - effectively it means you can create widgets at any time in your code, regardless of considerations of being in "update" vs "render" phases of your own application. - - refer to the examples applications in the examples/ folder for instruction on how to setup your code. - - a typical application skeleton may be: - - // Application init - ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); - io.DisplaySize.x = 1920.0f; - io.DisplaySize.y = 1280.0f; - io.IniFilename = "imgui.ini"; - io.RenderDrawListsFn = my_render_function; // Setup a render function, or set to NULL and call GetDrawData() after Render() to access the render data. - // TODO: Fill others settings of the io structure - - // Load texture atlas - // There is a default font so you don't need to care about choosing a font yet - unsigned char* pixels; - int width, height; - io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32(pixels, &width, &height); - // TODO: At this points you've got a texture pointed to by 'pixels' and you need to upload that your your graphic system - // TODO: Store your texture pointer/identifier (whatever your engine uses) in 'io.Fonts->TexID' - - // Application main loop - while (true) - { - // 1) get low-level inputs (e.g. on Win32, GetKeyboardState(), or poll your events, etc.) - // TODO: fill all fields of IO structure and call NewFrame - ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); - io.DeltaTime = 1.0f/60.0f; - io.MousePos = mouse_pos; - io.MouseDown[0] = mouse_button_0; - io.MouseDown[1] = mouse_button_1; - io.KeysDown[i] = ... - - // 2) call NewFrame(), after this point you can use ImGui::* functions anytime - ImGui::NewFrame(); - - // 3) most of your application code here - MyGameUpdate(); // may use any ImGui functions, e.g. ImGui::Begin("My window"); ImGui::Text("Hello, world!"); ImGui::End(); - MyGameRender(); // may use any ImGui functions - - // 4) render & swap video buffers - ImGui::Render(); - SwapBuffers(); - } - - - You can read back 'io.WantCaptureMouse', 'io.WantCaptureKeybord' etc. flags from the IO structure to tell how ImGui intends to use your - inputs and to know if you should share them or hide them from the rest of your application. Read the FAQ below for more information. - - - API BREAKING CHANGES - ==================== - - Occasionally introducing changes that are breaking the API. The breakage are generally minor and easy to fix. - Here is a change-log of API breaking changes, if you are using one of the functions listed, expect to have to fix some code. - Also read releases logs https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/releases for more details. - - - 2016/11/06 (1.50) - BeginChild(const char*) now applies the stack id to the provided label, consistently with other functions as it should always have been. It shouldn't affect you unless (extremely unlikely) you were appending multiple times to a same child from different locations of the stack id. If that's the case, generate an id with GetId() and use it instead of passing string to BeginChild(). - - 2016/10/15 (1.50) - avoid 'void* user_data' parameter to io.SetClipboardTextFn/io.GetClipboardTextFn pointers. We pass io.ClipboardUserData to it. - - 2016/09/25 (1.50) - style.WindowTitleAlign is now a ImVec2 (ImGuiAlign enum was removed). set to (0.5f,0.5f) for horizontal+vertical centering, (0.0f,0.0f) for upper-left, etc. - - 2016/07/30 (1.50) - SameLine(x) with x>0.0f is now relative to left of column/group if any, and not always to left of window. This was sort of always the intent and hopefully breakage should be minimal. - - 2016/05/12 (1.49) - title bar (using ImGuiCol_TitleBg/ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive colors) isn't rendered over a window background (ImGuiCol_WindowBg color) anymore. - If your TitleBg/TitleBgActive alpha was 1.0f or you are using the default theme it will not affect you. - However if your TitleBg/TitleBgActive alpha was <1.0f you need to tweak your custom theme to readjust for the fact that we don't draw a WindowBg background behind the title bar. - This helper function will convert an old TitleBg/TitleBgActive color into a new one with the same visual output, given the OLD color and the OLD WindowBg color. - ImVec4 ConvertTitleBgCol(const ImVec4& win_bg_col, const ImVec4& title_bg_col) - { - float new_a = 1.0f - ((1.0f - win_bg_col.w) * (1.0f - title_bg_col.w)), k = title_bg_col.w / new_a; - return ImVec4((win_bg_col.x * win_bg_col.w + title_bg_col.x) * k, (win_bg_col.y * win_bg_col.w + title_bg_col.y) * k, (win_bg_col.z * win_bg_col.w + title_bg_col.z) * k, new_a); - } - If this is confusing, pick the RGB value from title bar from an old screenshot and apply this as TitleBg/TitleBgActive. Or you may just create TitleBgActive from a tweaked TitleBg color. - - 2016/05/07 (1.49) - removed confusing set of GetInternalState(), GetInternalStateSize(), SetInternalState() functions. Now using CreateContext(), DestroyContext(), GetCurrentContext(), SetCurrentContext(). - - 2016/05/02 (1.49) - renamed SetNextTreeNodeOpened() to SetNextTreeNodeOpen(), no redirection. - - 2016/05/01 (1.49) - obsoleted old signature of CollapsingHeader(const char* label, const char* str_id = NULL, bool display_frame = true, bool default_open = false) as extra parameters were badly designed and rarely used. You can replace the "default_open = true" flag in new API with CollapsingHeader(label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen). - - 2016/04/26 (1.49) - changed ImDrawList::PushClipRect(ImVec4 rect) to ImDraw::PushClipRect(Imvec2 min,ImVec2 max,bool intersect_with_current_clip_rect=false). Note that higher-level ImGui::PushClipRect() is preferable because it will clip at logic/widget level, whereas ImDrawList::PushClipRect() only affect your renderer. - - 2016/04/03 (1.48) - removed style.WindowFillAlphaDefault setting which was redundant. Bake default BG alpha inside style.Colors[ImGuiCol_WindowBg] and all other Bg color values. (ref github issue #337). - - 2016/04/03 (1.48) - renamed ImGuiCol_TooltipBg to ImGuiCol_PopupBg, used by popups/menus and tooltips. popups/menus were previously using ImGuiCol_WindowBg. (ref github issue #337) - - 2016/03/21 (1.48) - renamed GetWindowFont() to GetFont(), GetWindowFontSize() to GetFontSize(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). - - 2016/03/02 (1.48) - InputText() completion/history/always callbacks: if you modify the text buffer manually (without using DeleteChars()/InsertChars() helper) you need to maintain the BufTextLen field. added an assert. - - 2016/01/23 (1.48) - fixed not honoring exact width passed to PushItemWidth(), previously it would add extra FramePadding.x*2 over that width. if you had manual pixel-perfect alignment in place it might affect you. - - 2015/12/27 (1.48) - fixed ImDrawList::AddRect() which used to render a rectangle 1 px too large on each axis. - - 2015/12/04 (1.47) - renamed Color() helpers to ValueColor() - dangerously named, rarely used and probably to be made obsolete. - - 2015/08/29 (1.45) - with the addition of horizontal scrollbar we made various fixes to inconsistencies with dealing with cursor position. - GetCursorPos()/SetCursorPos() functions now include the scrolled amount. It shouldn't affect the majority of users, but take note that SetCursorPosX(100.0f) puts you at +100 from the starting x position which may include scrolling, not at +100 from the window left side. - GetContentRegionMax()/GetWindowContentRegionMin()/GetWindowContentRegionMax() functions allow include the scrolled amount. Typically those were used in cases where no scrolling would happen so it may not be a problem, but watch out! - - 2015/08/29 (1.45) - renamed style.ScrollbarWidth to style.ScrollbarSize - - 2015/08/05 (1.44) - split imgui.cpp into extra files: imgui_demo.cpp imgui_draw.cpp imgui_internal.h that you need to add to your project. - - 2015/07/18 (1.44) - fixed angles in ImDrawList::PathArcTo(), PathArcToFast() (introduced in 1.43) being off by an extra PI for no justifiable reason - - 2015/07/14 (1.43) - add new ImFontAtlas::AddFont() API. For the old AddFont***, moved the 'font_no' parameter of ImFontAtlas::AddFont** functions to the ImFontConfig structure. - you need to render your textured triangles with bilinear filtering to benefit from sub-pixel positioning of text. - - 2015/07/08 (1.43) - switched rendering data to use indexed rendering. this is saving a fair amount of CPU/GPU and enables us to get anti-aliasing for a marginal cost. - this necessary change will break your rendering function! the fix should be very easy. sorry for that :( - - if you are using a vanilla copy of one of the imgui_impl_XXXX.cpp provided in the example, you just need to update your copy and you can ignore the rest. - - the signature of the io.RenderDrawListsFn handler has changed! - ImGui_XXXX_RenderDrawLists(ImDrawList** const cmd_lists, int cmd_lists_count) - became: - ImGui_XXXX_RenderDrawLists(ImDrawData* draw_data). - argument 'cmd_lists' -> 'draw_data->CmdLists' - argument 'cmd_lists_count' -> 'draw_data->CmdListsCount' - ImDrawList 'commands' -> 'CmdBuffer' - ImDrawList 'vtx_buffer' -> 'VtxBuffer' - ImDrawList n/a -> 'IdxBuffer' (new) - ImDrawCmd 'vtx_count' -> 'ElemCount' - ImDrawCmd 'clip_rect' -> 'ClipRect' - ImDrawCmd 'user_callback' -> 'UserCallback' - ImDrawCmd 'texture_id' -> 'TextureId' - - each ImDrawList now contains both a vertex buffer and an index buffer. For each command, render ElemCount/3 triangles using indices from the index buffer. - - if you REALLY cannot render indexed primitives, you can call the draw_data->DeIndexAllBuffers() method to de-index the buffers. This is slow and a waste of CPU/GPU. Prefer using indexed rendering! - - refer to code in the examples/ folder or ask on the GitHub if you are unsure of how to upgrade. please upgrade! - - 2015/07/10 (1.43) - changed SameLine() parameters from int to float. - - 2015/07/02 (1.42) - renamed SetScrollPosHere() to SetScrollFromCursorPos(). Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). - - 2015/07/02 (1.42) - renamed GetScrollPosY() to GetScrollY(). Necessary to reduce confusion along with other scrolling functions, because positions (e.g. cursor position) are not equivalent to scrolling amount. - - 2015/06/14 (1.41) - changed ImageButton() default bg_col parameter from (0,0,0,1) (black) to (0,0,0,0) (transparent) - makes a difference when texture have transparence - - 2015/06/14 (1.41) - changed Selectable() API from (label, selected, size) to (label, selected, flags, size). Size override should have been rarely be used. Sorry! - - 2015/05/31 (1.40) - renamed GetWindowCollapsed() to IsWindowCollapsed() for consistency. Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). - - 2015/05/31 (1.40) - renamed IsRectClipped() to IsRectVisible() for consistency. Note that return value is opposite! Kept inline redirection function (will obsolete). - - 2015/05/27 (1.40) - removed the third 'repeat_if_held' parameter from Button() - sorry! it was rarely used and inconsistent. Use PushButtonRepeat(true) / PopButtonRepeat() to enable repeat on desired buttons. - - 2015/05/11 (1.40) - changed BeginPopup() API, takes a string identifier instead of a bool. ImGui needs to manage the open/closed state of popups. Call OpenPopup() to actually set the "open" state of a popup. BeginPopup() returns true if the popup is opened. - - 2015/05/03 (1.40) - removed style.AutoFitPadding, using style.WindowPadding makes more sense (the default values were already the same). - - 2015/04/13 (1.38) - renamed IsClipped() to IsRectClipped(). Kept inline redirection function until 1.50. - - 2015/04/09 (1.38) - renamed ImDrawList::AddArc() to ImDrawList::AddArcFast() for compatibility with future API - - 2015/04/03 (1.38) - removed ImGuiCol_CheckHovered, ImGuiCol_CheckActive, replaced with the more general ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered, ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive. - - 2014/04/03 (1.38) - removed support for passing -FLT_MAX..+FLT_MAX as the range for a SliderFloat(). Use DragFloat() or Inputfloat() instead. - - 2015/03/17 (1.36) - renamed GetItemBoxMin()/GetItemBoxMax()/IsMouseHoveringBox() to GetItemRectMin()/GetItemRectMax()/IsMouseHoveringRect(). Kept inline redirection function until 1.50. - - 2015/03/15 (1.36) - renamed style.TreeNodeSpacing to style.IndentSpacing, ImGuiStyleVar_TreeNodeSpacing to ImGuiStyleVar_IndentSpacing - - 2015/03/13 (1.36) - renamed GetWindowIsFocused() to IsWindowFocused(). Kept inline redirection function until 1.50. - - 2015/03/08 (1.35) - renamed style.ScrollBarWidth to style.ScrollbarWidth (casing) - - 2015/02/27 (1.34) - renamed OpenNextNode(bool) to SetNextTreeNodeOpened(bool, ImGuiSetCond). Kept inline redirection function until 1.50. - - 2015/02/27 (1.34) - renamed ImGuiSetCondition_*** to ImGuiSetCond_***, and _FirstUseThisSession becomes _Once. - - 2015/02/11 (1.32) - changed text input callback ImGuiTextEditCallback return type from void-->int. reserved for future use, return 0 for now. - - 2015/02/10 (1.32) - renamed GetItemWidth() to CalcItemWidth() to clarify its evolving behavior - - 2015/02/08 (1.31) - renamed GetTextLineSpacing() to GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() - - 2015/02/01 (1.31) - removed IO.MemReallocFn (unused) - - 2015/01/19 (1.30) - renamed ImGuiStorage::GetIntPtr()/GetFloatPtr() to GetIntRef()/GetIntRef() because Ptr was conflicting with actual pointer storage functions. - - 2015/01/11 (1.30) - big font/image API change! now loads TTF file. allow for multiple fonts. no need for a PNG loader. - (1.30) - removed GetDefaultFontData(). uses io.Fonts->GetTextureData*() API to retrieve uncompressed pixels. - this sequence: - const void* png_data; - unsigned int png_size; - ImGui::GetDefaultFontData(NULL, NULL, &png_data, &png_size); - // - became: - unsigned char* pixels; - int width, height; - io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32(&pixels, &width, &height); - // - io.Fonts->TexID = (your_texture_identifier); - you now have much more flexibility to load multiple TTF fonts and manage the texture buffer for internal needs. - it is now recommended that you sample the font texture with bilinear interpolation. - (1.30) - added texture identifier in ImDrawCmd passed to your render function (we can now render images). make sure to set io.Fonts->TexID. - (1.30) - removed IO.PixelCenterOffset (unnecessary, can be handled in user projection matrix) - (1.30) - removed ImGui::IsItemFocused() in favor of ImGui::IsItemActive() which handles all widgets - - 2014/12/10 (1.18) - removed SetNewWindowDefaultPos() in favor of new generic API SetNextWindowPos(pos, ImGuiSetCondition_FirstUseEver) - - 2014/11/28 (1.17) - moved IO.Font*** options to inside the IO.Font-> structure (FontYOffset, FontTexUvForWhite, FontBaseScale, FontFallbackGlyph) - - 2014/11/26 (1.17) - reworked syntax of IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME helper macro to increase compiler compatibility - - 2014/11/07 (1.15) - renamed IsHovered() to IsItemHovered() - - 2014/10/02 (1.14) - renamed IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_CPP to IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_INL and imgui_user.cpp to imgui_user.inl (more IDE friendly) - - 2014/09/25 (1.13) - removed 'text_end' parameter from IO.SetClipboardTextFn (the string is now always zero-terminated for simplicity) - - 2014/09/24 (1.12) - renamed SetFontScale() to SetWindowFontScale() - - 2014/09/24 (1.12) - moved IM_MALLOC/IM_REALLOC/IM_FREE preprocessor defines to IO.MemAllocFn/IO.MemReallocFn/IO.MemFreeFn - - 2014/08/30 (1.09) - removed IO.FontHeight (now computed automatically) - - 2014/08/30 (1.09) - moved IMGUI_FONT_TEX_UV_FOR_WHITE preprocessor define to IO.FontTexUvForWhite - - 2014/08/28 (1.09) - changed the behavior of IO.PixelCenterOffset following various rendering fixes - - - FREQUENTLY ASKED QUESTIONS (FAQ), TIPS - ====================================== - - Q: How can I help? - A: - If you are experienced enough with ImGui and with C/C++, look at the todo list and see how you want/can help! - - Become a Patron/donate. Convince your company to become a Patron or provide serious funding for development time. - - Q: How do I update to a newer version of ImGui? - A: Overwrite the following files: - imgui.cpp - imgui.h - imgui_demo.cpp - imgui_draw.cpp - imgui_internal.h - stb_rect_pack.h - stb_textedit.h - stb_truetype.h - Don't overwrite imconfig.h if you have made modification to your copy. - Check the "API BREAKING CHANGES" sections for a list of occasional API breaking changes. If you have a problem with a function, search for its name - in the code, there will likely be a comment about it. Please report any issue to the GitHub page! - - Q: What is ImTextureID and how do I display an image? - A: ImTextureID is a void* used to pass renderer-agnostic texture references around until it hits your render function. - ImGui knows nothing about what those bits represent, it just passes them around. It is up to you to decide what you want the void* to carry! - It could be an identifier to your OpenGL texture (cast GLuint to void*), a pointer to your custom engine material (cast MyMaterial* to void*), etc. - At the end of the chain, your renderer takes this void* to cast it back into whatever it needs to select a current texture to render. - Refer to examples applications, where each renderer (in a imgui_impl_xxxx.cpp file) is treating ImTextureID as a different thing. - (c++ tip: OpenGL uses integers to identify textures. You can safely store an integer into a void*, just cast it to void*, don't take it's address!) - To display a custom image/texture within an ImGui window, you may use ImGui::Image(), ImGui::ImageButton(), ImDrawList::AddImage() functions. - ImGui will generate the geometry and draw calls using the ImTextureID that you passed and which your renderer can use. - It is your responsibility to get textures uploaded to your GPU. - - Q: I integrated ImGui in my engine and the text or lines are blurry.. - A: In your Render function, try translating your projection matrix by (0.5f,0.5f) or (0.375f,0.375f). - Also make sure your orthographic projection matrix and io.DisplaySize matches your actual framebuffer dimension. - - Q: I integrated ImGui in my engine and some elements are clipping or disappearing when I move windows around.. - A: Most likely you are mishandling the clipping rectangles in your render function. Rectangles provided by ImGui are defined as (x1=left,y1=top,x2=right,y2=bottom) and NOT as (x1,y1,width,height). - - Q: Can I have multiple widgets with the same label? Can I have widget without a label? (Yes) - A: Yes. A primer on the use of labels/IDs in ImGui.. - - - Elements that are not clickable, such as Text() items don't need an ID. - - - Interactive widgets require state to be carried over multiple frames (most typically ImGui often needs to remember what is the "active" widget). - to do so they need a unique ID. unique ID are typically derived from a string label, an integer index or a pointer. - - Button("OK"); // Label = "OK", ID = hash of "OK" - Button("Cancel"); // Label = "Cancel", ID = hash of "Cancel" - - - ID are uniquely scoped within windows, tree nodes, etc. so no conflict can happen if you have two buttons called "OK" in two different windows - or in two different locations of a tree. - - - If you have a same ID twice in the same location, you'll have a conflict: - - Button("OK"); - Button("OK"); // ID collision! Both buttons will be treated as the same. - - Fear not! this is easy to solve and there are many ways to solve it! - - - When passing a label you can optionally specify extra unique ID information within string itself. This helps solving the simpler collision cases. - use "##" to pass a complement to the ID that won't be visible to the end-user: - - Button("Play"); // Label = "Play", ID = hash of "Play" - Button("Play##foo1"); // Label = "Play", ID = hash of "Play##foo1" (different from above) - Button("Play##foo2"); // Label = "Play", ID = hash of "Play##foo2" (different from above) - - - If you want to completely hide the label, but still need an ID: - - Checkbox("##On", &b); // Label = "", ID = hash of "##On" (no label!) - - - Occasionally/rarely you might want change a label while preserving a constant ID. This allows you to animate labels. - For example you may want to include varying information in a window title bar (and windows are uniquely identified by their ID.. obviously) - Use "###" to pass a label that isn't part of ID: - - Button("Hello###ID"; // Label = "Hello", ID = hash of "ID" - Button("World###ID"; // Label = "World", ID = hash of "ID" (same as above) - - sprintf(buf, "My game (%f FPS)###MyGame"); - Begin(buf); // Variable label, ID = hash of "MyGame" - - - Use PushID() / PopID() to create scopes and avoid ID conflicts within the same Window. - This is the most convenient way of distinguishing ID if you are iterating and creating many UI elements. - You can push a pointer, a string or an integer value. Remember that ID are formed from the concatenation of everything in the ID stack! - - for (int i = 0; i < 100; i++) - { - PushID(i); - Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of integer + "label" (unique) - PopID(); - } - - for (int i = 0; i < 100; i++) - { - MyObject* obj = Objects[i]; - PushID(obj); - Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of pointer + "label" (unique) - PopID(); - } - - for (int i = 0; i < 100; i++) - { - MyObject* obj = Objects[i]; - PushID(obj->Name); - Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of string + "label" (unique) - PopID(); - } - - - More example showing that you can stack multiple prefixes into the ID stack: - - Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of "Click" - PushID("node"); - Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of "node" + "Click" - PushID(my_ptr); - Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of "node" + ptr + "Click" - PopID(); - PopID(); - - - Tree nodes implicitly creates a scope for you by calling PushID(). - - Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of "Click" - if (TreeNode("node")) - { - Button("Click"); // Label = "Click", ID = hash of "node" + "Click" - TreePop(); - } - - - When working with trees, ID are used to preserve the open/close state of each tree node. - Depending on your use cases you may want to use strings, indices or pointers as ID. - e.g. when displaying a single object that may change over time (1-1 relationship), using a static string as ID will preserve your node open/closed state when the targeted object change. - e.g. when displaying a list of objects, using indices or pointers as ID will preserve the node open/closed state differently. experiment and see what makes more sense! - - Q: How can I tell when ImGui wants my mouse/keyboard inputs and when I can pass them to my application? - A: You can read the 'io.WantCaptureXXX' flags in the ImGuiIO structure. Preferably read them after calling ImGui::NewFrame() to avoid those flags lagging by one frame, but either should be fine. - When 'io.WantCaptureMouse' or 'io.WantCaptureKeyboard' flags are set you may want to discard/hide the inputs from the rest of your application. - When 'io.WantInputsCharacters' is set to may want to notify your OS to popup an on-screen keyboard, if available. - ImGui is tracking dragging and widget activity that may occur outside the boundary of a window, so 'io.WantCaptureMouse' is a more accurate and complete than testing for ImGui::IsMouseHoveringAnyWindow(). - (Advanced note: text input releases focus on Return 'KeyDown', so the following Return 'KeyUp' event that your application receive will typically have 'io.WantcaptureKeyboard=false'. - Depending on your application logic it may or not be inconvenient. You might want to track which key-downs were for ImGui (e.g. with an array of bool) and filter out the corresponding key-ups.) - - Q: How can I load a different font than the default? (default is an embedded version of ProggyClean.ttf, rendered at size 13) - A: Use the font atlas to load the TTF file you want: - - ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); - io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("myfontfile.ttf", size_in_pixels); - io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32() or GetTexDataAsAlpha8() - - Q: How can I easily use icons in my application? - A: The most convenient and practical way is to merge an icon font such as FontAwesome inside you main font. Then you can refer to icons within your strings. - Read 'How can I load multiple fonts?' and the file 'extra_fonts/README.txt' for instructions. - - Q: How can I load multiple fonts? - A: Use the font atlas to pack them into a single texture: - (Read extra_fonts/README.txt and the code in ImFontAtlas for more details.) - - ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); - ImFont* font0 = io.Fonts->AddFontDefault(); - ImFont* font1 = io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("myfontfile.ttf", size_in_pixels); - ImFont* font2 = io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("myfontfile2.ttf", size_in_pixels); - io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32() or GetTexDataAsAlpha8() - // the first loaded font gets used by default - // use ImGui::PushFont()/ImGui::PopFont() to change the font at runtime - - // Options - ImFontConfig config; - config.OversampleH = 3; - config.OversampleV = 1; - config.GlyphExtraSpacing.x = 1.0f; - io.Fonts->LoadFromFileTTF("myfontfile.ttf", size_pixels, &config); - - // Combine multiple fonts into one (e.g. for icon fonts) - ImWchar ranges[] = { 0xf000, 0xf3ff, 0 }; - ImFontConfig config; - config.MergeMode = true; - io.Fonts->AddFontDefault(); - io.Fonts->LoadFromFileTTF("fontawesome-webfont.ttf", 16.0f, &config, ranges); // Merge icon font - io.Fonts->LoadFromFileTTF("myfontfile.ttf", size_pixels, NULL, &config, io.Fonts->GetGlyphRangesJapanese()); // Merge japanese glyphs - - Q: How can I display and input non-Latin characters such as Chinese, Japanese, Korean, Cyrillic? - A: When loading a font, pass custom Unicode ranges to specify the glyphs to load. - All your strings needs to use UTF-8 encoding. Specifying literal in your source code using a local code page (such as CP-923 for Japanese or CP-1251 for Cyrillic) will not work. - In C++11 you can encode a string literal in UTF-8 by using the u8"hello" syntax. Otherwise you can convert yourself to UTF-8 or load text data from file already saved as UTF-8. - You can also try to remap your local codepage characters to their Unicode codepoint using font->AddRemapChar(), but international users may have problems reading/editing your source code. - - io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("myfontfile.ttf", size_in_pixels, NULL, io.Fonts->GetGlyphRangesJapanese()); // Load Japanese characters - io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32() or GetTexDataAsAlpha8() - io.ImeWindowHandle = MY_HWND; // To input using Microsoft IME, give ImGui the hwnd of your application - - As for text input, depends on you passing the right character code to io.AddInputCharacter(). The example applications do that. - - Q: How can I use the drawing facilities without an ImGui window? (using ImDrawList API) - A: The easiest way is to create a dummy window. Call Begin() with NoTitleBar|NoResize|NoMove|NoScrollbar|NoSavedSettings|NoInputs flag, zero background alpha, - then retrieve the ImDrawList* via GetWindowDrawList() and draw to it in any way you like. - - - tip: the construct 'IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME { ... }' will run the block of code only once a frame. You can use it to quickly add custom UI in the middle of a deep nested inner loop in your code. - - tip: you can create widgets without a Begin()/End() block, they will go in an implicit window called "Debug" - - tip: you can call Begin() multiple times with the same name during the same frame, it will keep appending to the same window. this is also useful to set yourself in the context of another window (to get/set other settings) - - tip: you can call Render() multiple times (e.g for VR renders). - - tip: call and read the ShowTestWindow() code in imgui_demo.cpp for more example of how to use ImGui! - - - ISSUES & TODO-LIST - ================== - Issue numbers (#) refer to github issues listed at https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues - The list below consist mostly of ideas noted down before they are requested/discussed by users (at which point it usually moves to the github) - - - doc: add a proper documentation+regression testing system (#435) - - window: add a way for very transient windows (non-saved, temporary overlay over hundreds of objects) to "clean" up from the global window list. perhaps a lightweight explicit cleanup pass. - - window: calling SetNextWindowSize() every frame with <= 0 doesn't do anything, may be useful to allow (particularly when used for a single axis) (#690) - - window: auto-fit feedback loop when user relies on any dynamic layout (window width multiplier, column) appears weird to end-user. clarify. - - window: allow resizing of child windows (possibly given min/max for each axis?) - - window: background options for child windows, border option (disable rounding) - - window: add a way to clear an existing window instead of appending (e.g. for tooltip override using a consistent api rather than the deferred tooltip) - - window: resizing from any sides? + mouse cursor directives for app. -!- window: begin with *p_open == false should return false. - - window: get size/pos helpers given names (see discussion in #249) - - window: a collapsed window can be stuck behind the main menu bar? - - window: when window is small, prioritize resize button over close button. - - window: detect extra End() call that pop the "Debug" window out and assert at call site instead of later. - - window/tooltip: allow to set the width of a tooltip to allow TextWrapped() etc. while keeping the height automatic. - - window: increase minimum size of a window with menus or fix the menu rendering so that it doesn't look odd. - - draw-list: maintaining bounding box per command would allow to merge draw command when clipping isn't relied on (typical non-scrolling window or non-overflowing column would merge with previous command). -!- scrolling: allow immediately effective change of scroll if we haven't appended items yet - - splitter/separator: formalize the splitter idiom into an official api (we want to handle n-way split) (#319) - - widgets: display mode: widget-label, label-widget (aligned on column or using fixed size), label-newline-tab-widget etc. - - widgets: clean up widgets internal toward exposing everything. - - widgets: add disabled and read-only modes (#211) - - main: considering adding an Init() function? some constructs are awkward in the implementation because of the lack of them. -!- main: make it so that a frame with no window registered won't refocus every window on subsequent frames (~bump LastFrameActive of all windows). - - main: IsItemHovered() make it more consistent for various type of widgets, widgets with multiple components, etc. also effectively IsHovered() region sometimes differs from hot region, e.g tree nodes - - main: IsItemHovered() info stored in a stack? so that 'if TreeNode() { Text; TreePop; } if IsHovered' return the hover state of the TreeNode? - - input text: clean up the mess caused by converting UTF-8 <> wchar. the code is rather inefficient right now and super fragile. - - input text: reorganize event handling, allow CharFilter to modify buffers, allow multiple events? (#541) - - input text: expose CursorPos in char filter event (#816) - - input text: flag to disable live update of the user buffer (also applies to float/int text input) - - input text: resize behavior - field could stretch when being edited? hover tooltip shows more text? - - input text: add ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterToApply? (off #218) - - input text: add discard flag (e.g. ImGuiInputTextFlags_DiscardActiveBuffer) or make it easier to clear active focus for text replacement during edition (#725) - - input text multi-line: don't directly call AddText() which does an unnecessary vertex reserve for character count prior to clipping. and/or more line-based clipping to AddText(). and/or reorganize TextUnformatted/RenderText for more efficiency for large text (e.g TextUnformatted could clip and log separately, etc). - - input text multi-line: way to dynamically grow the buffer without forcing the user to initially allocate for worse case (follow up on #200) - - input text multi-line: line numbers? status bar? (follow up on #200) - - input text multi-line: behave better when user changes input buffer while editing is active (even though it is illegal behavior). namely, the change of buffer can create a scrollbar glitch (#725) - - input text: allow centering/positioning text so that ctrl+clicking Drag or Slider keeps the textual value at the same pixel position. - - input number: optional range min/max for Input*() functions - - input number: holding [-]/[+] buttons could increase the step speed non-linearly (or user-controlled) - - input number: use mouse wheel to step up/down - - input number: applying arithmetics ops (+,-,*,/) messes up with text edit undo stack. - - button: provide a button that looks framed. - - text: proper alignment options - - image/image button: misalignment on padded/bordered button? - - image/image button: parameters are confusing, image() has tint_col,border_col whereas imagebutton() has bg_col/tint_col. Even thou they are different parameters ordering could be more consistent. can we fix that? - - layout: horizontal layout helper (#97) - - layout: horizontal flow until no space left (#404) - - layout: more generic alignment state (left/right/centered) for single items? - - layout: clean up the InputFloatN/SliderFloatN/ColorEdit4 layout code. item width should include frame padding. - - layout: BeginGroup() needs a border option. - - columns: declare column set (each column: fixed size, %, fill, distribute default size among fills) (#513, #125) - - columns: add a conditional parameter to SetColumnOffset() (#513, #125) - - columns: separator function or parameter that works within the column (currently Separator() bypass all columns) (#125) - - columns: columns header to act as button (~sort op) and allow resize/reorder (#513, #125) - - columns: user specify columns size (#513, #125) - - columns: flag to add horizontal separator above/below? - - columns/layout: setup minimum line height (equivalent of automatically calling AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets) - - combo: sparse combo boxes (via function call?) / iterators - - combo: contents should extends to fit label if combo widget is small - - combo/listbox: keyboard control. need InputText-like non-active focus + key handling. considering keyboard for custom listbox (pr #203) - - listbox: multiple selection - - listbox: user may want to initial scroll to focus on the one selected value? - - listbox: keyboard navigation. - - listbox: scrolling should track modified selection. -!- popups/menus: clarify usage of popups id, how MenuItem/Selectable closing parent popups affects the ID, etc. this is quite fishy needs improvement! (#331, #402) - - popups: add variant using global identifier similar to Begin/End (#402) - - popups: border options. richer api like BeginChild() perhaps? (#197) - - tooltip: tooltip that doesn't fit in entire screen seems to lose their "last preferred button" and may teleport when moving mouse - - menus: local shortcuts, global shortcuts (#456, #126) - - menus: icons - - menus: menubars: some sort of priority / effect of main menu-bar on desktop size? - - menus: calling BeginMenu() twice with a same name doesn't seem to append nicely - - statusbar: add a per-window status bar helper similar to what menubar does. - - tabs (#261, #351) - - separator: separator on the initial position of a window is not visible (cursorpos.y <= clippos.y) -!- color: the color helpers/typing is a mess and needs sorting out. - - color: add a better color picker (#346) - - node/graph editor (#306) - - pie menus patterns (#434) - - drag'n drop, dragging helpers (carry dragging info, visualize drag source before clicking, drop target, etc.) (#143, #479) - - plot: PlotLines() should use the polygon-stroke facilities (currently issues with averaging normals) - - plot: make it easier for user to draw extra stuff into the graph (e.g: draw basis, highlight certain points, 2d plots, multiple plots) - - plot: "smooth" automatic scale over time, user give an input 0.0(full user scale) 1.0(full derived from value) - - plot: add a helper e.g. Plot(char* label, float value, float time_span=2.0f) that stores values and Plot them for you - probably another function name. and/or automatically allow to plot ANY displayed value (more reliance on stable ID) - - slider: allow using the [-]/[+] buttons used by InputFloat()/InputInt() - - slider: initial absolute click is imprecise. change to relative movement slider (same as scrollbar). - - slider: add dragging-based widgets to edit values with mouse (on 2 axises), saving screen real-estate. - - slider: tint background based on value (e.g. v_min -> v_max, or use 0.0f either side of the sign) - - slider & drag: int data passing through a float - - drag float: up/down axis - - drag float: added leeway on edge (e.g. a few invisible steps past the clamp limits) - - tree node / optimization: avoid formatting when clipped. - - tree node: tree-node/header right-most side doesn't take account of horizontal scrolling. - - tree node: add treenode/treepush int variants? not there because (void*) cast from int warns on some platforms/settings? - - tree node: try to apply scrolling at time of TreePop() if node was just opened and end of node is past scrolling limits? - - tree node / selectable render mismatch which is visible if you use them both next to each other (e.g. cf. property viewer) - - tree node: tweak color scheme to distinguish headers from selected tree node (#581) - - textwrapped: figure out better way to use TextWrapped() in an always auto-resize context (tooltip, etc.) (#249) - - settings: write more decent code to allow saving/loading new fields - - settings: api for per-tool simple persistent data (bool,int,float,columns sizes,etc.) in .ini file - - style: add window shadows. - - style/optimization: store rounded corners in texture to use 1 quad per corner (filled and wireframe) to lower the cost of rounding. - - style: color-box not always square? - - style: a concept of "compact style" that the end-user can easily rely on (e.g. PushStyleCompact()?) that maps to other settings? avoid implementing duplicate helpers such as SmallCheckbox(), etc. - - style: try to make PushStyleVar() more robust to incorrect parameters (to be more friendly to edit & continues situation). - - style: global scale setting. - - style: WindowPadding needs to be EVEN needs the 0.5 multiplier probably have a subtle effect on clip rectangle - - text: simple markup language for color change? - - font: dynamic font atlas to avoid baking huge ranges into bitmap and make scaling easier. - - font: small opt: for monospace font (like the defalt one) we can trim IndexXAdvance as long as trailing value is == FallbackXAdvance - - font: add support for kerning, probably optional. perhaps default to (32..128)^2 matrix ~ 36KB then hash fallback. - - font: add a simpler CalcTextSizeA() api? current one ok but not welcome if user needs to call it directly (without going through ImGui::CalcTextSize) - - font: fix AddRemapChar() to work before font has been built. - - log: LogButtons() options for specifying depth and/or hiding depth slider - - log: have more control over the log scope (e.g. stop logging when leaving current tree node scope) - - log: be able to log anything (e.g. right-click on a window/tree-node, shows context menu? log into tty/file/clipboard) - - log: let user copy any window content to clipboard easily (CTRL+C on windows? while moving it? context menu?). code is commented because it fails with multiple Begin/End pairs. - - filters: set a current filter that tree node can automatically query to hide themselves - - filters: handle wildcards (with implicit leading/trailing *), regexps - - shortcuts: add a shortcut api, e.g. parse "&Save" and/or "Save (CTRL+S)", pass in to widgets or provide simple ways to use (button=activate, input=focus) -!- keyboard: tooltip & combo boxes are messing up / not honoring keyboard tabbing - - keyboard: full keyboard navigation and focus. (#323) - - focus: preserve ActiveId/focus stack state, e.g. when opening a menu and close it, previously selected InputText() focus gets restored (#622) - - focus: SetKeyboardFocusHere() on with >= 0 offset could be done on same frame (else latch and modulate on beginning of next frame) - - input: rework IO system to be able to pass actual ordered/timestamped events. (~#335, #71) - - input: allow to decide and pass explicit double-clicks (e.g. for windows by the CS_DBLCLKS style). - - input: support track pad style scrolling & slider edit. - - misc: provide a way to compile out the entire implementation while providing a dummy API (e.g. #define IMGUI_DUMMY_IMPL) - - misc: double-clicking on title bar to minimize isn't consistent, perhaps move to single-click on left-most collapse icon? - - misc: provide HoveredTime and ActivatedTime to ease the creation of animations. - - style editor: have a more global HSV setter (e.g. alter hue on all elements). consider replacing active/hovered by offset in HSV space? (#438) - - style editor: color child window height expressed in multiple of line height. - - remote: make a system like RemoteImGui first-class citizen/project (#75) - - drawlist: move Font, FontSize, FontTexUvWhitePixel inside ImDrawList and make it self-contained (apart from drawing settings?) - - drawlist: end-user probably can't call Clear() directly because we expect a texture to be pushed in the stack. - - examples: directx9: save/restore device state more thoroughly. - - examples: window minimize, maximize (#583) - - optimization: add a flag to disable most of rendering, for the case where the user expect to skip it (#335) - - optimization: use another hash function than crc32, e.g. FNV1a - - optimization/render: merge command-lists with same clip-rect into one even if they aren't sequential? (as long as in-between clip rectangle don't overlap)? - - optimization: turn some the various stack vectors into statically-sized arrays - - optimization: better clipping for multi-component widgets -*/ - -#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS) -#define _CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS -#endif - -#include -#define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS -#define IMGUI_DEFINE_PLACEMENT_NEW -#include - -#include // toupper, isprint -#include // NULL, malloc, free, qsort, atoi -#include // vsnprintf, sscanf, printf -#include // INT_MIN, INT_MAX -#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER <= 1500 // MSVC 2008 or earlier -#include // intptr_t -#else -#include // intptr_t -#endif - -#ifdef _MSC_VER -#pragma warning (disable: 4127) // condition expression is constant -#pragma warning (disable: 4505) // unreferenced local function has been removed (stb stuff) -#pragma warning (disable: 4996) // 'This function or variable may be unsafe': strcpy, strdup, sprintf, vsnprintf, sscanf, fopen -#endif - -// Clang warnings with -Weverything -#ifdef __clang__ -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" // warning : use of old-style cast // yes, they are more terse. -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" // warning : comparing floating point with == or != is unsafe // storing and comparing against same constants ok. -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-nonliteral" // warning : format string is not a string literal // passing non-literal to vsnformat(). yes, user passing incorrect format strings can crash the code. -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wexit-time-destructors" // warning : declaration requires an exit-time destructor // exit-time destruction order is undefined. if MemFree() leads to users code that has been disabled before exit it might cause problems. ImGui coding style welcomes static/globals. -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wglobal-constructors" // warning : declaration requires a global destructor // similar to above, not sure what the exact difference it. -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wsign-conversion" // warning : implicit conversion changes signedness // -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wint-to-void-pointer-cast" // warning : cast to 'void *' from smaller integer type 'int' // -#elif defined(__GNUC__) -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-function" // warning: 'xxxx' defined but not used -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wint-to-pointer-cast" // warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wformat" // warning: format '%p' expects argument of type 'void*', but argument 6 has type 'ImGuiWindow*' -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wconversion" // warning: conversion to 'xxxx' from 'xxxx' may alter its value -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wcast-qual" // warning: cast from type 'xxxx' to type 'xxxx' casts away qualifiers -#endif - -//------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Forward Declarations -//------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -static void LogRenderedText(const ImVec2& ref_pos, const char* text, const char* text_end = NULL); - -static void PushMultiItemsWidths(int components, float w_full = 0.0f); -static float GetDraggedColumnOffset(int column_index); - -static bool IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey key, bool repeat = true); - -static ImFont* GetDefaultFont(); -static void SetCurrentFont(ImFont* font); -static void SetCurrentWindow(ImGuiWindow* window); -static void SetWindowScrollY(ImGuiWindow* window, float new_scroll_y); -static void SetWindowPos(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiSetCond cond); -static void SetWindowSize(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiSetCond cond); -static void SetWindowCollapsed(ImGuiWindow* window, bool collapsed, ImGuiSetCond cond); -static ImGuiWindow* FindHoveredWindow(ImVec2 pos, bool excluding_childs); -static ImGuiWindow* CreateNewWindow(const char* name, ImVec2 size, ImGuiWindowFlags flags); -static inline bool IsWindowContentHoverable(ImGuiWindow* window); -static void ClearSetNextWindowData(); -static void CheckStacksSize(ImGuiWindow* window, bool write); -static void Scrollbar(ImGuiWindow* window, bool horizontal); - -static void AddDrawListToRenderList(ImVector& out_render_list, ImDrawList* draw_list); -static void AddWindowToRenderList(ImVector& out_render_list, ImGuiWindow* window); -static void AddWindowToSortedBuffer(ImVector& out_sorted_windows, ImGuiWindow* window); - -static ImGuiIniData* FindWindowSettings(const char* name); -static ImGuiIniData* AddWindowSettings(const char* name); -static void LoadIniSettingsFromDisk(const char* ini_filename); -static void SaveIniSettingsToDisk(const char* ini_filename); -static void MarkIniSettingsDirty(); - -static void PushColumnClipRect(int column_index = -1); -static ImRect GetVisibleRect(); - -static bool BeginPopupEx(const char* str_id, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags); -static void CloseInactivePopups(); -static void ClosePopupToLevel(int remaining); -static void ClosePopup(ImGuiID id); -static bool IsPopupOpen(ImGuiID id); -static ImGuiWindow* GetFrontMostModalRootWindow(); -static ImVec2 FindBestPopupWindowPos(const ImVec2& base_pos, const ImVec2& size, int* last_dir, const ImRect& rect_to_avoid); - -static bool InputTextFilterCharacter(unsigned int* p_char, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback, void* user_data); -static int InputTextCalcTextLenAndLineCount(const char* text_begin, const char** out_text_end); -static ImVec2 InputTextCalcTextSizeW(const ImWchar* text_begin, const ImWchar* text_end, const ImWchar** remaining = NULL, ImVec2* out_offset = NULL, bool stop_on_new_line = false); - -static inline void DataTypeFormatString(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, const char* display_format, char* buf, int buf_size); -static inline void DataTypeFormatString(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, int decimal_precision, char* buf, int buf_size); -static void DataTypeApplyOp(ImGuiDataType data_type, int op, void* value1, const void* value2); -static bool DataTypeApplyOpFromText(const char* buf, const char* initial_value_buf, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, const char* scalar_format); - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Platform dependent default implementations -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -static const char* GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void* user_data); -static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void* user_data, const char* text); -static void ImeSetInputScreenPosFn_DefaultImpl(int x, int y); - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Context -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -// Default font atlas storage . -// New contexts always point by default to this font atlas. It can be changed by reassigning the GetIO().Fonts variable. -static ImFontAtlas GImDefaultFontAtlas; - -// Default context storage + current context pointer. -// Implicitely used by all ImGui functions. Always assumed to be != NULL. Change to a different context by calling ImGui::SetCurrentContext() -// ImGui is currently not thread-safe because of this variable. If you want thread-safety to allow N threads to access N different contexts, you might work around it by: -// - Having multiple instances of the ImGui code compiled inside different namespace (easiest/safest, if you have a finite number of contexts) -// - or: Changing this variable to be TLS. You may #define GImGui in imconfig.h for further custom hackery. Future development aim to make this context pointer explicit to all calls. Also read https://github.com/ocornut/imgui/issues/586 -#ifndef GImGui -static ImGuiContext GImDefaultContext; -ImGuiContext* GImGui = &GImDefaultContext; -#endif - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// User facing structures -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -ImGuiStyle::ImGuiStyle() -{ - Alpha = 1.0f; // Global alpha applies to everything in ImGui - WindowPadding = ImVec2(8,8); // Padding within a window - WindowMinSize = ImVec2(32,32); // Minimum window size - WindowRounding = 9.0f; // Radius of window corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular windows - WindowTitleAlign = ImVec2(0.0f,0.5f);// Alignment for title bar text - ChildWindowRounding = 0.0f; // Radius of child window corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular child windows - FramePadding = ImVec2(4,3); // Padding within a framed rectangle (used by most widgets) - FrameRounding = 0.0f; // Radius of frame corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular frames (used by most widgets). - ItemSpacing = ImVec2(8,4); // Horizontal and vertical spacing between widgets/lines - ItemInnerSpacing = ImVec2(4,4); // Horizontal and vertical spacing between within elements of a composed widget (e.g. a slider and its label) - TouchExtraPadding = ImVec2(0,0); // Expand reactive bounding box for touch-based system where touch position is not accurate enough. Unfortunately we don't sort widgets so priority on overlap will always be given to the first widget. So don't grow this too much! - IndentSpacing = 21.0f; // Horizontal spacing when e.g. entering a tree node. Generally == (FontSize + FramePadding.x*2). - ColumnsMinSpacing = 6.0f; // Minimum horizontal spacing between two columns - ScrollbarSize = 16.0f; // Width of the vertical scrollbar, Height of the horizontal scrollbar - ScrollbarRounding = 9.0f; // Radius of grab corners rounding for scrollbar - GrabMinSize = 10.0f; // Minimum width/height of a grab box for slider/scrollbar - GrabRounding = 0.0f; // Radius of grabs corners rounding. Set to 0.0f to have rectangular slider grabs. - ButtonTextAlign = ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f);// Alignment of button text when button is larger than text. - DisplayWindowPadding = ImVec2(22,22); // Window positions are clamped to be visible within the display area by at least this amount. Only covers regular windows. - DisplaySafeAreaPadding = ImVec2(4,4); // If you cannot see the edge of your screen (e.g. on a TV) increase the safe area padding. Covers popups/tooltips as well regular windows. - AntiAliasedLines = true; // Enable anti-aliasing on lines/borders. Disable if you are really short on CPU/GPU. - AntiAliasedShapes = true; // Enable anti-aliasing on filled shapes (rounded rectangles, circles, etc.) - CurveTessellationTol = 1.25f; // Tessellation tolerance. Decrease for highly tessellated curves (higher quality, more polygons), increase to reduce quality. - - Colors[ImGuiCol_Text] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.90f, 0.90f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled] = ImVec4(0.60f, 0.60f, 0.60f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_WindowBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.70f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ChildWindowBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_PopupBg] = ImVec4(0.05f, 0.05f, 0.10f, 0.90f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_Border] = ImVec4(0.70f, 0.70f, 0.70f, 0.65f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_BorderShadow] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f, 0.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBg] = ImVec4(0.80f, 0.80f, 0.80f, 0.30f); // Background of checkbox, radio button, plot, slider, text input - Colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.80f, 0.80f, 0.40f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.65f, 0.65f, 0.45f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBg] = ImVec4(0.27f, 0.27f, 0.54f, 0.83f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgCollapsed] = ImVec4(0.40f, 0.40f, 0.80f, 0.20f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive] = ImVec4(0.32f, 0.32f, 0.63f, 0.87f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg] = ImVec4(0.40f, 0.40f, 0.55f, 0.80f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg] = ImVec4(0.20f, 0.25f, 0.30f, 0.60f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab] = ImVec4(0.40f, 0.40f, 0.80f, 0.30f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered] = ImVec4(0.40f, 0.40f, 0.80f, 0.40f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive] = ImVec4(0.80f, 0.50f, 0.50f, 0.40f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ComboBg] = ImVec4(0.20f, 0.20f, 0.20f, 0.99f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_CheckMark] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.90f, 0.90f, 0.50f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_SliderGrab] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.30f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive] = ImVec4(0.80f, 0.50f, 0.50f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_Button] = ImVec4(0.67f, 0.40f, 0.40f, 0.60f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered] = ImVec4(0.67f, 0.40f, 0.40f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ButtonActive] = ImVec4(0.80f, 0.50f, 0.50f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_Header] = ImVec4(0.40f, 0.40f, 0.90f, 0.45f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered] = ImVec4(0.45f, 0.45f, 0.90f, 0.80f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_HeaderActive] = ImVec4(0.53f, 0.53f, 0.87f, 0.80f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_Column] = ImVec4(0.50f, 0.50f, 0.50f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ColumnHovered] = ImVec4(0.70f, 0.60f, 0.60f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ColumnActive] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.70f, 0.70f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.30f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.60f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 0.90f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_CloseButton] = ImVec4(0.50f, 0.50f, 0.90f, 0.50f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_CloseButtonHovered] = ImVec4(0.70f, 0.70f, 0.90f, 0.60f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_CloseButtonActive] = ImVec4(0.70f, 0.70f, 0.70f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLines] = ImVec4(1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.70f, 0.00f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram] = ImVec4(0.90f, 0.70f, 0.00f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered] = ImVec4(1.00f, 0.60f, 0.00f, 1.00f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg] = ImVec4(0.00f, 0.00f, 1.00f, 0.35f); - Colors[ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDarkening] = ImVec4(0.20f, 0.20f, 0.20f, 0.35f); -} - -ImGuiIO::ImGuiIO() -{ - // Most fields are initialized with zero - memset(this, 0, sizeof(*this)); - - DisplaySize = ImVec2(-1.0f, -1.0f); - DeltaTime = 1.0f/60.0f; - IniSavingRate = 5.0f; - //IniFilename = "TBFix_UI.ini"; - LogFilename = "logs/ui.log"; - - Fonts = &GImDefaultFontAtlas; - FontGlobalScale = 1.0f; - FontDefault = NULL; - DisplayFramebufferScale = ImVec2(1.0f, 1.0f); - MousePos = ImVec2(-1,-1); - MousePosPrev = ImVec2(-1,-1); - - MouseDoubleClickTime = 0.30f; - MouseDoubleClickMaxDist = 6.0f; - MouseDragThreshold = 6.0f; - - for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(MouseDownDuration); i++) - MouseDownDuration[i] = MouseDownDurationPrev[i] = -1.0f; - for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(KeysDownDuration); i++) - KeysDownDuration[i] = KeysDownDurationPrev[i] = -1.0f; - for (int i = 0; i < ImGuiKey_COUNT; i++) - KeyMap[i] = -1; - KeyRepeatDelay = 0.250f; - KeyRepeatRate = 0.050f; - UserData = NULL; - - // User functions - RenderDrawListsFn = NULL; - MemAllocFn = malloc; - MemFreeFn = free; - GetClipboardTextFn = GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl; // Platform dependent default implementations - SetClipboardTextFn = SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl; - ClipboardUserData = NULL; - ImeSetInputScreenPosFn = ImeSetInputScreenPosFn_DefaultImpl; - - // Set OS X style defaults based on __APPLE__ compile time flag -#ifdef __APPLE__ - OSXBehaviors = true; -#endif -} - -// Pass in translated ASCII characters for text input. -// - with glfw you can get those from the callback set in glfwSetCharCallback() -// - on Windows you can get those using ToAscii+keyboard state, or via the WM_CHAR message -void ImGuiIO::AddInputCharacter(ImWchar c) -{ - const int n = ImStrlenW(InputCharacters); - if (n + 1 < IM_ARRAYSIZE(InputCharacters)) - { - InputCharacters[n] = c; - InputCharacters[n+1] = '\0'; - } -} - -void ImGuiIO::AddInputCharactersUTF8(const char* utf8_chars) -{ - // We can't pass more wchars than ImGuiIO::InputCharacters[] can hold so don't convert more - const int wchars_buf_len = sizeof(ImGuiIO::InputCharacters) / sizeof(ImWchar); - ImWchar wchars[wchars_buf_len]; - ImTextStrFromUtf8(wchars, wchars_buf_len, utf8_chars, NULL); - for (int i = 0; i < wchars_buf_len && wchars[i] != 0; i++) - AddInputCharacter(wchars[i]); -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// HELPERS -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -#define IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(_VAL) ((int)((_VAL) * 255.0f + ((_VAL)>=0 ? 0.5f : -0.5f))) // Unsaturated, for display purpose -#define IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(_VAL) ((int)(ImSaturate(_VAL) * 255.0f + 0.5f)) // Saturated, always output 0..255 - -// Play it nice with Windows users. Notepad in 2015 still doesn't display text data with Unix-style \n. -#ifdef _WIN32 -#define IM_NEWLINE "\r\n" -#else -#define IM_NEWLINE "\n" -#endif - -bool ImIsPointInTriangle(const ImVec2& p, const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c) -{ - bool b1 = ((p.x - b.x) * (a.y - b.y) - (p.y - b.y) * (a.x - b.x)) < 0.0f; - bool b2 = ((p.x - c.x) * (b.y - c.y) - (p.y - c.y) * (b.x - c.x)) < 0.0f; - bool b3 = ((p.x - a.x) * (c.y - a.y) - (p.y - a.y) * (c.x - a.x)) < 0.0f; - return ((b1 == b2) && (b2 == b3)); -} - -int ImStricmp(const char* str1, const char* str2) -{ - int d; - while ((d = toupper(*str2) - toupper(*str1)) == 0 && *str1) { str1++; str2++; } - return d; -} - -int ImStrnicmp(const char* str1, const char* str2, int count) -{ - int d = 0; - while (count > 0 && (d = toupper(*str2) - toupper(*str1)) == 0 && *str1) { str1++; str2++; count--; } - return d; -} - -void ImStrncpy(char* dst, const char* src, int count) -{ - if (count < 1) return; - strncpy(dst, src, (size_t)count); - dst[count-1] = 0; -} - -char* ImStrdup(const char *str) -{ - size_t len = strlen(str) + 1; - void* buff = ImGui::MemAlloc(len); - return (char*)memcpy(buff, (const void*)str, len); -} - -int ImStrlenW(const ImWchar* str) -{ - int n = 0; - while (*str++) n++; - return n; -} - -const ImWchar* ImStrbolW(const ImWchar* buf_mid_line, const ImWchar* buf_begin) // find beginning-of-line -{ - while (buf_mid_line > buf_begin && buf_mid_line[-1] != '\n') - buf_mid_line--; - return buf_mid_line; -} - -const char* ImStristr(const char* haystack, const char* haystack_end, const char* needle, const char* needle_end) -{ - if (!needle_end) - needle_end = needle + strlen(needle); - - const char un0 = (char)toupper(*needle); - while ((!haystack_end && *haystack) || (haystack_end && haystack < haystack_end)) - { - if (toupper(*haystack) == un0) - { - const char* b = needle + 1; - for (const char* a = haystack + 1; b < needle_end; a++, b++) - if (toupper(*a) != toupper(*b)) - break; - if (b == needle_end) - return haystack; - } - haystack++; - } - return NULL; -} - - -// MSVC version appears to return -1 on overflow, whereas glibc appears to return total count (which may be >= buf_size). -// Ideally we would test for only one of those limits at runtime depending on the behavior the vsnprintf(), but trying to deduct it at compile time sounds like a pandora can of worm. -int ImFormatString(char* buf, int buf_size, const char* fmt, ...) -{ - IM_ASSERT(buf_size > 0); - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - int w = vsnprintf(buf, buf_size, fmt, args); - va_end(args); - if (w == -1 || w >= buf_size) - w = buf_size - 1; - buf[w] = 0; - return w; -} - -int ImFormatStringV(char* buf, int buf_size, const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - IM_ASSERT(buf_size > 0); - int w = vsnprintf(buf, buf_size, fmt, args); - if (w == -1 || w >= buf_size) - w = buf_size - 1; - buf[w] = 0; - return w; -} - -// Pass data_size==0 for zero-terminated strings -// FIXME-OPT: Replace with e.g. FNV1a hash? CRC32 pretty much randomly access 1KB. Need to do proper measurements. -ImU32 ImHash(const void* data, int data_size, ImU32 seed) -{ - static ImU32 crc32_lut[256] = { 0 }; - if (!crc32_lut[1]) - { - const ImU32 polynomial = 0xEDB88320; - for (ImU32 i = 0; i < 256; i++) - { - ImU32 crc = i; - for (ImU32 j = 0; j < 8; j++) - crc = (crc >> 1) ^ (ImU32(-int(crc & 1)) & polynomial); - crc32_lut[i] = crc; - } - } - - seed = ~seed; - ImU32 crc = seed; - const unsigned char* current = (const unsigned char*)data; - - if (data_size > 0) - { - // Known size - while (data_size--) - crc = (crc >> 8) ^ crc32_lut[(crc & 0xFF) ^ *current++]; - } - else - { - // Zero-terminated string - while (unsigned char c = *current++) - { - // We support a syntax of "label###id" where only "###id" is included in the hash, and only "label" gets displayed. - // Because this syntax is rarely used we are optimizing for the common case. - // - If we reach ### in the string we discard the hash so far and reset to the seed. - // - We don't do 'current += 2; continue;' after handling ### to keep the code smaller. - if (c == '#' && current[0] == '#' && current[1] == '#') - crc = seed; - crc = (crc >> 8) ^ crc32_lut[(crc & 0xFF) ^ c]; - } - } - return ~crc; -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// ImText* helpers -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -// Convert UTF-8 to 32-bits character, process single character input. -// Based on stb_from_utf8() from github.com/nothings/stb/ -// We handle UTF-8 decoding error by skipping forward. -int ImTextCharFromUtf8(unsigned int* out_char, const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end) -{ - unsigned int c = (unsigned int)-1; - const unsigned char* str = (const unsigned char*)in_text; - if (!(*str & 0x80)) - { - c = (unsigned int)(*str++); - *out_char = c; - return 1; - } - if ((*str & 0xe0) == 0xc0) - { - *out_char = 0xFFFD; // will be invalid but not end of string - if (in_text_end && in_text_end - (const char*)str < 2) return 1; - if (*str < 0xc2) return 2; - c = (unsigned int)((*str++ & 0x1f) << 6); - if ((*str & 0xc0) != 0x80) return 2; - c += (*str++ & 0x3f); - *out_char = c; - return 2; - } - if ((*str & 0xf0) == 0xe0) - { - *out_char = 0xFFFD; // will be invalid but not end of string - if (in_text_end && in_text_end - (const char*)str < 3) return 1; - if (*str == 0xe0 && (str[1] < 0xa0 || str[1] > 0xbf)) return 3; - if (*str == 0xed && str[1] > 0x9f) return 3; // str[1] < 0x80 is checked below - c = (unsigned int)((*str++ & 0x0f) << 12); - if ((*str & 0xc0) != 0x80) return 3; - c += (unsigned int)((*str++ & 0x3f) << 6); - if ((*str & 0xc0) != 0x80) return 3; - c += (*str++ & 0x3f); - *out_char = c; - return 3; - } - if ((*str & 0xf8) == 0xf0) - { - *out_char = 0xFFFD; // will be invalid but not end of string - if (in_text_end && in_text_end - (const char*)str < 4) return 1; - if (*str > 0xf4) return 4; - if (*str == 0xf0 && (str[1] < 0x90 || str[1] > 0xbf)) return 4; - if (*str == 0xf4 && str[1] > 0x8f) return 4; // str[1] < 0x80 is checked below - c = (unsigned int)((*str++ & 0x07) << 18); - if ((*str & 0xc0) != 0x80) return 4; - c += (unsigned int)((*str++ & 0x3f) << 12); - if ((*str & 0xc0) != 0x80) return 4; - c += (unsigned int)((*str++ & 0x3f) << 6); - if ((*str & 0xc0) != 0x80) return 4; - c += (*str++ & 0x3f); - // utf-8 encodings of values used in surrogate pairs are invalid - if ((c & 0xFFFFF800) == 0xD800) return 4; - *out_char = c; - return 4; - } - *out_char = 0; - return 0; -} - -int ImTextStrFromUtf8(ImWchar* buf, int buf_size, const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end, const char** in_text_remaining) -{ - ImWchar* buf_out = buf; - ImWchar* buf_end = buf + buf_size; - while (buf_out < buf_end-1 && (!in_text_end || in_text < in_text_end) && *in_text) - { - unsigned int c; - in_text += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, in_text, in_text_end); - if (c == 0) - break; - if (c < 0x10000) // FIXME: Losing characters that don't fit in 2 bytes - *buf_out++ = (ImWchar)c; - } - *buf_out = 0; - if (in_text_remaining) - *in_text_remaining = in_text; - return (int)(buf_out - buf); -} - -int ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(const char* in_text, const char* in_text_end) -{ - int char_count = 0; - while ((!in_text_end || in_text < in_text_end) && *in_text) - { - unsigned int c; - in_text += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, in_text, in_text_end); - if (c == 0) - break; - if (c < 0x10000) - char_count++; - } - return char_count; -} - -// Based on stb_to_utf8() from github.com/nothings/stb/ -static inline int ImTextCharToUtf8(char* buf, int buf_size, unsigned int c) -{ - if (c < 0x80) - { - buf[0] = (char)c; - return 1; - } - if (c < 0x800) - { - if (buf_size < 2) return 0; - buf[0] = (char)(0xc0 + (c >> 6)); - buf[1] = (char)(0x80 + (c & 0x3f)); - return 2; - } - if (c >= 0xdc00 && c < 0xe000) - { - return 0; - } - if (c >= 0xd800 && c < 0xdc00) - { - if (buf_size < 4) return 0; - buf[0] = (char)(0xf0 + (c >> 18)); - buf[1] = (char)(0x80 + ((c >> 12) & 0x3f)); - buf[2] = (char)(0x80 + ((c >> 6) & 0x3f)); - buf[3] = (char)(0x80 + ((c ) & 0x3f)); - return 4; - } - //else if (c < 0x10000) - { - if (buf_size < 3) return 0; - buf[0] = (char)(0xe0 + (c >> 12)); - buf[1] = (char)(0x80 + ((c>> 6) & 0x3f)); - buf[2] = (char)(0x80 + ((c ) & 0x3f)); - return 3; - } -} - -static inline int ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromChar(unsigned int c) -{ - if (c < 0x80) return 1; - if (c < 0x800) return 2; - if (c >= 0xdc00 && c < 0xe000) return 0; - if (c >= 0xd800 && c < 0xdc00) return 4; - return 3; -} - -int ImTextStrToUtf8(char* buf, int buf_size, const ImWchar* in_text, const ImWchar* in_text_end) -{ - char* buf_out = buf; - const char* buf_end = buf + buf_size; - while (buf_out < buf_end-1 && (!in_text_end || in_text < in_text_end) && *in_text) - { - unsigned int c = (unsigned int)(*in_text++); - if (c < 0x80) - *buf_out++ = (char)c; - else - buf_out += ImTextCharToUtf8(buf_out, (int)(buf_end-buf_out-1), c); - } - *buf_out = 0; - return (int)(buf_out - buf); -} - -int ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(const ImWchar* in_text, const ImWchar* in_text_end) -{ - int bytes_count = 0; - while ((!in_text_end || in_text < in_text_end) && *in_text) - { - unsigned int c = (unsigned int)(*in_text++); - if (c < 0x80) - bytes_count++; - else - bytes_count += ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromChar(c); - } - return bytes_count; -} - -ImVec4 ImGui::ColorConvertU32ToFloat4(ImU32 in) -{ - float s = 1.0f/255.0f; - return ImVec4( - ((in >> IM_COL32_R_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * s, - ((in >> IM_COL32_G_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * s, - ((in >> IM_COL32_B_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * s, - ((in >> IM_COL32_A_SHIFT) & 0xFF) * s); -} - -ImU32 ImGui::ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(const ImVec4& in) -{ - ImU32 out; - out = ((ImU32)IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(in.x)) << IM_COL32_R_SHIFT; - out |= ((ImU32)IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(in.y)) << IM_COL32_G_SHIFT; - out |= ((ImU32)IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(in.z)) << IM_COL32_B_SHIFT; - out |= ((ImU32)IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(in.w)) << IM_COL32_A_SHIFT; - return out; -} - -ImU32 ImGui::GetColorU32(ImGuiCol idx, float alpha_mul) -{ - ImVec4 c = GImGui->Style.Colors[idx]; - c.w *= GImGui->Style.Alpha * alpha_mul; - return ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(c); -} - -ImU32 ImGui::GetColorU32(const ImVec4& col) -{ - ImVec4 c = col; - c.w *= GImGui->Style.Alpha; - return ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(c); -} - -// Convert rgb floats ([0-1],[0-1],[0-1]) to hsv floats ([0-1],[0-1],[0-1]), from Foley & van Dam p592 -// Optimized http://lolengine.net/blog/2013/01/13/fast-rgb-to-hsv -void ImGui::ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(float r, float g, float b, float& out_h, float& out_s, float& out_v) -{ - float K = 0.f; - if (g < b) - { - const float tmp = g; g = b; b = tmp; - K = -1.f; - } - if (r < g) - { - const float tmp = r; r = g; g = tmp; - K = -2.f / 6.f - K; - } - - const float chroma = r - (g < b ? g : b); - out_h = fabsf(K + (g - b) / (6.f * chroma + 1e-20f)); - out_s = chroma / (r + 1e-20f); - out_v = r; -} - -// Convert hsv floats ([0-1],[0-1],[0-1]) to rgb floats ([0-1],[0-1],[0-1]), from Foley & van Dam p593 -// also http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/HSL_and_HSV -void ImGui::ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(float h, float s, float v, float& out_r, float& out_g, float& out_b) -{ - if (s == 0.0f) - { - // gray - out_r = out_g = out_b = v; - return; - } - - h = fmodf(h, 1.0f) / (60.0f/360.0f); - int i = (int)h; - float f = h - (float)i; - float p = v * (1.0f - s); - float q = v * (1.0f - s * f); - float t = v * (1.0f - s * (1.0f - f)); - - switch (i) - { - case 0: out_r = v; out_g = t; out_b = p; break; - case 1: out_r = q; out_g = v; out_b = p; break; - case 2: out_r = p; out_g = v; out_b = t; break; - case 3: out_r = p; out_g = q; out_b = v; break; - case 4: out_r = t; out_g = p; out_b = v; break; - case 5: default: out_r = v; out_g = p; out_b = q; break; - } -} - -FILE* ImFileOpen(const char* filename, const char* mode) -{ -#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(__CYGWIN__) - // We need a fopen() wrapper because MSVC/Windows fopen doesn't handle UTF-8 filenames. Converting both strings from UTF-8 to wchar format (using a single allocation, because we can) - const int filename_wsize = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(filename, NULL) + 1; - const int mode_wsize = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(mode, NULL) + 1; - ImVector buf; - buf.resize(filename_wsize + mode_wsize); - ImTextStrFromUtf8(&buf[0], filename_wsize, filename, NULL); - ImTextStrFromUtf8(&buf[filename_wsize], mode_wsize, mode, NULL); - return _wfopen((wchar_t*)&buf[0], (wchar_t*)&buf[filename_wsize]); -#else - return fopen(filename, mode); -#endif -} - -// Load file content into memory -// Memory allocated with ImGui::MemAlloc(), must be freed by user using ImGui::MemFree() -void* ImFileLoadToMemory(const char* filename, const char* file_open_mode, int* out_file_size, int padding_bytes) -{ - IM_ASSERT(filename && file_open_mode); - if (out_file_size) - *out_file_size = 0; - - FILE* f; - if ((f = ImFileOpen(filename, file_open_mode)) == NULL) - return NULL; - - long file_size_signed; - if (fseek(f, 0, SEEK_END) || (file_size_signed = ftell(f)) == -1 || fseek(f, 0, SEEK_SET)) - { - fclose(f); - return NULL; - } - - int file_size = (int)file_size_signed; - void* file_data = ImGui::MemAlloc(file_size + padding_bytes); - if (file_data == NULL) - { - fclose(f); - return NULL; - } - if (fread(file_data, 1, (size_t)file_size, f) != (size_t)file_size) - { - fclose(f); - ImGui::MemFree(file_data); - return NULL; - } - if (padding_bytes > 0) - memset((void *)(((char*)file_data) + file_size), 0, padding_bytes); - - fclose(f); - if (out_file_size) - *out_file_size = file_size; - - return file_data; -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// ImGuiStorage -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -// Helper: Key->value storage -void ImGuiStorage::Clear() -{ - Data.clear(); -} - -// std::lower_bound but without the bullshit -static ImVector::iterator LowerBound(ImVector& data, ImGuiID key) -{ - ImVector::iterator first = data.begin(); - ImVector::iterator last = data.end(); - int count = (int)(last - first); - while (count > 0) - { - int count2 = count / 2; - ImVector::iterator mid = first + count2; - if (mid->key < key) - { - first = ++mid; - count -= count2 + 1; - } - else - { - count = count2; - } - } - return first; -} - -int ImGuiStorage::GetInt(ImGuiID key, int default_val) const -{ - ImVector::iterator it = LowerBound(const_cast&>(Data), key); - if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) - return default_val; - return it->val_i; -} - -bool ImGuiStorage::GetBool(ImGuiID key, bool default_val) const -{ - return GetInt(key, default_val ? 1 : 0) != 0; -} - -float ImGuiStorage::GetFloat(ImGuiID key, float default_val) const -{ - ImVector::iterator it = LowerBound(const_cast&>(Data), key); - if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) - return default_val; - return it->val_f; -} - -void* ImGuiStorage::GetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key) const -{ - ImVector::iterator it = LowerBound(const_cast&>(Data), key); - if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) - return NULL; - return it->val_p; -} - -// References are only valid until a new value is added to the storage. Calling a Set***() function or a Get***Ref() function invalidates the pointer. -int* ImGuiStorage::GetIntRef(ImGuiID key, int default_val) -{ - ImVector::iterator it = LowerBound(Data, key); - if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) - it = Data.insert(it, Pair(key, default_val)); - return &it->val_i; -} - -bool* ImGuiStorage::GetBoolRef(ImGuiID key, bool default_val) -{ - return (bool*)GetIntRef(key, default_val ? 1 : 0); -} - -float* ImGuiStorage::GetFloatRef(ImGuiID key, float default_val) -{ - ImVector::iterator it = LowerBound(Data, key); - if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) - it = Data.insert(it, Pair(key, default_val)); - return &it->val_f; -} - -void** ImGuiStorage::GetVoidPtrRef(ImGuiID key, void* default_val) -{ - ImVector::iterator it = LowerBound(Data, key); - if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) - it = Data.insert(it, Pair(key, default_val)); - return &it->val_p; -} - -// FIXME-OPT: Need a way to reuse the result of lower_bound when doing GetInt()/SetInt() - not too bad because it only happens on explicit interaction (maximum one a frame) -void ImGuiStorage::SetInt(ImGuiID key, int val) -{ - ImVector::iterator it = LowerBound(Data, key); - if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) - { - Data.insert(it, Pair(key, val)); - return; - } - it->val_i = val; -} - -void ImGuiStorage::SetBool(ImGuiID key, bool val) -{ - SetInt(key, val ? 1 : 0); -} - -void ImGuiStorage::SetFloat(ImGuiID key, float val) -{ - ImVector::iterator it = LowerBound(Data, key); - if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) - { - Data.insert(it, Pair(key, val)); - return; - } - it->val_f = val; -} - -void ImGuiStorage::SetVoidPtr(ImGuiID key, void* val) -{ - ImVector::iterator it = LowerBound(Data, key); - if (it == Data.end() || it->key != key) - { - Data.insert(it, Pair(key, val)); - return; - } - it->val_p = val; -} - -void ImGuiStorage::SetAllInt(int v) -{ - for (int i = 0; i < Data.Size; i++) - Data[i].val_i = v; -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// ImGuiTextFilter -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -// Helper: Parse and apply text filters. In format "aaaaa[,bbbb][,ccccc]" -ImGuiTextFilter::ImGuiTextFilter(const char* default_filter) -{ - if (default_filter) - { - ImStrncpy(InputBuf, default_filter, IM_ARRAYSIZE(InputBuf)); - Build(); - } - else - { - InputBuf[0] = 0; - CountGrep = 0; - } -} - -bool ImGuiTextFilter::Draw(const char* label, float width) -{ - if (width != 0.0f) - ImGui::PushItemWidth(width); - bool value_changed = ImGui::InputText(label, InputBuf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(InputBuf)); - if (width != 0.0f) - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - if (value_changed) - Build(); - return value_changed; -} - -void ImGuiTextFilter::TextRange::split(char separator, ImVector& out) -{ - out.resize(0); - const char* wb = b; - const char* we = wb; - while (we < e) - { - if (*we == separator) - { - out.push_back(TextRange(wb, we)); - wb = we + 1; - } - we++; - } - if (wb != we) - out.push_back(TextRange(wb, we)); -} - -void ImGuiTextFilter::Build() -{ - Filters.resize(0); - TextRange input_range(InputBuf, InputBuf+strlen(InputBuf)); - input_range.split(',', Filters); - - CountGrep = 0; - for (int i = 0; i != Filters.Size; i++) - { - Filters[i].trim_blanks(); - if (Filters[i].empty()) - continue; - if (Filters[i].front() != '-') - CountGrep += 1; - } -} - -bool ImGuiTextFilter::PassFilter(const char* text, const char* text_end) const -{ - if (Filters.empty()) - return true; - - if (text == NULL) - text = ""; - - for (int i = 0; i != Filters.Size; i++) - { - const TextRange& f = Filters[i]; - if (f.empty()) - continue; - if (f.front() == '-') - { - // Subtract - if (ImStristr(text, text_end, f.begin()+1, f.end()) != NULL) - return false; - } - else - { - // Grep - if (ImStristr(text, text_end, f.begin(), f.end()) != NULL) - return true; - } - } - - // Implicit * grep - if (CountGrep == 0) - return true; - - return false; -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// ImGuiTextBuffer -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -// On some platform vsnprintf() takes va_list by reference and modifies it. -// va_copy is the 'correct' way to copy a va_list but Visual Studio prior to 2013 doesn't have it. -#ifndef va_copy -#define va_copy(dest, src) (dest = src) -#endif - -// Helper: Text buffer for logging/accumulating text -void ImGuiTextBuffer::appendv(const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - va_list args_copy; - va_copy(args_copy, args); - - int len = vsnprintf(NULL, 0, fmt, args); // FIXME-OPT: could do a first pass write attempt, likely successful on first pass. - if (len <= 0) - return; - - const int write_off = Buf.Size; - const int needed_sz = write_off + len; - if (write_off + len >= Buf.Capacity) - { - int double_capacity = Buf.Capacity * 2; - Buf.reserve(needed_sz > double_capacity ? needed_sz : double_capacity); - } - - Buf.resize(needed_sz); - ImFormatStringV(&Buf[write_off] - 1, len+1, fmt, args_copy); -} - -void ImGuiTextBuffer::append(const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - appendv(fmt, args); - va_end(args); -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// ImGuiSimpleColumns -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -ImGuiSimpleColumns::ImGuiSimpleColumns() -{ - Count = 0; - Spacing = Width = NextWidth = 0.0f; - memset(Pos, 0, sizeof(Pos)); - memset(NextWidths, 0, sizeof(NextWidths)); -} - -void ImGuiSimpleColumns::Update(int count, float spacing, bool clear) -{ - IM_ASSERT(Count <= IM_ARRAYSIZE(Pos)); - Count = count; - Width = NextWidth = 0.0f; - Spacing = spacing; - if (clear) memset(NextWidths, 0, sizeof(NextWidths)); - for (int i = 0; i < Count; i++) - { - if (i > 0 && NextWidths[i] > 0.0f) - Width += Spacing; - Pos[i] = (float)(int)Width; - Width += NextWidths[i]; - NextWidths[i] = 0.0f; - } -} - -float ImGuiSimpleColumns::DeclColumns(float w0, float w1, float w2) // not using va_arg because they promote float to double -{ - NextWidth = 0.0f; - NextWidths[0] = ImMax(NextWidths[0], w0); - NextWidths[1] = ImMax(NextWidths[1], w1); - NextWidths[2] = ImMax(NextWidths[2], w2); - for (int i = 0; i < 3; i++) - NextWidth += NextWidths[i] + ((i > 0 && NextWidths[i] > 0.0f) ? Spacing : 0.0f); - return ImMax(Width, NextWidth); -} - -float ImGuiSimpleColumns::CalcExtraSpace(float avail_w) -{ - return ImMax(0.0f, avail_w - Width); -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// ImGuiListClipper -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -static void SetCursorPosYAndSetupDummyPrevLine(float pos_y, float line_height) -{ - // Set cursor position and a few other things so that SetScrollHere() and Columns() can work when seeking cursor. - // FIXME: It is problematic that we have to do that here, because custom/equivalent end-user code would stumble on the same issue. Consider moving within SetCursorXXX functions? - ImGui::SetCursorPosY(pos_y); - ImGuiWindow* window = ImGui::GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y = window->DC.CursorPos.y - line_height; // Setting those fields so that SetScrollHere() can properly function after the end of our clipper usage. - window->DC.PrevLineHeight = (line_height - GImGui->Style.ItemSpacing.y); // If we end up needing more accurate data (to e.g. use SameLine) we may as well make the clipper have a fourth step to let user process and display the last item in their list. - if (window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1) - window->DC.ColumnsCellMinY = window->DC.CursorPos.y; // Setting this so that cell Y position are set properly -} - -// Use case A: Begin() called from constructor with items_height<0, then called again from Sync() in StepNo 1 -// Use case B: Begin() called from constructor with items_height>0 -// FIXME-LEGACY: Ideally we should remove the Begin/End functions but they are part of the legacy API we still support. This is why some of the code in Step() calling Begin() and reassign some fields, spaghetti style. -void ImGuiListClipper::Begin(int count, float items_height) -{ - StartPosY = ImGui::GetCursorPosY(); - ItemsHeight = items_height; - ItemsCount = count; - StepNo = 0; - DisplayEnd = DisplayStart = -1; - if (ItemsHeight > 0.0f) - { - ImGui::CalcListClipping(ItemsCount, ItemsHeight, &DisplayStart, &DisplayEnd); // calculate how many to clip/display - if (DisplayStart > 0) - SetCursorPosYAndSetupDummyPrevLine(StartPosY + DisplayStart * ItemsHeight, ItemsHeight); // advance cursor - StepNo = 2; - } -} - -void ImGuiListClipper::End() -{ - if (ItemsCount < 0) - return; - // In theory here we should assert that ImGui::GetCursorPosY() == StartPosY + DisplayEnd * ItemsHeight, but it feels saner to just seek at the end and not assert/crash the user. - if (ItemsCount < INT_MAX) - SetCursorPosYAndSetupDummyPrevLine(StartPosY + ItemsCount * ItemsHeight, ItemsHeight); // advance cursor - ItemsCount = -1; - StepNo = 3; -} - -bool ImGuiListClipper::Step() -{ - if (ItemsCount == 0 || ImGui::GetCurrentWindowRead()->SkipItems) - { - ItemsCount = -1; - return false; - } - if (StepNo == 0) // Step 0: the clipper let you process the first element, regardless of it being visible or not, so we can measure the element height. - { - DisplayStart = 0; - DisplayEnd = 1; - StartPosY = ImGui::GetCursorPosY(); - StepNo = 1; - return true; - } - if (StepNo == 1) // Step 1: the clipper infer height from first element, calculate the actual range of elements to display, and position the cursor before the first element. - { - if (ItemsCount == 1) { ItemsCount = -1; return false; } - float items_height = ImGui::GetCursorPosY() - StartPosY; - IM_ASSERT(items_height > 0.0f); // If this triggers, it means Item 0 hasn't moved the cursor vertically - Begin(ItemsCount-1, items_height); - DisplayStart++; - DisplayEnd++; - StepNo = 3; - return true; - } - if (StepNo == 2) // Step 2: dummy step only required if an explicit items_height was passed to constructor or Begin() and user still call Step(). Does nothing and switch to Step 3. - { - IM_ASSERT(DisplayStart >= 0 && DisplayEnd >= 0); - StepNo = 3; - return true; - } - if (StepNo == 3) // Step 3: the clipper validate that we have reached the expected Y position (corresponding to element DisplayEnd), advance the cursor to the end of the list and then returns 'false' to end the loop. - End(); - return false; -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// ImGuiWindow -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -ImGuiWindow::ImGuiWindow(const char* name) -{ - Name = ImStrdup(name); - ID = ImHash(name, 0); - IDStack.push_back(ID); - MoveId = GetID("#MOVE"); - - Flags = 0; - IndexWithinParent = 0; - PosFloat = Pos = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - Size = SizeFull = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - SizeContents = SizeContentsExplicit = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - WindowPadding = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - Scroll = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - ScrollTarget = ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX); - ScrollTargetCenterRatio = ImVec2(0.5f, 0.5f); - ScrollbarX = ScrollbarY = false; - ScrollbarSizes = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - BorderSize = 0.0f; - Active = WasActive = false; - Accessed = false; - Collapsed = false; - SkipItems = false; - BeginCount = 0; - PopupId = 0; - AutoFitFramesX = AutoFitFramesY = -1; - AutoFitOnlyGrows = false; - AutoPosLastDirection = -1; - HiddenFrames = 0; - SetWindowPosAllowFlags = SetWindowSizeAllowFlags = SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags = ImGuiSetCond_Always | ImGuiSetCond_Once | ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiSetCond_Appearing; - SetWindowPosCenterWanted = false; - - LastFrameActive = -1; - ItemWidthDefault = 0.0f; - FontWindowScale = 1.0f; - - DrawList = (ImDrawList*)ImGui::MemAlloc(sizeof(ImDrawList)); - IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(DrawList) ImDrawList(); - DrawList->_OwnerName = Name; - RootWindow = NULL; - RootNonPopupWindow = NULL; - ParentWindow = NULL; - - FocusIdxAllCounter = FocusIdxTabCounter = -1; - FocusIdxAllRequestCurrent = FocusIdxTabRequestCurrent = INT_MAX; - FocusIdxAllRequestNext = FocusIdxTabRequestNext = INT_MAX; -} - -ImGuiWindow::~ImGuiWindow() -{ - DrawList->~ImDrawList(); - ImGui::MemFree(DrawList); - DrawList = NULL; - ImGui::MemFree(Name); - Name = NULL; -} - -ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetID(const char* str, const char* str_end) -{ - ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back(); - ImGuiID id = ImHash(str, str_end ? (int)(str_end - str) : 0, seed); - ImGui::KeepAliveID(id); - return id; -} - -ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetID(const void* ptr) -{ - ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back(); - ImGuiID id = ImHash(&ptr, sizeof(void*), seed); - ImGui::KeepAliveID(id); - return id; -} - -ImGuiID ImGuiWindow::GetIDNoKeepAlive(const char* str, const char* str_end) -{ - ImGuiID seed = IDStack.back(); - return ImHash(str, str_end ? (int)(str_end - str) : 0, seed); -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Internal API exposed in imgui_internal.h -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -static void SetCurrentWindow(ImGuiWindow* window) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.CurrentWindow = window; - if (window) - g.FontSize = window->CalcFontSize(); -} - -ImGuiWindow* ImGui::GetParentWindow() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindowStack.Size >= 2); - return g.CurrentWindowStack[(unsigned int)g.CurrentWindowStack.Size - 2]; -} - -void ImGui::SetActiveID(ImGuiID id, ImGuiWindow* window) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.ActiveId = id; - g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap = false; - g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated = true; - if (id) - g.ActiveIdIsAlive = true; - g.ActiveIdWindow = window; -} - -void ImGui::ClearActiveID() -{ - SetActiveID(0, NULL); -} - -void ImGui::SetHoveredID(ImGuiID id) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.HoveredId = id; - g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap = false; -} - -void ImGui::KeepAliveID(ImGuiID id) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.ActiveId == id) - g.ActiveIdIsAlive = true; -} - -// Advance cursor given item size for layout. -void ImGui::ItemSize(const ImVec2& size, float text_offset_y) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - // Always align ourselves on pixel boundaries - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const float line_height = ImMax(window->DC.CurrentLineHeight, size.y); - const float text_base_offset = ImMax(window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset, text_offset_y); - window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine = ImVec2(window->DC.CursorPos.x + size.x, window->DC.CursorPos.y); - window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2((float)(int)(window->Pos.x + window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX), (float)(int)(window->DC.CursorPos.y + line_height + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y)); - window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x, window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.x); - window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y, window->DC.CursorPos.y); - - //window->DrawList->AddCircle(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, 3.0f, IM_COL32(255,0,0,255), 4); // Debug - - window->DC.PrevLineHeight = line_height; - window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset = text_base_offset; - window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f; -} - -void ImGui::ItemSize(const ImRect& bb, float text_offset_y) -{ - ItemSize(bb.GetSize(), text_offset_y); -} - -// Declare item bounding box for clipping and interaction. -// Note that the size can be different than the one provided to ItemSize(). Typically, widgets that spread over available surface -// declares their minimum size requirement to ItemSize() and then use a larger region for drawing/interaction, which is passed to ItemAdd(). -bool ImGui::ItemAdd(const ImRect& bb, const ImGuiID* id) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.LastItemId = id ? *id : 0; - window->DC.LastItemRect = bb; - window->DC.LastItemHoveredAndUsable = window->DC.LastItemHoveredRect = false; - if (IsClippedEx(bb, id, false)) - return false; - - // This is a sensible default, but widgets are free to override it after calling ItemAdd() - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (IsMouseHoveringRect(bb.Min, bb.Max)) - { - // Matching the behavior of IsHovered() but allow if ActiveId==window->MoveID (we clicked on the window background) - // So that clicking on items with no active id such as Text() still returns true with IsItemHovered() - window->DC.LastItemHoveredRect = true; - if (g.HoveredRootWindow == window->RootWindow) - if (g.ActiveId == 0 || (id && g.ActiveId == *id) || g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap || (g.ActiveId == window->MoveId)) - if (IsWindowContentHoverable(window)) - window->DC.LastItemHoveredAndUsable = true; - } - - return true; -} - -bool ImGui::IsClippedEx(const ImRect& bb, const ImGuiID* id, bool clip_even_when_logged) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - - if (!bb.Overlaps(window->ClipRect)) - if (!id || *id != GImGui->ActiveId) - if (clip_even_when_logged || !g.LogEnabled) - return true; - return false; -} - -// NB: This is an internal helper. The user-facing IsItemHovered() is using data emitted from ItemAdd(), with a slightly different logic. -bool ImGui::IsHovered(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool flatten_childs) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.HoveredId == 0 || g.HoveredId == id || g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap) - { - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - if (g.HoveredWindow == window || (flatten_childs && g.HoveredRootWindow == window->RootWindow)) - if ((g.ActiveId == 0 || g.ActiveId == id || g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap) && IsMouseHoveringRect(bb.Min, bb.Max)) - if (IsWindowContentHoverable(g.HoveredRootWindow)) - return true; - } - return false; -} - -bool ImGui::FocusableItemRegister(ImGuiWindow* window, bool is_active, bool tab_stop) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - - const bool allow_keyboard_focus = window->DC.AllowKeyboardFocus; - window->FocusIdxAllCounter++; - if (allow_keyboard_focus) - window->FocusIdxTabCounter++; - - // Process keyboard input at this point: TAB, Shift-TAB switch focus - // We can always TAB out of a widget that doesn't allow tabbing in. - if (tab_stop && window->FocusIdxAllRequestNext == INT_MAX && window->FocusIdxTabRequestNext == INT_MAX && is_active && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab)) - { - // Modulo on index will be applied at the end of frame once we've got the total counter of items. - window->FocusIdxTabRequestNext = window->FocusIdxTabCounter + (g.IO.KeyShift ? (allow_keyboard_focus ? -1 : 0) : +1); - } - - if (window->FocusIdxAllCounter == window->FocusIdxAllRequestCurrent) - return true; - - if (allow_keyboard_focus) - if (window->FocusIdxTabCounter == window->FocusIdxTabRequestCurrent) - return true; - - return false; -} - -void ImGui::FocusableItemUnregister(ImGuiWindow* window) -{ - window->FocusIdxAllCounter--; - window->FocusIdxTabCounter--; -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::CalcItemSize(ImVec2 size, float default_x, float default_y) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImVec2 content_max; - if (size.x < 0.0f || size.y < 0.0f) - content_max = g.CurrentWindow->Pos + GetContentRegionMax(); - if (size.x <= 0.0f) - size.x = (size.x == 0.0f) ? default_x : ImMax(content_max.x - g.CurrentWindow->DC.CursorPos.x, 4.0f) + size.x; - if (size.y <= 0.0f) - size.y = (size.y == 0.0f) ? default_y : ImMax(content_max.y - g.CurrentWindow->DC.CursorPos.y, 4.0f) + size.y; - return size; -} - -float ImGui::CalcWrapWidthForPos(const ImVec2& pos, float wrap_pos_x) -{ - if (wrap_pos_x < 0.0f) - return 0.0f; - - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - if (wrap_pos_x == 0.0f) - wrap_pos_x = GetContentRegionMax().x + window->Pos.x; - else if (wrap_pos_x > 0.0f) - wrap_pos_x += window->Pos.x - window->Scroll.x; // wrap_pos_x is provided is window local space - - return ImMax(wrap_pos_x - pos.x, 1.0f); -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -void* ImGui::MemAlloc(size_t sz) -{ - GImGui->IO.MetricsAllocs++; - return GImGui->IO.MemAllocFn(sz); -} - -void ImGui::MemFree(void* ptr) -{ - if (ptr) GImGui->IO.MetricsAllocs--; - return GImGui->IO.MemFreeFn(ptr); -} - -const char* ImGui::GetClipboardText() -{ - return GImGui->IO.GetClipboardTextFn ? GImGui->IO.GetClipboardTextFn(GImGui->IO.ClipboardUserData) : ""; -} - -void ImGui::SetClipboardText(const char* text) -{ - if (GImGui->IO.SetClipboardTextFn) - GImGui->IO.SetClipboardTextFn(GImGui->IO.ClipboardUserData, text); -} - -const char* ImGui::GetVersion() -{ - return IMGUI_VERSION; -} - -// Internal state access - if you want to share ImGui state between modules (e.g. DLL) or allocate it yourself -// Note that we still point to some static data and members (such as GFontAtlas), so the state instance you end up using will point to the static data within its module -ImGuiContext* ImGui::GetCurrentContext() -{ - return GImGui; -} - -void ImGui::SetCurrentContext(ImGuiContext* ctx) -{ -#ifdef IMGUI_SET_CURRENT_CONTEXT_FUNC - IMGUI_SET_CURRENT_CONTEXT_FUNC(ctx); // For custom thread-based hackery you may want to have control over this. -#else - GImGui = ctx; -#endif -} - -ImGuiContext* ImGui::CreateContext(void* (*malloc_fn)(size_t), void (*free_fn)(void*)) -{ - if (!malloc_fn) malloc_fn = malloc; - ImGuiContext* ctx = (ImGuiContext*)malloc_fn(sizeof(ImGuiContext)); - IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(ctx) ImGuiContext(); - ctx->IO.MemAllocFn = malloc_fn; - ctx->IO.MemFreeFn = free_fn ? free_fn : free; - return ctx; -} - -void ImGui::DestroyContext(ImGuiContext* ctx) -{ - void (*free_fn)(void*) = ctx->IO.MemFreeFn; - ctx->~ImGuiContext(); - free_fn(ctx); - if (GImGui == ctx) - SetCurrentContext(NULL); -} - -ImGuiIO& ImGui::GetIO() -{ - return GImGui->IO; -} - -ImGuiStyle& ImGui::GetStyle() -{ - return GImGui->Style; -} - -// Same value as passed to your RenderDrawListsFn() function. valid after Render() and until the next call to NewFrame() -ImDrawData* ImGui::GetDrawData() -{ - return GImGui->RenderDrawData.Valid ? &GImGui->RenderDrawData : NULL; -} - -float ImGui::GetTime() -{ - return GImGui->Time; -} - -int ImGui::GetFrameCount() -{ - return GImGui->FrameCount; -} - -void ImGui::NewFrame() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - - // Check user data - IM_ASSERT(g.IO.DeltaTime >= 0.0f); // Need a positive DeltaTime (zero is tolerated but will cause some timing issues) - IM_ASSERT(g.IO.DisplaySize.x >= 0.0f && g.IO.DisplaySize.y >= 0.0f); - IM_ASSERT(g.IO.Fonts->Fonts.Size > 0); // Font Atlas not created. Did you call io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32 / GetTexDataAsAlpha8 ? - IM_ASSERT(g.IO.Fonts->Fonts[0]->IsLoaded()); // Font Atlas not created. Did you call io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32 / GetTexDataAsAlpha8 ? - IM_ASSERT(g.Style.CurveTessellationTol > 0.0f); // Invalid style setting - - if (!g.Initialized) - { - // Initialize on first frame - g.LogClipboard = (ImGuiTextBuffer*)ImGui::MemAlloc(sizeof(ImGuiTextBuffer)); - IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(g.LogClipboard) ImGuiTextBuffer(); - - IM_ASSERT(g.Settings.empty()); - //LoadIniSettingsFromDisk(g.IO.IniFilename); - g.Initialized = true; - } - - SetCurrentFont(GetDefaultFont()); - IM_ASSERT(g.Font->IsLoaded()); - - g.Time += g.IO.DeltaTime; - g.FrameCount += 1; - g.Tooltip[0] = '\0'; - g.OverlayDrawList.Clear(); - g.OverlayDrawList.PushTextureID(g.IO.Fonts->TexID); - g.OverlayDrawList.PushClipRectFullScreen(); - - // Mark rendering data as invalid to prevent user who may have a handle on it to use it - g.RenderDrawData.Valid = false; - g.RenderDrawData.CmdLists = NULL; - g.RenderDrawData.CmdListsCount = g.RenderDrawData.TotalVtxCount = g.RenderDrawData.TotalIdxCount = 0; - - // Update inputs state - if (g.IO.MousePos.x < 0 && g.IO.MousePos.y < 0) - g.IO.MousePos = ImVec2(-9999.0f, -9999.0f); - if ((g.IO.MousePos.x < 0 && g.IO.MousePos.y < 0) || (g.IO.MousePosPrev.x < 0 && g.IO.MousePosPrev.y < 0)) // if mouse just appeared or disappeared (negative coordinate) we cancel out movement in MouseDelta - g.IO.MouseDelta = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - else - g.IO.MouseDelta = g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MousePosPrev; - g.IO.MousePosPrev = g.IO.MousePos; - for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown); i++) - { - g.IO.MouseClicked[i] = g.IO.MouseDown[i] && g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] < 0.0f; - g.IO.MouseReleased[i] = !g.IO.MouseDown[i] && g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] >= 0.0f; - g.IO.MouseDownDurationPrev[i] = g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i]; - g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] = g.IO.MouseDown[i] ? (g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] < 0.0f ? 0.0f : g.IO.MouseDownDuration[i] + g.IO.DeltaTime) : -1.0f; - g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[i] = false; - if (g.IO.MouseClicked[i]) - { - if (g.Time - g.IO.MouseClickedTime[i] < g.IO.MouseDoubleClickTime) - { - if (ImLengthSqr(g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseClickedPos[i]) < g.IO.MouseDoubleClickMaxDist * g.IO.MouseDoubleClickMaxDist) - g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[i] = true; - g.IO.MouseClickedTime[i] = -FLT_MAX; // so the third click isn't turned into a double-click - } - else - { - g.IO.MouseClickedTime[i] = g.Time; - } - g.IO.MouseClickedPos[i] = g.IO.MousePos; - g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[i] = 0.0f; - } - else if (g.IO.MouseDown[i]) - { - g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[i] = ImMax(g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[i], ImLengthSqr(g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseClickedPos[i])); - } - } - memcpy(g.IO.KeysDownDurationPrev, g.IO.KeysDownDuration, sizeof(g.IO.KeysDownDuration)); - for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown); i++) - g.IO.KeysDownDuration[i] = g.IO.KeysDown[i] ? (g.IO.KeysDownDuration[i] < 0.0f ? 0.0f : g.IO.KeysDownDuration[i] + g.IO.DeltaTime) : -1.0f; - - // Calculate frame-rate for the user, as a purely luxurious feature - g.FramerateSecPerFrameAccum += g.IO.DeltaTime - g.FramerateSecPerFrame[g.FramerateSecPerFrameIdx]; - g.FramerateSecPerFrame[g.FramerateSecPerFrameIdx] = g.IO.DeltaTime; - g.FramerateSecPerFrameIdx = (g.FramerateSecPerFrameIdx + 1) % IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.FramerateSecPerFrame); - g.IO.Framerate = 1.0f / (g.FramerateSecPerFrameAccum / (float)IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.FramerateSecPerFrame)); - - // Clear reference to active widget if the widget isn't alive anymore - g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame = g.HoveredId; - g.HoveredId = 0; - g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap = false; - if (!g.ActiveIdIsAlive && g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame == g.ActiveId && g.ActiveId != 0) - ClearActiveID(); - g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame = g.ActiveId; - g.ActiveIdIsAlive = false; - g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated = false; - - // Handle user moving window (at the beginning of the frame to avoid input lag or sheering). Only valid for root windows. - if (g.MovedWindowMoveId && g.MovedWindowMoveId == g.ActiveId) - { - KeepAliveID(g.MovedWindowMoveId); - IM_ASSERT(g.MovedWindow && g.MovedWindow->RootWindow); - IM_ASSERT(g.MovedWindow->RootWindow->MoveId == g.MovedWindowMoveId); - if (g.IO.MouseDown[0]) - { - if (!(g.MovedWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove)) - { - g.MovedWindow->PosFloat += g.IO.MouseDelta; - if (!(g.MovedWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings) && (g.IO.MouseDelta.x != 0.0f || g.IO.MouseDelta.y != 0.0f)) - MarkIniSettingsDirty(); - } - FocusWindow(g.MovedWindow); - } - else - { - ClearActiveID(); - g.MovedWindow = NULL; - g.MovedWindowMoveId = 0; - } - } - else - { - g.MovedWindow = NULL; - g.MovedWindowMoveId = 0; - } - - // Delay saving settings so we don't spam disk too much - if (g.SettingsDirtyTimer > 0.0f) - { - g.SettingsDirtyTimer -= g.IO.DeltaTime; - //if (g.SettingsDirtyTimer <= 0.0f) - //SaveIniSettingsToDisk(g.IO.IniFilename); - } - - // Find the window we are hovering. Child windows can extend beyond the limit of their parent so we need to derive HoveredRootWindow from HoveredWindow - g.HoveredWindow = g.MovedWindow ? g.MovedWindow : FindHoveredWindow(g.IO.MousePos, false); - if (g.HoveredWindow && (g.HoveredWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) - g.HoveredRootWindow = g.HoveredWindow->RootWindow; - else - g.HoveredRootWindow = g.MovedWindow ? g.MovedWindow->RootWindow : FindHoveredWindow(g.IO.MousePos, true); - - if (ImGuiWindow* modal_window = GetFrontMostModalRootWindow()) - { - g.ModalWindowDarkeningRatio = ImMin(g.ModalWindowDarkeningRatio + g.IO.DeltaTime * 6.0f, 1.0f); - ImGuiWindow* window = g.HoveredRootWindow; - while (window && window != modal_window) - window = window->ParentWindow; - if (!window) - g.HoveredRootWindow = g.HoveredWindow = NULL; - } - else - { - g.ModalWindowDarkeningRatio = 0.0f; - } - - // Are we using inputs? Tell user so they can capture/discard the inputs away from the rest of their application. - // When clicking outside of a window we assume the click is owned by the application and won't request capture. We need to track click ownership. - int mouse_earliest_button_down = -1; - bool mouse_any_down = false; - for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown); i++) - { - if (g.IO.MouseClicked[i]) - g.IO.MouseDownOwned[i] = (g.HoveredWindow != NULL) || (!g.OpenPopupStack.empty()); - mouse_any_down |= g.IO.MouseDown[i]; - if (g.IO.MouseDown[i]) - if (mouse_earliest_button_down == -1 || g.IO.MouseClickedTime[mouse_earliest_button_down] > g.IO.MouseClickedTime[i]) - mouse_earliest_button_down = i; - } - bool mouse_avail_to_imgui = (mouse_earliest_button_down == -1) || g.IO.MouseDownOwned[mouse_earliest_button_down]; - if (g.CaptureMouseNextFrame != -1) - g.IO.WantCaptureMouse = (g.CaptureMouseNextFrame != 0); - else - g.IO.WantCaptureMouse = (mouse_avail_to_imgui && (g.HoveredWindow != NULL || mouse_any_down)) || (g.ActiveId != 0) || (!g.OpenPopupStack.empty()); - g.IO.WantCaptureKeyboard = (g.CaptureKeyboardNextFrame != -1) ? (g.CaptureKeyboardNextFrame != 0) : (g.ActiveId != 0); - g.IO.WantTextInput = (g.ActiveId != 0 && g.InputTextState.Id == g.ActiveId); - g.MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow; - g.CaptureMouseNextFrame = g.CaptureKeyboardNextFrame = -1; - g.OsImePosRequest = ImVec2(1.0f, 1.0f); // OS Input Method Editor showing on top-left of our window by default - - // If mouse was first clicked outside of ImGui bounds we also cancel out hovering. - if (!mouse_avail_to_imgui) - g.HoveredWindow = g.HoveredRootWindow = NULL; - - // Scale & Scrolling - if (g.HoveredWindow && g.IO.MouseWheel != 0.0f && !g.HoveredWindow->Collapsed) - { - ImGuiWindow* window = g.HoveredWindow; - if (g.IO.KeyCtrl) - { - if (g.IO.FontAllowUserScaling) - { - // Zoom / Scale window - float new_font_scale = ImClamp(window->FontWindowScale + g.IO.MouseWheel * 0.10f, 0.50f, 2.50f); - float scale = new_font_scale / window->FontWindowScale; - window->FontWindowScale = new_font_scale; - - const ImVec2 offset = window->Size * (1.0f - scale) * (g.IO.MousePos - window->Pos) / window->Size; - window->Pos += offset; - window->PosFloat += offset; - window->Size *= scale; - window->SizeFull *= scale; - } - } - else if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollWithMouse)) - { - // Scroll - const int scroll_lines = (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox) ? 3 : 5; - SetWindowScrollY(window, window->Scroll.y - g.IO.MouseWheel * window->CalcFontSize() * scroll_lines); - } - } - - // Pressing TAB activate widget focus - // NB: Don't discard FocusedWindow if it isn't active, so that a window that go on/off programatically won't lose its keyboard focus. - if (g.ActiveId == 0 && g.FocusedWindow != NULL && g.FocusedWindow->Active && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab, false)) - g.FocusedWindow->FocusIdxTabRequestNext = 0; - - // Mark all windows as not visible - for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++) - { - ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i]; - window->WasActive = window->Active; - window->Active = false; - window->Accessed = false; - } - - // Closing the focused window restore focus to the first active root window in descending z-order - if (g.FocusedWindow && !g.FocusedWindow->WasActive) - for (int i = g.Windows.Size-1; i >= 0; i--) - if (g.Windows[i]->WasActive && !(g.Windows[i]->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) - { - FocusWindow(g.Windows[i]); - break; - } - - // No window should be open at the beginning of the frame. - // But in order to allow the user to call NewFrame() multiple times without calling Render(), we are doing an explicit clear. - g.CurrentWindowStack.resize(0); - g.CurrentPopupStack.resize(0); - CloseInactivePopups(); - - // Create implicit window - we will only render it if the user has added something to it. - ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(400,400), ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver); - ImGui::Begin("Debug"); -} - -// NB: behavior of ImGui after Shutdown() is not tested/guaranteed at the moment. This function is merely here to free heap allocations. -void ImGui::Shutdown() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - - // The fonts atlas can be used prior to calling NewFrame(), so we clear it even if g.Initialized is FALSE (which would happen if we never called NewFrame) - if (g.IO.Fonts) // Testing for NULL to allow user to NULLify in case of running Shutdown() on multiple contexts. Bit hacky. - g.IO.Fonts->Clear(); - - // Cleanup of other data are conditional on actually having used ImGui. - if (!g.Initialized) - return; - - //SaveIniSettingsToDisk(g.IO.IniFilename); - - for (int i = 0; i < g.Windows.Size; i++) - { - g.Windows[i]->~ImGuiWindow(); - ImGui::MemFree(g.Windows[i]); - } - g.Windows.clear(); - g.WindowsSortBuffer.clear(); - g.CurrentWindow = NULL; - g.CurrentWindowStack.clear(); - g.FocusedWindow = NULL; - g.HoveredWindow = NULL; - g.HoveredRootWindow = NULL; - g.ActiveIdWindow = NULL; - g.MovedWindow = NULL; - for (int i = 0; i < g.Settings.Size; i++) - ImGui::MemFree(g.Settings[i].Name); - g.Settings.clear(); - g.ColorModifiers.clear(); - g.StyleModifiers.clear(); - g.FontStack.clear(); - g.OpenPopupStack.clear(); - g.CurrentPopupStack.clear(); - g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallback = NULL; - g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallbackUserData = NULL; - for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.RenderDrawLists); i++) - g.RenderDrawLists[i].clear(); - g.OverlayDrawList.ClearFreeMemory(); - g.ColorEditModeStorage.Clear(); - if (g.PrivateClipboard) - { - ImGui::MemFree(g.PrivateClipboard); - g.PrivateClipboard = NULL; - } - g.InputTextState.Text.clear(); - g.InputTextState.InitialText.clear(); - g.InputTextState.TempTextBuffer.clear(); - - if (g.LogFile && g.LogFile != stdout) - { - fclose(g.LogFile); - g.LogFile = NULL; - } - if (g.LogClipboard) - { - g.LogClipboard->~ImGuiTextBuffer(); - ImGui::MemFree(g.LogClipboard); - } - - g.Initialized = false; -} - -static ImGuiIniData* FindWindowSettings(const char* name) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiID id = ImHash(name, 0); - for (int i = 0; i != g.Settings.Size; i++) - { - ImGuiIniData* ini = &g.Settings[i]; - if (ini->Id == id) - return ini; - } - return NULL; -} - -static ImGuiIniData* AddWindowSettings(const char* name) -{ - GImGui->Settings.resize(GImGui->Settings.Size + 1); - ImGuiIniData* ini = &GImGui->Settings.back(); - ini->Name = ImStrdup(name); - ini->Id = ImHash(name, 0); - ini->Collapsed = false; - ini->Pos = ImVec2(FLT_MAX,FLT_MAX); - ini->Size = ImVec2(0,0); - return ini; -} - -// Zero-tolerance, poor-man .ini parsing -// FIXME: Write something less rubbish -static void LoadIniSettingsFromDisk(const char* ini_filename) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (!ini_filename) - return; - - int file_size; - char* file_data = (char*)ImFileLoadToMemory(ini_filename, "rb", &file_size, 1); - if (!file_data) - return; - - ImGuiIniData* settings = NULL; - const char* buf_end = file_data + file_size; - for (const char* line_start = file_data; line_start < buf_end; ) - { - const char* line_end = line_start; - while (line_end < buf_end && *line_end != '\n' && *line_end != '\r') - line_end++; - - if (line_start[0] == '[' && line_end > line_start && line_end[-1] == ']') - { - char name[64]; - ImFormatString(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "%.*s", (int)(line_end-line_start-2), line_start+1); - settings = FindWindowSettings(name); - if (!settings) - settings = AddWindowSettings(name); - } - else if (settings) - { - float x, y; - int i; - if (sscanf(line_start, "Pos=%f,%f", &x, &y) == 2) - settings->Pos = ImVec2(x, y); - else if (sscanf(line_start, "Size=%f,%f", &x, &y) == 2) - settings->Size = ImMax(ImVec2(x, y), g.Style.WindowMinSize); - else if (sscanf(line_start, "Collapsed=%d", &i) == 1) - settings->Collapsed = (i != 0); - } - - line_start = line_end+1; - } - - ImGui::MemFree(file_data); -} - -static void SaveIniSettingsToDisk(const char* ini_filename) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.SettingsDirtyTimer = 0.0f; - if (!ini_filename) - return; - - // Gather data from windows that were active during this session - for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++) - { - ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i]; - if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings) - continue; - ImGuiIniData* settings = FindWindowSettings(window->Name); - settings->Pos = window->Pos; - settings->Size = window->SizeFull; - settings->Collapsed = window->Collapsed; - } - - // Write .ini file - // If a window wasn't opened in this session we preserve its settings - FILE* f = ImFileOpen(ini_filename, "wt"); - if (!f) - return; - for (int i = 0; i != g.Settings.Size; i++) - { - const ImGuiIniData* settings = &g.Settings[i]; - if (settings->Pos.x == FLT_MAX) - continue; - const char* name = settings->Name; - if (const char* p = strstr(name, "###")) // Skip to the "###" marker if any. We don't skip past to match the behavior of GetID() - name = p; - fprintf(f, "[%s]\n", name); - fprintf(f, "Pos=%d,%d\n", (int)settings->Pos.x, (int)settings->Pos.y); - fprintf(f, "Size=%d,%d\n", (int)settings->Size.x, (int)settings->Size.y); - fprintf(f, "Collapsed=%d\n", settings->Collapsed); - fprintf(f, "\n"); - } - - fclose(f); -} - -static void MarkIniSettingsDirty() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.SettingsDirtyTimer <= 0.0f) - g.SettingsDirtyTimer = g.IO.IniSavingRate; -} - -// FIXME: Add a more explicit sort order in the window structure. -static int ChildWindowComparer(const void* lhs, const void* rhs) -{ - const ImGuiWindow* a = *(const ImGuiWindow**)lhs; - const ImGuiWindow* b = *(const ImGuiWindow**)rhs; - if (int d = (a->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) - (b->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)) - return d; - if (int d = (a->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) - (b->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip)) - return d; - if (int d = (a->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox) - (b->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox)) - return d; - return (a->IndexWithinParent - b->IndexWithinParent); -} - -static void AddWindowToSortedBuffer(ImVector& out_sorted_windows, ImGuiWindow* window) -{ - out_sorted_windows.push_back(window); - if (window->Active) - { - int count = window->DC.ChildWindows.Size; - if (count > 1) - qsort(window->DC.ChildWindows.begin(), (size_t)count, sizeof(ImGuiWindow*), ChildWindowComparer); - for (int i = 0; i < count; i++) - { - ImGuiWindow* child = window->DC.ChildWindows[i]; - if (child->Active) - AddWindowToSortedBuffer(out_sorted_windows, child); - } - } -} - -static void AddDrawListToRenderList(ImVector& out_render_list, ImDrawList* draw_list) -{ - if (draw_list->CmdBuffer.empty()) - return; - - // Remove trailing command if unused - ImDrawCmd& last_cmd = draw_list->CmdBuffer.back(); - if (last_cmd.ElemCount == 0 && last_cmd.UserCallback == NULL) - { - draw_list->CmdBuffer.pop_back(); - if (draw_list->CmdBuffer.empty()) - return; - } - - // Draw list sanity check. Detect mismatch between PrimReserve() calls and incrementing _VtxCurrentIdx, _VtxWritePtr etc. - IM_ASSERT(draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size == 0 || draw_list->_VtxWritePtr == draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data + draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size); - IM_ASSERT(draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size == 0 || draw_list->_IdxWritePtr == draw_list->IdxBuffer.Data + draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size); - IM_ASSERT((int)draw_list->_VtxCurrentIdx == draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size); - - // Check that draw_list doesn't use more vertices than indexable (default ImDrawIdx = 2 bytes = 64K vertices) - // If this assert triggers because you are drawing lots of stuff manually, A) workaround by calling BeginChild()/EndChild() to put your draw commands in multiple draw lists, B) #define ImDrawIdx to a 'unsigned int' in imconfig.h and render accordingly. - IM_ASSERT((int64_t)draw_list->_VtxCurrentIdx <= ((int64_t)1L << (sizeof(ImDrawIdx)*8))); // Too many vertices in same ImDrawList. See comment above. - - out_render_list.push_back(draw_list); - GImGui->IO.MetricsRenderVertices += draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size; - GImGui->IO.MetricsRenderIndices += draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size; -} - -static void AddWindowToRenderList(ImVector& out_render_list, ImGuiWindow* window) -{ - AddDrawListToRenderList(out_render_list, window->DrawList); - for (int i = 0; i < window->DC.ChildWindows.Size; i++) - { - ImGuiWindow* child = window->DC.ChildWindows[i]; - if (!child->Active) // clipped children may have been marked not active - continue; - if ((child->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && child->HiddenFrames > 0) - continue; - AddWindowToRenderList(out_render_list, child); - } -} - -// When using this function it is sane to ensure that float are perfectly rounded to integer values, to that e.g. (int)(max.x-min.x) in user's render produce correct result. -void ImGui::PushClipRect(const ImVec2& clip_rect_min, const ImVec2& clip_rect_max, bool intersect_with_current_clip_rect) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DrawList->PushClipRect(clip_rect_min, clip_rect_max, intersect_with_current_clip_rect); - window->ClipRect = window->DrawList->_ClipRectStack.back(); -} - -void ImGui::PopClipRect() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DrawList->PopClipRect(); - window->ClipRect = window->DrawList->_ClipRectStack.back(); -} - -// This is normally called by Render(). You may want to call it directly if you want to avoid calling Render() but the gain will be very minimal. -void ImGui::EndFrame() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - IM_ASSERT(g.Initialized); // Forgot to call ImGui::NewFrame() - IM_ASSERT(g.FrameCountEnded != g.FrameCount); // ImGui::EndFrame() called multiple times, or forgot to call ImGui::NewFrame() again - - // Render tooltip - if (g.Tooltip[0]) - { - ImGui::BeginTooltip(); - ImGui::TextUnformatted(g.Tooltip); - ImGui::EndTooltip(); - } - - // Notify OS when our Input Method Editor cursor has moved (e.g. CJK inputs using Microsoft IME) - if (g.IO.ImeSetInputScreenPosFn && ImLengthSqr(g.OsImePosRequest - g.OsImePosSet) > 0.0001f) - { - g.IO.ImeSetInputScreenPosFn((int)g.OsImePosRequest.x, (int)g.OsImePosRequest.y); - g.OsImePosSet = g.OsImePosRequest; - } - - // Hide implicit "Debug" window if it hasn't been used - IM_ASSERT(g.CurrentWindowStack.Size == 1); // Mismatched Begin()/End() calls - if (g.CurrentWindow && !g.CurrentWindow->Accessed) - g.CurrentWindow->Active = false; - ImGui::End(); - - // Click to focus window and start moving (after we're done with all our widgets) - if (g.ActiveId == 0 && g.HoveredId == 0 && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]) - { - if (!(g.FocusedWindow && !g.FocusedWindow->WasActive && g.FocusedWindow->Active)) // Unless we just made a popup appear - { - if (g.HoveredRootWindow != NULL) - { - FocusWindow(g.HoveredWindow); - if (!(g.HoveredWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove)) - { - g.MovedWindow = g.HoveredWindow; - g.MovedWindowMoveId = g.HoveredRootWindow->MoveId; - SetActiveID(g.MovedWindowMoveId, g.HoveredRootWindow); - } - } - else if (g.FocusedWindow != NULL && GetFrontMostModalRootWindow() == NULL) - { - // Clicking on void disable focus - FocusWindow(NULL); - } - } - } - - // Sort the window list so that all child windows are after their parent - // We cannot do that on FocusWindow() because childs may not exist yet - g.WindowsSortBuffer.resize(0); - g.WindowsSortBuffer.reserve(g.Windows.Size); - for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++) - { - ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i]; - if (window->Active && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) // if a child is active its parent will add it - continue; - AddWindowToSortedBuffer(g.WindowsSortBuffer, window); - } - IM_ASSERT(g.Windows.Size == g.WindowsSortBuffer.Size); // we done something wrong - g.Windows.swap(g.WindowsSortBuffer); - - // Clear Input data for next frame - g.IO.MouseWheel = 0.0f; - memset(g.IO.InputCharacters, 0, sizeof(g.IO.InputCharacters)); - - g.FrameCountEnded = g.FrameCount; -} - -void ImGui::Render() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - IM_ASSERT(g.Initialized); // Forgot to call ImGui::NewFrame() - - if (g.FrameCountEnded != g.FrameCount) - ImGui::EndFrame(); - g.FrameCountRendered = g.FrameCount; - - // Skip render altogether if alpha is 0.0 - // Note that vertex buffers have been created and are wasted, so it is best practice that you don't create windows in the first place, or consistently respond to Begin() returning false. - if (g.Style.Alpha > 0.0f) - { - // Gather windows to render - g.IO.MetricsRenderVertices = g.IO.MetricsRenderIndices = g.IO.MetricsActiveWindows = 0; - for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.RenderDrawLists); i++) - g.RenderDrawLists[i].resize(0); - for (int i = 0; i != g.Windows.Size; i++) - { - ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i]; - if (window->Active && window->HiddenFrames <= 0 && (window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) == 0) - { - // FIXME: Generalize this with a proper layering system so e.g. user can draw in specific layers, below text, .. - g.IO.MetricsActiveWindows++; - if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) - AddWindowToRenderList(g.RenderDrawLists[1], window); - else if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) - AddWindowToRenderList(g.RenderDrawLists[2], window); - else - AddWindowToRenderList(g.RenderDrawLists[0], window); - } - } - - // Flatten layers - int n = g.RenderDrawLists[0].Size; - int flattened_size = n; - for (int i = 1; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.RenderDrawLists); i++) - flattened_size += g.RenderDrawLists[i].Size; - g.RenderDrawLists[0].resize(flattened_size); - for (int i = 1; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.RenderDrawLists); i++) - { - ImVector& layer = g.RenderDrawLists[i]; - if (layer.empty()) - continue; - memcpy(&g.RenderDrawLists[0][n], &layer[0], layer.Size * sizeof(ImDrawList*)); - n += layer.Size; - } - - // Draw software mouse cursor if requested - if (g.IO.MouseDrawCursor) - { - const ImGuiMouseCursorData& cursor_data = g.MouseCursorData[g.MouseCursor]; - const ImVec2 pos = g.IO.MousePos - cursor_data.HotOffset; - const ImVec2 size = cursor_data.Size; - const ImTextureID tex_id = g.IO.Fonts->TexID; - g.OverlayDrawList.PushTextureID(tex_id); - g.OverlayDrawList.AddImage(tex_id, pos+ImVec2(1,0), pos+ImVec2(1,0) + size, cursor_data.TexUvMin[1], cursor_data.TexUvMax[1], IM_COL32(0,0,0,48)); // Shadow - g.OverlayDrawList.AddImage(tex_id, pos+ImVec2(2,0), pos+ImVec2(2,0) + size, cursor_data.TexUvMin[1], cursor_data.TexUvMax[1], IM_COL32(0,0,0,48)); // Shadow - g.OverlayDrawList.AddImage(tex_id, pos, pos + size, cursor_data.TexUvMin[1], cursor_data.TexUvMax[1], IM_COL32(0,0,0,255)); // Black border - g.OverlayDrawList.AddImage(tex_id, pos, pos + size, cursor_data.TexUvMin[0], cursor_data.TexUvMax[0], IM_COL32(255,255,255,255)); // White fill - g.OverlayDrawList.PopTextureID(); - } - if (!g.OverlayDrawList.VtxBuffer.empty()) - AddDrawListToRenderList(g.RenderDrawLists[0], &g.OverlayDrawList); - - // Setup draw data - g.RenderDrawData.Valid = true; - g.RenderDrawData.CmdLists = (g.RenderDrawLists[0].Size > 0) ? &g.RenderDrawLists[0][0] : NULL; - g.RenderDrawData.CmdListsCount = g.RenderDrawLists[0].Size; - g.RenderDrawData.TotalVtxCount = g.IO.MetricsRenderVertices; - g.RenderDrawData.TotalIdxCount = g.IO.MetricsRenderIndices; - - // Render. If user hasn't set a callback then they may retrieve the draw data via GetDrawData() - if (g.RenderDrawData.CmdListsCount > 0 && g.IO.RenderDrawListsFn != NULL) - g.IO.RenderDrawListsFn(&g.RenderDrawData); - } -} - -const char* ImGui::FindRenderedTextEnd(const char* text, const char* text_end) -{ - const char* text_display_end = text; - if (!text_end) - text_end = (const char*)-1; - - while (text_display_end < text_end && *text_display_end != '\0' && (text_display_end[0] != '#' || text_display_end[1] != '#')) - text_display_end++; - return text_display_end; -} - -// Pass text data straight to log (without being displayed) -void ImGui::LogText(const char* fmt, ...) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (!g.LogEnabled) - return; - - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - if (g.LogFile) - { - vfprintf(g.LogFile, fmt, args); - } - else - { - g.LogClipboard->appendv(fmt, args); - } - va_end(args); -} - -// Internal version that takes a position to decide on newline placement and pad items according to their depth. -// We split text into individual lines to add current tree level padding -static void LogRenderedText(const ImVec2& ref_pos, const char* text, const char* text_end) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = ImGui::GetCurrentWindowRead(); - - if (!text_end) - text_end = ImGui::FindRenderedTextEnd(text, text_end); - - const bool log_new_line = ref_pos.y > window->DC.LogLinePosY+1; - window->DC.LogLinePosY = ref_pos.y; - - const char* text_remaining = text; - if (g.LogStartDepth > window->DC.TreeDepth) // Re-adjust padding if we have popped out of our starting depth - g.LogStartDepth = window->DC.TreeDepth; - const int tree_depth = (window->DC.TreeDepth - g.LogStartDepth); - for (;;) - { - // Split the string. Each new line (after a '\n') is followed by spacing corresponding to the current depth of our log entry. - const char* line_end = text_remaining; - while (line_end < text_end) - if (*line_end == '\n') - break; - else - line_end++; - if (line_end >= text_end) - line_end = NULL; - - const bool is_first_line = (text == text_remaining); - bool is_last_line = false; - if (line_end == NULL) - { - is_last_line = true; - line_end = text_end; - } - if (line_end != NULL && !(is_last_line && (line_end - text_remaining)==0)) - { - const int char_count = (int)(line_end - text_remaining); - if (log_new_line || !is_first_line) - ImGui::LogText(IM_NEWLINE "%*s%.*s", tree_depth*4, "", char_count, text_remaining); - else - ImGui::LogText(" %.*s", char_count, text_remaining); - } - - if (is_last_line) - break; - text_remaining = line_end + 1; - } -} - -// Internal ImGui functions to render text -// RenderText***() functions calls ImDrawList::AddText() calls ImBitmapFont::RenderText() -void ImGui::RenderText(ImVec2 pos, const char* text, const char* text_end, bool hide_text_after_hash) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - - // Hide anything after a '##' string - const char* text_display_end; - if (hide_text_after_hash) - { - text_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(text, text_end); - } - else - { - if (!text_end) - text_end = text + strlen(text); // FIXME-OPT - text_display_end = text_end; - } - - const int text_len = (int)(text_display_end - text); - if (text_len > 0) - { - window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), text, text_display_end); - if (g.LogEnabled) - LogRenderedText(pos, text, text_display_end); - } -} - -void ImGui::RenderTextWrapped(ImVec2 pos, const char* text, const char* text_end, float wrap_width) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - - if (!text_end) - text_end = text + strlen(text); // FIXME-OPT - - const int text_len = (int)(text_end - text); - if (text_len > 0) - { - window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), text, text_end, wrap_width); - if (g.LogEnabled) - LogRenderedText(pos, text, text_end); - } -} - -// Default clip_rect uses (pos_min,pos_max) -// Handle clipping on CPU immediately (vs typically let the GPU clip the triangles that are overlapping the clipping rectangle edges) -void ImGui::RenderTextClipped(const ImVec2& pos_min, const ImVec2& pos_max, const char* text, const char* text_end, const ImVec2* text_size_if_known, const ImVec2& align, const ImRect* clip_rect) -{ - // Hide anything after a '##' string - const char* text_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(text, text_end); - const int text_len = (int)(text_display_end - text); - if (text_len == 0) - return; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - - // Perform CPU side clipping for single clipped element to avoid using scissor state - ImVec2 pos = pos_min; - const ImVec2 text_size = text_size_if_known ? *text_size_if_known : CalcTextSize(text, text_display_end, false, 0.0f); - - const ImVec2* clip_min = clip_rect ? &clip_rect->Min : &pos_min; - const ImVec2* clip_max = clip_rect ? &clip_rect->Max : &pos_max; - bool need_clipping = (pos.x + text_size.x >= clip_max->x) || (pos.y + text_size.y >= clip_max->y); - if (clip_rect) // If we had no explicit clipping rectangle then pos==clip_min - need_clipping |= (pos.x < clip_min->x) || (pos.y < clip_min->y); - - // Align whole block. We should defer that to the better rendering function when we'll have support for individual line alignment. - if (align.x > 0.0f) pos.x = ImMax(pos.x, pos.x + (pos_max.x - pos.x - text_size.x) * align.x); - if (align.y > 0.0f) pos.y = ImMax(pos.y, pos.y + (pos_max.y - pos.y - text_size.y) * align.y); - - // Render - if (need_clipping) - { - ImVec4 fine_clip_rect(clip_min->x, clip_min->y, clip_max->x, clip_max->y); - window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), text, text_display_end, 0.0f, &fine_clip_rect); - } - else - { - window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), text, text_display_end, 0.0f, NULL); - } - if (g.LogEnabled) - LogRenderedText(pos, text, text_display_end); -} - -// Render a rectangle shaped with optional rounding and borders -void ImGui::RenderFrame(ImVec2 p_min, ImVec2 p_max, ImU32 fill_col, bool border, float rounding) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(p_min, p_max, fill_col, rounding); - if (border && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders)) - { - window->DrawList->AddRect(p_min+ImVec2(1,1), p_max+ImVec2(1,1), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_BorderShadow), rounding); - window->DrawList->AddRect(p_min, p_max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), rounding); - } -} - -// Render a triangle to denote expanded/collapsed state -void ImGui::RenderCollapseTriangle(ImVec2 p_min, bool is_open, float scale) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - - const float h = g.FontSize * 1.00f; - const float r = h * 0.40f * scale; - ImVec2 center = p_min + ImVec2(h*0.50f, h*0.50f*scale); - - ImVec2 a, b, c; - if (is_open) - { - center.y -= r*0.25f; - a = center + ImVec2(0,1)*r; - b = center + ImVec2(-0.866f,-0.5f)*r; - c = center + ImVec2(0.866f,-0.5f)*r; - } - else - { - a = center + ImVec2(1,0)*r; - b = center + ImVec2(-0.500f,0.866f)*r; - c = center + ImVec2(-0.500f,-0.866f)*r; - } - - window->DrawList->AddTriangleFilled(a, b, c, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text)); -} - -void ImGui::RenderBullet(ImVec2 pos) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(pos, GImGui->FontSize*0.20f, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), 8); -} - -void ImGui::RenderCheckMark(ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - - ImVec2 a, b, c; - float start_x = (float)(int)(g.FontSize * 0.307f + 0.5f); - float rem_third = (float)(int)((g.FontSize - start_x) / 3.0f); - a.x = pos.x + 0.5f + start_x; - b.x = a.x + rem_third; - c.x = a.x + rem_third * 3.0f; - b.y = pos.y - 1.0f + (float)(int)(g.Font->Ascent * (g.FontSize / g.Font->FontSize) + 0.5f) + (float)(int)(g.Font->DisplayOffset.y); - a.y = b.y - rem_third; - c.y = b.y - rem_third * 2.0f; - - window->DrawList->PathLineTo(a); - window->DrawList->PathLineTo(b); - window->DrawList->PathLineTo(c); - window->DrawList->PathStroke(col, false); -} - -// Calculate text size. Text can be multi-line. Optionally ignore text after a ## marker. -// CalcTextSize("") should return ImVec2(0.0f, GImGui->FontSize) -ImVec2 ImGui::CalcTextSize(const char* text, const char* text_end, bool hide_text_after_double_hash, float wrap_width) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - - const char* text_display_end; - if (hide_text_after_double_hash) - text_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(text, text_end); // Hide anything after a '##' string - else - text_display_end = text_end; - - ImFont* font = g.Font; - const float font_size = g.FontSize; - if (text == text_display_end) - return ImVec2(0.0f, font_size); - ImVec2 text_size = font->CalcTextSizeA(font_size, FLT_MAX, wrap_width, text, text_display_end, NULL); - - // Cancel out character spacing for the last character of a line (it is baked into glyph->XAdvance field) - const float font_scale = font_size / font->FontSize; - const float character_spacing_x = 1.0f * font_scale; - if (text_size.x > 0.0f) - text_size.x -= character_spacing_x; - text_size.x = (float)(int)(text_size.x + 0.95f); - - return text_size; -} - -// Helper to calculate coarse clipping of large list of evenly sized items. -// NB: Prefer using the ImGuiListClipper higher-level helper if you can! Read comments and instructions there on how those use this sort of pattern. -// NB: 'items_count' is only used to clamp the result, if you don't know your count you can use INT_MAX -void ImGui::CalcListClipping(int items_count, float items_height, int* out_items_display_start, int* out_items_display_end) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - if (g.LogEnabled) - { - // If logging is active, do not perform any clipping - *out_items_display_start = 0; - *out_items_display_end = items_count; - return; - } - if (window->SkipItems) - { - *out_items_display_start = *out_items_display_end = 0; - return; - } - - const ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; - int start = (int)((window->ClipRect.Min.y - pos.y) / items_height); - int end = (int)((window->ClipRect.Max.y - pos.y) / items_height); - start = ImClamp(start, 0, items_count); - end = ImClamp(end + 1, start, items_count); - *out_items_display_start = start; - *out_items_display_end = end; -} - -// Find window given position, search front-to-back -// FIXME: Note that we have a lag here because WindowRectClipped is updated in Begin() so windows moved by user via SetWindowPos() and not SetNextWindowPos() will have that rectangle lagging by a frame at the time FindHoveredWindow() is called, aka before the next Begin(). Moving window thankfully isn't affected. -static ImGuiWindow* FindHoveredWindow(ImVec2 pos, bool excluding_childs) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - for (int i = g.Windows.Size-1; i >= 0; i--) - { - ImGuiWindow* window = g.Windows[i]; - if (!window->Active) - continue; - if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs) - continue; - if (excluding_childs && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) != 0) - continue; - - // Using the clipped AABB so a child window will typically be clipped by its parent. - ImRect bb(window->WindowRectClipped.Min - g.Style.TouchExtraPadding, window->WindowRectClipped.Max + g.Style.TouchExtraPadding); - if (bb.Contains(pos)) - return window; - } - return NULL; -} - -// Test if mouse cursor is hovering given rectangle -// NB- Rectangle is clipped by our current clip setting -// NB- Expand the rectangle to be generous on imprecise inputs systems (g.Style.TouchExtraPadding) -bool ImGui::IsMouseHoveringRect(const ImVec2& r_min, const ImVec2& r_max, bool clip) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - - // Clip - ImRect rect_clipped(r_min, r_max); - if (clip) - rect_clipped.Clip(window->ClipRect); - - // Expand for touch input - const ImRect rect_for_touch(rect_clipped.Min - g.Style.TouchExtraPadding, rect_clipped.Max + g.Style.TouchExtraPadding); - return rect_for_touch.Contains(g.IO.MousePos); -} - -bool ImGui::IsMouseHoveringWindow() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.HoveredWindow == g.CurrentWindow; -} - -bool ImGui::IsMouseHoveringAnyWindow() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.HoveredWindow != NULL; -} - -bool ImGui::IsPosHoveringAnyWindow(const ImVec2& pos) -{ - return FindHoveredWindow(pos, false) != NULL; -} - -static bool IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey key, bool repeat) -{ - const int key_index = GImGui->IO.KeyMap[key]; - return ImGui::IsKeyPressed(key_index, repeat); -} - -int ImGui::GetKeyIndex(ImGuiKey key) -{ - IM_ASSERT(key >= 0 && key < ImGuiKey_COUNT); - return GImGui->IO.KeyMap[key]; -} - -bool ImGui::IsKeyDown(int key_index) -{ - if (key_index < 0) return false; - IM_ASSERT(key_index >= 0 && key_index < IM_ARRAYSIZE(GImGui->IO.KeysDown)); - return GImGui->IO.KeysDown[key_index]; -} - -bool ImGui::IsKeyPressed(int key_index, bool repeat) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (key_index < 0) return false; - IM_ASSERT(key_index >= 0 && key_index < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown)); - const float t = g.IO.KeysDownDuration[key_index]; - if (t == 0.0f) - return true; - - if (repeat && t > g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay) - { - float delay = g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay, rate = g.IO.KeyRepeatRate; - if ((fmodf(t - delay, rate) > rate*0.5f) != (fmodf(t - delay - g.IO.DeltaTime, rate) > rate*0.5f)) - return true; - } - return false; -} - -bool ImGui::IsKeyReleased(int key_index) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (key_index < 0) return false; - IM_ASSERT(key_index >= 0 && key_index < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.KeysDown)); - if (g.IO.KeysDownDurationPrev[key_index] >= 0.0f && !g.IO.KeysDown[key_index]) - return true; - return false; -} - -bool ImGui::IsMouseDown(int button) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); - return g.IO.MouseDown[button]; -} - -bool ImGui::IsMouseClicked(int button, bool repeat) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); - const float t = g.IO.MouseDownDuration[button]; - if (t == 0.0f) - return true; - - if (repeat && t > g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay) - { - float delay = g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay, rate = g.IO.KeyRepeatRate; - if ((fmodf(t - delay, rate) > rate*0.5f) != (fmodf(t - delay - g.IO.DeltaTime, rate) > rate*0.5f)) - return true; - } - - return false; -} - -bool ImGui::IsMouseReleased(int button) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); - return g.IO.MouseReleased[button]; -} - -bool ImGui::IsMouseDoubleClicked(int button) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); - return g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[button]; -} - -bool ImGui::IsMouseDragging(int button, float lock_threshold) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); - if (!g.IO.MouseDown[button]) - return false; - if (lock_threshold < 0.0f) - lock_threshold = g.IO.MouseDragThreshold; - return g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[button] >= lock_threshold * lock_threshold; -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::GetMousePos() -{ - return GImGui->IO.MousePos; -} - -// NB: prefer to call right after BeginPopup(). At the time Selectable/MenuItem is activated, the popup is already closed! -ImVec2 ImGui::GetMousePosOnOpeningCurrentPopup() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.CurrentPopupStack.Size > 0) - return g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size-1].MousePosOnOpen; - return g.IO.MousePos; -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::GetMouseDragDelta(int button, float lock_threshold) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); - if (lock_threshold < 0.0f) - lock_threshold = g.IO.MouseDragThreshold; - if (g.IO.MouseDown[button]) - if (g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr[button] >= lock_threshold * lock_threshold) - return g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseClickedPos[button]; // Assume we can only get active with left-mouse button (at the moment). - return ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); -} - -void ImGui::ResetMouseDragDelta(int button) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - IM_ASSERT(button >= 0 && button < IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.IO.MouseDown)); - // NB: We don't need to reset g.IO.MouseDragMaxDistanceSqr - g.IO.MouseClickedPos[button] = g.IO.MousePos; -} - -ImGuiMouseCursor ImGui::GetMouseCursor() -{ - return GImGui->MouseCursor; -} - -void ImGui::SetMouseCursor(ImGuiMouseCursor cursor_type) -{ - GImGui->MouseCursor = cursor_type; -} - -void ImGui::CaptureKeyboardFromApp(bool capture) -{ - GImGui->CaptureKeyboardNextFrame = capture ? 1 : 0; -} - -void ImGui::CaptureMouseFromApp(bool capture) -{ - GImGui->CaptureMouseNextFrame = capture ? 1 : 0; -} - -bool ImGui::IsItemHovered() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.LastItemHoveredAndUsable; -} - -bool ImGui::IsItemHoveredRect() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.LastItemHoveredRect; -} - -bool ImGui::IsItemActive() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.ActiveId) - { - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return g.ActiveId == window->DC.LastItemId; - } - return false; -} - -bool ImGui::IsItemClicked(int mouse_button) -{ - return IsMouseClicked(mouse_button) && IsItemHovered(); -} - -bool ImGui::IsAnyItemHovered() -{ - return GImGui->HoveredId != 0 || GImGui->HoveredIdPreviousFrame != 0; -} - -bool ImGui::IsAnyItemActive() -{ - return GImGui->ActiveId != 0; -} - -bool ImGui::IsItemVisible() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - ImRect r(window->ClipRect); - return r.Overlaps(window->DC.LastItemRect); -} - -// Allow last item to be overlapped by a subsequent item. Both may be activated during the same frame before the later one takes priority. -void ImGui::SetItemAllowOverlap() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.HoveredId == g.CurrentWindow->DC.LastItemId) - g.HoveredIdAllowOverlap = true; - if (g.ActiveId == g.CurrentWindow->DC.LastItemId) - g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap = true; -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::GetItemRectMin() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.LastItemRect.Min; -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::GetItemRectMax() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.LastItemRect.Max; -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::GetItemRectSize() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.LastItemRect.GetSize(); -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::CalcItemRectClosestPoint(const ImVec2& pos, bool on_edge, float outward) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - ImRect rect = window->DC.LastItemRect; - rect.Expand(outward); - return rect.GetClosestPoint(pos, on_edge); -} - -// Tooltip is stored and turned into a BeginTooltip()/EndTooltip() sequence at the end of the frame. Each call override previous value. -void ImGui::SetTooltipV(const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImFormatStringV(g.Tooltip, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.Tooltip), fmt, args); -} - -void ImGui::SetTooltip(const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - SetTooltipV(fmt, args); - va_end(args); -} - -static ImRect GetVisibleRect() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.IO.DisplayVisibleMin.x != g.IO.DisplayVisibleMax.x && g.IO.DisplayVisibleMin.y != g.IO.DisplayVisibleMax.y) - return ImRect(g.IO.DisplayVisibleMin, g.IO.DisplayVisibleMax); - return ImRect(0.0f, 0.0f, g.IO.DisplaySize.x, g.IO.DisplaySize.y); -} - -void ImGui::BeginTooltip() -{ - ImGuiWindowFlags flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings|ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize; - ImGui::Begin("##Tooltip", NULL, flags); -} - -void ImGui::EndTooltip() -{ - IM_ASSERT(GetCurrentWindowRead()->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip); // Mismatched BeginTooltip()/EndTooltip() calls - ImGui::End(); -} - -static bool IsPopupOpen(ImGuiID id) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.CurrentPopupStack.Size && g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size].PopupId == id; -} - -// Mark popup as open (toggle toward open state). -// Popups are closed when user click outside, or activate a pressable item, or CloseCurrentPopup() is called within a BeginPopup()/EndPopup() block. -// Popup identifiers are relative to the current ID-stack (so OpenPopup and BeginPopup needs to be at the same level). -// One open popup per level of the popup hierarchy (NB: when assigning we reset the Window member of ImGuiPopupRef to NULL) -void ImGui::OpenPopupEx(const char* str_id, bool reopen_existing) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; - ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id); - int current_stack_size = g.CurrentPopupStack.Size; - ImGuiPopupRef popup_ref = ImGuiPopupRef(id, window, window->GetID("##menus"), g.IO.MousePos); // Tagged as new ref because constructor sets Window to NULL (we are passing the ParentWindow info here) - if (g.OpenPopupStack.Size < current_stack_size + 1) - g.OpenPopupStack.push_back(popup_ref); - else if (reopen_existing || g.OpenPopupStack[current_stack_size].PopupId != id) - { - g.OpenPopupStack.resize(current_stack_size+1); - g.OpenPopupStack[current_stack_size] = popup_ref; - } -} - -void ImGui::OpenPopup(const char* str_id) -{ - ImGui::OpenPopupEx(str_id, false); -} - -static void CloseInactivePopups() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.OpenPopupStack.empty()) - return; - - // When popups are stacked, clicking on a lower level popups puts focus back to it and close popups above it. - // Don't close our own child popup windows - int n = 0; - if (g.FocusedWindow) - { - for (n = 0; n < g.OpenPopupStack.Size; n++) - { - ImGuiPopupRef& popup = g.OpenPopupStack[n]; - if (!popup.Window) - continue; - IM_ASSERT((popup.Window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) != 0); - if (popup.Window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) - continue; - - bool has_focus = false; - for (int m = n; m < g.OpenPopupStack.Size && !has_focus; m++) - has_focus = (g.OpenPopupStack[m].Window && g.OpenPopupStack[m].Window->RootWindow == g.FocusedWindow->RootWindow); - if (!has_focus) - break; - } - } - if (n < g.OpenPopupStack.Size) // This test is not required but it allows to set a useful breakpoint on the line below - g.OpenPopupStack.resize(n); -} - -static ImGuiWindow* GetFrontMostModalRootWindow() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - for (int n = g.OpenPopupStack.Size-1; n >= 0; n--) - if (ImGuiWindow* front_most_popup = g.OpenPopupStack.Data[n].Window) - if (front_most_popup->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) - return front_most_popup; - return NULL; -} - -static void ClosePopupToLevel(int remaining) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (remaining > 0) - ImGui::FocusWindow(g.OpenPopupStack[remaining-1].Window); - else - ImGui::FocusWindow(g.OpenPopupStack[0].ParentWindow); - g.OpenPopupStack.resize(remaining); -} - -static void ClosePopup(ImGuiID id) -{ - if (!IsPopupOpen(id)) - return; - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ClosePopupToLevel(g.OpenPopupStack.Size - 1); -} - -// Close the popup we have begin-ed into. -void ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - int popup_idx = g.CurrentPopupStack.Size - 1; - if (popup_idx < 0 || popup_idx > g.OpenPopupStack.Size || g.CurrentPopupStack[popup_idx].PopupId != g.OpenPopupStack[popup_idx].PopupId) - return; - while (popup_idx > 0 && g.OpenPopupStack[popup_idx].Window && (g.OpenPopupStack[popup_idx].Window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)) - popup_idx--; - ClosePopupToLevel(popup_idx); -} - -static inline void ClearSetNextWindowData() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.SetNextWindowPosCond = g.SetNextWindowSizeCond = g.SetNextWindowContentSizeCond = g.SetNextWindowCollapsedCond = 0; - g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraint = g.SetNextWindowFocus = false; -} - -static bool BeginPopupEx(const char* str_id, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id); - if (!IsPopupOpen(id)) - { - ClearSetNextWindowData(); // We behave like Begin() and need to consume those values - return false; - } - - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowRounding, 0.0f); - ImGuiWindowFlags flags = extra_flags|ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings|ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize; - - char name[20]; - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) - ImFormatString(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "##menu_%d", g.CurrentPopupStack.Size); // Recycle windows based on depth - else - ImFormatString(name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(name), "##popup_%08x", id); // Not recycling, so we can close/open during the same frame - - bool is_open = ImGui::Begin(name, NULL, flags); - if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders)) - g.CurrentWindow->Flags &= ~ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders; - if (!is_open) // NB: is_open can be 'false' when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display) - ImGui::EndPopup(); - - return is_open; -} - -bool ImGui::BeginPopup(const char* str_id) -{ - if (GImGui->OpenPopupStack.Size <= GImGui->CurrentPopupStack.Size) // Early out for performance - { - ClearSetNextWindowData(); // We behave like Begin() and need to consume those values - return false; - } - return BeginPopupEx(str_id, ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders); -} - -bool ImGui::BeginPopupModal(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(name); - if (!IsPopupOpen(id)) - { - ClearSetNextWindowData(); // We behave like Begin() and need to consume those values - return false; - } - - ImGuiWindowFlags flags = extra_flags|ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup|ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings; - bool is_open = ImGui::Begin(name, p_open, flags); - if (!is_open || (p_open && !*p_open)) // NB: is_open can be 'false' when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display) - { - ImGui::EndPopup(); - if (is_open) - ClosePopup(id); - return false; - } - - return is_open; -} - -void ImGui::EndPopup() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - IM_ASSERT(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup); // Mismatched BeginPopup()/EndPopup() calls - IM_ASSERT(GImGui->CurrentPopupStack.Size > 0); - ImGui::End(); - if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal)) - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); -} - -// This is a helper to handle the most simple case of associating one named popup to one given widget. -// 1. If you have many possible popups (for different "instances" of a same widget, or for wholly different widgets), you may be better off handling -// this yourself so you can store data relative to the widget that opened the popup instead of choosing different popup identifiers. -// 2. If you want right-clicking on the same item to reopen the popup at new location, use the same code replacing IsItemHovered() with IsItemHoveredRect() -// and passing true to the OpenPopupEx(). -// Because: hovering an item in a window below the popup won't normally trigger is hovering behavior/coloring. The pattern of ignoring the fact that -// the item isn't interactable (because it is blocked by the active popup) may useful in some situation when e.g. large canvas as one item, content of menu -// driven by click position. -bool ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem(const char* str_id, int mouse_button) -{ - if (IsItemHovered() && IsMouseClicked(mouse_button)) - OpenPopupEx(str_id, false); - return BeginPopup(str_id); -} - -bool ImGui::BeginPopupContextWindow(bool also_over_items, const char* str_id, int mouse_button) -{ - if (!str_id) str_id = "window_context_menu"; - if (IsMouseHoveringWindow() && IsMouseClicked(mouse_button)) - if (also_over_items || !IsAnyItemHovered()) - OpenPopupEx(str_id, true); - return BeginPopup(str_id); -} - -bool ImGui::BeginPopupContextVoid(const char* str_id, int mouse_button) -{ - if (!str_id) str_id = "void_context_menu"; - if (!IsMouseHoveringAnyWindow() && IsMouseClicked(mouse_button)) - OpenPopupEx(str_id, true); - return BeginPopup(str_id); -} - -static bool BeginChildEx(const char* name, ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size_arg, bool border, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = ImGui::GetCurrentWindow(); - ImGuiWindowFlags flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings|ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow; - - const ImVec2 content_avail = ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail(); - ImVec2 size = ImFloor(size_arg); - if (size.x <= 0.0f) - { - if (size.x == 0.0f) - flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindowAutoFitX; - size.x = ImMax(content_avail.x, 4.0f) - fabsf(size.x); // Arbitrary minimum zero-ish child size of 4.0f (0.0f causing too much issues) - } - if (size.y <= 0.0f) - { - if (size.y == 0.0f) - flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindowAutoFitY; - size.y = ImMax(content_avail.y, 4.0f) - fabsf(size.y); - } - if (border) - flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders; - flags |= extra_flags; - - char title[256]; - if (name) - ImFormatString(title, IM_ARRAYSIZE(title), "%s.%s.%08X", window->Name, name, id); - else - ImFormatString(title, IM_ARRAYSIZE(title), "%s.%08X", window->Name, id); - - bool ret = ImGui::Begin(title, NULL, size, -1.0f, flags); - - if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders)) - ImGui::GetCurrentWindow()->Flags &= ~ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders; - - return ret; -} - -bool ImGui::BeginChild(const char* str_id, const ImVec2& size_arg, bool border, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - return BeginChildEx(str_id, window->GetID(str_id), size_arg, border, extra_flags); -} - -bool ImGui::BeginChild(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size_arg, bool border, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags) -{ - return BeginChildEx(NULL, id, size_arg, border, extra_flags); -} - -void ImGui::EndChild() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - - IM_ASSERT(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow); // Mismatched BeginChild()/EndChild() callss - if ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox) || window->BeginCount > 1) - { - ImGui::End(); - } - else - { - // When using auto-filling child window, we don't provide full width/height to ItemSize so that it doesn't feed back into automatic size-fitting. - ImVec2 sz = GetWindowSize(); - if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindowAutoFitX) // Arbitrary minimum zero-ish child size of 4.0f causes less trouble than a 0.0f - sz.x = ImMax(4.0f, sz.x); - if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindowAutoFitY) - sz.y = ImMax(4.0f, sz.y); - - ImGui::End(); - - window = GetCurrentWindow(); - ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + sz); - ItemSize(sz); - ItemAdd(bb, NULL); - } -} - -// Helper to create a child window / scrolling region that looks like a normal widget frame. -bool ImGui::BeginChildFrame(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiWindowFlags extra_flags) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ChildWindowBg, style.Colors[ImGuiCol_FrameBg]); - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildWindowRounding, style.FrameRounding); - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, style.FramePadding); - return ImGui::BeginChild(id, size, (g.CurrentWindow->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders) ? true : false, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding | extra_flags); -} - -void ImGui::EndChildFrame() -{ - ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::PopStyleVar(2); - ImGui::PopStyleColor(); -} - -// Save and compare stack sizes on Begin()/End() to detect usage errors -static void CheckStacksSize(ImGuiWindow* window, bool write) -{ - // NOT checking: DC.ItemWidth, DC.AllowKeyboardFocus, DC.ButtonRepeat, DC.TextWrapPos (per window) to allow user to conveniently push once and not pop (they are cleared on Begin) - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - int* p_backup = &window->DC.StackSizesBackup[0]; - { int current = window->IDStack.Size; if (write) *p_backup = current; else IM_ASSERT(*p_backup == current && "PushID/PopID Mismatch!"); p_backup++; } // User forgot PopID() - { int current = window->DC.GroupStack.Size; if (write) *p_backup = current; else IM_ASSERT(*p_backup == current && "BeginGroup/EndGroup Mismatch!"); p_backup++; } // User forgot EndGroup() - { int current = g.CurrentPopupStack.Size; if (write) *p_backup = current; else IM_ASSERT(*p_backup == current && "BeginMenu/EndMenu or BeginPopup/EndPopup Mismatch"); p_backup++; }// User forgot EndPopup()/EndMenu() - { int current = g.ColorModifiers.Size; if (write) *p_backup = current; else IM_ASSERT(*p_backup == current && "PushStyleColor/PopStyleColor Mismatch!"); p_backup++; } // User forgot PopStyleColor() - { int current = g.StyleModifiers.Size; if (write) *p_backup = current; else IM_ASSERT(*p_backup == current && "PushStyleVar/PopStyleVar Mismatch!"); p_backup++; } // User forgot PopStyleVar() - { int current = g.FontStack.Size; if (write) *p_backup = current; else IM_ASSERT(*p_backup == current && "PushFont/PopFont Mismatch!"); p_backup++; } // User forgot PopFont() - IM_ASSERT(p_backup == window->DC.StackSizesBackup + IM_ARRAYSIZE(window->DC.StackSizesBackup)); -} - -static ImVec2 FindBestPopupWindowPos(const ImVec2& base_pos, const ImVec2& size, int* last_dir, const ImRect& r_inner) -{ - const ImGuiStyle& style = GImGui->Style; - - // Clamp into visible area while not overlapping the cursor. Safety padding is optional if our popup size won't fit without it. - ImVec2 safe_padding = style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding; - ImRect r_outer(GetVisibleRect()); - r_outer.Reduce(ImVec2((size.x - r_outer.GetWidth() > safe_padding.x*2) ? safe_padding.x : 0.0f, (size.y - r_outer.GetHeight() > safe_padding.y*2) ? safe_padding.y : 0.0f)); - ImVec2 base_pos_clamped = ImClamp(base_pos, r_outer.Min, r_outer.Max - size); - - for (int n = (*last_dir != -1) ? -1 : 0; n < 4; n++) // Last, Right, down, up, left. (Favor last used direction). - { - const int dir = (n == -1) ? *last_dir : n; - ImRect rect(dir == 0 ? r_inner.Max.x : r_outer.Min.x, dir == 1 ? r_inner.Max.y : r_outer.Min.y, dir == 3 ? r_inner.Min.x : r_outer.Max.x, dir == 2 ? r_inner.Min.y : r_outer.Max.y); - if (rect.GetWidth() < size.x || rect.GetHeight() < size.y) - continue; - *last_dir = dir; - return ImVec2(dir == 0 ? r_inner.Max.x : dir == 3 ? r_inner.Min.x - size.x : base_pos_clamped.x, dir == 1 ? r_inner.Max.y : dir == 2 ? r_inner.Min.y - size.y : base_pos_clamped.y); - } - - // Fallback, try to keep within display - *last_dir = -1; - ImVec2 pos = base_pos; - pos.x = ImMax(ImMin(pos.x + size.x, r_outer.Max.x) - size.x, r_outer.Min.x); - pos.y = ImMax(ImMin(pos.y + size.y, r_outer.Max.y) - size.y, r_outer.Min.y); - return pos; -} - -ImGuiWindow* ImGui::FindWindowByName(const char* name) -{ - // FIXME-OPT: Store sorted hashes -> pointers so we can do a bissection in a contiguous block - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiID id = ImHash(name, 0); - for (int i = 0; i < g.Windows.Size; i++) - if (g.Windows[i]->ID == id) - return g.Windows[i]; - return NULL; -} - -static ImGuiWindow* CreateNewWindow(const char* name, ImVec2 size, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - - // Create window the first time - ImGuiWindow* window = (ImGuiWindow*)ImGui::MemAlloc(sizeof(ImGuiWindow)); - IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(window) ImGuiWindow(name); - window->Flags = flags; - - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings) - { - // User can disable loading and saving of settings. Tooltip and child windows also don't store settings. - window->Size = window->SizeFull = size; - } - else - { - // Retrieve settings from .ini file - // Use SetWindowPos() or SetNextWindowPos() with the appropriate condition flag to change the initial position of a window. - window->PosFloat = ImVec2(60, 60); - window->Pos = ImVec2((float)(int)window->PosFloat.x, (float)(int)window->PosFloat.y); - - ImGuiIniData* settings = FindWindowSettings(name); - if (!settings) - { - settings = AddWindowSettings(name); - } - else - { - window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags &= ~ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver; - window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags &= ~ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver; - window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags &= ~ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver; - } - - if (settings->Pos.x != FLT_MAX) - { - window->PosFloat = settings->Pos; - window->Pos = ImVec2((float)(int)window->PosFloat.x, (float)(int)window->PosFloat.y); - window->Collapsed = settings->Collapsed; - } - - if (ImLengthSqr(settings->Size) > 0.00001f && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize)) - size = settings->Size; - window->Size = window->SizeFull = size; - } - - if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) != 0) - { - window->AutoFitFramesX = window->AutoFitFramesY = 2; - window->AutoFitOnlyGrows = false; - } - else - { - if (window->Size.x <= 0.0f) - window->AutoFitFramesX = 2; - if (window->Size.y <= 0.0f) - window->AutoFitFramesY = 2; - window->AutoFitOnlyGrows = (window->AutoFitFramesX > 0) || (window->AutoFitFramesY > 0); - } - - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBringToFrontOnFocus) - g.Windows.insert(g.Windows.begin(), window); // Quite slow but rare and only once - else - g.Windows.push_back(window); - return window; -} - -static void ApplySizeFullWithConstraint(ImGuiWindow* window, ImVec2 new_size) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraint) - { - // Using -1,-1 on either X/Y axis to preserve the current size. - ImRect cr = g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintRect; - new_size.x = (cr.Min.x >= 0 && cr.Max.x >= 0) ? ImClamp(new_size.x, cr.Min.x, cr.Max.x) : window->SizeFull.x; - new_size.y = (cr.Min.y >= 0 && cr.Max.y >= 0) ? ImClamp(new_size.y, cr.Min.y, cr.Max.y) : window->SizeFull.y; - if (g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallback) - { - ImGuiSizeConstraintCallbackData data; - data.UserData = g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallbackUserData; - data.Pos = window->Pos; - data.CurrentSize = window->SizeFull; - data.DesiredSize = new_size; - g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallback(&data); - new_size = data.DesiredSize; - } - } - if (!(window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow | ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize))) - new_size = ImMax(new_size, g.Style.WindowMinSize); - window->SizeFull = new_size; -} - -// Push a new ImGui window to add widgets to. -// - A default window called "Debug" is automatically stacked at the beginning of every frame so you can use widgets without explicitly calling a Begin/End pair. -// - Begin/End can be called multiple times during the frame with the same window name to append content. -// - 'size_on_first_use' for a regular window denote the initial size for first-time creation (no saved data) and isn't that useful. Use SetNextWindowSize() prior to calling Begin() for more flexible window manipulation. -// - The window name is used as a unique identifier to preserve window information across frames (and save rudimentary information to the .ini file). -// You can use the "##" or "###" markers to use the same label with different id, or same id with different label. See documentation at the top of this file. -// - Return false when window is collapsed, so you can early out in your code. You always need to call ImGui::End() even if false is returned. -// - Passing 'bool* p_open' displays a Close button on the upper-right corner of the window, the pointed value will be set to false when the button is pressed. -// - Passing non-zero 'size' is roughly equivalent to calling SetNextWindowSize(size, ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver) prior to calling Begin(). -bool ImGui::Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) -{ - return ImGui::Begin(name, p_open, ImVec2(0.f, 0.f), -1.0f, flags); -} - -bool ImGui::Begin(const char* name, bool* p_open, const ImVec2& size_on_first_use, float bg_alpha, ImGuiWindowFlags flags) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - IM_ASSERT(name != NULL); // Window name required - IM_ASSERT(g.Initialized); // Forgot to call ImGui::NewFrame() - IM_ASSERT(g.FrameCountEnded != g.FrameCount); // Called ImGui::Render() or ImGui::EndFrame() and haven't called ImGui::NewFrame() again yet - - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoInputs) - flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove | ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize; - - // Find or create - bool window_is_new = false; - ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name); - if (!window) - { - window = CreateNewWindow(name, size_on_first_use, flags); - window_is_new = true; - } - - const int current_frame = ImGui::GetFrameCount(); - const bool first_begin_of_the_frame = (window->LastFrameActive != current_frame); - if (first_begin_of_the_frame) - window->Flags = (ImGuiWindowFlags)flags; - else - flags = window->Flags; - - // Add to stack - ImGuiWindow* parent_window = !g.CurrentWindowStack.empty() ? g.CurrentWindowStack.back() : NULL; - g.CurrentWindowStack.push_back(window); - SetCurrentWindow(window); - CheckStacksSize(window, true); - IM_ASSERT(parent_window != NULL || !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)); - - bool window_was_active = (window->LastFrameActive == current_frame - 1); // Not using !WasActive because the implicit "Debug" window would always toggle off->on - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) - { - ImGuiPopupRef& popup_ref = g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size]; - window_was_active &= (window->PopupId == popup_ref.PopupId); - window_was_active &= (window == popup_ref.Window); - popup_ref.Window = window; - g.CurrentPopupStack.push_back(popup_ref); - window->PopupId = popup_ref.PopupId; - } - - const bool window_appearing_after_being_hidden = (window->HiddenFrames == 1); - - // Process SetNextWindow***() calls - bool window_pos_set_by_api = false, window_size_set_by_api = false; - if (g.SetNextWindowPosCond) - { - const ImVec2 backup_cursor_pos = window->DC.CursorPos; // FIXME: not sure of the exact reason of this saving/restore anymore :( need to look into that. - if (!window_was_active || window_appearing_after_being_hidden) window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags |= ImGuiSetCond_Appearing; - window_pos_set_by_api = (window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags & g.SetNextWindowPosCond) != 0; - if (window_pos_set_by_api && ImLengthSqr(g.SetNextWindowPosVal - ImVec2(-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX)) < 0.001f) - { - window->SetWindowPosCenterWanted = true; // May be processed on the next frame if this is our first frame and we are measuring size - window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags &= ~(ImGuiSetCond_Once | ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiSetCond_Appearing); - } - else - { - SetWindowPos(window, g.SetNextWindowPosVal, g.SetNextWindowPosCond); - } - window->DC.CursorPos = backup_cursor_pos; - g.SetNextWindowPosCond = 0; - } - if (g.SetNextWindowSizeCond) - { - if (!window_was_active || window_appearing_after_being_hidden) window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags |= ImGuiSetCond_Appearing; - window_size_set_by_api = (window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags & g.SetNextWindowSizeCond) != 0; - SetWindowSize(window, g.SetNextWindowSizeVal, g.SetNextWindowSizeCond); - g.SetNextWindowSizeCond = 0; - } - if (g.SetNextWindowContentSizeCond) - { - window->SizeContentsExplicit = g.SetNextWindowContentSizeVal; - g.SetNextWindowContentSizeCond = 0; - } - else if (first_begin_of_the_frame) - { - window->SizeContentsExplicit = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - } - if (g.SetNextWindowCollapsedCond) - { - if (!window_was_active || window_appearing_after_being_hidden) window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags |= ImGuiSetCond_Appearing; - SetWindowCollapsed(window, g.SetNextWindowCollapsedVal, g.SetNextWindowCollapsedCond); - g.SetNextWindowCollapsedCond = 0; - } - if (g.SetNextWindowFocus) - { - ImGui::SetWindowFocus(); - g.SetNextWindowFocus = false; - } - - // Update known root window (if we are a child window, otherwise window == window->RootWindow) - int root_idx, root_non_popup_idx; - for (root_idx = g.CurrentWindowStack.Size - 1; root_idx > 0; root_idx--) - if (!(g.CurrentWindowStack[root_idx]->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) - break; - for (root_non_popup_idx = root_idx; root_non_popup_idx > 0; root_non_popup_idx--) - if (!(g.CurrentWindowStack[root_non_popup_idx]->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup))) - break; - window->ParentWindow = parent_window; - window->RootWindow = g.CurrentWindowStack[root_idx]; - window->RootNonPopupWindow = g.CurrentWindowStack[root_non_popup_idx]; // This is merely for displaying the TitleBgActive color. - - // When reusing window again multiple times a frame, just append content (don't need to setup again) - if (first_begin_of_the_frame) - { - window->Active = true; - window->IndexWithinParent = 0; - window->BeginCount = 0; - window->ClipRect = ImVec4(-FLT_MAX,-FLT_MAX,+FLT_MAX,+FLT_MAX); - window->LastFrameActive = current_frame; - window->IDStack.resize(1); - - // Clear draw list, setup texture, outer clipping rectangle - window->DrawList->Clear(); - window->DrawList->PushTextureID(g.Font->ContainerAtlas->TexID); - ImRect fullscreen_rect(GetVisibleRect()); - if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox|ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup))) - PushClipRect(parent_window->ClipRect.Min, parent_window->ClipRect.Max, true); - else - PushClipRect(fullscreen_rect.Min, fullscreen_rect.Max, true); - - if (!window_was_active) - { - // Popup first latch mouse position, will position itself when it appears next frame - window->AutoPosLastDirection = -1; - if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) != 0 && !window_pos_set_by_api) - window->PosFloat = g.IO.MousePos; - } - - // Collapse window by double-clicking on title bar - // At this point we don't have a clipping rectangle setup yet, so we can use the title bar area for hit detection and drawing - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse)) - { - ImRect title_bar_rect = window->TitleBarRect(); - if (g.HoveredWindow == window && IsMouseHoveringRect(title_bar_rect.Min, title_bar_rect.Max) && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0]) - { - window->Collapsed = !window->Collapsed; - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings)) - MarkIniSettingsDirty(); - FocusWindow(window); - } - } - else - { - window->Collapsed = false; - } - - // SIZE - - // Save contents size from last frame for auto-fitting (unless explicitly specified) - window->SizeContents.x = (float)(int)((window->SizeContentsExplicit.x != 0.0f) ? window->SizeContentsExplicit.x : ((window_is_new ? 0.0f : window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x - window->Pos.x) + window->Scroll.x)); - window->SizeContents.y = (float)(int)((window->SizeContentsExplicit.y != 0.0f) ? window->SizeContentsExplicit.y : ((window_is_new ? 0.0f : window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y - window->Pos.y) + window->Scroll.y)); - - // Hide popup/tooltip window when first appearing while we measure size (because we recycle them) - if (window->HiddenFrames > 0) - window->HiddenFrames--; - if ((flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup | ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip)) != 0 && !window_was_active) - { - window->HiddenFrames = 1; - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) - { - if (!window_size_set_by_api) - window->Size = window->SizeFull = ImVec2(0.f, 0.f); - window->SizeContents = ImVec2(0.f, 0.f); - } - } - - // Lock window padding so that altering the ShowBorders flag for children doesn't have side-effects. - window->WindowPadding = ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysUseWindowPadding | ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders | ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox | ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup))) ? ImVec2(0,0) : style.WindowPadding; - - // Calculate auto-fit size - ImVec2 size_auto_fit; - if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) != 0) - { - // Tooltip always resize. We keep the spacing symmetric on both axises for aesthetic purpose. - size_auto_fit = window->SizeContents + window->WindowPadding - ImVec2(0.0f, style.ItemSpacing.y); - } - else - { - size_auto_fit = ImClamp(window->SizeContents + window->WindowPadding, style.WindowMinSize, ImMax(style.WindowMinSize, g.IO.DisplaySize - g.Style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding)); - - // Handling case of auto fit window not fitting in screen on one axis, we are growing auto fit size on the other axis to compensate for expected scrollbar. FIXME: Might turn bigger than DisplaySize-WindowPadding. - if (size_auto_fit.x < window->SizeContents.x && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar) && (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar)) - size_auto_fit.y += style.ScrollbarSize; - if (size_auto_fit.y < window->SizeContents.y && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar)) - size_auto_fit.x += style.ScrollbarSize; - size_auto_fit.y = ImMax(size_auto_fit.y - style.ItemSpacing.y, 0.0f); - } - - // Handle automatic resize - if (window->Collapsed) - { - // We still process initial auto-fit on collapsed windows to get a window width, - // But otherwise we don't honor ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize when collapsed. - if (window->AutoFitFramesX > 0) - window->SizeFull.x = window->AutoFitOnlyGrows ? ImMax(window->SizeFull.x, size_auto_fit.x) : size_auto_fit.x; - if (window->AutoFitFramesY > 0) - window->SizeFull.y = window->AutoFitOnlyGrows ? ImMax(window->SizeFull.y, size_auto_fit.y) : size_auto_fit.y; - } - else - { - if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) && !window_size_set_by_api) - { - window->SizeFull = size_auto_fit; - } - else if ((window->AutoFitFramesX > 0 || window->AutoFitFramesY > 0) && !window_size_set_by_api) - { - // Auto-fit only grows during the first few frames - if (window->AutoFitFramesX > 0) - window->SizeFull.x = window->AutoFitOnlyGrows ? ImMax(window->SizeFull.x, size_auto_fit.x) : size_auto_fit.x; - if (window->AutoFitFramesY > 0) - window->SizeFull.y = window->AutoFitOnlyGrows ? ImMax(window->SizeFull.y, size_auto_fit.y) : size_auto_fit.y; - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings)) - MarkIniSettingsDirty(); - } - } - - // Apply minimum/maximum window size constraints and final size - ApplySizeFullWithConstraint(window, window->SizeFull); - window->Size = window->Collapsed ? window->TitleBarRect().GetSize() : window->SizeFull; - - // POSITION - - // Position child window - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) - { - window->IndexWithinParent = parent_window->DC.ChildWindows.Size; - parent_window->DC.ChildWindows.push_back(window); - } - if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)) - { - window->Pos = window->PosFloat = parent_window->DC.CursorPos; - window->Size = window->SizeFull = size_on_first_use; // NB: argument name 'size_on_first_use' misleading here, it's really just 'size' as provided by user passed via BeginChild()->Begin(). - } - - bool window_pos_center = false; - window_pos_center |= (window->SetWindowPosCenterWanted && window->HiddenFrames == 0); - window_pos_center |= ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) && !window_pos_set_by_api && window_appearing_after_being_hidden); - if (window_pos_center) - { - // Center (any sort of window) - SetWindowPos(window, ImMax(style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding, fullscreen_rect.GetCenter() - window->SizeFull * 0.5f), 0); - } - else if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) - { - IM_ASSERT(window_pos_set_by_api); - ImRect rect_to_avoid; - if (parent_window->DC.MenuBarAppending) - rect_to_avoid = ImRect(-FLT_MAX, parent_window->Pos.y + parent_window->TitleBarHeight(), FLT_MAX, parent_window->Pos.y + parent_window->TitleBarHeight() + parent_window->MenuBarHeight()); - else - rect_to_avoid = ImRect(parent_window->Pos.x + style.ItemSpacing.x, -FLT_MAX, parent_window->Pos.x + parent_window->Size.x - style.ItemSpacing.x - parent_window->ScrollbarSizes.x, FLT_MAX); // We want some overlap to convey the relative depth of each popup (here hard-coded to 4) - window->PosFloat = FindBestPopupWindowPos(window->PosFloat, window->Size, &window->AutoPosLastDirection, rect_to_avoid); - } - else if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) != 0 && !window_pos_set_by_api && window_appearing_after_being_hidden) - { - ImRect rect_to_avoid(window->PosFloat.x - 1, window->PosFloat.y - 1, window->PosFloat.x + 1, window->PosFloat.y + 1); - window->PosFloat = FindBestPopupWindowPos(window->PosFloat, window->Size, &window->AutoPosLastDirection, rect_to_avoid); - } - - // Position tooltip (always follows mouse) - if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) != 0 && !window_pos_set_by_api) - { - ImRect rect_to_avoid(g.IO.MousePos.x - 16, g.IO.MousePos.y - 8, g.IO.MousePos.x + 24, g.IO.MousePos.y + 24); // FIXME: Completely hard-coded. Perhaps center on cursor hit-point instead? - window->PosFloat = FindBestPopupWindowPos(g.IO.MousePos, window->Size, &window->AutoPosLastDirection, rect_to_avoid); - if (window->AutoPosLastDirection == -1) - window->PosFloat = g.IO.MousePos + ImVec2(2,2); // If there's not enough room, for tooltip we prefer avoiding the cursor at all cost even if it means that part of the tooltip won't be visible. - } - - // Clamp position so it stays visible - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip)) - { - if (!window_pos_set_by_api && window->AutoFitFramesX <= 0 && window->AutoFitFramesY <= 0 && g.IO.DisplaySize.x > 0.0f && g.IO.DisplaySize.y > 0.0f) // Ignore zero-sized display explicitly to avoid losing positions if a window manager reports zero-sized window when initializing or minimizing. - { - ImVec2 padding = ImMax(style.DisplayWindowPadding, style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding); - window->PosFloat = ImMax(window->PosFloat + window->Size, padding) - window->Size; - window->PosFloat = ImMin(window->PosFloat, g.IO.DisplaySize - padding); - } - } - window->Pos = ImVec2((float)(int)window->PosFloat.x, (float)(int)window->PosFloat.y); - - // Default item width. Make it proportional to window size if window manually resizes - if (window->Size.x > 0.0f && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)) - window->ItemWidthDefault = (float)(int)(window->Size.x * 0.65f); - else - window->ItemWidthDefault = (float)(int)(g.FontSize * 16.0f); - - // Prepare for focus requests - window->FocusIdxAllRequestCurrent = (window->FocusIdxAllRequestNext == INT_MAX || window->FocusIdxAllCounter == -1) ? INT_MAX : (window->FocusIdxAllRequestNext + (window->FocusIdxAllCounter+1)) % (window->FocusIdxAllCounter+1); - window->FocusIdxTabRequestCurrent = (window->FocusIdxTabRequestNext == INT_MAX || window->FocusIdxTabCounter == -1) ? INT_MAX : (window->FocusIdxTabRequestNext + (window->FocusIdxTabCounter+1)) % (window->FocusIdxTabCounter+1); - window->FocusIdxAllCounter = window->FocusIdxTabCounter = -1; - window->FocusIdxAllRequestNext = window->FocusIdxTabRequestNext = INT_MAX; - - // Apply scrolling - if (window->ScrollTarget.x < FLT_MAX) - { - window->Scroll.x = window->ScrollTarget.x; - window->ScrollTarget.x = FLT_MAX; - } - if (window->ScrollTarget.y < FLT_MAX) - { - float center_ratio = window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.y; - window->Scroll.y = window->ScrollTarget.y - ((1.0f - center_ratio) * (window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight())) - (center_ratio * window->SizeFull.y); - window->ScrollTarget.y = FLT_MAX; - } - window->Scroll = ImMax(window->Scroll, ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)); - if (!window->Collapsed && !window->SkipItems) - window->Scroll = ImMin(window->Scroll, ImMax(ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f), window->SizeContents - window->SizeFull + window->ScrollbarSizes)); - - // Modal window darkens what is behind them - if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Modal) != 0 && window == GetFrontMostModalRootWindow()) - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(fullscreen_rect.Min, fullscreen_rect.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDarkening, g.ModalWindowDarkeningRatio)); - - // Draw window + handle manual resize - ImRect title_bar_rect = window->TitleBarRect(); - const float window_rounding = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? style.ChildWindowRounding : style.WindowRounding; - if (window->Collapsed) - { - // Draw title bar only - RenderFrame(title_bar_rect.GetTL(), title_bar_rect.GetBR(), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_TitleBgCollapsed), true, window_rounding); - } - else - { - ImU32 resize_col = 0; - const float resize_corner_size = ImMax(g.FontSize * 1.35f, window_rounding + 1.0f + g.FontSize * 0.2f); - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) && window->AutoFitFramesX <= 0 && window->AutoFitFramesY <= 0 && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize)) - { - // Manual resize - const ImVec2 br = window->Rect().GetBR(); - const ImRect resize_rect(br - ImVec2(resize_corner_size * 0.75f, resize_corner_size * 0.75f), br); - const ImGuiID resize_id = window->GetID("#RESIZE"); - bool hovered, held; - ButtonBehavior(resize_rect, resize_id, &hovered, &held, ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChilds); - resize_col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered : ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip); - - if (hovered || held) - g.MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNWSE; - - if (g.HoveredWindow == window && held && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0]) - { - // Manual auto-fit when double-clicking - ApplySizeFullWithConstraint(window, size_auto_fit); - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings)) - MarkIniSettingsDirty(); - ClearActiveID(); - } - else if (held) - { - // We don't use an incremental MouseDelta but rather compute an absolute target size based on mouse position - ApplySizeFullWithConstraint(window, (g.IO.MousePos - g.ActiveIdClickOffset + resize_rect.GetSize()) - window->Pos); - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings)) - MarkIniSettingsDirty(); - } - - window->Size = window->SizeFull; - title_bar_rect = window->TitleBarRect(); - } - - // Scrollbars - window->ScrollbarY = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar) || ((window->SizeContents.y > window->Size.y + style.ItemSpacing.y) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar)); - window->ScrollbarX = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysHorizontalScrollbar) || ((window->SizeContents.x > window->Size.x - (window->ScrollbarY ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f) - window->WindowPadding.x) && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar) && (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar)); - window->ScrollbarSizes = ImVec2(window->ScrollbarY ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f, window->ScrollbarX ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f); - window->BorderSize = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders) ? 1.0f : 0.0f; - - // Window background, Default Alpha - ImGuiCol bg_color_idx = ImGuiCol_WindowBg; - if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox) != 0) - bg_color_idx = ImGuiCol_ComboBg; - else if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip) != 0 || (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) != 0) - bg_color_idx = ImGuiCol_PopupBg; - else if ((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) != 0) - bg_color_idx = ImGuiCol_ChildWindowBg; - ImVec4 bg_color = style.Colors[bg_color_idx]; - if (bg_alpha >= 0.0f) - bg_color.w = bg_alpha; - bg_color.w *= style.Alpha; - if (bg_color.w > 0.0f) - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(window->Pos+ImVec2(0,window->TitleBarHeight()), window->Pos+window->Size, ColorConvertFloat4ToU32(bg_color), window_rounding, (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) ? ImGuiCorner_All : ImGuiCorner_BottomLeft|ImGuiCorner_BottomRight); - - // Title bar - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar)) - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(title_bar_rect.GetTL(), title_bar_rect.GetBR(), GetColorU32((g.FocusedWindow && window->RootNonPopupWindow == g.FocusedWindow->RootNonPopupWindow) ? ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive : ImGuiCol_TitleBg), window_rounding, ImGuiCorner_TopLeft|ImGuiCorner_TopRight); - - // Menu bar - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) - { - ImRect menu_bar_rect = window->MenuBarRect(); - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders) - window->DrawList->AddLine(menu_bar_rect.GetBL(), menu_bar_rect.GetBR(), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border)); - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(menu_bar_rect.GetTL(), menu_bar_rect.GetBR(), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg), (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) ? window_rounding : 0.0f, ImGuiCorner_TopLeft|ImGuiCorner_TopRight); - } - - // Scrollbars - if (window->ScrollbarX) - Scrollbar(window, true); - if (window->ScrollbarY) - Scrollbar(window, false); - - // Render resize grip - // (after the input handling so we don't have a frame of latency) - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize)) - { - const ImVec2 br = window->Rect().GetBR(); - window->DrawList->PathLineTo(br + ImVec2(-resize_corner_size, -window->BorderSize)); - window->DrawList->PathLineTo(br + ImVec2(-window->BorderSize, -resize_corner_size)); - window->DrawList->PathArcToFast(ImVec2(br.x - window_rounding - window->BorderSize, br.y - window_rounding - window->BorderSize), window_rounding, 0, 3); - window->DrawList->PathFill(resize_col); - } - - // Borders - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders) - { - window->DrawList->AddRect(window->Pos+ImVec2(1,1), window->Pos+window->Size+ImVec2(1,1), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_BorderShadow), window_rounding); - window->DrawList->AddRect(window->Pos, window->Pos+window->Size, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), window_rounding); - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar)) - window->DrawList->AddLine(title_bar_rect.GetBL()+ImVec2(1,0), title_bar_rect.GetBR()-ImVec2(1,0), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border)); - } - } - - // Update ContentsRegionMax. All the variable it depends on are set above in this function. - window->ContentsRegionRect.Min.x = -window->Scroll.x + window->WindowPadding.x; - window->ContentsRegionRect.Min.y = -window->Scroll.y + window->WindowPadding.y + window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight(); - window->ContentsRegionRect.Max.x = -window->Scroll.x - window->WindowPadding.x + (window->SizeContentsExplicit.x != 0.0f ? window->SizeContentsExplicit.x : (window->Size.x - window->ScrollbarSizes.x)); - window->ContentsRegionRect.Max.y = -window->Scroll.y - window->WindowPadding.y + (window->SizeContentsExplicit.y != 0.0f ? window->SizeContentsExplicit.y : (window->Size.y - window->ScrollbarSizes.y)); - - // Setup drawing context - window->DC.IndentX = 0.0f + window->WindowPadding.x - window->Scroll.x; - window->DC.GroupOffsetX = 0.0f; - window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX = 0.0f; - window->DC.CursorStartPos = window->Pos + ImVec2(window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX, window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight() + window->WindowPadding.y - window->Scroll.y); - window->DC.CursorPos = window->DC.CursorStartPos; - window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine = window->DC.CursorPos; - window->DC.CursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorStartPos; - window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = window->DC.PrevLineHeight = 0.0f; - window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f; - window->DC.MenuBarAppending = false; - window->DC.MenuBarOffsetX = ImMax(window->WindowPadding.x, style.ItemSpacing.x); - window->DC.LogLinePosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y - 9999.0f; - window->DC.ChildWindows.resize(0); - window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical; - window->DC.ItemWidth = window->ItemWidthDefault; - window->DC.TextWrapPos = -1.0f; // disabled - window->DC.AllowKeyboardFocus = true; - window->DC.ButtonRepeat = false; - window->DC.ItemWidthStack.resize(0); - window->DC.AllowKeyboardFocusStack.resize(0); - window->DC.ButtonRepeatStack.resize(0); - window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.resize(0); - window->DC.ColumnsCurrent = 0; - window->DC.ColumnsCount = 1; - window->DC.ColumnsStartPosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y; - window->DC.ColumnsCellMinY = window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY = window->DC.ColumnsStartPosY; - window->DC.TreeDepth = 0; - window->DC.StateStorage = &window->StateStorage; - window->DC.GroupStack.resize(0); - window->DC.ColorEditMode = ImGuiColorEditMode_UserSelect; - window->MenuColumns.Update(3, style.ItemSpacing.x, !window_was_active); - - if (window->AutoFitFramesX > 0) - window->AutoFitFramesX--; - if (window->AutoFitFramesY > 0) - window->AutoFitFramesY--; - - // New windows appears in front (we need to do that AFTER setting DC.CursorStartPos so our initial navigation reference rectangle can start around there) - if (!window_was_active && !(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoFocusOnAppearing)) - if (!(flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow|ImGuiWindowFlags_Tooltip)) || (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)) - FocusWindow(window); - - // Title bar - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar)) - { - if (p_open != NULL) - { - const float pad = 2.0f; - const float rad = (window->TitleBarHeight() - pad*2.0f) * 0.5f; - if (CloseButton(window->GetID("#CLOSE"), window->Rect().GetTR() + ImVec2(-pad - rad, pad + rad), rad)) - *p_open = false; - } - - const ImVec2 text_size = CalcTextSize(name, NULL, true); - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse)) - RenderCollapseTriangle(window->Pos + style.FramePadding, !window->Collapsed, 1.0f); - - ImVec2 text_min = window->Pos; - ImVec2 text_max = window->Pos + ImVec2(window->Size.x, style.FramePadding.y*2 + text_size.y); - ImRect clip_rect; - clip_rect.Max = ImVec2(window->Pos.x + window->Size.x - (p_open ? title_bar_rect.GetHeight() - 3 : style.FramePadding.x), text_max.y); // Match the size of CloseWindowButton() - float pad_left = (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse) == 0 ? (style.FramePadding.x + g.FontSize + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) : style.FramePadding.x; - float pad_right = (p_open != NULL) ? (style.FramePadding.x + g.FontSize + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) : style.FramePadding.x; - if (style.WindowTitleAlign.x > 0.0f) pad_right = ImLerp(pad_right, pad_left, style.WindowTitleAlign.x); - text_min.x += pad_left; - text_max.x -= pad_right; - clip_rect.Min = ImVec2(text_min.x, window->Pos.y); - RenderTextClipped(text_min, text_max, name, NULL, &text_size, style.WindowTitleAlign, &clip_rect); - } - - // Save clipped aabb so we can access it in constant-time in FindHoveredWindow() - window->WindowRectClipped = window->Rect(); - window->WindowRectClipped.Clip(window->ClipRect); - - // Pressing CTRL+C while holding on a window copy its content to the clipboard - // This works but 1. doesn't handle multiple Begin/End pairs, 2. recursing into another Begin/End pair - so we need to work that out and add better logging scope. - // Maybe we can support CTRL+C on every element? - /* - if (g.ActiveId == move_id) - if (g.IO.KeyCtrl && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_C)) - ImGui::LogToClipboard(); - */ - } - - // Inner clipping rectangle - // We set this up after processing the resize grip so that our clip rectangle doesn't lag by a frame - // Note that if our window is collapsed we will end up with a null clipping rectangle which is the correct behavior. - const ImRect title_bar_rect = window->TitleBarRect(); - const float border_size = window->BorderSize; - ImRect clip_rect; // Force round to ensure that e.g. (int)(max.x-min.x) in user's render code produce correct result. - clip_rect.Min.x = ImFloor(0.5f + title_bar_rect.Min.x + ImMax(border_size, ImFloor(window->WindowPadding.x*0.5f))); - clip_rect.Min.y = ImFloor(0.5f + title_bar_rect.Max.y + window->MenuBarHeight() + border_size); - clip_rect.Max.x = ImFloor(0.5f + window->Pos.x + window->Size.x - window->ScrollbarSizes.x - ImMax(border_size, ImFloor(window->WindowPadding.x*0.5f))); - clip_rect.Max.y = ImFloor(0.5f + window->Pos.y + window->Size.y - window->ScrollbarSizes.y - border_size); - PushClipRect(clip_rect.Min, clip_rect.Max, true); - - // Clear 'accessed' flag last thing - if (first_begin_of_the_frame) - window->Accessed = false; - window->BeginCount++; - g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraint = false; - - // Child window can be out of sight and have "negative" clip windows. - // Mark them as collapsed so commands are skipped earlier (we can't manually collapse because they have no title bar). - if (flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) - { - IM_ASSERT((flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) != 0); - window->Collapsed = parent_window && parent_window->Collapsed; - - if (!(flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize) && window->AutoFitFramesX <= 0 && window->AutoFitFramesY <= 0) - window->Collapsed |= (window->WindowRectClipped.Min.x >= window->WindowRectClipped.Max.x || window->WindowRectClipped.Min.y >= window->WindowRectClipped.Max.y); - - // We also hide the window from rendering because we've already added its border to the command list. - // (we could perform the check earlier in the function but it is simpler at this point) - if (window->Collapsed) - window->Active = false; - } - if (style.Alpha <= 0.0f) - window->Active = false; - - // Return false if we don't intend to display anything to allow user to perform an early out optimization - window->SkipItems = (window->Collapsed || !window->Active) && window->AutoFitFramesX <= 0 && window->AutoFitFramesY <= 0; - return !window->SkipItems; -} - -void ImGui::End() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; - - Columns(1, "#CloseColumns"); - PopClipRect(); // inner window clip rectangle - - // Stop logging - if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow)) // FIXME: add more options for scope of logging - LogFinish(); - - // Pop - // NB: we don't clear 'window->RootWindow'. The pointer is allowed to live until the next call to Begin(). - g.CurrentWindowStack.pop_back(); - if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) - g.CurrentPopupStack.pop_back(); - CheckStacksSize(window, false); - SetCurrentWindow(g.CurrentWindowStack.empty() ? NULL : g.CurrentWindowStack.back()); -} - -// Vertical scrollbar -// The entire piece of code below is rather confusing because: -// - We handle absolute seeking (when first clicking outside the grab) and relative manipulation (afterward or when clicking inside the grab) -// - We store values as normalized ratio and in a form that allows the window content to change while we are holding on a scrollbar -// - We handle both horizontal and vertical scrollbars, which makes the terminology not ideal. -static void Scrollbar(ImGuiWindow* window, bool horizontal) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(horizontal ? "#SCROLLX" : "#SCROLLY"); - - // Render background - bool other_scrollbar = (horizontal ? window->ScrollbarY : window->ScrollbarX); - float other_scrollbar_size_w = other_scrollbar ? style.ScrollbarSize : 0.0f; - const ImRect window_rect = window->Rect(); - const float border_size = window->BorderSize; - ImRect bb = horizontal - ? ImRect(window->Pos.x + border_size, window_rect.Max.y - style.ScrollbarSize, window_rect.Max.x - other_scrollbar_size_w - border_size, window_rect.Max.y - border_size) - : ImRect(window_rect.Max.x - style.ScrollbarSize, window->Pos.y + border_size, window_rect.Max.x - border_size, window_rect.Max.y - other_scrollbar_size_w - border_size); - if (!horizontal) - bb.Min.y += window->TitleBarHeight() + ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) ? window->MenuBarHeight() : 0.0f); - - float window_rounding = (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? style.ChildWindowRounding : style.WindowRounding; - int window_rounding_corners; - if (horizontal) - window_rounding_corners = ImGuiCorner_BottomLeft | (other_scrollbar ? 0 : ImGuiCorner_BottomRight); - else - window_rounding_corners = (((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar) && !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar)) ? ImGuiCorner_TopRight : 0) | (other_scrollbar ? 0 : ImGuiCorner_BottomRight); - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(bb.Min, bb.Max, ImGui::GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg), window_rounding, window_rounding_corners); - bb.Reduce(ImVec2(ImClamp((float)(int)((bb.Max.x - bb.Min.x - 2.0f) * 0.5f), 0.0f, 3.0f), ImClamp((float)(int)((bb.Max.y - bb.Min.y - 2.0f) * 0.5f), 0.0f, 3.0f))); - - // V denote the main axis of the scrollbar - float scrollbar_size_v = horizontal ? bb.GetWidth() : bb.GetHeight(); - float scroll_v = horizontal ? window->Scroll.x : window->Scroll.y; - float win_size_avail_v = (horizontal ? window->Size.x : window->Size.y) - other_scrollbar_size_w; - float win_size_contents_v = horizontal ? window->SizeContents.x : window->SizeContents.y; - - // The grabable box size generally represent the amount visible (vs the total scrollable amount) - // But we maintain a minimum size in pixel to allow for the user to still aim inside. - const float grab_h_pixels = ImMin(ImMax(scrollbar_size_v * ImSaturate(win_size_avail_v / ImMax(win_size_contents_v, win_size_avail_v)), style.GrabMinSize), scrollbar_size_v); - const float grab_h_norm = grab_h_pixels / scrollbar_size_v; - - // Handle input right away. None of the code of Begin() is relying on scrolling position before calling Scrollbar(). - bool held = false; - bool hovered = false; - const bool previously_held = (g.ActiveId == id); - ImGui::ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held); - - float scroll_max = ImMax(1.0f, win_size_contents_v - win_size_avail_v); - float scroll_ratio = ImSaturate(scroll_v / scroll_max); - float grab_v_norm = scroll_ratio * (scrollbar_size_v - grab_h_pixels) / scrollbar_size_v; - if (held && grab_h_norm < 1.0f) - { - float scrollbar_pos_v = horizontal ? bb.Min.x : bb.Min.y; - float mouse_pos_v = horizontal ? g.IO.MousePos.x : g.IO.MousePos.y; - float* click_delta_to_grab_center_v = horizontal ? &g.ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter.x : &g.ScrollbarClickDeltaToGrabCenter.y; - - // Click position in scrollbar normalized space (0.0f->1.0f) - const float clicked_v_norm = ImSaturate((mouse_pos_v - scrollbar_pos_v) / scrollbar_size_v); - ImGui::SetHoveredID(id); - - bool seek_absolute = false; - if (!previously_held) - { - // On initial click calculate the distance between mouse and the center of the grab - if (clicked_v_norm >= grab_v_norm && clicked_v_norm <= grab_v_norm + grab_h_norm) - { - *click_delta_to_grab_center_v = clicked_v_norm - grab_v_norm - grab_h_norm*0.5f; - } - else - { - seek_absolute = true; - *click_delta_to_grab_center_v = 0.0f; - } - } - - // Apply scroll - // It is ok to modify Scroll here because we are being called in Begin() after the calculation of SizeContents and before setting up our starting position - const float scroll_v_norm = ImSaturate((clicked_v_norm - *click_delta_to_grab_center_v - grab_h_norm*0.5f) / (1.0f - grab_h_norm)); - scroll_v = (float)(int)(0.5f + scroll_v_norm * scroll_max);//(win_size_contents_v - win_size_v)); - if (horizontal) - window->Scroll.x = scroll_v; - else - window->Scroll.y = scroll_v; - - // Update values for rendering - scroll_ratio = ImSaturate(scroll_v / scroll_max); - grab_v_norm = scroll_ratio * (scrollbar_size_v - grab_h_pixels) / scrollbar_size_v; - - // Update distance to grab now that we have seeked and saturated - if (seek_absolute) - *click_delta_to_grab_center_v = clicked_v_norm - grab_v_norm - grab_h_norm*0.5f; - } - - // Render - const ImU32 grab_col = ImGui::GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered : ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab); - if (horizontal) - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(ImLerp(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x, grab_v_norm), bb.Min.y), ImVec2(ImLerp(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x, grab_v_norm) + grab_h_pixels, bb.Max.y), grab_col, style.ScrollbarRounding); - else - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(bb.Min.x, ImLerp(bb.Min.y, bb.Max.y, grab_v_norm)), ImVec2(bb.Max.x, ImLerp(bb.Min.y, bb.Max.y, grab_v_norm) + grab_h_pixels), grab_col, style.ScrollbarRounding); -} - -// Moving window to front of display (which happens to be back of our sorted list) -void ImGui::FocusWindow(ImGuiWindow* window) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - - // Always mark the window we passed as focused. This is used for keyboard interactions such as tabbing. - g.FocusedWindow = window; - - // Passing NULL allow to disable keyboard focus - if (!window) - return; - - // And move its root window to the top of the pile - if (window->RootWindow) - window = window->RootWindow; - - // Steal focus on active widgets - if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) // FIXME: This statement should be unnecessary. Need further testing before removing it.. - if (g.ActiveId != 0 && g.ActiveIdWindow && g.ActiveIdWindow->RootWindow != window) - ClearActiveID(); - - // Bring to front - if ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoBringToFrontOnFocus) || g.Windows.back() == window) - return; - for (int i = 0; i < g.Windows.Size; i++) - if (g.Windows[i] == window) - { - g.Windows.erase(g.Windows.begin() + i); - break; - } - g.Windows.push_back(window); -} - -void ImGui::PushItemWidth(float item_width) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.ItemWidth = (item_width == 0.0f ? window->ItemWidthDefault : item_width); - window->DC.ItemWidthStack.push_back(window->DC.ItemWidth); -} - -static void PushMultiItemsWidths(int components, float w_full) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = ImGui::GetCurrentWindow(); - const ImGuiStyle& style = GImGui->Style; - if (w_full <= 0.0f) - w_full = ImGui::CalcItemWidth(); - const float w_item_one = ImMax(1.0f, (float)(int)((w_full - (style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components-1)) / (float)components)); - const float w_item_last = ImMax(1.0f, (float)(int)(w_full - (w_item_one + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components-1))); - window->DC.ItemWidthStack.push_back(w_item_last); - for (int i = 0; i < components-1; i++) - window->DC.ItemWidthStack.push_back(w_item_one); - window->DC.ItemWidth = window->DC.ItemWidthStack.back(); -} - -void ImGui::PopItemWidth() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.ItemWidthStack.pop_back(); - window->DC.ItemWidth = window->DC.ItemWidthStack.empty() ? window->ItemWidthDefault : window->DC.ItemWidthStack.back(); -} - -float ImGui::CalcItemWidth() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - float w = window->DC.ItemWidth; - if (w < 0.0f) - { - // Align to a right-side limit. We include 1 frame padding in the calculation because this is how the width is always used (we add 2 frame padding to it), but we could move that responsibility to the widget as well. - float width_to_right_edge = GetContentRegionAvail().x; - w = ImMax(1.0f, width_to_right_edge + w); - } - w = (float)(int)w; - return w; -} - -static ImFont* GetDefaultFont() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.IO.FontDefault ? g.IO.FontDefault : g.IO.Fonts->Fonts[0]; -} - -static void SetCurrentFont(ImFont* font) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - IM_ASSERT(font && font->IsLoaded()); // Font Atlas not created. Did you call io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32 / GetTexDataAsAlpha8 ? - IM_ASSERT(font->Scale > 0.0f); - g.Font = font; - g.FontBaseSize = g.IO.FontGlobalScale * g.Font->FontSize * g.Font->Scale; - g.FontSize = g.CurrentWindow ? g.CurrentWindow->CalcFontSize() : 0.0f; - g.FontTexUvWhitePixel = g.Font->ContainerAtlas->TexUvWhitePixel; -} - -void ImGui::PushFont(ImFont* font) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (!font) - font = GetDefaultFont(); - SetCurrentFont(font); - g.FontStack.push_back(font); - g.CurrentWindow->DrawList->PushTextureID(font->ContainerAtlas->TexID); -} - -void ImGui::PopFont() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.CurrentWindow->DrawList->PopTextureID(); - g.FontStack.pop_back(); - SetCurrentFont(g.FontStack.empty() ? GetDefaultFont() : g.FontStack.back()); -} - -void ImGui::PushAllowKeyboardFocus(bool allow_keyboard_focus) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.AllowKeyboardFocus = allow_keyboard_focus; - window->DC.AllowKeyboardFocusStack.push_back(allow_keyboard_focus); -} - -void ImGui::PopAllowKeyboardFocus() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.AllowKeyboardFocusStack.pop_back(); - window->DC.AllowKeyboardFocus = window->DC.AllowKeyboardFocusStack.empty() ? true : window->DC.AllowKeyboardFocusStack.back(); -} - -void ImGui::PushButtonRepeat(bool repeat) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.ButtonRepeat = repeat; - window->DC.ButtonRepeatStack.push_back(repeat); -} - -void ImGui::PopButtonRepeat() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.ButtonRepeatStack.pop_back(); - window->DC.ButtonRepeat = window->DC.ButtonRepeatStack.empty() ? false : window->DC.ButtonRepeatStack.back(); -} - -void ImGui::PushTextWrapPos(float wrap_pos_x) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.TextWrapPos = wrap_pos_x; - window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.push_back(wrap_pos_x); -} - -void ImGui::PopTextWrapPos() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.pop_back(); - window->DC.TextWrapPos = window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.empty() ? -1.0f : window->DC.TextWrapPosStack.back(); -} - -void ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol idx, const ImVec4& col) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiColMod backup; - backup.Col = idx; - backup.BackupValue = g.Style.Colors[idx]; - g.ColorModifiers.push_back(backup); - g.Style.Colors[idx] = col; -} - -void ImGui::PopStyleColor(int count) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - while (count > 0) - { - ImGuiColMod& backup = g.ColorModifiers.back(); - g.Style.Colors[backup.Col] = backup.BackupValue; - g.ColorModifiers.pop_back(); - count--; - } -} - -struct ImGuiStyleVarInfo -{ - ImGuiDataType Type; - ImU32 Offset; - void* GetVarPtr() const { return (void*)((unsigned char*)&GImGui->Style + Offset); } -}; - -static const ImGuiStyleVarInfo GStyleVarInfo[ImGuiStyleVar_Count_] = -{ - { ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, Alpha) }, - { ImGuiDataType_Float2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, WindowPadding) }, - { ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, WindowRounding) }, - { ImGuiDataType_Float2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, WindowMinSize) }, - { ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ChildWindowRounding) }, - { ImGuiDataType_Float2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, FramePadding) }, - { ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, FrameRounding) }, - { ImGuiDataType_Float2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ItemSpacing) }, - { ImGuiDataType_Float2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ItemInnerSpacing) }, - { ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, IndentSpacing) }, - { ImGuiDataType_Float, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, GrabMinSize) }, - { ImGuiDataType_Float2, (ImU32)IM_OFFSETOF(ImGuiStyle, ButtonTextAlign) }, -}; - -static const ImGuiStyleVarInfo* GetStyleVarInfo(ImGuiStyleVar idx) -{ - IM_ASSERT(idx >= 0 && idx < ImGuiStyleVar_Count_); - return &GStyleVarInfo[idx]; -} - -void ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar idx, float val) -{ - const ImGuiStyleVarInfo* var_info = GetStyleVarInfo(idx); - if (var_info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float) - { - float* pvar = (float*)var_info->GetVarPtr(); - GImGui->StyleModifiers.push_back(ImGuiStyleMod(idx, *pvar)); - *pvar = val; - return; - } - IM_ASSERT(0); // Called function with wrong-type? Variable is not a float. -} - -void ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar idx, const ImVec2& val) -{ - const ImGuiStyleVarInfo* var_info = GetStyleVarInfo(idx); - if (var_info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float2) - { - ImVec2* pvar = (ImVec2*)var_info->GetVarPtr(); - GImGui->StyleModifiers.push_back(ImGuiStyleMod(idx, *pvar)); - *pvar = val; - return; - } - IM_ASSERT(0); // Called function with wrong-type? Variable is not a ImVec2. -} - -void ImGui::PopStyleVar(int count) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - while (count > 0) - { - ImGuiStyleMod& backup = g.StyleModifiers.back(); - const ImGuiStyleVarInfo* info = GetStyleVarInfo(backup.VarIdx); - if (info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float) (*(float*)info->GetVarPtr()) = backup.BackupFloat[0]; - else if (info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Float2) (*(ImVec2*)info->GetVarPtr()) = ImVec2(backup.BackupFloat[0], backup.BackupFloat[1]); - else if (info->Type == ImGuiDataType_Int) (*(int*)info->GetVarPtr()) = backup.BackupInt[0]; - g.StyleModifiers.pop_back(); - count--; - } -} - -const char* ImGui::GetStyleColName(ImGuiCol idx) -{ - // Create switch-case from enum with regexp: ImGuiCol_{.*}, --> case ImGuiCol_\1: return "\1"; - switch (idx) - { - case ImGuiCol_Text: return "Text"; - case ImGuiCol_TextDisabled: return "TextDisabled"; - case ImGuiCol_WindowBg: return "WindowBg"; - case ImGuiCol_ChildWindowBg: return "ChildWindowBg"; - case ImGuiCol_PopupBg: return "PopupBg"; - case ImGuiCol_Border: return "Border"; - case ImGuiCol_BorderShadow: return "BorderShadow"; - case ImGuiCol_FrameBg: return "FrameBg"; - case ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered: return "FrameBgHovered"; - case ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive: return "FrameBgActive"; - case ImGuiCol_TitleBg: return "TitleBg"; - case ImGuiCol_TitleBgCollapsed: return "TitleBgCollapsed"; - case ImGuiCol_TitleBgActive: return "TitleBgActive"; - case ImGuiCol_MenuBarBg: return "MenuBarBg"; - case ImGuiCol_ScrollbarBg: return "ScrollbarBg"; - case ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrab: return "ScrollbarGrab"; - case ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabHovered: return "ScrollbarGrabHovered"; - case ImGuiCol_ScrollbarGrabActive: return "ScrollbarGrabActive"; - case ImGuiCol_ComboBg: return "ComboBg"; - case ImGuiCol_CheckMark: return "CheckMark"; - case ImGuiCol_SliderGrab: return "SliderGrab"; - case ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive: return "SliderGrabActive"; - case ImGuiCol_Button: return "Button"; - case ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered: return "ButtonHovered"; - case ImGuiCol_ButtonActive: return "ButtonActive"; - case ImGuiCol_Header: return "Header"; - case ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered: return "HeaderHovered"; - case ImGuiCol_HeaderActive: return "HeaderActive"; - case ImGuiCol_Column: return "Column"; - case ImGuiCol_ColumnHovered: return "ColumnHovered"; - case ImGuiCol_ColumnActive: return "ColumnActive"; - case ImGuiCol_ResizeGrip: return "ResizeGrip"; - case ImGuiCol_ResizeGripHovered: return "ResizeGripHovered"; - case ImGuiCol_ResizeGripActive: return "ResizeGripActive"; - case ImGuiCol_CloseButton: return "CloseButton"; - case ImGuiCol_CloseButtonHovered: return "CloseButtonHovered"; - case ImGuiCol_CloseButtonActive: return "CloseButtonActive"; - case ImGuiCol_PlotLines: return "PlotLines"; - case ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered: return "PlotLinesHovered"; - case ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram: return "PlotHistogram"; - case ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered: return "PlotHistogramHovered"; - case ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg: return "TextSelectedBg"; - case ImGuiCol_ModalWindowDarkening: return "ModalWindowDarkening"; - } - IM_ASSERT(0); - return "Unknown"; -} - -bool ImGui::IsWindowHovered() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.HoveredWindow == g.CurrentWindow && IsWindowContentHoverable(g.HoveredRootWindow); -} - -bool ImGui::IsWindowFocused() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.FocusedWindow == g.CurrentWindow; -} - -bool ImGui::IsRootWindowFocused() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.FocusedWindow == g.CurrentWindow->RootWindow; -} - -bool ImGui::IsRootWindowOrAnyChildFocused() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.FocusedWindow && g.FocusedWindow->RootWindow == g.CurrentWindow->RootWindow; -} - -bool ImGui::IsRootWindowOrAnyChildHovered() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.HoveredRootWindow && (g.HoveredRootWindow == g.CurrentWindow->RootWindow) && IsWindowContentHoverable(g.HoveredRootWindow); -} - -float ImGui::GetWindowWidth() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; - return window->Size.x; -} - -float ImGui::GetWindowHeight() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GImGui->CurrentWindow; - return window->Size.y; -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::GetWindowPos() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; - return window->Pos; -} - -static void SetWindowScrollY(ImGuiWindow* window, float new_scroll_y) -{ - window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y += window->Scroll.y; - window->Scroll.y = new_scroll_y; - window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y -= window->Scroll.y; -} - -static void SetWindowPos(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - // Test condition (NB: bit 0 is always true) and clear flags for next time - if (cond && (window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags & cond) == 0) - return; - window->SetWindowPosAllowFlags &= ~(ImGuiSetCond_Once | ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiSetCond_Appearing); - window->SetWindowPosCenterWanted = false; - - // Set - const ImVec2 old_pos = window->Pos; - window->PosFloat = pos; - window->Pos = ImVec2((float)(int)window->PosFloat.x, (float)(int)window->PosFloat.y); - window->DC.CursorPos += (window->Pos - old_pos); // As we happen to move the window while it is being appended to (which is a bad idea - will smear) let's at least offset the cursor - window->DC.CursorMaxPos += (window->Pos - old_pos); // And more importantly we need to adjust this so size calculation doesn't get affected. -} - -void ImGui::SetWindowPos(const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - SetWindowPos(window, pos, cond); -} - -void ImGui::SetWindowPos(const char* name, const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - if (ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name)) - SetWindowPos(window, pos, cond); -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::GetWindowSize() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->Size; -} - -static void SetWindowSize(ImGuiWindow* window, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - // Test condition (NB: bit 0 is always true) and clear flags for next time - if (cond && (window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags & cond) == 0) - return; - window->SetWindowSizeAllowFlags &= ~(ImGuiSetCond_Once | ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiSetCond_Appearing); - - // Set - if (size.x > 0.0f) - { - window->AutoFitFramesX = 0; - window->SizeFull.x = size.x; - } - else - { - window->AutoFitFramesX = 2; - window->AutoFitOnlyGrows = false; - } - if (size.y > 0.0f) - { - window->AutoFitFramesY = 0; - window->SizeFull.y = size.y; - } - else - { - window->AutoFitFramesY = 2; - window->AutoFitOnlyGrows = false; - } -} - -void ImGui::SetWindowSize(const ImVec2& size, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - SetWindowSize(GImGui->CurrentWindow, size, cond); -} - -void ImGui::SetWindowSize(const char* name, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name); - if (window) - SetWindowSize(window, size, cond); -} - -static void SetWindowCollapsed(ImGuiWindow* window, bool collapsed, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - // Test condition (NB: bit 0 is always true) and clear flags for next time - if (cond && (window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags & cond) == 0) - return; - window->SetWindowCollapsedAllowFlags &= ~(ImGuiSetCond_Once | ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver | ImGuiSetCond_Appearing); - - // Set - window->Collapsed = collapsed; -} - -void ImGui::SetWindowCollapsed(bool collapsed, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - SetWindowCollapsed(GImGui->CurrentWindow, collapsed, cond); -} - -bool ImGui::IsWindowCollapsed() -{ - return GImGui->CurrentWindow->Collapsed; -} - -void ImGui::SetWindowCollapsed(const char* name, bool collapsed, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name); - if (window) - SetWindowCollapsed(window, collapsed, cond); -} - -void ImGui::SetWindowFocus() -{ - FocusWindow(GImGui->CurrentWindow); -} - -void ImGui::SetWindowFocus(const char* name) -{ - if (name) - { - if (ImGuiWindow* window = FindWindowByName(name)) - FocusWindow(window); - } - else - { - FocusWindow(NULL); - } -} - -void ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(const ImVec2& pos, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.SetNextWindowPosVal = pos; - g.SetNextWindowPosCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiSetCond_Always; -} - -void ImGui::SetNextWindowPosCenter(ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.SetNextWindowPosVal = ImVec2(-FLT_MAX, -FLT_MAX); - g.SetNextWindowPosCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiSetCond_Always; -} - -void ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(const ImVec2& size, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.SetNextWindowSizeVal = size; - g.SetNextWindowSizeCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiSetCond_Always; -} - -void ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(const ImVec2& size_min, const ImVec2& size_max, ImGuiSizeConstraintCallback custom_callback, void* custom_callback_user_data) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraint = true; - g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintRect = ImRect(size_min, size_max); - g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallback = custom_callback; - g.SetNextWindowSizeConstraintCallbackUserData = custom_callback_user_data; -} - -void ImGui::SetNextWindowContentSize(const ImVec2& size) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.SetNextWindowContentSizeVal = size; - g.SetNextWindowContentSizeCond = ImGuiSetCond_Always; -} - -void ImGui::SetNextWindowContentWidth(float width) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.SetNextWindowContentSizeVal = ImVec2(width, g.SetNextWindowContentSizeCond ? g.SetNextWindowContentSizeVal.y : 0.0f); - g.SetNextWindowContentSizeCond = ImGuiSetCond_Always; -} - -void ImGui::SetNextWindowCollapsed(bool collapsed, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.SetNextWindowCollapsedVal = collapsed; - g.SetNextWindowCollapsedCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiSetCond_Always; -} - -void ImGui::SetNextWindowFocus() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.SetNextWindowFocus = true; -} - -// In window space (not screen space!) -ImVec2 ImGui::GetContentRegionMax() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - ImVec2 mx = window->ContentsRegionRect.Max; - if (window->DC.ColumnsCount != 1) - mx.x = GetColumnOffset(window->DC.ColumnsCurrent + 1) - window->WindowPadding.x; - return mx; -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return GetContentRegionMax() - (window->DC.CursorPos - window->Pos); -} - -float ImGui::GetContentRegionAvailWidth() -{ - return GetContentRegionAvail().x; -} - -// In window space (not screen space!) -ImVec2 ImGui::GetWindowContentRegionMin() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->ContentsRegionRect.Min; -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::GetWindowContentRegionMax() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->ContentsRegionRect.Max; -} - -float ImGui::GetWindowContentRegionWidth() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->ContentsRegionRect.Max.x - window->ContentsRegionRect.Min.x; -} - -float ImGui::GetTextLineHeight() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.FontSize; -} - -float ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.FontSize + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y; -} - -float ImGui::GetItemsLineHeightWithSpacing() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f + g.Style.ItemSpacing.y; -} - -ImDrawList* ImGui::GetWindowDrawList() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - return window->DrawList; -} - -ImFont* ImGui::GetFont() -{ - return GImGui->Font; -} - -float ImGui::GetFontSize() -{ - return GImGui->FontSize; -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::GetFontTexUvWhitePixel() -{ - return GImGui->FontTexUvWhitePixel; -} - -void ImGui::SetWindowFontScale(float scale) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->FontWindowScale = scale; - g.FontSize = window->CalcFontSize(); -} - -// User generally sees positions in window coordinates. Internally we store CursorPos in absolute screen coordinates because it is more convenient. -// Conversion happens as we pass the value to user, but it makes our naming convention confusing because GetCursorPos() == (DC.CursorPos - window.Pos). May want to rename 'DC.CursorPos'. -ImVec2 ImGui::GetCursorPos() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.CursorPos - window->Pos + window->Scroll; -} - -float ImGui::GetCursorPosX() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.CursorPos.x - window->Pos.x + window->Scroll.x; -} - -float ImGui::GetCursorPosY() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.CursorPos.y - window->Pos.y + window->Scroll.y; -} - -void ImGui::SetCursorPos(const ImVec2& local_pos) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.CursorPos = window->Pos - window->Scroll + local_pos; - window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, window->DC.CursorPos); -} - -void ImGui::SetCursorPosX(float x) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->Pos.x - window->Scroll.x + x; - window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.x, window->DC.CursorPos.x); -} - -void ImGui::SetCursorPosY(float y) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->Pos.y - window->Scroll.y + y; - window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos.y, window->DC.CursorPos.y); -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::GetCursorStartPos() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.CursorStartPos - window->Pos; -} - -ImVec2 ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.CursorPos; -} - -void ImGui::SetCursorScreenPos(const ImVec2& screen_pos) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.CursorPos = screen_pos; - window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(window->DC.CursorMaxPos, window->DC.CursorPos); -} - -float ImGui::GetScrollX() -{ - return GImGui->CurrentWindow->Scroll.x; -} - -float ImGui::GetScrollY() -{ - return GImGui->CurrentWindow->Scroll.y; -} - -float ImGui::GetScrollMaxX() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->SizeContents.x - window->SizeFull.x - window->ScrollbarSizes.x; -} - -float ImGui::GetScrollMaxY() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->SizeContents.y - window->SizeFull.y - window->ScrollbarSizes.y; -} - -void ImGui::SetScrollX(float scroll_x) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->ScrollTarget.x = scroll_x; - window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.x = 0.0f; -} - -void ImGui::SetScrollY(float scroll_y) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->ScrollTarget.y = scroll_y + window->TitleBarHeight() + window->MenuBarHeight(); // title bar height canceled out when using ScrollTargetRelY - window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.y = 0.0f; -} - -void ImGui::SetScrollFromPosY(float pos_y, float center_y_ratio) -{ - // We store a target position so centering can occur on the next frame when we are guaranteed to have a known window size - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - IM_ASSERT(center_y_ratio >= 0.0f && center_y_ratio <= 1.0f); - window->ScrollTarget.y = (float)(int)(pos_y + window->Scroll.y); - if (center_y_ratio <= 0.0f && window->ScrollTarget.y <= window->WindowPadding.y) // Minor hack to make "scroll to top" take account of WindowPadding, else it would scroll to (WindowPadding.y - ItemSpacing.y) - window->ScrollTarget.y = 0.0f; - window->ScrollTargetCenterRatio.y = center_y_ratio; -} - -// center_y_ratio: 0.0f top of last item, 0.5f vertical center of last item, 1.0f bottom of last item. -void ImGui::SetScrollHere(float center_y_ratio) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - float target_y = window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y + (window->DC.PrevLineHeight * center_y_ratio) + (GImGui->Style.ItemSpacing.y * (center_y_ratio - 0.5f) * 2.0f); // Precisely aim above, in the middle or below the last line. - SetScrollFromPosY(target_y - window->Pos.y, center_y_ratio); -} - -void ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(int offset) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->FocusIdxAllRequestNext = window->FocusIdxAllCounter + 1 + offset; - window->FocusIdxTabRequestNext = INT_MAX; -} - -void ImGui::SetStateStorage(ImGuiStorage* tree) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.StateStorage = tree ? tree : &window->StateStorage; -} - -ImGuiStorage* ImGui::GetStateStorage() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.StateStorage; -} - -void ImGui::TextV(const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const char* text_end = g.TempBuffer + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args); - TextUnformatted(g.TempBuffer, text_end); -} - -void ImGui::Text(const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - TextV(fmt, args); - va_end(args); -} - -void ImGui::TextColoredV(const ImVec4& col, const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, col); - TextV(fmt, args); - PopStyleColor(); -} - -void ImGui::TextColored(const ImVec4& col, const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - TextColoredV(col, fmt, args); - va_end(args); -} - -void ImGui::TextDisabledV(const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, GImGui->Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]); - TextV(fmt, args); - PopStyleColor(); -} - -void ImGui::TextDisabled(const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - TextDisabledV(fmt, args); - va_end(args); -} - -void ImGui::TextWrappedV(const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - bool need_wrap = (GImGui->CurrentWindow->DC.TextWrapPos < 0.0f); // Keep existing wrap position is one ia already set - if (need_wrap) PushTextWrapPos(0.0f); - TextV(fmt, args); - if (need_wrap) PopTextWrapPos(); -} - -void ImGui::TextWrapped(const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - TextWrappedV(fmt, args); - va_end(args); -} - -void ImGui::TextUnformatted(const char* text, const char* text_end) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - IM_ASSERT(text != NULL); - const char* text_begin = text; - if (text_end == NULL) - text_end = text + strlen(text); // FIXME-OPT - - const float wrap_pos_x = window->DC.TextWrapPos; - const bool wrap_enabled = wrap_pos_x >= 0.0f; - if (text_end - text > 2000 && !wrap_enabled) - { - // Long text! - // Perform manual coarse clipping to optimize for long multi-line text - // From this point we will only compute the width of lines that are visible. Optimization only available when word-wrapping is disabled. - // We also don't vertically center the text within the line full height, which is unlikely to matter because we are likely the biggest and only item on the line. - const char* line = text; - const float line_height = GetTextLineHeight(); - const ImVec2 text_pos = window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(0.0f, window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset); - const ImRect clip_rect = window->ClipRect; - ImVec2 text_size(0,0); - - if (text_pos.y <= clip_rect.Max.y) - { - ImVec2 pos = text_pos; - - // Lines to skip (can't skip when logging text) - if (!g.LogEnabled) - { - int lines_skippable = (int)((clip_rect.Min.y - text_pos.y) / line_height); - if (lines_skippable > 0) - { - int lines_skipped = 0; - while (line < text_end && lines_skipped < lines_skippable) - { - const char* line_end = strchr(line, '\n'); - if (!line_end) - line_end = text_end; - line = line_end + 1; - lines_skipped++; - } - pos.y += lines_skipped * line_height; - } - } - - // Lines to render - if (line < text_end) - { - ImRect line_rect(pos, pos + ImVec2(FLT_MAX, line_height)); - while (line < text_end) - { - const char* line_end = strchr(line, '\n'); - if (IsClippedEx(line_rect, NULL, false)) - break; - - const ImVec2 line_size = CalcTextSize(line, line_end, false); - text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, line_size.x); - RenderText(pos, line, line_end, false); - if (!line_end) - line_end = text_end; - line = line_end + 1; - line_rect.Min.y += line_height; - line_rect.Max.y += line_height; - pos.y += line_height; - } - - // Count remaining lines - int lines_skipped = 0; - while (line < text_end) - { - const char* line_end = strchr(line, '\n'); - if (!line_end) - line_end = text_end; - line = line_end + 1; - lines_skipped++; - } - pos.y += lines_skipped * line_height; - } - - text_size.y += (pos - text_pos).y; - } - - ImRect bb(text_pos, text_pos + text_size); - ItemSize(bb); - ItemAdd(bb, NULL); - } - else - { - const float wrap_width = wrap_enabled ? CalcWrapWidthForPos(window->DC.CursorPos, wrap_pos_x) : 0.0f; - const ImVec2 text_size = CalcTextSize(text_begin, text_end, false, wrap_width); - - // Account of baseline offset - ImVec2 text_pos(window->DC.CursorPos.x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset); - ImRect bb(text_pos, text_pos + text_size); - ItemSize(text_size); - if (!ItemAdd(bb, NULL)) - return; - - // Render (we don't hide text after ## in this end-user function) - RenderTextWrapped(bb.Min, text_begin, text_end, wrap_width); - } -} - -void ImGui::AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - // Declare a dummy item size to that upcoming items that are smaller will center-align on the newly expanded line height. - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ItemSize(ImVec2(0, g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y*2), g.Style.FramePadding.y); - SameLine(0, 0); -} - -// Add a label+text combo aligned to other label+value widgets -void ImGui::LabelTextV(const char* label, const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const float w = CalcItemWidth(); - - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - const ImRect value_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2)); - const ImRect total_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x : 0.0f), style.FramePadding.y*2) + label_size); - ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); - if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, NULL)) - return; - - // Render - const char* value_text_begin = &g.TempBuffer[0]; - const char* value_text_end = value_text_begin + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args); - RenderTextClipped(value_bb.Min, value_bb.Max, value_text_begin, value_text_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.0f,0.5f)); - if (label_size.x > 0.0f) - RenderText(ImVec2(value_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, value_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); -} - -void ImGui::LabelText(const char* label, const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - LabelTextV(label, fmt, args); - va_end(args); -} - -static inline bool IsWindowContentHoverable(ImGuiWindow* window) -{ - // An active popup disable hovering on other windows (apart from its own children) - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (ImGuiWindow* focused_window = g.FocusedWindow) - if (ImGuiWindow* focused_root_window = focused_window->RootWindow) - if ((focused_root_window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) != 0 && focused_root_window->WasActive && focused_root_window != window->RootWindow) - return false; - - return true; -} - -bool ImGui::ButtonBehavior(const ImRect& bb, ImGuiID id, bool* out_hovered, bool* out_held, ImGuiButtonFlags flags) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - - if (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Disabled) - { - if (out_hovered) *out_hovered = false; - if (out_held) *out_held = false; - if (g.ActiveId == id) ClearActiveID(); - return false; - } - - if ((flags & (ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick)) == 0) - flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease; - - bool pressed = false; - bool hovered = IsHovered(bb, id, (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_FlattenChilds) != 0); - if (hovered) - { - SetHoveredID(id); - if (!(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers) || (!g.IO.KeyCtrl && !g.IO.KeyShift && !g.IO.KeyAlt)) - { - // | CLICKING | HOLDING with ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat - // PressedOnClickRelease | * | .. (NOT on release) <-- MOST COMMON! (*) only if both click/release were over bounds - // PressedOnClick | | .. - // PressedOnRelease | | .. (NOT on release) - // PressedOnDoubleClick | | .. - if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease) && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]) - { - SetActiveID(id, window); // Hold on ID - FocusWindow(window); - g.ActiveIdClickOffset = g.IO.MousePos - bb.Min; - } - if (((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick) && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]) || ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick) && g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0])) - { - pressed = true; - ClearActiveID(); - FocusWindow(window); - } - if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease) && g.IO.MouseReleased[0]) - { - if (!((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat) && g.IO.MouseDownDurationPrev[0] >= g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay)) // Repeat mode trumps - pressed = true; - ClearActiveID(); - } - - // 'Repeat' mode acts when held regardless of _PressedOn flags (see table above). - // Relies on repeat logic of IsMouseClicked() but we may as well do it ourselves if we end up exposing finer RepeatDelay/RepeatRate settings. - if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat) && g.ActiveId == id && g.IO.MouseDownDuration[0] > 0.0f && IsMouseClicked(0, true)) - pressed = true; - } - } - - bool held = false; - if (g.ActiveId == id) - { - if (g.IO.MouseDown[0]) - { - held = true; - } - else - { - if (hovered && (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease)) - if (!((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat) && g.IO.MouseDownDurationPrev[0] >= g.IO.KeyRepeatDelay)) // Repeat mode trumps - pressed = true; - ClearActiveID(); - } - } - - // AllowOverlap mode (rarely used) requires previous frame HoveredId to be null or to match. This allows using patterns where a later submitted widget overlaps a previous one. - if (hovered && (flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowOverlapMode) && (g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != id && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != 0)) - hovered = pressed = held = false; - - if (out_hovered) *out_hovered = hovered; - if (out_held) *out_held = held; - - return pressed; -} - -bool ImGui::ButtonEx(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiButtonFlags flags) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - - ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; - if ((flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_AlignTextBaseLine) && style.FramePadding.y < window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset) // Try to vertically align buttons that are smaller/have no padding so that text baseline matches (bit hacky, since it shouldn't be a flag) - pos.y += window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset - style.FramePadding.y; - ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, label_size.x + style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f); - - const ImRect bb(pos, pos + size); - ItemSize(bb, style.FramePadding.y); - if (!ItemAdd(bb, &id)) - return false; - - if (window->DC.ButtonRepeat) flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat; - bool hovered, held; - bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held, flags); - - // Render - const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((hovered && held) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button); - RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, true, style.FrameRounding); - RenderTextClipped(bb.Min + style.FramePadding, bb.Max - style.FramePadding, label, NULL, &label_size, style.ButtonTextAlign, &bb); - - // Automatically close popups - //if (pressed && !(flags & ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups) && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)) - // CloseCurrentPopup(); - - return pressed; -} - -bool ImGui::Button(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg) -{ - return ButtonEx(label, size_arg, 0); -} - -// Small buttons fits within text without additional vertical spacing. -bool ImGui::SmallButton(const char* label) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - float backup_padding_y = g.Style.FramePadding.y; - g.Style.FramePadding.y = 0.0f; - bool pressed = ButtonEx(label, ImVec2(0,0), ImGuiButtonFlags_AlignTextBaseLine); - g.Style.FramePadding.y = backup_padding_y; - return pressed; -} - -// Tip: use ImGui::PushID()/PopID() to push indices or pointers in the ID stack. -// Then you can keep 'str_id' empty or the same for all your buttons (instead of creating a string based on a non-string id) -bool ImGui::InvisibleButton(const char* str_id, const ImVec2& size_arg) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(str_id); - ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, 0.0f, 0.0f); - const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size); - ItemSize(bb); - if (!ItemAdd(bb, &id)) - return false; - - bool hovered, held; - bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held); - - return pressed; -} - -// Upper-right button to close a window. -bool ImGui::CloseButton(ImGuiID id, const ImVec2& pos, float radius) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - - const ImRect bb(pos - ImVec2(radius,radius), pos + ImVec2(radius,radius)); - - bool hovered, held; - bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held); - - // Render - const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_CloseButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_CloseButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_CloseButton); - const ImVec2 center = bb.GetCenter(); - window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, ImMax(2.0f, radius), col, 12); - - const float cross_extent = (radius * 0.7071f) - 1.0f; - if (hovered) - { - window->DrawList->AddLine(center + ImVec2(+cross_extent,+cross_extent), center + ImVec2(-cross_extent,-cross_extent), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text)); - window->DrawList->AddLine(center + ImVec2(+cross_extent,-cross_extent), center + ImVec2(-cross_extent,+cross_extent), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text)); - } - - return pressed; -} - -void ImGui::Image(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0, const ImVec2& uv1, const ImVec4& tint_col, const ImVec4& border_col) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size); - if (border_col.w > 0.0f) - bb.Max += ImVec2(2,2); - ItemSize(bb); - if (!ItemAdd(bb, NULL)) - return; - - if (border_col.w > 0.0f) - { - window->DrawList->AddRect(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(border_col), 0.0f); - window->DrawList->AddImage(user_texture_id, bb.Min+ImVec2(1,1), bb.Max-ImVec2(1,1), uv0, uv1, GetColorU32(tint_col)); - } - else - { - window->DrawList->AddImage(user_texture_id, bb.Min, bb.Max, uv0, uv1, GetColorU32(tint_col)); - } -} - -// frame_padding < 0: uses FramePadding from style (default) -// frame_padding = 0: no framing -// frame_padding > 0: set framing size -// The color used are the button colors. -bool ImGui::ImageButton(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& size, const ImVec2& uv0, const ImVec2& uv1, int frame_padding, const ImVec4& bg_col, const ImVec4& tint_col) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - - // Default to using texture ID as ID. User can still push string/integer prefixes. - // We could hash the size/uv to create a unique ID but that would prevent the user from animating UV. - PushID((void *)user_texture_id); - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID("#image"); - PopID(); - - const ImVec2 padding = (frame_padding >= 0) ? ImVec2((float)frame_padding, (float)frame_padding) : style.FramePadding; - const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size + padding*2); - const ImRect image_bb(window->DC.CursorPos + padding, window->DC.CursorPos + padding + size); - ItemSize(bb); - if (!ItemAdd(bb, &id)) - return false; - - bool hovered, held; - bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held); - - // Render - const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((hovered && held) ? ImGuiCol_ButtonActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button); - RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, true, ImClamp((float)ImMin(padding.x, padding.y), 0.0f, style.FrameRounding)); - if (bg_col.w > 0.0f) - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(image_bb.Min, image_bb.Max, GetColorU32(bg_col)); - window->DrawList->AddImage(user_texture_id, image_bb.Min, image_bb.Max, uv0, uv1, GetColorU32(tint_col)); - - return pressed; -} - -// Start logging ImGui output to TTY -void ImGui::LogToTTY(int max_depth) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.LogEnabled) - return; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - - g.LogEnabled = true; - g.LogFile = stdout; - g.LogStartDepth = window->DC.TreeDepth; - if (max_depth >= 0) - g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth = max_depth; -} - -// Start logging ImGui output to given file -void ImGui::LogToFile(int max_depth, const char* filename) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.LogEnabled) - return; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - - if (!filename) - { - filename = g.IO.LogFilename; - if (!filename) - return; - } - - g.LogFile = ImFileOpen(filename, "ab"); - if (!g.LogFile) - { - IM_ASSERT(g.LogFile != NULL); // Consider this an error - return; - } - g.LogEnabled = true; - g.LogStartDepth = window->DC.TreeDepth; - if (max_depth >= 0) - g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth = max_depth; -} - -// Start logging ImGui output to clipboard -void ImGui::LogToClipboard(int max_depth) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.LogEnabled) - return; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - - g.LogEnabled = true; - g.LogFile = NULL; - g.LogStartDepth = window->DC.TreeDepth; - if (max_depth >= 0) - g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth = max_depth; -} - -void ImGui::LogFinish() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (!g.LogEnabled) - return; - - LogText(IM_NEWLINE); - g.LogEnabled = false; - if (g.LogFile != NULL) - { - if (g.LogFile == stdout) - fflush(g.LogFile); - else - fclose(g.LogFile); - g.LogFile = NULL; - } - if (g.LogClipboard->size() > 1) - { - SetClipboardText(g.LogClipboard->begin()); - g.LogClipboard->clear(); - } -} - -// Helper to display logging buttons -void ImGui::LogButtons() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - - PushID("LogButtons"); - const bool log_to_tty = Button("Log To TTY"); SameLine(); - const bool log_to_file = Button("Log To File"); SameLine(); - const bool log_to_clipboard = Button("Log To Clipboard"); SameLine(); - PushItemWidth(80.0f); - PushAllowKeyboardFocus(false); - SliderInt("Depth", &g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth, 0, 9, NULL); - PopAllowKeyboardFocus(); - PopItemWidth(); - PopID(); - - // Start logging at the end of the function so that the buttons don't appear in the log - if (log_to_tty) - LogToTTY(g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth); - if (log_to_file) - LogToFile(g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth, g.IO.LogFilename); - if (log_to_clipboard) - LogToClipboard(g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth); -} - -bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehaviorIsOpen(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) -{ - if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf) - return true; - - // We only write to the tree storage if the user clicks (or explicitely use SetNextTreeNode*** functions) - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = g.CurrentWindow; - ImGuiStorage* storage = window->DC.StateStorage; - - bool is_open; - if (g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenCond != 0) - { - if (g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenCond & ImGuiSetCond_Always) - { - is_open = g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenVal; - storage->SetInt(id, is_open); - } - else - { - // We treat ImGuiSetCondition_Once and ImGuiSetCondition_FirstUseEver the same because tree node state are not saved persistently. - const int stored_value = storage->GetInt(id, -1); - if (stored_value == -1) - { - is_open = g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenVal; - storage->SetInt(id, is_open); - } - else - { - is_open = stored_value != 0; - } - } - g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenCond = 0; - } - else - { - is_open = storage->GetInt(id, (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_DefaultOpen) ? 1 : 0) != 0; - } - - // When logging is enabled, we automatically expand tree nodes (but *NOT* collapsing headers.. seems like sensible behavior). - // NB- If we are above max depth we still allow manually opened nodes to be logged. - if (g.LogEnabled && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoAutoOpenOnLog) && window->DC.TreeDepth < g.LogAutoExpandMaxDepth) - is_open = true; - - return is_open; -} - -bool ImGui::TreeNodeBehavior(ImGuiID id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* label, const char* label_end) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const bool display_frame = (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Framed) != 0; - const ImVec2 padding = display_frame ? style.FramePadding : ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x, 0.0f); - - if (!label_end) - label_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label); - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, label_end, false); - - // We vertically grow up to current line height up the typical widget height. - const float text_base_offset_y = ImMax(0.0f, window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset - padding.y); // Latch before ItemSize changes it - const float frame_height = ImMax(ImMin(window->DC.CurrentLineHeight, g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.y*2), label_size.y + padding.y*2); - ImRect bb = ImRect(window->DC.CursorPos, ImVec2(window->Pos.x + GetContentRegionMax().x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + frame_height)); - if (display_frame) - { - // Framed header expand a little outside the default padding - bb.Min.x -= (float)(int)(window->WindowPadding.x*0.5f) - 1; - bb.Max.x += (float)(int)(window->WindowPadding.x*0.5f) - 1; - } - - const float text_offset_x = (g.FontSize + (display_frame ? padding.x*3 : padding.x*2)); // Collapser arrow width + Spacing - const float text_width = g.FontSize + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? label_size.x + padding.x*2 : 0.0f); // Include collapser - ItemSize(ImVec2(text_width, frame_height), text_base_offset_y); - - // For regular tree nodes, we arbitrary allow to click past 2 worth of ItemSpacing - // (Ideally we'd want to add a flag for the user to specify we want want the hit test to be done up to the right side of the content or not) - const ImRect interact_bb = display_frame ? bb : ImRect(bb.Min.x, bb.Min.y, bb.Min.x + text_width + style.ItemSpacing.x*2, bb.Max.y); - bool is_open = TreeNodeBehaviorIsOpen(id, flags); - if (!ItemAdd(interact_bb, &id)) - { - if (is_open && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen)) - TreePushRawID(id); - return is_open; - } - - // Flags that affects opening behavior: - // - 0(default) ..................... single-click anywhere to open - // - OpenOnDoubleClick .............. double-click anywhere to open - // - OpenOnArrow .................... single-click on arrow to open - // - OpenOnDoubleClick|OpenOnArrow .. single-click on arrow or double-click anywhere to open - ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = ImGuiButtonFlags_NoKeyModifiers | ((flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowOverlapMode) ? ImGuiButtonFlags_AllowOverlapMode : 0); - if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick) - button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick | ((flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow) ? ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease : 0); - bool hovered, held, pressed = ButtonBehavior(interact_bb, id, &hovered, &held, button_flags); - if (pressed && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf)) - { - bool toggled = !(flags & (ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick)); - if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow) - toggled |= IsMouseHoveringRect(interact_bb.Min, ImVec2(interact_bb.Min.x + text_offset_x, interact_bb.Max.y)); - if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick) - toggled |= g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0]; - if (toggled) - { - is_open = !is_open; - window->DC.StateStorage->SetInt(id, is_open); - } - } - if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowOverlapMode) - SetItemAllowOverlap(); - - // Render - const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header); - const ImVec2 text_pos = bb.Min + ImVec2(text_offset_x, padding.y + text_base_offset_y); - if (display_frame) - { - // Framed type - RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, true, style.FrameRounding); - RenderCollapseTriangle(bb.Min + padding + ImVec2(0.0f, text_base_offset_y), is_open, 1.0f); - if (g.LogEnabled) - { - // NB: '##' is normally used to hide text (as a library-wide feature), so we need to specify the text range to make sure the ## aren't stripped out here. - const char log_prefix[] = "\n##"; - const char log_suffix[] = "##"; - LogRenderedText(text_pos, log_prefix, log_prefix+3); - RenderTextClipped(text_pos, bb.Max, label, label_end, &label_size); - LogRenderedText(text_pos, log_suffix+1, log_suffix+3); - } - else - { - RenderTextClipped(text_pos, bb.Max, label, label_end, &label_size); - } - } - else - { - // Unframed typed for tree nodes - if (hovered || (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Selected)) - RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, col, false); - - if (flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Bullet) - RenderBullet(bb.Min + ImVec2(text_offset_x * 0.5f, g.FontSize*0.50f + text_base_offset_y)); - else if (!(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf)) - RenderCollapseTriangle(bb.Min + ImVec2(padding.x, g.FontSize*0.15f + text_base_offset_y), is_open, 0.70f); - if (g.LogEnabled) - LogRenderedText(text_pos, ">"); - RenderText(text_pos, label, label_end, false); - } - - if (is_open && !(flags & ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen)) - TreePushRawID(id); - return is_open; -} - -// CollapsingHeader returns true when opened but do not indent nor push into the ID stack (because of the ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen flag). -// This is basically the same as calling TreeNodeEx(label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen). You can remove the _NoTreePushOnOpen flag if you want behavior closer to normal TreeNode(). -bool ImGui::CollapsingHeader(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), flags | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen, label); -} - -bool ImGui::CollapsingHeader(const char* label, bool* p_open, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - if (p_open && !*p_open) - return false; - - ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); - bool is_open = TreeNodeBehavior(id, flags | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_CollapsingHeader | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen | (p_open ? ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_AllowOverlapMode : 0), label); - if (p_open) - { - // Create a small overlapping close button // FIXME: We can evolve this into user accessible helpers to add extra buttons on title bars, headers, etc. - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - float button_sz = g.FontSize * 0.5f; - if (CloseButton(window->GetID((void*)(intptr_t)(id+1)), ImVec2(ImMin(window->DC.LastItemRect.Max.x, window->ClipRect.Max.x) - g.Style.FramePadding.x - button_sz, window->DC.LastItemRect.Min.y + g.Style.FramePadding.y + button_sz), button_sz)) - *p_open = false; - } - - return is_open; -} - -bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const char* label, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), flags, label, NULL); -} - -bool ImGui::TreeNodeExV(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const char* label_end = g.TempBuffer + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args); - return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(str_id), flags, g.TempBuffer, label_end); -} - -bool ImGui::TreeNodeExV(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const char* label_end = g.TempBuffer + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args); - return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(ptr_id), flags, g.TempBuffer, label_end); -} - -bool ImGui::TreeNodeV(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - return TreeNodeExV(str_id, 0, fmt, args); -} - -bool ImGui::TreeNodeV(const void* ptr_id, const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - return TreeNodeExV(ptr_id, 0, fmt, args); -} - -bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const char* str_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(str_id, flags, fmt, args); - va_end(args); - return is_open; -} - -bool ImGui::TreeNodeEx(const void* ptr_id, ImGuiTreeNodeFlags flags, const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(ptr_id, flags, fmt, args); - va_end(args); - return is_open; -} - -bool ImGui::TreeNode(const char* str_id, const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(str_id, 0, fmt, args); - va_end(args); - return is_open; -} - -bool ImGui::TreeNode(const void* ptr_id, const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - bool is_open = TreeNodeExV(ptr_id, 0, fmt, args); - va_end(args); - return is_open; -} - -bool ImGui::TreeNode(const char* label) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - return TreeNodeBehavior(window->GetID(label), 0, label, NULL); -} - -void ImGui::TreeAdvanceToLabelPos() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.CurrentWindow->DC.CursorPos.x += GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing(); -} - -// Horizontal distance preceding label when using TreeNode() or Bullet() -float ImGui::GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - return g.FontSize + (g.Style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f); -} - -void ImGui::SetNextTreeNodeOpen(bool is_open, ImGuiSetCond cond) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenVal = is_open; - g.SetNextTreeNodeOpenCond = cond ? cond : ImGuiSetCond_Always; -} - -void ImGui::PushID(const char* str_id) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->IDStack.push_back(window->GetID(str_id)); -} - -void ImGui::PushID(const char* str_id_begin, const char* str_id_end) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->IDStack.push_back(window->GetID(str_id_begin, str_id_end)); -} - -void ImGui::PushID(const void* ptr_id) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->IDStack.push_back(window->GetID(ptr_id)); -} - -void ImGui::PushID(int int_id) -{ - const void* ptr_id = (void*)(intptr_t)int_id; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->IDStack.push_back(window->GetID(ptr_id)); -} - -void ImGui::PopID() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->IDStack.pop_back(); -} - -ImGuiID ImGui::GetID(const char* str_id) -{ - return GImGui->CurrentWindow->GetID(str_id); -} - -ImGuiID ImGui::GetID(const char* str_id_begin, const char* str_id_end) -{ - return GImGui->CurrentWindow->GetID(str_id_begin, str_id_end); -} - -ImGuiID ImGui::GetID(const void* ptr_id) -{ - return GImGui->CurrentWindow->GetID(ptr_id); -} - -void ImGui::Bullet() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const float line_height = ImMax(ImMin(window->DC.CurrentLineHeight, g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y*2), g.FontSize); - const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(g.FontSize, line_height)); - ItemSize(bb); - if (!ItemAdd(bb, NULL)) - { - SameLine(0, style.FramePadding.x*2); - return; - } - - // Render and stay on same line - RenderBullet(bb.Min + ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x + g.FontSize*0.5f, line_height*0.5f)); - SameLine(0, style.FramePadding.x*2); -} - -// Text with a little bullet aligned to the typical tree node. -void ImGui::BulletTextV(const char* fmt, va_list args) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - - const char* text_begin = g.TempBuffer; - const char* text_end = text_begin + ImFormatStringV(g.TempBuffer, IM_ARRAYSIZE(g.TempBuffer), fmt, args); - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(text_begin, text_end, false); - const float text_base_offset_y = ImMax(0.0f, window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset); // Latch before ItemSize changes it - const float line_height = ImMax(ImMin(window->DC.CurrentLineHeight, g.FontSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y*2), g.FontSize); - const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(g.FontSize + (label_size.x > 0.0f ? (label_size.x + style.FramePadding.x*2) : 0.0f), ImMax(line_height, label_size.y))); // Empty text doesn't add padding - ItemSize(bb); - if (!ItemAdd(bb, NULL)) - return; - - // Render - RenderBullet(bb.Min + ImVec2(style.FramePadding.x + g.FontSize*0.5f, line_height*0.5f)); - RenderText(bb.Min+ImVec2(g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.x*2, text_base_offset_y), text_begin, text_end, false); -} - -void ImGui::BulletText(const char* fmt, ...) -{ - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - BulletTextV(fmt, args); - va_end(args); -} - -static inline void DataTypeFormatString(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, const char* display_format, char* buf, int buf_size) -{ - if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Int) - ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, display_format, *(int*)data_ptr); - else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float) - ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, display_format, *(float*)data_ptr); -} - -static inline void DataTypeFormatString(ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, int decimal_precision, char* buf, int buf_size) -{ - if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Int) - { - if (decimal_precision < 0) - ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, "%d", *(int*)data_ptr); - else - ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, "%.*d", decimal_precision, *(int*)data_ptr); - } - else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float) - { - if (decimal_precision < 0) - ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, "%f", *(float*)data_ptr); // Ideally we'd have a minimum decimal precision of 1 to visually denote that it is a float, while hiding non-significant digits? - else - ImFormatString(buf, buf_size, "%.*f", decimal_precision, *(float*)data_ptr); - } -} - -static void DataTypeApplyOp(ImGuiDataType data_type, int op, void* value1, const void* value2)// Store into value1 -{ - if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Int) - { - if (op == '+') - *(int*)value1 = *(int*)value1 + *(const int*)value2; - else if (op == '-') - *(int*)value1 = *(int*)value1 - *(const int*)value2; - } - else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float) - { - if (op == '+') - *(float*)value1 = *(float*)value1 + *(const float*)value2; - else if (op == '-') - *(float*)value1 = *(float*)value1 - *(const float*)value2; - } -} - -// User can input math operators (e.g. +100) to edit a numerical values. -static bool DataTypeApplyOpFromText(const char* buf, const char* initial_value_buf, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, const char* scalar_format) -{ - while (ImCharIsSpace(*buf)) - buf++; - - // We don't support '-' op because it would conflict with inputing negative value. - // Instead you can use +-100 to subtract from an existing value - char op = buf[0]; - if (op == '+' || op == '*' || op == '/') - { - buf++; - while (ImCharIsSpace(*buf)) - buf++; - } - else - { - op = 0; - } - if (!buf[0]) - return false; - - if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Int) - { - if (!scalar_format) - scalar_format = "%d"; - int* v = (int*)data_ptr; - const int old_v = *v; - int arg0 = *v; - if (op && sscanf(initial_value_buf, scalar_format, &arg0) < 1) - return false; - - // Store operand in a float so we can use fractional value for multipliers (*1.1), but constant always parsed as integer so we can fit big integers (e.g. 2000000003) past float precision - float arg1 = 0.0f; - if (op == '+') { if (sscanf(buf, "%f", &arg1) == 1) *v = (int)(arg0 + arg1); } // Add (use "+-" to subtract) - else if (op == '*') { if (sscanf(buf, "%f", &arg1) == 1) *v = (int)(arg0 * arg1); } // Multiply - else if (op == '/') { if (sscanf(buf, "%f", &arg1) == 1 && arg1 != 0.0f) *v = (int)(arg0 / arg1); }// Divide - else { if (sscanf(buf, scalar_format, &arg0) == 1) *v = arg0; } // Assign constant - return (old_v != *v); - } - else if (data_type == ImGuiDataType_Float) - { - // For floats we have to ignore format with precision (e.g. "%.2f") because sscanf doesn't take them in - scalar_format = "%f"; - float* v = (float*)data_ptr; - const float old_v = *v; - float arg0 = *v; - if (op && sscanf(initial_value_buf, scalar_format, &arg0) < 1) - return false; - - float arg1 = 0.0f; - if (sscanf(buf, scalar_format, &arg1) < 1) - return false; - if (op == '+') { *v = arg0 + arg1; } // Add (use "+-" to subtract) - else if (op == '*') { *v = arg0 * arg1; } // Multiply - else if (op == '/') { if (arg1 != 0.0f) *v = arg0 / arg1; } // Divide - else { *v = arg1; } // Assign constant - return (old_v != *v); - } - - return false; -} - -// Create text input in place of a slider (when CTRL+Clicking on slider) -bool ImGui::InputScalarAsWidgetReplacement(const ImRect& aabb, const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, ImGuiID id, int decimal_precision) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - - // Our replacement widget will override the focus ID (registered previously to allow for a TAB focus to happen) - SetActiveID(g.ScalarAsInputTextId, window); - SetHoveredID(0); - FocusableItemUnregister(window); - - char buf[32]; - DataTypeFormatString(data_type, data_ptr, decimal_precision, buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); - bool text_value_changed = InputTextEx(label, buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), aabb.GetSize(), ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll); - if (g.ScalarAsInputTextId == 0) - { - // First frame - IM_ASSERT(g.ActiveId == id); // InputText ID expected to match the Slider ID (else we'd need to store them both, which is also possible) - g.ScalarAsInputTextId = g.ActiveId; - SetHoveredID(id); - } - else if (g.ActiveId != g.ScalarAsInputTextId) - { - // Release - g.ScalarAsInputTextId = 0; - } - if (text_value_changed) - return DataTypeApplyOpFromText(buf, GImGui->InputTextState.InitialText.begin(), data_type, data_ptr, NULL); - return false; -} - -// Parse display precision back from the display format string -int ImGui::ParseFormatPrecision(const char* fmt, int default_precision) -{ - int precision = default_precision; - while ((fmt = strchr(fmt, '%')) != NULL) - { - fmt++; - if (fmt[0] == '%') { fmt++; continue; } // Ignore "%%" - while (*fmt >= '0' && *fmt <= '9') - fmt++; - if (*fmt == '.') - { - precision = atoi(fmt + 1); - if (precision < 0 || precision > 10) - precision = default_precision; - } - break; - } - return precision; -} - -float ImGui::RoundScalar(float value, int decimal_precision) -{ - // Round past decimal precision - // So when our value is 1.99999 with a precision of 0.001 we'll end up rounding to 2.0 - // FIXME: Investigate better rounding methods - static const float min_steps[10] = { 1.0f, 0.1f, 0.01f, 0.001f, 0.0001f, 0.00001f, 0.000001f, 0.0000001f, 0.00000001f, 0.000000001f }; - float min_step = (decimal_precision >= 0 && decimal_precision < 10) ? min_steps[decimal_precision] : powf(10.0f, (float)-decimal_precision); - bool negative = value < 0.0f; - value = fabsf(value); - float remainder = fmodf(value, min_step); - if (remainder <= min_step*0.5f) - value -= remainder; - else - value += (min_step - remainder); - return negative ? -value : value; -} - -static inline float SliderBehaviorCalcRatioFromValue(float v, float v_min, float v_max, float power, float linear_zero_pos) -{ - if (v_min == v_max) - return 0.0f; - - const bool is_non_linear = (power < 1.0f-0.00001f) || (power > 1.0f+0.00001f); - const float v_clamped = (v_min < v_max) ? ImClamp(v, v_min, v_max) : ImClamp(v, v_max, v_min); - if (is_non_linear) - { - if (v_clamped < 0.0f) - { - const float f = 1.0f - (v_clamped - v_min) / (ImMin(0.0f,v_max) - v_min); - return (1.0f - powf(f, 1.0f/power)) * linear_zero_pos; - } - else - { - const float f = (v_clamped - ImMax(0.0f,v_min)) / (v_max - ImMax(0.0f,v_min)); - return linear_zero_pos + powf(f, 1.0f/power) * (1.0f - linear_zero_pos); - } - } - - // Linear slider - return (v_clamped - v_min) / (v_max - v_min); -} - -bool ImGui::SliderBehavior(const ImRect& frame_bb, ImGuiID id, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, float power, int decimal_precision, ImGuiSliderFlags flags) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - - // Draw frame - RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding); - - const bool is_non_linear = (power < 1.0f-0.00001f) || (power > 1.0f+0.00001f); - const bool is_horizontal = (flags & ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical) == 0; - - const float grab_padding = 2.0f; - const float slider_sz = is_horizontal ? (frame_bb.GetWidth() - grab_padding * 2.0f) : (frame_bb.GetHeight() - grab_padding * 2.0f); - float grab_sz; - if (decimal_precision > 0) - grab_sz = ImMin(style.GrabMinSize, slider_sz); - else - grab_sz = ImMin(ImMax(1.0f * (slider_sz / ((v_min < v_max ? v_max - v_min : v_min - v_max) + 1.0f)), style.GrabMinSize), slider_sz); // Integer sliders, if possible have the grab size represent 1 unit - const float slider_usable_sz = slider_sz - grab_sz; - const float slider_usable_pos_min = (is_horizontal ? frame_bb.Min.x : frame_bb.Min.y) + grab_padding + grab_sz*0.5f; - const float slider_usable_pos_max = (is_horizontal ? frame_bb.Max.x : frame_bb.Max.y) - grab_padding - grab_sz*0.5f; - - // For logarithmic sliders that cross over sign boundary we want the exponential increase to be symmetric around 0.0f - float linear_zero_pos = 0.0f; // 0.0->1.0f - if (v_min * v_max < 0.0f) - { - // Different sign - const float linear_dist_min_to_0 = powf(fabsf(0.0f - v_min), 1.0f/power); - const float linear_dist_max_to_0 = powf(fabsf(v_max - 0.0f), 1.0f/power); - linear_zero_pos = linear_dist_min_to_0 / (linear_dist_min_to_0+linear_dist_max_to_0); - } - else - { - // Same sign - linear_zero_pos = v_min < 0.0f ? 1.0f : 0.0f; - } - - // Process clicking on the slider - bool value_changed = false; - if (g.ActiveId == id) - { - if (g.IO.MouseDown[0]) - { - const float mouse_abs_pos = is_horizontal ? g.IO.MousePos.x : g.IO.MousePos.y; - float clicked_t = (slider_usable_sz > 0.0f) ? ImClamp((mouse_abs_pos - slider_usable_pos_min) / slider_usable_sz, 0.0f, 1.0f) : 0.0f; - if (!is_horizontal) - clicked_t = 1.0f - clicked_t; - - float new_value; - if (is_non_linear) - { - // Account for logarithmic scale on both sides of the zero - if (clicked_t < linear_zero_pos) - { - // Negative: rescale to the negative range before powering - float a = 1.0f - (clicked_t / linear_zero_pos); - a = powf(a, power); - new_value = ImLerp(ImMin(v_max,0.0f), v_min, a); - } - else - { - // Positive: rescale to the positive range before powering - float a; - if (fabsf(linear_zero_pos - 1.0f) > 1.e-6f) - a = (clicked_t - linear_zero_pos) / (1.0f - linear_zero_pos); - else - a = clicked_t; - a = powf(a, power); - new_value = ImLerp(ImMax(v_min,0.0f), v_max, a); - } - } - else - { - // Linear slider - new_value = ImLerp(v_min, v_max, clicked_t); - } - - // Round past decimal precision - new_value = RoundScalar(new_value, decimal_precision); - if (*v != new_value) - { - *v = new_value; - value_changed = true; - } - } - else - { - ClearActiveID(); - } - } - - // Calculate slider grab positioning - float grab_t = SliderBehaviorCalcRatioFromValue(*v, v_min, v_max, power, linear_zero_pos); - - // Draw - if (!is_horizontal) - grab_t = 1.0f - grab_t; - const float grab_pos = ImLerp(slider_usable_pos_min, slider_usable_pos_max, grab_t); - ImRect grab_bb; - if (is_horizontal) - grab_bb = ImRect(ImVec2(grab_pos - grab_sz*0.5f, frame_bb.Min.y + grab_padding), ImVec2(grab_pos + grab_sz*0.5f, frame_bb.Max.y - grab_padding)); - else - grab_bb = ImRect(ImVec2(frame_bb.Min.x + grab_padding, grab_pos - grab_sz*0.5f), ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x - grab_padding, grab_pos + grab_sz*0.5f)); - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(grab_bb.Min, grab_bb.Max, GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_SliderGrabActive : ImGuiCol_SliderGrab), style.GrabRounding); - - return value_changed; -} - -// Use power!=1.0 for logarithmic sliders. -// Adjust display_format to decorate the value with a prefix or a suffix. -// "%.3f" 1.234 -// "%5.2f secs" 01.23 secs -// "Gold: %.0f" Gold: 1 -bool ImGui::SliderFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); - const float w = CalcItemWidth(); - - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f)); - const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f)); - - // NB- we don't call ItemSize() yet because we may turn into a text edit box below - if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, &id)) - { - ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); - return false; - } - - const bool hovered = IsHovered(frame_bb, id); - if (hovered) - SetHoveredID(id); - - if (!display_format) - display_format = "%.3f"; - int decimal_precision = ParseFormatPrecision(display_format, 3); - - // Tabbing or CTRL-clicking on Slider turns it into an input box - bool start_text_input = false; - const bool tab_focus_requested = FocusableItemRegister(window, g.ActiveId == id); - if (tab_focus_requested || (hovered && g.IO.MouseClicked[0])) - { - SetActiveID(id, window); - FocusWindow(window); - - if (tab_focus_requested || g.IO.KeyCtrl) - { - start_text_input = true; - g.ScalarAsInputTextId = 0; - } - } - if (start_text_input || (g.ActiveId == id && g.ScalarAsInputTextId == id)) - return InputScalarAsWidgetReplacement(frame_bb, label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, id, decimal_precision); - - ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); - - // Actual slider behavior + render grab - const bool value_changed = SliderBehavior(frame_bb, id, v, v_min, v_max, power, decimal_precision); - - // Display value using user-provided display format so user can add prefix/suffix/decorations to the value. - char value_buf[64]; - const char* value_buf_end = value_buf + ImFormatString(value_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(value_buf), display_format, *v); - RenderTextClipped(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, value_buf, value_buf_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f)); - - if (label_size.x > 0.0f) - RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); - - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::VSliderFloat(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, float* v, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); - - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size); - const ImRect bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f)); - - ItemSize(bb, style.FramePadding.y); - if (!ItemAdd(frame_bb, &id)) - return false; - - const bool hovered = IsHovered(frame_bb, id); - if (hovered) - SetHoveredID(id); - - if (!display_format) - display_format = "%.3f"; - int decimal_precision = ParseFormatPrecision(display_format, 3); - - if (hovered && g.IO.MouseClicked[0]) - { - SetActiveID(id, window); - FocusWindow(window); - } - - // Actual slider behavior + render grab - bool value_changed = SliderBehavior(frame_bb, id, v, v_min, v_max, power, decimal_precision, ImGuiSliderFlags_Vertical); - - // Display value using user-provided display format so user can add prefix/suffix/decorations to the value. - // For the vertical slider we allow centered text to overlap the frame padding - char value_buf[64]; - char* value_buf_end = value_buf + ImFormatString(value_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(value_buf), display_format, *v); - RenderTextClipped(ImVec2(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), frame_bb.Max, value_buf, value_buf_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f,0.0f)); - if (label_size.x > 0.0f) - RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); - - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::SliderAngle(const char* label, float* v_rad, float v_degrees_min, float v_degrees_max) -{ - float v_deg = (*v_rad) * 360.0f / (2*IM_PI); - bool value_changed = SliderFloat(label, &v_deg, v_degrees_min, v_degrees_max, "%.0f deg", 1.0f); - *v_rad = v_deg * (2*IM_PI) / 360.0f; - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::SliderInt(const char* label, int* v, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format) -{ - if (!display_format) - display_format = "%.0f"; - float v_f = (float)*v; - bool value_changed = SliderFloat(label, &v_f, (float)v_min, (float)v_max, display_format, 1.0f); - *v = (int)v_f; - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::VSliderInt(const char* label, const ImVec2& size, int* v, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format) -{ - if (!display_format) - display_format = "%.0f"; - float v_f = (float)*v; - bool value_changed = VSliderFloat(label, size, &v_f, (float)v_min, (float)v_max, display_format, 1.0f); - *v = (int)v_f; - return value_changed; -} - -// Add multiple sliders on 1 line for compact edition of multiple components -bool ImGui::SliderFloatN(const char* label, float* v, int components, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - bool value_changed = false; - BeginGroup(); - PushID(label); - PushMultiItemsWidths(components); - for (int i = 0; i < components; i++) - { - PushID(i); - value_changed |= SliderFloat("##v", &v[i], v_min, v_max, display_format, power); - SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - PopID(); - PopItemWidth(); - } - PopID(); - - TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label)); - EndGroup(); - - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::SliderFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power) -{ - return SliderFloatN(label, v, 2, v_min, v_max, display_format, power); -} - -bool ImGui::SliderFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power) -{ - return SliderFloatN(label, v, 3, v_min, v_max, display_format, power); -} - -bool ImGui::SliderFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power) -{ - return SliderFloatN(label, v, 4, v_min, v_max, display_format, power); -} - -bool ImGui::SliderIntN(const char* label, int* v, int components, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - bool value_changed = false; - BeginGroup(); - PushID(label); - PushMultiItemsWidths(components); - for (int i = 0; i < components; i++) - { - PushID(i); - value_changed |= SliderInt("##v", &v[i], v_min, v_max, display_format); - SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - PopID(); - PopItemWidth(); - } - PopID(); - - TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label)); - EndGroup(); - - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::SliderInt2(const char* label, int v[2], int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format) -{ - return SliderIntN(label, v, 2, v_min, v_max, display_format); -} - -bool ImGui::SliderInt3(const char* label, int v[3], int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format) -{ - return SliderIntN(label, v, 3, v_min, v_max, display_format); -} - -bool ImGui::SliderInt4(const char* label, int v[4], int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format) -{ - return SliderIntN(label, v, 4, v_min, v_max, display_format); -} - -bool ImGui::DragBehavior(const ImRect& frame_bb, ImGuiID id, float* v, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, int decimal_precision, float power) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - - // Draw frame - const ImU32 frame_col = GetColorU32(g.ActiveId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : g.HoveredId == id ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg); - RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, frame_col, true, style.FrameRounding); - - bool value_changed = false; - - // Process clicking on the drag - if (g.ActiveId == id) - { - if (g.IO.MouseDown[0]) - { - if (g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated) - { - // Lock current value on click - g.DragCurrentValue = *v; - g.DragLastMouseDelta = ImVec2(0.f, 0.f); - } - - float v_cur = g.DragCurrentValue; - const ImVec2 mouse_drag_delta = GetMouseDragDelta(0, 1.0f); - if (fabsf(mouse_drag_delta.x - g.DragLastMouseDelta.x) > 0.0f) - { - float speed = v_speed; - if (speed == 0.0f && (v_max - v_min) != 0.0f && (v_max - v_min) < FLT_MAX) - speed = (v_max - v_min) * g.DragSpeedDefaultRatio; - if (g.IO.KeyShift && g.DragSpeedScaleFast >= 0.0f) - speed = speed * g.DragSpeedScaleFast; - if (g.IO.KeyAlt && g.DragSpeedScaleSlow >= 0.0f) - speed = speed * g.DragSpeedScaleSlow; - - float delta = (mouse_drag_delta.x - g.DragLastMouseDelta.x) * speed; - if (fabsf(power - 1.0f) > 0.001f) - { - // Logarithmic curve on both side of 0.0 - float v0_abs = v_cur >= 0.0f ? v_cur : -v_cur; - float v0_sign = v_cur >= 0.0f ? 1.0f : -1.0f; - float v1 = powf(v0_abs, 1.0f / power) + (delta * v0_sign); - float v1_abs = v1 >= 0.0f ? v1 : -v1; - float v1_sign = v1 >= 0.0f ? 1.0f : -1.0f; // Crossed sign line - v_cur = powf(v1_abs, power) * v0_sign * v1_sign; // Reapply sign - } - else - { - v_cur += delta; - } - g.DragLastMouseDelta.x = mouse_drag_delta.x; - - // Clamp - if (v_min < v_max) - v_cur = ImClamp(v_cur, v_min, v_max); - g.DragCurrentValue = v_cur; - } - - // Round to user desired precision, then apply - v_cur = RoundScalar(v_cur, decimal_precision); - if (*v != v_cur) - { - *v = v_cur; - value_changed = true; - } - } - else - { - ClearActiveID(); - } - } - - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::DragFloat(const char* label, float* v, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); - const float w = CalcItemWidth(); - - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f)); - const ImRect inner_bb(frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding, frame_bb.Max - style.FramePadding); - const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f)); - - // NB- we don't call ItemSize() yet because we may turn into a text edit box below - if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, &id)) - { - ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); - return false; - } - - const bool hovered = IsHovered(frame_bb, id); - if (hovered) - SetHoveredID(id); - - if (!display_format) - display_format = "%.3f"; - int decimal_precision = ParseFormatPrecision(display_format, 3); - - // Tabbing or CTRL-clicking on Drag turns it into an input box - bool start_text_input = false; - const bool tab_focus_requested = FocusableItemRegister(window, g.ActiveId == id); - if (tab_focus_requested || (hovered && (g.IO.MouseClicked[0] | g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0]))) - { - SetActiveID(id, window); - FocusWindow(window); - - if (tab_focus_requested || g.IO.KeyCtrl || g.IO.MouseDoubleClicked[0]) - { - start_text_input = true; - g.ScalarAsInputTextId = 0; - } - } - if (start_text_input || (g.ActiveId == id && g.ScalarAsInputTextId == id)) - return InputScalarAsWidgetReplacement(frame_bb, label, ImGuiDataType_Float, v, id, decimal_precision); - - // Actual drag behavior - ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); - const bool value_changed = DragBehavior(frame_bb, id, v, v_speed, v_min, v_max, decimal_precision, power); - - // Display value using user-provided display format so user can add prefix/suffix/decorations to the value. - char value_buf[64]; - const char* value_buf_end = value_buf + ImFormatString(value_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(value_buf), display_format, *v); - RenderTextClipped(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, value_buf, value_buf_end, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f)); - - if (label_size.x > 0.0f) - RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, inner_bb.Min.y), label); - - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::DragFloatN(const char* label, float* v, int components, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - bool value_changed = false; - BeginGroup(); - PushID(label); - PushMultiItemsWidths(components); - for (int i = 0; i < components; i++) - { - PushID(i); - value_changed |= DragFloat("##v", &v[i], v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format, power); - SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - PopID(); - PopItemWidth(); - } - PopID(); - - TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label)); - EndGroup(); - - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::DragFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power) -{ - return DragFloatN(label, v, 2, v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format, power); -} - -bool ImGui::DragFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power) -{ - return DragFloatN(label, v, 3, v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format, power); -} - -bool ImGui::DragFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, float power) -{ - return DragFloatN(label, v, 4, v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format, power); -} - -bool ImGui::DragFloatRange2(const char* label, float* v_current_min, float* v_current_max, float v_speed, float v_min, float v_max, const char* display_format, const char* display_format_max, float power) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - PushID(label); - BeginGroup(); - PushMultiItemsWidths(2); - - bool value_changed = DragFloat("##min", v_current_min, v_speed, (v_min >= v_max) ? -FLT_MAX : v_min, (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_max : ImMin(v_max, *v_current_max), display_format, power); - PopItemWidth(); - SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - value_changed |= DragFloat("##max", v_current_max, v_speed, (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_min : ImMax(v_min, *v_current_min), (v_min >= v_max) ? FLT_MAX : v_max, display_format_max ? display_format_max : display_format, power); - PopItemWidth(); - SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - - TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label)); - EndGroup(); - PopID(); - - return value_changed; -} - -// NB: v_speed is float to allow adjusting the drag speed with more precision -bool ImGui::DragInt(const char* label, int* v, float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format) -{ - if (!display_format) - display_format = "%.0f"; - float v_f = (float)*v; - bool value_changed = DragFloat(label, &v_f, v_speed, (float)v_min, (float)v_max, display_format); - *v = (int)v_f; - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::DragIntN(const char* label, int* v, int components, float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - bool value_changed = false; - BeginGroup(); - PushID(label); - PushMultiItemsWidths(components); - for (int i = 0; i < components; i++) - { - PushID(i); - value_changed |= DragInt("##v", &v[i], v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format); - SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - PopID(); - PopItemWidth(); - } - PopID(); - - TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label)); - EndGroup(); - - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::DragInt2(const char* label, int v[2], float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format) -{ - return DragIntN(label, v, 2, v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format); -} - -bool ImGui::DragInt3(const char* label, int v[3], float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format) -{ - return DragIntN(label, v, 3, v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format); -} - -bool ImGui::DragInt4(const char* label, int v[4], float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format) -{ - return DragIntN(label, v, 4, v_speed, v_min, v_max, display_format); -} - -bool ImGui::DragIntRange2(const char* label, int* v_current_min, int* v_current_max, float v_speed, int v_min, int v_max, const char* display_format, const char* display_format_max) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - PushID(label); - BeginGroup(); - PushMultiItemsWidths(2); - - bool value_changed = DragInt("##min", v_current_min, v_speed, (v_min >= v_max) ? INT_MIN : v_min, (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_max : ImMin(v_max, *v_current_max), display_format); - PopItemWidth(); - SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - value_changed |= DragInt("##max", v_current_max, v_speed, (v_min >= v_max) ? *v_current_min : ImMax(v_min, *v_current_min), (v_min >= v_max) ? INT_MAX : v_max, display_format_max ? display_format_max : display_format); - PopItemWidth(); - SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - - TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label)); - EndGroup(); - PopID(); - - return value_changed; -} - -void ImGui::PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType plot_type, const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - if (graph_size.x == 0.0f) - graph_size.x = CalcItemWidth(); - if (graph_size.y == 0.0f) - graph_size.y = label_size.y + (style.FramePadding.y * 2); - - const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(graph_size.x, graph_size.y)); - const ImRect inner_bb(frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding, frame_bb.Max - style.FramePadding); - const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0)); - ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); - if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, NULL)) - return; - - // Determine scale from values if not specified - if (scale_min == FLT_MAX || scale_max == FLT_MAX) - { - float v_min = FLT_MAX; - float v_max = -FLT_MAX; - for (int i = 0; i < values_count; i++) - { - const float v = values_getter(data, i); - v_min = ImMin(v_min, v); - v_max = ImMax(v_max, v); - } - if (scale_min == FLT_MAX) - scale_min = v_min; - if (scale_max == FLT_MAX) - scale_max = v_max; - } - - RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding); - - if (values_count > 0) - { - int res_w = ImMin((int)graph_size.x, values_count) + ((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? -1 : 0); - int item_count = values_count + ((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? -1 : 0); - - // Tooltip on hover - int v_hovered = -1; - if (IsHovered(inner_bb, 0)) - { - const float t = ImClamp((g.IO.MousePos.x - inner_bb.Min.x) / (inner_bb.Max.x - inner_bb.Min.x), 0.0f, 0.9999f); - const int v_idx = (int)(t * item_count); - IM_ASSERT(v_idx >= 0 && v_idx < values_count); - - const float v0 = values_getter(data, (v_idx + values_offset) % values_count); - const float v1 = values_getter(data, (v_idx + 1 + values_offset) % values_count); - if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) - SetTooltip("%d: %8.4g\n%d: %8.4g", v_idx, v0, v_idx+1, v1); - else if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Histogram) - SetTooltip("%d: %8.4g", v_idx, v0); - v_hovered = v_idx; - } - - const float t_step = 1.0f / (float)res_w; - - float v0 = values_getter(data, (0 + values_offset) % values_count); - float t0 = 0.0f; - ImVec2 tp0 = ImVec2( t0, 1.0f - ImSaturate((v0 - scale_min) / (scale_max - scale_min)) ); // Point in the normalized space of our target rectangle - - const ImU32 col_base = GetColorU32((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? ImGuiCol_PlotLines : ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram); - const ImU32 col_hovered = GetColorU32((plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? ImGuiCol_PlotLinesHovered : ImGuiCol_PlotHistogramHovered); - - for (int n = 0; n < res_w; n++) - { - const float t1 = t0 + t_step; - const int v1_idx = (int)(t0 * item_count + 0.5f); - IM_ASSERT(v1_idx >= 0 && v1_idx < values_count); - const float v1 = values_getter(data, (v1_idx + values_offset + 1) % values_count); - const ImVec2 tp1 = ImVec2( t1, 1.0f - ImSaturate((v1 - scale_min) / (scale_max - scale_min)) ); - - // NB: Draw calls are merged together by the DrawList system. Still, we should render our batch are lower level to save a bit of CPU. - ImVec2 pos0 = ImLerp(inner_bb.Min, inner_bb.Max, tp0); - ImVec2 pos1 = ImLerp(inner_bb.Min, inner_bb.Max, (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) ? tp1 : ImVec2(tp1.x, 1.0f)); - if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Lines) - { - window->DrawList->AddLine(pos0, pos1, v_hovered == v1_idx ? col_hovered : col_base); - } - else if (plot_type == ImGuiPlotType_Histogram) - { - if (pos1.x >= pos0.x + 2.0f) - pos1.x -= 1.0f; - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(pos0, pos1, v_hovered == v1_idx ? col_hovered : col_base); - } - - t0 = t1; - tp0 = tp1; - } - } - - // Text overlay - if (overlay_text) - RenderTextClipped(ImVec2(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), frame_bb.Max, overlay_text, NULL, NULL, ImVec2(0.5f,0.0f)); - - if (label_size.x > 0.0f) - RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, inner_bb.Min.y), label); -} - -struct ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData -{ - const float* Values; - int Stride; - - ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData(const float* values, int stride) { Values = values; Stride = stride; } -}; - -static float Plot_ArrayGetter(void* data, int idx) -{ - ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData* plot_data = (ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData*)data; - const float v = *(float*)(void*)((unsigned char*)plot_data->Values + (size_t)idx * plot_data->Stride); - return v; -} - -void ImGui::PlotLines(const char* label, const float* values, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size, int stride) -{ - ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData data(values, stride); - PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Lines, label, &Plot_ArrayGetter, (void*)&data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size); -} - -void ImGui::PlotLines(const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size) -{ - PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Lines, label, values_getter, data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size); -} - -void ImGui::PlotHistogram(const char* label, const float* values, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size, int stride) -{ - ImGuiPlotArrayGetterData data(values, stride); - PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Histogram, label, &Plot_ArrayGetter, (void*)&data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size); -} - -void ImGui::PlotHistogram(const char* label, float (*values_getter)(void* data, int idx), void* data, int values_count, int values_offset, const char* overlay_text, float scale_min, float scale_max, ImVec2 graph_size) -{ - PlotEx(ImGuiPlotType_Histogram, label, values_getter, data, values_count, values_offset, overlay_text, scale_min, scale_max, graph_size); -} - -// size_arg (for each axis) < 0.0f: align to end, 0.0f: auto, > 0.0f: specified size -void ImGui::ProgressBar(float fraction, const ImVec2& size_arg, const char* overlay) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - - ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; - ImRect bb(pos, pos + CalcItemSize(size_arg, CalcItemWidth(), g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f)); - ItemSize(bb, style.FramePadding.y); - if (!ItemAdd(bb, NULL)) - return; - - // Render - fraction = ImSaturate(fraction); - RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding); - bb.Reduce(ImVec2(window->BorderSize, window->BorderSize)); - const ImVec2 fill_br = ImVec2(ImLerp(bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x, fraction), bb.Max.y); - RenderFrame(bb.Min, fill_br, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_PlotHistogram), false, style.FrameRounding); - - // Default displaying the fraction as percentage string, but user can override it - char overlay_buf[32]; - if (!overlay) - { - ImFormatString(overlay_buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(overlay_buf), "%.0f%%", fraction*100+0.01f); - overlay = overlay_buf; - } - - ImVec2 overlay_size = CalcTextSize(overlay, NULL); - if (overlay_size.x > 0.0f) - RenderTextClipped(ImVec2(ImClamp(fill_br.x + style.ItemSpacing.x, bb.Min.x, bb.Max.x - overlay_size.x - style.ItemInnerSpacing.x), bb.Min.y), bb.Max, overlay, NULL, &overlay_size, ImVec2(0.0f,0.5f), &bb); -} - -bool ImGui::Checkbox(const char* label, bool* v) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - - const ImRect check_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2)); - ItemSize(check_bb, style.FramePadding.y); - - ImRect total_bb = check_bb; - if (label_size.x > 0) - SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - const ImRect text_bb(window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(0,style.FramePadding.y), window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(0,style.FramePadding.y) + label_size); - if (label_size.x > 0) - { - ItemSize(ImVec2(text_bb.GetWidth(), check_bb.GetHeight()), style.FramePadding.y); - total_bb = ImRect(ImMin(check_bb.Min, text_bb.Min), ImMax(check_bb.Max, text_bb.Max)); - } - - if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, &id)) - return false; - - bool hovered, held; - bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(total_bb, id, &hovered, &held); - if (pressed) - *v = !(*v); - - RenderFrame(check_bb.Min, check_bb.Max, GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding); - if (*v) - { - const float check_sz = ImMin(check_bb.GetWidth(), check_bb.GetHeight()); - const float pad = ImMax(1.0f, (float)(int)(check_sz / 6.0f)); - window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(check_bb.Min+ImVec2(pad,pad), check_bb.Max-ImVec2(pad,pad), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_CheckMark), style.FrameRounding); - } - - if (g.LogEnabled) - LogRenderedText(text_bb.GetTL(), *v ? "[x]" : "[ ]"); - if (label_size.x > 0.0f) - RenderText(text_bb.GetTL(), label); - - return pressed; -} - -bool ImGui::CheckboxFlags(const char* label, unsigned int* flags, unsigned int flags_value) -{ - bool v = ((*flags & flags_value) == flags_value); - bool pressed = Checkbox(label, &v); - if (pressed) - { - if (v) - *flags |= flags_value; - else - *flags &= ~flags_value; - } - - return pressed; -} - -bool ImGui::RadioButton(const char* label, bool active) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - - const ImRect check_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2-1, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2-1)); - ItemSize(check_bb, style.FramePadding.y); - - ImRect total_bb = check_bb; - if (label_size.x > 0) - SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - const ImRect text_bb(window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(0, style.FramePadding.y), window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(0, style.FramePadding.y) + label_size); - if (label_size.x > 0) - { - ItemSize(ImVec2(text_bb.GetWidth(), check_bb.GetHeight()), style.FramePadding.y); - total_bb.Add(text_bb); - } - - if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, &id)) - return false; - - ImVec2 center = check_bb.GetCenter(); - center.x = (float)(int)center.x + 0.5f; - center.y = (float)(int)center.y + 0.5f; - const float radius = check_bb.GetHeight() * 0.5f; - - bool hovered, held; - bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(total_bb, id, &hovered, &held); - - window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, radius, GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered : ImGuiCol_FrameBg), 16); - if (active) - { - const float check_sz = ImMin(check_bb.GetWidth(), check_bb.GetHeight()); - const float pad = ImMax(1.0f, (float)(int)(check_sz / 6.0f)); - window->DrawList->AddCircleFilled(center, radius-pad, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_CheckMark), 16); - } - - if (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders) - { - window->DrawList->AddCircle(center+ImVec2(1,1), radius, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_BorderShadow), 16); - window->DrawList->AddCircle(center, radius, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border), 16); - } - - if (g.LogEnabled) - LogRenderedText(text_bb.GetTL(), active ? "(x)" : "( )"); - if (label_size.x > 0.0f) - RenderText(text_bb.GetTL(), label); - - return pressed; -} - -bool ImGui::RadioButton(const char* label, int* v, int v_button) -{ - const bool pressed = RadioButton(label, *v == v_button); - if (pressed) - { - *v = v_button; - } - return pressed; -} - -static int InputTextCalcTextLenAndLineCount(const char* text_begin, const char** out_text_end) -{ - int line_count = 0; - const char* s = text_begin; - while (char c = *s++) // We are only matching for \n so we can ignore UTF-8 decoding - if (c == '\n') - line_count++; - s--; - if (s[0] != '\n' && s[0] != '\r') - line_count++; - *out_text_end = s; - return line_count; -} - -static ImVec2 InputTextCalcTextSizeW(const ImWchar* text_begin, const ImWchar* text_end, const ImWchar** remaining, ImVec2* out_offset, bool stop_on_new_line) -{ - ImFont* font = GImGui->Font; - const float line_height = GImGui->FontSize; - const float scale = line_height / font->FontSize; - - ImVec2 text_size = ImVec2(0,0); - float line_width = 0.0f; - - const ImWchar* s = text_begin; - while (s < text_end) - { - unsigned int c = (unsigned int)(*s++); - if (c == '\n') - { - text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, line_width); - text_size.y += line_height; - line_width = 0.0f; - if (stop_on_new_line) - break; - continue; - } - if (c == '\r') - continue; - - const float char_width = font->GetCharAdvance((unsigned short)c) * scale; - line_width += char_width; - } - - if (text_size.x < line_width) - text_size.x = line_width; - - if (out_offset) - *out_offset = ImVec2(line_width, text_size.y + line_height); // offset allow for the possibility of sitting after a trailing \n - - if (line_width > 0 || text_size.y == 0.0f) // whereas size.y will ignore the trailing \n - text_size.y += line_height; - - if (remaining) - *remaining = s; - - return text_size; -} - -// Wrapper for stb_textedit.h to edit text (our wrapper is for: statically sized buffer, single-line, wchar characters. InputText converts between UTF-8 and wchar) -namespace ImGuiStb -{ - -static int STB_TEXTEDIT_STRINGLEN(const STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj) { return obj->CurLenW; } -static ImWchar STB_TEXTEDIT_GETCHAR(const STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { return obj->Text[idx]; } -static float STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int line_start_idx, int char_idx) { ImWchar c = obj->Text[line_start_idx+char_idx]; if (c == '\n') return STB_TEXTEDIT_GETWIDTH_NEWLINE; return GImGui->Font->GetCharAdvance(c) * (GImGui->FontSize / GImGui->Font->FontSize); } -static int STB_TEXTEDIT_KEYTOTEXT(int key) { return key >= 0x10000 ? 0 : key; } -static ImWchar STB_TEXTEDIT_NEWLINE = '\n'; -static void STB_TEXTEDIT_LAYOUTROW(StbTexteditRow* r, STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int line_start_idx) -{ - const ImWchar* text = obj->Text.Data; - const ImWchar* text_remaining = NULL; - const ImVec2 size = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(text + line_start_idx, text + obj->CurLenW, &text_remaining, NULL, true); - r->x0 = 0.0f; - r->x1 = size.x; - r->baseline_y_delta = size.y; - r->ymin = 0.0f; - r->ymax = size.y; - r->num_chars = (int)(text_remaining - (text + line_start_idx)); -} - -static bool is_separator(unsigned int c) { return ImCharIsSpace(c) || c==',' || c==';' || c=='(' || c==')' || c=='{' || c=='}' || c=='[' || c==']' || c=='|'; } -static int is_word_boundary_from_right(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { return idx > 0 ? (is_separator( obj->Text[idx-1] ) && !is_separator( obj->Text[idx] ) ) : 1; } -static int STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT_IMPL(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { idx--; while (idx >= 0 && !is_word_boundary_from_right(obj, idx)) idx--; return idx < 0 ? 0 : idx; } -#ifdef __APPLE__ // FIXME: Move setting to IO structure -static int is_word_boundary_from_left(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { return idx > 0 ? (!is_separator( obj->Text[idx-1] ) && is_separator( obj->Text[idx] ) ) : 1; } -static int STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT_IMPL(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { idx++; int len = obj->CurLenW; while (idx < len && !is_word_boundary_from_left(obj, idx)) idx++; return idx > len ? len : idx; } -#else -static int STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT_IMPL(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int idx) { idx++; int len = obj->CurLenW; while (idx < len && !is_word_boundary_from_right(obj, idx)) idx++; return idx > len ? len : idx; } -#endif -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDLEFT_IMPL // They need to be #define for stb_textedit.h -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT STB_TEXTEDIT_MOVEWORDRIGHT_IMPL - -static void STB_TEXTEDIT_DELETECHARS(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int pos, int n) -{ - ImWchar* dst = obj->Text.Data + pos; - - // We maintain our buffer length in both UTF-8 and wchar formats - obj->CurLenA -= ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(dst, dst + n); - obj->CurLenW -= n; - - // Offset remaining text - const ImWchar* src = obj->Text.Data + pos + n; - while (ImWchar c = *src++) - *dst++ = c; - *dst = '\0'; -} - -static bool STB_TEXTEDIT_INSERTCHARS(STB_TEXTEDIT_STRING* obj, int pos, const ImWchar* new_text, int new_text_len) -{ - const int text_len = obj->CurLenW; - IM_ASSERT(pos <= text_len); - if (new_text_len + text_len + 1 > obj->Text.Size) - return false; - - const int new_text_len_utf8 = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(new_text, new_text + new_text_len); - if (new_text_len_utf8 + obj->CurLenA + 1 > obj->BufSizeA) - return false; - - ImWchar* text = obj->Text.Data; - if (pos != text_len) - memmove(text + pos + new_text_len, text + pos, (size_t)(text_len - pos) * sizeof(ImWchar)); - memcpy(text + pos, new_text, (size_t)new_text_len * sizeof(ImWchar)); - - obj->CurLenW += new_text_len; - obj->CurLenA += new_text_len_utf8; - obj->Text[obj->CurLenW] = '\0'; - - return true; -} - -// We don't use an enum so we can build even with conflicting symbols (if another user of stb_textedit.h leak their STB_TEXTEDIT_K_* symbols) -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT 0x10000 // keyboard input to move cursor left -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT 0x10001 // keyboard input to move cursor right -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP 0x10002 // keyboard input to move cursor up -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN 0x10003 // keyboard input to move cursor down -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART 0x10004 // keyboard input to move cursor to start of line -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND 0x10005 // keyboard input to move cursor to end of line -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART 0x10006 // keyboard input to move cursor to start of text -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND 0x10007 // keyboard input to move cursor to end of text -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE 0x10008 // keyboard input to delete selection or character under cursor -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE 0x10009 // keyboard input to delete selection or character left of cursor -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UNDO 0x1000A // keyboard input to perform undo -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_REDO 0x1000B // keyboard input to perform redo -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT 0x1000C // keyboard input to move cursor left one word -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT 0x1000D // keyboard input to move cursor right one word -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT 0x20000 - -#define STB_TEXTEDIT_IMPLEMENTATION -#include - -} - -void ImGuiTextEditState::OnKeyPressed(int key) -{ - stb_textedit_key(this, &StbState, key); - CursorFollow = true; - CursorAnimReset(); -} - -// Public API to manipulate UTF-8 text -// We expose UTF-8 to the user (unlike the STB_TEXTEDIT_* functions which are manipulating wchar) -// FIXME: The existence of this rarely exercised code path is a bit of a nuisance. -void ImGuiTextEditCallbackData::DeleteChars(int pos, int bytes_count) -{ - IM_ASSERT(pos + bytes_count <= BufTextLen); - char* dst = Buf + pos; - const char* src = Buf + pos + bytes_count; - while (char c = *src++) - *dst++ = c; - *dst = '\0'; - - if (CursorPos + bytes_count >= pos) - CursorPos -= bytes_count; - else if (CursorPos >= pos) - CursorPos = pos; - SelectionStart = SelectionEnd = CursorPos; - BufDirty = true; - BufTextLen -= bytes_count; -} - -void ImGuiTextEditCallbackData::InsertChars(int pos, const char* new_text, const char* new_text_end) -{ - const int new_text_len = new_text_end ? (int)(new_text_end - new_text) : (int)strlen(new_text); - if (new_text_len + BufTextLen + 1 >= BufSize) - return; - - if (BufTextLen != pos) - memmove(Buf + pos + new_text_len, Buf + pos, (size_t)(BufTextLen - pos)); - memcpy(Buf + pos, new_text, (size_t)new_text_len * sizeof(char)); - Buf[BufTextLen + new_text_len] = '\0'; - - if (CursorPos >= pos) - CursorPos += new_text_len; - SelectionStart = SelectionEnd = CursorPos; - BufDirty = true; - BufTextLen += new_text_len; -} - -// Return false to discard a character. -static bool InputTextFilterCharacter(unsigned int* p_char, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback, void* user_data) -{ - unsigned int c = *p_char; - - if (c < 128 && c != ' ' && !isprint((int)(c & 0xFF))) - { - bool pass = false; - pass |= (c == '\n' && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline)); - pass |= (c == '\t' && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput)); - if (!pass) - return false; - } - - if (c >= 0xE000 && c <= 0xF8FF) // Filter private Unicode range. I don't imagine anybody would want to input them. GLFW on OSX seems to send private characters for special keys like arrow keys. - return false; - - if (flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank)) - { - if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal) - if (!(c >= '0' && c <= '9') && (c != '.') && (c != '-') && (c != '+') && (c != '*') && (c != '/')) - return false; - - if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal) - if (!(c >= '0' && c <= '9') && !(c >= 'a' && c <= 'f') && !(c >= 'A' && c <= 'F')) - return false; - - if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase) - if (c >= 'a' && c <= 'z') - *p_char = (c += (unsigned int)('A'-'a')); - - if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank) - if (ImCharIsSpace(c)) - return false; - } - - if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter) - { - ImGuiTextEditCallbackData callback_data; - memset(&callback_data, 0, sizeof(ImGuiTextEditCallbackData)); - callback_data.EventFlag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter; - callback_data.EventChar = (ImWchar)c; - callback_data.Flags = flags; - callback_data.UserData = user_data; - if (callback(&callback_data) != 0) - return false; - *p_char = callback_data.EventChar; - if (!callback_data.EventChar) - return false; - } - - return true; -} - -// Edit a string of text -// NB: when active, hold on a privately held copy of the text (and apply back to 'buf'). So changing 'buf' while active has no effect. -// FIXME: Rather messy function partly because we are doing UTF8 > u16 > UTF8 conversions on the go to more easily handle stb_textedit calls. Ideally we should stay in UTF-8 all the time. See https://github.com/nothings/stb/issues/188 -bool ImGui::InputTextEx(const char* label, char* buf, int buf_size, const ImVec2& size_arg, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback, void* user_data) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - IM_ASSERT(!((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline))); // Can't use both together (they both use up/down keys) - IM_ASSERT(!((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion) && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput))); // Can't use both together (they both use tab key) - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiIO& io = g.IO; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - - const bool is_multiline = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline) != 0; - const bool is_editable = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly) == 0; - const bool is_password = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password) != 0; - - if (is_multiline) // Open group before calling GetID() because groups tracks id created during their spawn - BeginGroup(); - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, CalcItemWidth(), (is_multiline ? GetTextLineHeight() * 8.0f : label_size.y) + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f); // Arbitrary default of 8 lines high for multi-line - const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size); - const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? (style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x) : 0.0f, 0.0f)); - - ImGuiWindow* draw_window = window; - if (is_multiline) - { - if (!BeginChildFrame(id, frame_bb.GetSize())) - { - EndChildFrame(); - EndGroup(); - return false; - } - draw_window = GetCurrentWindow(); - size.x -= draw_window->ScrollbarSizes.x; - } - else - { - ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); - if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, &id)) - return false; - } - - // Password pushes a temporary font with only a fallback glyph - if (is_password) - { - const ImFont::Glyph* glyph = g.Font->FindGlyph('*'); - ImFont* password_font = &g.InputTextPasswordFont; - password_font->FontSize = g.Font->FontSize; - password_font->Scale = g.Font->Scale; - password_font->DisplayOffset = g.Font->DisplayOffset; - password_font->Ascent = g.Font->Ascent; - password_font->Descent = g.Font->Descent; - password_font->ContainerAtlas = g.Font->ContainerAtlas; - password_font->FallbackGlyph = glyph; - password_font->FallbackXAdvance = glyph->XAdvance; - IM_ASSERT(password_font->Glyphs.empty() && password_font->IndexXAdvance.empty() && password_font->IndexLookup.empty()); - PushFont(password_font); - } - - // NB: we are only allowed to access 'edit_state' if we are the active widget. - ImGuiTextEditState& edit_state = g.InputTextState; - - const bool focus_requested = FocusableItemRegister(window, g.ActiveId == id, (flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion|ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput)) == 0); // Using completion callback disable keyboard tabbing - const bool focus_requested_by_code = focus_requested && (window->FocusIdxAllCounter == window->FocusIdxAllRequestCurrent); - const bool focus_requested_by_tab = focus_requested && !focus_requested_by_code; - - const bool hovered = IsHovered(frame_bb, id); - if (hovered) - { - SetHoveredID(id); - g.MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_TextInput; - } - const bool user_clicked = hovered && io.MouseClicked[0]; - const bool user_scrolled = is_multiline && g.ActiveId == 0 && edit_state.Id == id && g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame == draw_window->GetIDNoKeepAlive("#SCROLLY"); - - bool select_all = (g.ActiveId != id) && (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll) != 0; - if (focus_requested || user_clicked || user_scrolled) - { - if (g.ActiveId != id) - { - // Start edition - // Take a copy of the initial buffer value (both in original UTF-8 format and converted to wchar) - // From the moment we focused we are ignoring the content of 'buf' (unless we are in read-only mode) - const int prev_len_w = edit_state.CurLenW; - edit_state.Text.resize(buf_size+1); // wchar count <= UTF-8 count. we use +1 to make sure that .Data isn't NULL so it doesn't crash. - edit_state.InitialText.resize(buf_size+1); // UTF-8. we use +1 to make sure that .Data isn't NULL so it doesn't crash. - ImStrncpy(edit_state.InitialText.Data, buf, edit_state.InitialText.Size); - const char* buf_end = NULL; - edit_state.CurLenW = ImTextStrFromUtf8(edit_state.Text.Data, edit_state.Text.Size, buf, NULL, &buf_end); - edit_state.CurLenA = (int)(buf_end - buf); // We can't get the result from ImFormatString() above because it is not UTF-8 aware. Here we'll cut off malformed UTF-8. - edit_state.CursorAnimReset(); - - // Preserve cursor position and undo/redo stack if we come back to same widget - // FIXME: We should probably compare the whole buffer to be on the safety side. Comparing buf (utf8) and edit_state.Text (wchar). - const bool recycle_state = (edit_state.Id == id) && (prev_len_w == edit_state.CurLenW); - if (recycle_state) - { - // Recycle existing cursor/selection/undo stack but clamp position - // Note a single mouse click will override the cursor/position immediately by calling stb_textedit_click handler. - edit_state.CursorClamp(); - } - else - { - edit_state.Id = id; - edit_state.ScrollX = 0.0f; - stb_textedit_initialize_state(&edit_state.StbState, !is_multiline); - if (!is_multiline && focus_requested_by_code) - select_all = true; - } - if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AlwaysInsertMode) - edit_state.StbState.insert_mode = true; - if (!is_multiline && (focus_requested_by_tab || (user_clicked && io.KeyCtrl))) - select_all = true; - } - SetActiveID(id, window); - FocusWindow(window); - } - else if (io.MouseClicked[0]) - { - // Release focus when we click outside - if (g.ActiveId == id) - ClearActiveID(); - } - - bool value_changed = false; - bool enter_pressed = false; - - if (g.ActiveId == id) - { - if (!is_editable && !g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated) - { - // When read-only we always use the live data passed to the function - edit_state.Text.resize(buf_size+1); - const char* buf_end = NULL; - edit_state.CurLenW = ImTextStrFromUtf8(edit_state.Text.Data, edit_state.Text.Size, buf, NULL, &buf_end); - edit_state.CurLenA = (int)(buf_end - buf); - edit_state.CursorClamp(); - } - - edit_state.BufSizeA = buf_size; - - // Although we are active we don't prevent mouse from hovering other elements unless we are interacting right now with the widget. - // Down the line we should have a cleaner library-wide concept of Selected vs Active. - g.ActiveIdAllowOverlap = !io.MouseDown[0]; - - // Edit in progress - const float mouse_x = (io.MousePos.x - frame_bb.Min.x - style.FramePadding.x) + edit_state.ScrollX; - const float mouse_y = (is_multiline ? (io.MousePos.y - draw_window->DC.CursorPos.y - style.FramePadding.y) : (g.FontSize*0.5f)); - - const bool osx_double_click_selects_words = io.OSXBehaviors; // OS X style: Double click selects by word instead of selecting whole text - if (select_all || (hovered && !osx_double_click_selects_words && io.MouseDoubleClicked[0])) - { - edit_state.SelectAll(); - edit_state.SelectedAllMouseLock = true; - } - else if (hovered && osx_double_click_selects_words && io.MouseDoubleClicked[0]) - { - // Select a word only, OS X style (by simulating keystrokes) - edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT); - edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT | STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT); - } - else if (io.MouseClicked[0] && !edit_state.SelectedAllMouseLock) - { - stb_textedit_click(&edit_state, &edit_state.StbState, mouse_x, mouse_y); - edit_state.CursorAnimReset(); - } - else if (io.MouseDown[0] && !edit_state.SelectedAllMouseLock && (io.MouseDelta.x != 0.0f || io.MouseDelta.y != 0.0f)) - { - stb_textedit_drag(&edit_state, &edit_state.StbState, mouse_x, mouse_y); - edit_state.CursorAnimReset(); - edit_state.CursorFollow = true; - } - if (edit_state.SelectedAllMouseLock && !io.MouseDown[0]) - edit_state.SelectedAllMouseLock = false; - - if (io.InputCharacters[0]) - { - // Process text input (before we check for Return because using some IME will effectively send a Return?) - // We ignore CTRL inputs, but need to allow CTRL+ALT as some keyboards (e.g. German) use AltGR - which is Alt+Ctrl - to input certain characters. - if (!(io.KeyCtrl && !io.KeyAlt) && is_editable) - { - for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.InputCharacters) && io.InputCharacters[n]; n++) - if (unsigned int c = (unsigned int)io.InputCharacters[n]) - { - // Insert character if they pass filtering - if (!InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, user_data)) - continue; - edit_state.OnKeyPressed((int)c); - } - } - - // Consume characters - memset(g.IO.InputCharacters, 0, sizeof(g.IO.InputCharacters)); - } - - // Handle various key-presses - bool cancel_edit = false; - const int k_mask = (io.KeyShift ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT : 0); - const bool is_shortcut_key_only = (io.OSXBehaviors ? (io.KeySuper && !io.KeyCtrl) : (io.KeyCtrl && !io.KeySuper)) && !io.KeyAlt && !io.KeyShift; // OS X style: Shortcuts using Cmd/Super instead of Ctrl - const bool is_wordmove_key_down = io.OSXBehaviors ? io.KeyAlt : io.KeyCtrl; // OS X style: Text editing cursor movement using Alt instead of Ctrl - const bool is_startend_key_down = io.OSXBehaviors && io.KeySuper && !io.KeyCtrl && !io.KeyAlt; // OS X style: Line/Text Start and End using Cmd+Arrows instead of Home/End - - if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_LeftArrow)) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART : is_wordmove_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LEFT) | k_mask); } - else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_RightArrow)) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND : is_wordmove_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDRIGHT : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_RIGHT) | k_mask); } - else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_UpArrow) && is_multiline) { if (io.KeyCtrl) SetWindowScrollY(draw_window, ImMax(draw_window->Scroll.y - g.FontSize, 0.0f)); else edit_state.OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UP) | k_mask); } - else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_DownArrow) && is_multiline) { if (io.KeyCtrl) SetWindowScrollY(draw_window, ImMin(draw_window->Scroll.y + g.FontSize, GetScrollMaxY())); else edit_state.OnKeyPressed((is_startend_key_down ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DOWN) | k_mask); } - else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Home)) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed(io.KeyCtrl ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTSTART | k_mask : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART | k_mask); } - else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_End)) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed(io.KeyCtrl ? STB_TEXTEDIT_K_TEXTEND | k_mask : STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINEEND | k_mask); } - else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Delete) && is_editable) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_DELETE | k_mask); } - else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Backspace) && is_editable) - { - if (!edit_state.HasSelection()) - { - if (is_wordmove_key_down) edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_WORDLEFT|STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT); - else if (io.OSXBehaviors && io.KeySuper && !io.KeyAlt && !io.KeyCtrl) edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_LINESTART|STB_TEXTEDIT_K_SHIFT); - } - edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_BACKSPACE | k_mask); - } - else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Enter)) - { - bool ctrl_enter_for_new_line = (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CtrlEnterForNewLine) != 0; - if (!is_multiline || (ctrl_enter_for_new_line && !io.KeyCtrl) || (!ctrl_enter_for_new_line && io.KeyCtrl)) - { - ClearActiveID(); - enter_pressed = true; - } - else if (is_editable) - { - unsigned int c = '\n'; // Insert new line - if (InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, user_data)) - edit_state.OnKeyPressed((int)c); - } - } - else if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput) && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab) && !io.KeyCtrl && !io.KeyShift && !io.KeyAlt && is_editable) - { - unsigned int c = '\t'; // Insert TAB - if (InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, user_data)) - edit_state.OnKeyPressed((int)c); - } - else if (IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Escape)) { ClearActiveID(); cancel_edit = true; } - else if (is_shortcut_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Z) && is_editable) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_UNDO); edit_state.ClearSelection(); } - else if (is_shortcut_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Y) && is_editable) { edit_state.OnKeyPressed(STB_TEXTEDIT_K_REDO); edit_state.ClearSelection(); } - else if (is_shortcut_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_A)) { edit_state.SelectAll(); edit_state.CursorFollow = true; } - else if (is_shortcut_key_only && !is_password && ((IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_X) && is_editable) || IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_C)) && (!is_multiline || edit_state.HasSelection())) - { - // Cut, Copy - const bool cut = IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_X); - if (cut && !edit_state.HasSelection()) - edit_state.SelectAll(); - - if (io.SetClipboardTextFn) - { - const int ib = edit_state.HasSelection() ? ImMin(edit_state.StbState.select_start, edit_state.StbState.select_end) : 0; - const int ie = edit_state.HasSelection() ? ImMax(edit_state.StbState.select_start, edit_state.StbState.select_end) : edit_state.CurLenW; - edit_state.TempTextBuffer.resize((ie-ib) * 4 + 1); - ImTextStrToUtf8(edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data, edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Size, edit_state.Text.Data+ib, edit_state.Text.Data+ie); - SetClipboardText(edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data); - } - - if (cut) - { - edit_state.CursorFollow = true; - stb_textedit_cut(&edit_state, &edit_state.StbState); - } - } - else if (is_shortcut_key_only && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_V) && is_editable) - { - // Paste - if (const char* clipboard = GetClipboardText()) - { - // Filter pasted buffer - const int clipboard_len = (int)strlen(clipboard); - ImWchar* clipboard_filtered = (ImWchar*)ImGui::MemAlloc((clipboard_len+1) * sizeof(ImWchar)); - int clipboard_filtered_len = 0; - for (const char* s = clipboard; *s; ) - { - unsigned int c; - s += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, s, NULL); - if (c == 0) - break; - if (c >= 0x10000 || !InputTextFilterCharacter(&c, flags, callback, user_data)) - continue; - clipboard_filtered[clipboard_filtered_len++] = (ImWchar)c; - } - clipboard_filtered[clipboard_filtered_len] = 0; - if (clipboard_filtered_len > 0) // If everything was filtered, ignore the pasting operation - { - stb_textedit_paste(&edit_state, &edit_state.StbState, clipboard_filtered, clipboard_filtered_len); - edit_state.CursorFollow = true; - } - ImGui::MemFree(clipboard_filtered); - } - } - - if (cancel_edit) - { - // Restore initial value - if (is_editable) - { - ImStrncpy(buf, edit_state.InitialText.Data, buf_size); - value_changed = true; - } - } - else - { - // Apply new value immediately - copy modified buffer back - // Note that as soon as the input box is active, the in-widget value gets priority over any underlying modification of the input buffer - // FIXME: We actually always render 'buf' when calling DrawList->AddText, making the comment above incorrect. - // FIXME-OPT: CPU waste to do this every time the widget is active, should mark dirty state from the stb_textedit callbacks. - if (is_editable) - { - edit_state.TempTextBuffer.resize(edit_state.Text.Size * 4); - ImTextStrToUtf8(edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data, edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Size, edit_state.Text.Data, NULL); - } - - // User callback - if ((flags & (ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways)) != 0) - { - IM_ASSERT(callback != NULL); - - // The reason we specify the usage semantic (Completion/History) is that Completion needs to disable keyboard TABBING at the moment. - ImGuiInputTextFlags event_flag = 0; - ImGuiKey event_key = ImGuiKey_COUNT; - if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion) != 0 && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_Tab)) - { - event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion; - event_key = ImGuiKey_Tab; - } - else if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) != 0 && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_UpArrow)) - { - event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory; - event_key = ImGuiKey_UpArrow; - } - else if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory) != 0 && IsKeyPressedMap(ImGuiKey_DownArrow)) - { - event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory; - event_key = ImGuiKey_DownArrow; - } - else if (flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways) - event_flag = ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackAlways; - - if (event_flag) - { - ImGuiTextEditCallbackData callback_data; - memset(&callback_data, 0, sizeof(ImGuiTextEditCallbackData)); - callback_data.EventFlag = event_flag; - callback_data.Flags = flags; - callback_data.UserData = user_data; - callback_data.ReadOnly = !is_editable; - - callback_data.EventKey = event_key; - callback_data.Buf = edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data; - callback_data.BufTextLen = edit_state.CurLenA; - callback_data.BufSize = edit_state.BufSizeA; - callback_data.BufDirty = false; - - // We have to convert from wchar-positions to UTF-8-positions, which can be pretty slow (an incentive to ditch the ImWchar buffer, see https://github.com/nothings/stb/issues/188) - ImWchar* text = edit_state.Text.Data; - const int utf8_cursor_pos = callback_data.CursorPos = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(text, text + edit_state.StbState.cursor); - const int utf8_selection_start = callback_data.SelectionStart = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(text, text + edit_state.StbState.select_start); - const int utf8_selection_end = callback_data.SelectionEnd = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(text, text + edit_state.StbState.select_end); - - // Call user code - callback(&callback_data); - - // Read back what user may have modified - IM_ASSERT(callback_data.Buf == edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data); // Invalid to modify those fields - IM_ASSERT(callback_data.BufSize == edit_state.BufSizeA); - IM_ASSERT(callback_data.Flags == flags); - if (callback_data.CursorPos != utf8_cursor_pos) edit_state.StbState.cursor = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(callback_data.Buf, callback_data.Buf + callback_data.CursorPos); - if (callback_data.SelectionStart != utf8_selection_start) edit_state.StbState.select_start = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(callback_data.Buf, callback_data.Buf + callback_data.SelectionStart); - if (callback_data.SelectionEnd != utf8_selection_end) edit_state.StbState.select_end = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(callback_data.Buf, callback_data.Buf + callback_data.SelectionEnd); - if (callback_data.BufDirty) - { - IM_ASSERT(callback_data.BufTextLen == (int)strlen(callback_data.Buf)); // You need to maintain BufTextLen if you change the text! - edit_state.CurLenW = ImTextStrFromUtf8(edit_state.Text.Data, edit_state.Text.Size, callback_data.Buf, NULL); - edit_state.CurLenA = callback_data.BufTextLen; // Assume correct length and valid UTF-8 from user, saves us an extra strlen() - edit_state.CursorAnimReset(); - } - } - } - - // Copy back to user buffer - if (is_editable && strcmp(edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data, buf) != 0) - { - ImStrncpy(buf, edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data, buf_size); - value_changed = true; - } - } - } - - // Render - // Select which buffer we are going to display. When ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoLiveEdit is set 'buf' might still be the old value. We set buf to NULL to prevent accidental usage from now on. - const char* buf_display = (g.ActiveId == id && is_editable) ? edit_state.TempTextBuffer.Data : buf; buf = NULL; - - if (!is_multiline) - RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding); - - const ImVec4 clip_rect(frame_bb.Min.x, frame_bb.Min.y, frame_bb.Min.x + size.x, frame_bb.Min.y + size.y); // Not using frame_bb.Max because we have adjusted size - ImVec2 render_pos = is_multiline ? draw_window->DC.CursorPos : frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding; - ImVec2 text_size(0.f, 0.f); - const bool is_currently_scrolling = (edit_state.Id == id && is_multiline && g.ActiveId == draw_window->GetIDNoKeepAlive("#SCROLLY")); - if (g.ActiveId == id || is_currently_scrolling) - { - edit_state.CursorAnim += io.DeltaTime; - - // This is going to be messy. We need to: - // - Display the text (this alone can be more easily clipped) - // - Handle scrolling, highlight selection, display cursor (those all requires some form of 1d->2d cursor position calculation) - // - Measure text height (for scrollbar) - // We are attempting to do most of that in **one main pass** to minimize the computation cost (non-negligible for large amount of text) + 2nd pass for selection rendering (we could merge them by an extra refactoring effort) - // FIXME: This should occur on buf_display but we'd need to maintain cursor/select_start/select_end for UTF-8. - const ImWchar* text_begin = edit_state.Text.Data; - ImVec2 cursor_offset, select_start_offset; - - { - // Count lines + find lines numbers straddling 'cursor' and 'select_start' position. - const ImWchar* searches_input_ptr[2]; - searches_input_ptr[0] = text_begin + edit_state.StbState.cursor; - searches_input_ptr[1] = NULL; - int searches_remaining = 1; - int searches_result_line_number[2] = { -1, -999 }; - if (edit_state.StbState.select_start != edit_state.StbState.select_end) - { - searches_input_ptr[1] = text_begin + ImMin(edit_state.StbState.select_start, edit_state.StbState.select_end); - searches_result_line_number[1] = -1; - searches_remaining++; - } - - // Iterate all lines to find our line numbers - // In multi-line mode, we never exit the loop until all lines are counted, so add one extra to the searches_remaining counter. - searches_remaining += is_multiline ? 1 : 0; - int line_count = 0; - for (const ImWchar* s = text_begin; *s != 0; s++) - if (*s == '\n') - { - line_count++; - if (searches_result_line_number[0] == -1 && s >= searches_input_ptr[0]) { searches_result_line_number[0] = line_count; if (--searches_remaining <= 0) break; } - if (searches_result_line_number[1] == -1 && s >= searches_input_ptr[1]) { searches_result_line_number[1] = line_count; if (--searches_remaining <= 0) break; } - } - line_count++; - if (searches_result_line_number[0] == -1) searches_result_line_number[0] = line_count; - if (searches_result_line_number[1] == -1) searches_result_line_number[1] = line_count; - - // Calculate 2d position by finding the beginning of the line and measuring distance - cursor_offset.x = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(ImStrbolW(searches_input_ptr[0], text_begin), searches_input_ptr[0]).x; - cursor_offset.y = searches_result_line_number[0] * g.FontSize; - if (searches_result_line_number[1] >= 0) - { - select_start_offset.x = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(ImStrbolW(searches_input_ptr[1], text_begin), searches_input_ptr[1]).x; - select_start_offset.y = searches_result_line_number[1] * g.FontSize; - } - - // Calculate text height - if (is_multiline) - text_size = ImVec2(size.x, line_count * g.FontSize); - } - - // Scroll - if (edit_state.CursorFollow) - { - // Horizontal scroll in chunks of quarter width - if (!(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_NoHorizontalScroll)) - { - const float scroll_increment_x = size.x * 0.25f; - if (cursor_offset.x < edit_state.ScrollX) - edit_state.ScrollX = (float)(int)ImMax(0.0f, cursor_offset.x - scroll_increment_x); - else if (cursor_offset.x - size.x >= edit_state.ScrollX) - edit_state.ScrollX = (float)(int)(cursor_offset.x - size.x + scroll_increment_x); - } - else - { - edit_state.ScrollX = 0.0f; - } - - // Vertical scroll - if (is_multiline) - { - float scroll_y = draw_window->Scroll.y; - if (cursor_offset.y - g.FontSize < scroll_y) - scroll_y = ImMax(0.0f, cursor_offset.y - g.FontSize); - else if (cursor_offset.y - size.y >= scroll_y) - scroll_y = cursor_offset.y - size.y; - draw_window->DC.CursorPos.y += (draw_window->Scroll.y - scroll_y); // To avoid a frame of lag - draw_window->Scroll.y = scroll_y; - render_pos.y = draw_window->DC.CursorPos.y; - } - } - edit_state.CursorFollow = false; - const ImVec2 render_scroll = ImVec2(edit_state.ScrollX, 0.0f); - - // Draw selection - if (edit_state.StbState.select_start != edit_state.StbState.select_end) - { - const ImWchar* text_selected_begin = text_begin + ImMin(edit_state.StbState.select_start, edit_state.StbState.select_end); - const ImWchar* text_selected_end = text_begin + ImMax(edit_state.StbState.select_start, edit_state.StbState.select_end); - - float bg_offy_up = is_multiline ? 0.0f : -1.0f; // FIXME: those offsets should be part of the style? they don't play so well with multi-line selection. - float bg_offy_dn = is_multiline ? 0.0f : 2.0f; - ImU32 bg_color = GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_TextSelectedBg); - ImVec2 rect_pos = render_pos + select_start_offset - render_scroll; - for (const ImWchar* p = text_selected_begin; p < text_selected_end; ) - { - if (rect_pos.y > clip_rect.w + g.FontSize) - break; - if (rect_pos.y < clip_rect.y) - { - while (p < text_selected_end) - if (*p++ == '\n') - break; - } - else - { - ImVec2 rect_size = InputTextCalcTextSizeW(p, text_selected_end, &p, NULL, true); - if (rect_size.x <= 0.0f) rect_size.x = (float)(int)(g.Font->GetCharAdvance((unsigned short)' ') * 0.50f); // So we can see selected empty lines - ImRect rect(rect_pos + ImVec2(0.0f, bg_offy_up - g.FontSize), rect_pos +ImVec2(rect_size.x, bg_offy_dn)); - rect.Clip(clip_rect); - if (rect.Overlaps(clip_rect)) - draw_window->DrawList->AddRectFilled(rect.Min, rect.Max, bg_color); - } - rect_pos.x = render_pos.x - render_scroll.x; - rect_pos.y += g.FontSize; - } - } - - draw_window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, render_pos - render_scroll, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), buf_display, buf_display + edit_state.CurLenA, 0.0f, is_multiline ? NULL : &clip_rect); - - // Draw blinking cursor - bool cursor_is_visible = (g.InputTextState.CursorAnim <= 0.0f) || fmodf(g.InputTextState.CursorAnim, 1.20f) <= 0.80f; - ImVec2 cursor_screen_pos = render_pos + cursor_offset - render_scroll; - ImRect cursor_screen_rect(cursor_screen_pos.x, cursor_screen_pos.y-g.FontSize+0.5f, cursor_screen_pos.x+1.0f, cursor_screen_pos.y-1.5f); - if (cursor_is_visible && cursor_screen_rect.Overlaps(clip_rect)) - draw_window->DrawList->AddLine(cursor_screen_rect.Min, cursor_screen_rect.GetBL(), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text)); - - // Notify OS of text input position for advanced IME (-1 x offset so that Windows IME can cover our cursor. Bit of an extra nicety.) - if (is_editable) - g.OsImePosRequest = ImVec2(cursor_screen_pos.x - 1, cursor_screen_pos.y - g.FontSize); - } - else - { - // Render text only - const char* buf_end = NULL; - if (is_multiline) - text_size = ImVec2(size.x, InputTextCalcTextLenAndLineCount(buf_display, &buf_end) * g.FontSize); // We don't need width - draw_window->DrawList->AddText(g.Font, g.FontSize, render_pos, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), buf_display, buf_end, 0.0f, is_multiline ? NULL : &clip_rect); - } - - if (is_multiline) - { - Dummy(text_size + ImVec2(0.0f, g.FontSize)); // Always add room to scroll an extra line - EndChildFrame(); - EndGroup(); - } - - if (is_password) - PopFont(); - - // Log as text - if (g.LogEnabled && !is_password) - LogRenderedText(render_pos, buf_display, NULL); - - if (label_size.x > 0) - RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); - - if ((flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue) != 0) - return enter_pressed; - else - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::InputText(const char* label, char* buf, size_t buf_size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback, void* user_data) -{ - IM_ASSERT(!(flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline)); // call InputTextMultiline() - return InputTextEx(label, buf, (int)buf_size, ImVec2(0,0), flags, callback, user_data); -} - -bool ImGui::InputTextMultiline(const char* label, char* buf, size_t buf_size, const ImVec2& size, ImGuiInputTextFlags flags, ImGuiTextEditCallback callback, void* user_data) -{ - return InputTextEx(label, buf, (int)buf_size, size, flags | ImGuiInputTextFlags_Multiline, callback, user_data); -} - -// NB: scalar_format here must be a simple "%xx" format string with no prefix/suffix (unlike the Drag/Slider functions "display_format" argument) -bool ImGui::InputScalarEx(const char* label, ImGuiDataType data_type, void* data_ptr, void* step_ptr, void* step_fast_ptr, const char* scalar_format, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - - BeginGroup(); - PushID(label); - const ImVec2 button_sz = ImVec2(g.FontSize, g.FontSize) + style.FramePadding*2.0f; - if (step_ptr) - PushItemWidth(ImMax(1.0f, CalcItemWidth() - (button_sz.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x)*2)); - - char buf[64]; - DataTypeFormatString(data_type, data_ptr, scalar_format, buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); - - bool value_changed = false; - if (!(extra_flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal)) - extra_flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal; - extra_flags |= ImGuiInputTextFlags_AutoSelectAll; - if (InputText("", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), extra_flags)) // PushId(label) + "" gives us the expected ID from outside point of view - value_changed = DataTypeApplyOpFromText(buf, GImGui->InputTextState.InitialText.begin(), data_type, data_ptr, scalar_format); - - // Step buttons - if (step_ptr) - { - PopItemWidth(); - SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - if (ButtonEx("-", button_sz, ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat | ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups)) - { - DataTypeApplyOp(data_type, '-', data_ptr, g.IO.KeyCtrl && step_fast_ptr ? step_fast_ptr : step_ptr); - value_changed = true; - } - SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - if (ButtonEx("+", button_sz, ImGuiButtonFlags_Repeat | ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups)) - { - DataTypeApplyOp(data_type, '+', data_ptr, g.IO.KeyCtrl && step_fast_ptr ? step_fast_ptr : step_ptr); - value_changed = true; - } - } - PopID(); - - if (label_size.x > 0) - { - SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - RenderText(ImVec2(window->DC.CursorPos.x, window->DC.CursorPos.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); - ItemSize(label_size, style.FramePadding.y); - } - EndGroup(); - - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::InputFloat(const char* label, float* v, float step, float step_fast, int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags) -{ - char display_format[16]; - if (decimal_precision < 0) - strcpy(display_format, "%f"); // Ideally we'd have a minimum decimal precision of 1 to visually denote that this is a float, while hiding non-significant digits? %f doesn't have a minimum of 1 - else - ImFormatString(display_format, IM_ARRAYSIZE(display_format), "%%.%df", decimal_precision); - return InputScalarEx(label, ImGuiDataType_Float, (void*)v, (void*)(step>0.0f ? &step : NULL), (void*)(step_fast>0.0f ? &step_fast : NULL), display_format, extra_flags); -} - -bool ImGui::InputInt(const char* label, int* v, int step, int step_fast, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags) -{ - // Hexadecimal input provided as a convenience but the flag name is awkward. Typically you'd use InputText() to parse your own data, if you want to handle prefixes. - const char* scalar_format = (extra_flags & ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal) ? "%08X" : "%d"; - return InputScalarEx(label, ImGuiDataType_Int, (void*)v, (void*)(step>0.0f ? &step : NULL), (void*)(step_fast>0.0f ? &step_fast : NULL), scalar_format, extra_flags); -} - -bool ImGui::InputFloatN(const char* label, float* v, int components, int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - bool value_changed = false; - BeginGroup(); - PushID(label); - PushMultiItemsWidths(components); - for (int i = 0; i < components; i++) - { - PushID(i); - value_changed |= InputFloat("##v", &v[i], 0, 0, decimal_precision, extra_flags); - SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - PopID(); - PopItemWidth(); - } - PopID(); - - window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = ImMax(window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset, g.Style.FramePadding.y); - TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label)); - EndGroup(); - - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::InputFloat2(const char* label, float v[2], int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags) -{ - return InputFloatN(label, v, 2, decimal_precision, extra_flags); -} - -bool ImGui::InputFloat3(const char* label, float v[3], int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags) -{ - return InputFloatN(label, v, 3, decimal_precision, extra_flags); -} - -bool ImGui::InputFloat4(const char* label, float v[4], int decimal_precision, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags) -{ - return InputFloatN(label, v, 4, decimal_precision, extra_flags); -} - -bool ImGui::InputIntN(const char* label, int* v, int components, ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - bool value_changed = false; - BeginGroup(); - PushID(label); - PushMultiItemsWidths(components); - for (int i = 0; i < components; i++) - { - PushID(i); - value_changed |= InputInt("##v", &v[i], 0, 0, extra_flags); - SameLine(0, g.Style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - PopID(); - PopItemWidth(); - } - PopID(); - - window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = ImMax(window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset, g.Style.FramePadding.y); - TextUnformatted(label, FindRenderedTextEnd(label)); - EndGroup(); - - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::InputInt2(const char* label, int v[2], ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags) -{ - return InputIntN(label, v, 2, extra_flags); -} - -bool ImGui::InputInt3(const char* label, int v[3], ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags) -{ - return InputIntN(label, v, 3, extra_flags); -} - -bool ImGui::InputInt4(const char* label, int v[4], ImGuiInputTextFlags extra_flags) -{ - return InputIntN(label, v, 4, extra_flags); -} - -static bool Items_ArrayGetter(void* data, int idx, const char** out_text) -{ - const char* const* items = (const char* const*)data; - if (out_text) - *out_text = items[idx]; - return true; -} - -static bool Items_SingleStringGetter(void* data, int idx, const char** out_text) -{ - // FIXME-OPT: we could pre-compute the indices to fasten this. But only 1 active combo means the waste is limited. - const char* items_separated_by_zeros = (const char*)data; - int items_count = 0; - const char* p = items_separated_by_zeros; - while (*p) - { - if (idx == items_count) - break; - p += strlen(p) + 1; - items_count++; - } - if (!*p) - return false; - if (out_text) - *out_text = p; - return true; -} - -// Combo box helper allowing to pass an array of strings. -bool ImGui::Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* const* items, int items_count, int height_in_items) -{ - const bool value_changed = Combo(label, current_item, Items_ArrayGetter, (void*)items, items_count, height_in_items); - return value_changed; -} - -// Combo box helper allowing to pass all items in a single string. -bool ImGui::Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* items_separated_by_zeros, int height_in_items) -{ - int items_count = 0; - const char* p = items_separated_by_zeros; // FIXME-OPT: Avoid computing this, or at least only when combo is open - while (*p) - { - p += strlen(p) + 1; - items_count++; - } - bool value_changed = Combo(label, current_item, Items_SingleStringGetter, (void*)items_separated_by_zeros, items_count, height_in_items); - return value_changed; -} - -// Combo box function. -bool ImGui::Combo(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*items_getter)(void*, int, const char**), void* data, int items_count, int height_in_items) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); - const float w = CalcItemWidth(); - - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - const ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(w, label_size.y + style.FramePadding.y*2.0f)); - const ImRect total_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f)); - ItemSize(total_bb, style.FramePadding.y); - if (!ItemAdd(total_bb, &id)) - return false; - - const float arrow_size = (g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.x * 2.0f); - const bool hovered = IsHovered(frame_bb, id); - bool popup_open = IsPopupOpen(id); - bool popup_opened_now = false; - - const ImRect value_bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max - ImVec2(arrow_size, 0.0f)); - RenderFrame(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_FrameBg), true, style.FrameRounding); - RenderFrame(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x-arrow_size, frame_bb.Min.y), frame_bb.Max, GetColorU32(popup_open || hovered ? ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered : ImGuiCol_Button), true, style.FrameRounding); // FIXME-ROUNDING - RenderCollapseTriangle(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x-arrow_size, frame_bb.Min.y) + style.FramePadding, true); - - if (*current_item >= 0 && *current_item < items_count) - { - const char* item_text; - if (items_getter(data, *current_item, &item_text)) - RenderTextClipped(frame_bb.Min + style.FramePadding, value_bb.Max, item_text, NULL, NULL, ImVec2(0.0f,0.0f)); - } - - if (label_size.x > 0) - RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); - - if (hovered) - { - SetHoveredID(id); - if (g.IO.MouseClicked[0]) - { - ClearActiveID(); - if (IsPopupOpen(id)) - { - ClosePopup(id); - } - else - { - FocusWindow(window); - OpenPopup(label); - popup_open = popup_opened_now = true; - } - } - } - - bool value_changed = false; - if (IsPopupOpen(id)) - { - // Size default to hold ~7 items - if (height_in_items < 0) - height_in_items = 7; - - float popup_height = (label_size.y + style.ItemSpacing.y) * ImMin(items_count, height_in_items) + (style.FramePadding.y * 3); - float popup_y1 = frame_bb.Max.y; - float popup_y2 = ImClamp(popup_y1 + popup_height, popup_y1, g.IO.DisplaySize.y - style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding.y); - if ((popup_y2 - popup_y1) < ImMin(popup_height, frame_bb.Min.y - style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding.y)) - { - // Position our combo ABOVE because there's more space to fit! (FIXME: Handle in Begin() or use a shared helper. We have similar code in Begin() for popup placement) - popup_y1 = ImClamp(frame_bb.Min.y - popup_height, style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding.y, frame_bb.Min.y); - popup_y2 = frame_bb.Min.y; - } - ImRect popup_rect(ImVec2(frame_bb.Min.x, popup_y1), ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x, popup_y2)); - SetNextWindowPos(popup_rect.Min); - SetNextWindowSize(popup_rect.GetSize()); - PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowPadding, style.FramePadding); - - const ImGuiWindowFlags flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_ComboBox | ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders) ? ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders : 0); - if (BeginPopupEx(label, flags)) - { - // Display items - Spacing(); - for (int i = 0; i < items_count; i++) - { - PushID((void*)(intptr_t)i); - const bool item_selected = (i == *current_item); - const char* item_text; - if (!items_getter(data, i, &item_text)) - item_text = "*Unknown item*"; - if (Selectable(item_text, item_selected)) - { - ClearActiveID(); - value_changed = true; - *current_item = i; - } - if (item_selected && popup_opened_now) - SetScrollHere(); - PopID(); - } - EndPopup(); - } - PopStyleVar(); - } - return value_changed; -} - -// Tip: pass an empty label (e.g. "##dummy") then you can use the space to draw other text or image. -// But you need to make sure the ID is unique, e.g. enclose calls in PushID/PopID. -bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags, const ImVec2& size_arg) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - - if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) && window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1) - PopClipRect(); - - ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); - ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - ImVec2 size(size_arg.x != 0.0f ? size_arg.x : label_size.x, size_arg.y != 0.0f ? size_arg.y : label_size.y); - ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; - pos.y += window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset; - ImRect bb(pos, pos + size); - ItemSize(bb); - - // Fill horizontal space. - ImVec2 window_padding = window->WindowPadding; - float max_x = (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) ? GetWindowContentRegionMax().x : GetContentRegionMax().x; - float w_draw = ImMax(label_size.x, window->Pos.x + max_x - window_padding.x - window->DC.CursorPos.x); - ImVec2 size_draw((size_arg.x != 0 && !(flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawFillAvailWidth)) ? size_arg.x : w_draw, size_arg.y != 0.0f ? size_arg.y : size.y); - ImRect bb_with_spacing(pos, pos + size_draw); - if (size_arg.x == 0.0f || (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawFillAvailWidth)) - bb_with_spacing.Max.x += window_padding.x; - - // Selectables are tightly packed together, we extend the box to cover spacing between selectable. - float spacing_L = (float)(int)(style.ItemSpacing.x * 0.5f); - float spacing_U = (float)(int)(style.ItemSpacing.y * 0.5f); - float spacing_R = style.ItemSpacing.x - spacing_L; - float spacing_D = style.ItemSpacing.y - spacing_U; - bb_with_spacing.Min.x -= spacing_L; - bb_with_spacing.Min.y -= spacing_U; - bb_with_spacing.Max.x += spacing_R; - bb_with_spacing.Max.y += spacing_D; - if (!ItemAdd(bb_with_spacing, &id)) - { - if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) && window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1) - PushColumnClipRect(); - return false; - } - - ImGuiButtonFlags button_flags = 0; - if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Menu) button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick; - if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_MenuItem) button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClick|ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnRelease; - if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_Disabled; - if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowDoubleClick) button_flags |= ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnClickRelease | ImGuiButtonFlags_PressedOnDoubleClick; - bool hovered, held; - bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb_with_spacing, id, &hovered, &held, button_flags); - if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) - selected = false; - - // Render - if (hovered || selected) - { - const ImU32 col = GetColorU32((held && hovered) ? ImGuiCol_HeaderActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_HeaderHovered : ImGuiCol_Header); - RenderFrame(bb_with_spacing.Min, bb_with_spacing.Max, col, false, 0.0f); - } - - if ((flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns) && window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1) - { - PushColumnClipRect(); - bb_with_spacing.Max.x -= (GetContentRegionMax().x - max_x); - } - - if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]); - RenderTextClipped(bb.Min, bb_with_spacing.Max, label, NULL, &label_size, ImVec2(0.0f,0.0f)); - if (flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled) PopStyleColor(); - - // Automatically close popups - if (pressed && !(flags & ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups) && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup)) - CloseCurrentPopup(); - return pressed; -} - -bool ImGui::Selectable(const char* label, bool* p_selected, ImGuiSelectableFlags flags, const ImVec2& size_arg) -{ - if (Selectable(label, *p_selected, flags, size_arg)) - { - *p_selected = !*p_selected; - return true; - } - return false; -} - -// Helper to calculate the size of a listbox and display a label on the right. -// Tip: To have a list filling the entire window width, PushItemWidth(-1) and pass an empty label "##empty" -bool ImGui::ListBoxHeader(const char* label, const ImVec2& size_arg) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - const ImGuiStyle& style = GetStyle(); - const ImGuiID id = GetID(label); - const ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - - // Size default to hold ~7 items. Fractional number of items helps seeing that we can scroll down/up without looking at scrollbar. - ImVec2 size = CalcItemSize(size_arg, CalcItemWidth(), GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() * 7.4f + style.ItemSpacing.y); - ImVec2 frame_size = ImVec2(size.x, ImMax(size.y, label_size.y)); - ImRect frame_bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + frame_size); - ImRect bb(frame_bb.Min, frame_bb.Max + ImVec2(label_size.x > 0.0f ? style.ItemInnerSpacing.x + label_size.x : 0.0f, 0.0f)); - window->DC.LastItemRect = bb; - - BeginGroup(); - if (label_size.x > 0) - RenderText(ImVec2(frame_bb.Max.x + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x, frame_bb.Min.y + style.FramePadding.y), label); - - BeginChildFrame(id, frame_bb.GetSize()); - return true; -} - -bool ImGui::ListBoxHeader(const char* label, int items_count, int height_in_items) -{ - // Size default to hold ~7 items. Fractional number of items helps seeing that we can scroll down/up without looking at scrollbar. - // However we don't add +0.40f if items_count <= height_in_items. It is slightly dodgy, because it means a dynamic list of items will make the widget resize occasionally when it crosses that size. - // I am expecting that someone will come and complain about this behavior in a remote future, then we can advise on a better solution. - if (height_in_items < 0) - height_in_items = ImMin(items_count, 7); - float height_in_items_f = height_in_items < items_count ? (height_in_items + 0.40f) : (height_in_items + 0.00f); - - // We include ItemSpacing.y so that a list sized for the exact number of items doesn't make a scrollbar appears. We could also enforce that by passing a flag to BeginChild(). - ImVec2 size; - size.x = 0.0f; - size.y = GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing() * height_in_items_f + GetStyle().ItemSpacing.y; - return ListBoxHeader(label, size); -} - -void ImGui::ListBoxFooter() -{ - ImGuiWindow* parent_window = GetParentWindow(); - const ImRect bb = parent_window->DC.LastItemRect; - const ImGuiStyle& style = GetStyle(); - - EndChildFrame(); - - // Redeclare item size so that it includes the label (we have stored the full size in LastItemRect) - // We call SameLine() to restore DC.CurrentLine* data - SameLine(); - parent_window->DC.CursorPos = bb.Min; - ItemSize(bb, style.FramePadding.y); - EndGroup(); -} - -bool ImGui::ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, const char* const* items, int items_count, int height_items) -{ - const bool value_changed = ListBox(label, current_item, Items_ArrayGetter, (void*)items, items_count, height_items); - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::ListBox(const char* label, int* current_item, bool (*items_getter)(void*, int, const char**), void* data, int items_count, int height_in_items) -{ - if (!ListBoxHeader(label, items_count, height_in_items)) - return false; - - // Assume all items have even height (= 1 line of text). If you need items of different or variable sizes you can create a custom version of ListBox() in your code without using the clipper. - bool value_changed = false; - ImGuiListClipper clipper(items_count, GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing()); - while (clipper.Step()) - for (int i = clipper.DisplayStart; i < clipper.DisplayEnd; i++) - { - const bool item_selected = (i == *current_item); - const char* item_text; - if (!items_getter(data, i, &item_text)) - item_text = "*Unknown item*"; - - PushID(i); - if (Selectable(item_text, item_selected)) - { - *current_item = i; - value_changed = true; - } - PopID(); - } - ListBoxFooter(); - return value_changed; -} - -bool ImGui::MenuItem(const char* label, const char* shortcut, bool selected, bool enabled) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImVec2 pos = window->DC.CursorPos; - ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - ImVec2 shortcut_size = shortcut ? CalcTextSize(shortcut, NULL) : ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - float w = window->MenuColumns.DeclColumns(label_size.x, shortcut_size.x, (float)(int)(g.FontSize * 1.20f)); // Feedback for next frame - float extra_w = ImMax(0.0f, GetContentRegionAvail().x - w); - - bool pressed = Selectable(label, false, ImGuiSelectableFlags_MenuItem | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawFillAvailWidth | (enabled ? 0 : ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled), ImVec2(w, 0.0f)); - if (shortcut_size.x > 0.0f) - { - PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]); - RenderText(pos + ImVec2(window->MenuColumns.Pos[1] + extra_w, 0.0f), shortcut, NULL, false); - PopStyleColor(); - } - - if (selected) - RenderCheckMark(pos + ImVec2(window->MenuColumns.Pos[2] + extra_w + g.FontSize * 0.20f, 0.0f), GetColorU32(enabled ? ImGuiCol_Text : ImGuiCol_TextDisabled)); - - return pressed; -} - -bool ImGui::MenuItem(const char* label, const char* shortcut, bool* p_selected, bool enabled) -{ - if (MenuItem(label, shortcut, p_selected ? *p_selected : false, enabled)) - { - if (p_selected) - *p_selected = !*p_selected; - return true; - } - return false; -} - -bool ImGui::BeginMainMenuBar() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)); - SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(g.IO.DisplaySize.x, g.FontBaseSize + g.Style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f)); - PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowRounding, 0.0f); - PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_WindowMinSize, ImVec2(0,0)); - if (!Begin("##MainMenuBar", NULL, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings|ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar) - || !BeginMenuBar()) - { - End(); - PopStyleVar(2); - return false; - } - g.CurrentWindow->DC.MenuBarOffsetX += g.Style.DisplaySafeAreaPadding.x; - return true; -} - -void ImGui::EndMainMenuBar() -{ - EndMenuBar(); - End(); - PopStyleVar(2); -} - -bool ImGui::BeginMenuBar() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - if (!(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar)) - return false; - - IM_ASSERT(!window->DC.MenuBarAppending); - BeginGroup(); // Save position - PushID("##menubar"); - ImRect rect = window->MenuBarRect(); - PushClipRect(ImVec2(ImFloor(rect.Min.x+0.5f), ImFloor(rect.Min.y + window->BorderSize + 0.5f)), ImVec2(ImFloor(rect.Max.x+0.5f), ImFloor(rect.Max.y+0.5f)), false); - window->DC.CursorPos = ImVec2(rect.Min.x + window->DC.MenuBarOffsetX, rect.Min.y);// + g.Style.FramePadding.y); - window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal; - window->DC.MenuBarAppending = true; - AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets(); - return true; -} - -void ImGui::EndMenuBar() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - IM_ASSERT(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar); - IM_ASSERT(window->DC.MenuBarAppending); - PopClipRect(); - PopID(); - window->DC.MenuBarOffsetX = window->DC.CursorPos.x - window->MenuBarRect().Min.x; - window->DC.GroupStack.back().AdvanceCursor = false; - EndGroup(); - window->DC.LayoutType = ImGuiLayoutType_Vertical; - window->DC.MenuBarAppending = false; -} - -bool ImGui::BeginMenu(const char* label, bool enabled) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); - - ImVec2 label_size = CalcTextSize(label, NULL, true); - ImGuiWindow* backed_focused_window = g.FocusedWindow; - - bool pressed; - bool menu_is_open = IsPopupOpen(id); - bool menuset_is_open = !(window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup) && (g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.CurrentPopupStack.Size && g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size].ParentMenuSet == window->GetID("##menus")); - if (menuset_is_open) - g.FocusedWindow = window; - - ImVec2 popup_pos, pos = window->DC.CursorPos; - if (window->DC.LayoutType == ImGuiLayoutType_Horizontal) - { - popup_pos = ImVec2(pos.x - window->WindowPadding.x, pos.y - style.FramePadding.y + window->MenuBarHeight()); - window->DC.CursorPos.x += (float)(int)(style.ItemSpacing.x * 0.5f); - PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, style.ItemSpacing * 2.0f); - float w = label_size.x; - pressed = Selectable(label, menu_is_open, ImGuiSelectableFlags_Menu | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups | (!enabled ? ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled : 0), ImVec2(w, 0.0f)); - PopStyleVar(); - SameLine(); - window->DC.CursorPos.x += (float)(int)(style.ItemSpacing.x * 0.5f); - } - else - { - popup_pos = ImVec2(pos.x, pos.y - style.WindowPadding.y); - float w = window->MenuColumns.DeclColumns(label_size.x, 0.0f, (float)(int)(g.FontSize * 1.20f)); // Feedback to next frame - float extra_w = ImMax(0.0f, GetContentRegionAvail().x - w); - pressed = Selectable(label, menu_is_open, ImGuiSelectableFlags_Menu | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DontClosePopups | ImGuiSelectableFlags_DrawFillAvailWidth | (!enabled ? ImGuiSelectableFlags_Disabled : 0), ImVec2(w, 0.0f)); - if (!enabled) PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, g.Style.Colors[ImGuiCol_TextDisabled]); - RenderCollapseTriangle(pos + ImVec2(window->MenuColumns.Pos[2] + extra_w + g.FontSize * 0.20f, 0.0f), false); - if (!enabled) PopStyleColor(); - } - - bool hovered = enabled && IsHovered(window->DC.LastItemRect, id); - if (menuset_is_open) - g.FocusedWindow = backed_focused_window; - - bool want_open = false, want_close = false; - if (window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup|ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)) - { - // Implement http://bjk5.com/post/44698559168/breaking-down-amazons-mega-dropdown to avoid using timers, so menus feels more reactive. - bool moving_within_opened_triangle = false; - if (g.HoveredWindow == window && g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.CurrentPopupStack.Size && g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size].ParentWindow == window) - { - if (ImGuiWindow* next_window = g.OpenPopupStack[g.CurrentPopupStack.Size].Window) - { - ImRect next_window_rect = next_window->Rect(); - ImVec2 ta = g.IO.MousePos - g.IO.MouseDelta; - ImVec2 tb = (window->Pos.x < next_window->Pos.x) ? next_window_rect.GetTL() : next_window_rect.GetTR(); - ImVec2 tc = (window->Pos.x < next_window->Pos.x) ? next_window_rect.GetBL() : next_window_rect.GetBR(); - float extra = ImClamp(fabsf(ta.x - tb.x) * 0.30f, 5.0f, 30.0f); // add a bit of extra slack. - ta.x += (window->Pos.x < next_window->Pos.x) ? -0.5f : +0.5f; // to avoid numerical issues - tb.y = ta.y + ImMax((tb.y - extra) - ta.y, -100.0f); // triangle is maximum 200 high to limit the slope and the bias toward large sub-menus // FIXME: Multiply by fb_scale? - tc.y = ta.y + ImMin((tc.y + extra) - ta.y, +100.0f); - moving_within_opened_triangle = ImIsPointInTriangle(g.IO.MousePos, ta, tb, tc); - //window->DrawList->PushClipRectFullScreen(); window->DrawList->AddTriangleFilled(ta, tb, tc, moving_within_opened_triangle ? IM_COL32(0,128,0,128) : IM_COL32(128,0,0,128)); window->DrawList->PopClipRect(); // Debug - } - } - - want_close = (menu_is_open && !hovered && g.HoveredWindow == window && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != 0 && g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame != id && !moving_within_opened_triangle); - want_open = (!menu_is_open && hovered && !moving_within_opened_triangle) || (!menu_is_open && hovered && pressed); - } - else if (menu_is_open && pressed && menuset_is_open) // menu-bar: click open menu to close - { - want_close = true; - want_open = menu_is_open = false; - } - else if (pressed || (hovered && menuset_is_open && !menu_is_open)) // menu-bar: first click to open, then hover to open others - want_open = true; - if (!enabled) // explicitly close if an open menu becomes disabled, facilitate users code a lot in pattern such as 'if (BeginMenu("options", has_object)) { ..use object.. }' - want_close = true; - if (want_close && IsPopupOpen(id)) - ClosePopupToLevel(GImGui->CurrentPopupStack.Size); - - if (!menu_is_open && want_open && g.OpenPopupStack.Size > g.CurrentPopupStack.Size) - { - // Don't recycle same menu level in the same frame, first close the other menu and yield for a frame. - OpenPopup(label); - return false; - } - - menu_is_open |= want_open; - if (want_open) - OpenPopup(label); - - if (menu_is_open) - { - SetNextWindowPos(popup_pos, ImGuiSetCond_Always); - ImGuiWindowFlags flags = ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders | ((window->Flags & (ImGuiWindowFlags_Popup|ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu)) ? ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu|ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow : ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu); - menu_is_open = BeginPopupEx(label, flags); // menu_is_open can be 'false' when the popup is completely clipped (e.g. zero size display) - } - - return menu_is_open; -} - -void ImGui::EndMenu() -{ - EndPopup(); -} - -// A little colored square. Return true when clicked. -// FIXME: May want to display/ignore the alpha component in the color display? Yet show it in the tooltip. -bool ImGui::ColorButton(const ImVec4& col, bool small_height, bool outline_border) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID("#colorbutton"); - const float square_size = g.FontSize; - const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + ImVec2(square_size + style.FramePadding.y*2, square_size + (small_height ? 0 : style.FramePadding.y*2))); - ItemSize(bb, small_height ? 0.0f : style.FramePadding.y); - if (!ItemAdd(bb, &id)) - return false; - - bool hovered, held; - bool pressed = ButtonBehavior(bb, id, &hovered, &held); - RenderFrame(bb.Min, bb.Max, GetColorU32(col), outline_border, style.FrameRounding); - - if (hovered) - SetTooltip("Color:\n(%.2f,%.2f,%.2f,%.2f)\n#%02X%02X%02X%02X", col.x, col.y, col.z, col.w, IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col.x), IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col.y), IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col.z), IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col.z)); - - return pressed; -} - -bool ImGui::ColorEdit3(const char* label, float col[3]) -{ - float col4[4]; - col4[0] = col[0]; - col4[1] = col[1]; - col4[2] = col[2]; - col4[3] = 1.0f; - const bool value_changed = ColorEdit4(label, col4, false); - col[0] = col4[0]; - col[1] = col4[1]; - col[2] = col4[2]; - return value_changed; -} - -// Edit colors components (each component in 0.0f..1.0f range -// Use CTRL-Click to input value and TAB to go to next item. -bool ImGui::ColorEdit4(const char* label, float col[4], bool alpha) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return false; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - const ImGuiStyle& style = g.Style; - const ImGuiID id = window->GetID(label); - const float w_full = CalcItemWidth(); - const float square_sz = (g.FontSize + style.FramePadding.y * 2.0f); - - ImGuiColorEditMode edit_mode = window->DC.ColorEditMode; - if (edit_mode == ImGuiColorEditMode_UserSelect || edit_mode == ImGuiColorEditMode_UserSelectShowButton) - edit_mode = g.ColorEditModeStorage.GetInt(id, 0) % 3; - - float f[4] = { col[0], col[1], col[2], col[3] }; - if (edit_mode == ImGuiColorEditMode_HSV) - ColorConvertRGBtoHSV(f[0], f[1], f[2], f[0], f[1], f[2]); - - int i[4] = { IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[0]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[1]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[2]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_UNBOUND(f[3]) }; - - int components = alpha ? 4 : 3; - bool value_changed = false; - - BeginGroup(); - PushID(label); - - const bool hsv = (edit_mode == 1); - switch (edit_mode) - { - case ImGuiColorEditMode_RGB: - case ImGuiColorEditMode_HSV: - { - // RGB/HSV 0..255 Sliders - const float w_items_all = w_full - (square_sz + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - const float w_item_one = ImMax(1.0f, (float)(int)((w_items_all - (style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components-1)) / (float)components)); - const float w_item_last = ImMax(1.0f, (float)(int)(w_items_all - (w_item_one + style.ItemInnerSpacing.x) * (components-1))); - - const bool hide_prefix = (w_item_one <= CalcTextSize("M:999").x); - const char* ids[4] = { "##X", "##Y", "##Z", "##W" }; - const char* fmt_table[3][4] = - { - { "%3.0f", "%3.0f", "%3.0f", "%3.0f" }, - { "R:%3.0f", "G:%3.0f", "B:%3.0f", "A:%3.0f" }, - { "H:%3.0f", "S:%3.0f", "V:%3.0f", "A:%3.0f" } - }; - const char** fmt = hide_prefix ? fmt_table[0] : hsv ? fmt_table[2] : fmt_table[1]; - - PushItemWidth(w_item_one); - for (int n = 0; n < components; n++) - { - if (n > 0) - SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - if (n + 1 == components) - PushItemWidth(w_item_last); - value_changed |= DragInt(ids[n], &i[n], 1.0f, 0, 255, fmt[n]); - } - PopItemWidth(); - PopItemWidth(); - } - break; - case ImGuiColorEditMode_HEX: - { - // RGB Hexadecimal Input - const float w_slider_all = w_full - square_sz; - char buf[64]; - if (alpha) - ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "#%02X%02X%02X%02X", i[0], i[1], i[2], i[3]); - else - ImFormatString(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), "#%02X%02X%02X", i[0], i[1], i[2]); - PushItemWidth(w_slider_all - style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - if (InputText("##Text", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase)) - { - value_changed |= true; - char* p = buf; - while (*p == '#' || ImCharIsSpace(*p)) - p++; - i[0] = i[1] = i[2] = i[3] = 0; - if (alpha) - sscanf(p, "%02X%02X%02X%02X", (unsigned int*)&i[0], (unsigned int*)&i[1], (unsigned int*)&i[2], (unsigned int*)&i[3]); // Treat at unsigned (%X is unsigned) - else - sscanf(p, "%02X%02X%02X", (unsigned int*)&i[0], (unsigned int*)&i[1], (unsigned int*)&i[2]); - } - PopItemWidth(); - } - break; - } - - SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - - const ImVec4 col_display(col[0], col[1], col[2], 1.0f); - if (ColorButton(col_display)) - g.ColorEditModeStorage.SetInt(id, (edit_mode + 1) % 3); // Don't set local copy of 'edit_mode' right away! - - // Recreate our own tooltip over's ColorButton() one because we want to display correct alpha here - if (IsItemHovered()) - SetTooltip("Color:\n(%.2f,%.2f,%.2f,%.2f)\n#%02X%02X%02X%02X", col[0], col[1], col[2], col[3], IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[0]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[1]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[2]), IM_F32_TO_INT8_SAT(col[3])); - - if (window->DC.ColorEditMode == ImGuiColorEditMode_UserSelectShowButton) - { - SameLine(0, style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - const char* button_titles[3] = { "RGB", "HSV", "HEX" }; - if (ButtonEx(button_titles[edit_mode], ImVec2(0,0), ImGuiButtonFlags_DontClosePopups)) - g.ColorEditModeStorage.SetInt(id, (edit_mode + 1) % 3); // Don't set local copy of 'edit_mode' right away! - } - - const char* label_display_end = FindRenderedTextEnd(label); - if (label != label_display_end) - { - SameLine(0, (window->DC.ColorEditMode == ImGuiColorEditMode_UserSelectShowButton) ? -1.0f : style.ItemInnerSpacing.x); - TextUnformatted(label, label_display_end); - } - - // Convert back - for (int n = 0; n < 4; n++) - f[n] = i[n] / 255.0f; - if (edit_mode == 1) - ColorConvertHSVtoRGB(f[0], f[1], f[2], f[0], f[1], f[2]); - - if (value_changed) - { - col[0] = f[0]; - col[1] = f[1]; - col[2] = f[2]; - if (alpha) - col[3] = f[3]; - } - - PopID(); - EndGroup(); - - return value_changed; -} - -void ImGui::ColorEditMode(ImGuiColorEditMode mode) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.ColorEditMode = mode; -} - -// Horizontal separating line. -void ImGui::Separator() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - if (window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1) - PopClipRect(); - - float x1 = window->Pos.x; - float x2 = window->Pos.x + window->Size.x; - if (!window->DC.GroupStack.empty()) - x1 += window->DC.IndentX; - - const ImRect bb(ImVec2(x1, window->DC.CursorPos.y), ImVec2(x2, window->DC.CursorPos.y+1.0f)); - ItemSize(ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f)); // NB: we don't provide our width so that it doesn't get feed back into AutoFit, we don't provide height to not alter layout. - if (!ItemAdd(bb, NULL)) - { - if (window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1) - PushColumnClipRect(); - return; - } - - window->DrawList->AddLine(bb.Min, ImVec2(bb.Max.x,bb.Min.y), GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Border)); - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.LogEnabled) - LogText(IM_NEWLINE "--------------------------------"); - - if (window->DC.ColumnsCount > 1) - { - PushColumnClipRect(); - window->DC.ColumnsCellMinY = window->DC.CursorPos.y; - } -} - -void ImGui::Spacing() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - ItemSize(ImVec2(0,0)); -} - -void ImGui::Dummy(const ImVec2& size) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - const ImRect bb(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size); - ItemSize(bb); - ItemAdd(bb, NULL); -} - -bool ImGui::IsRectVisible(const ImVec2& size) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->ClipRect.Overlaps(ImRect(window->DC.CursorPos, window->DC.CursorPos + size)); -} - -bool ImGui::IsRectVisible(const ImVec2& rect_min, const ImVec2& rect_max) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->ClipRect.Overlaps(ImRect(rect_min, rect_max)); -} - -// Lock horizontal starting position + capture group bounding box into one "item" (so you can use IsItemHovered() or layout primitives such as SameLine() on whole group, etc.) -void ImGui::BeginGroup() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - - window->DC.GroupStack.resize(window->DC.GroupStack.Size + 1); - ImGuiGroupData& group_data = window->DC.GroupStack.back(); - group_data.BackupCursorPos = window->DC.CursorPos; - group_data.BackupCursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorMaxPos; - group_data.BackupIndentX = window->DC.IndentX; - group_data.BackupGroupOffsetX = window->DC.GroupOffsetX; - group_data.BackupCurrentLineHeight = window->DC.CurrentLineHeight; - group_data.BackupCurrentLineTextBaseOffset = window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset; - group_data.BackupLogLinePosY = window->DC.LogLinePosY; - group_data.BackupActiveIdIsAlive = GImGui->ActiveIdIsAlive; - group_data.AdvanceCursor = true; - - window->DC.GroupOffsetX = window->DC.CursorPos.x - window->Pos.x - window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX; - window->DC.IndentX = window->DC.GroupOffsetX; - window->DC.CursorMaxPos = window->DC.CursorPos; - window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = 0.0f; - window->DC.LogLinePosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y - 9999.0f; -} - -void ImGui::EndGroup() -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - - IM_ASSERT(!window->DC.GroupStack.empty()); // Mismatched BeginGroup()/EndGroup() calls - - ImGuiGroupData& group_data = window->DC.GroupStack.back(); - - ImRect group_bb(group_data.BackupCursorPos, window->DC.CursorMaxPos); - group_bb.Max.y -= g.Style.ItemSpacing.y; // Cancel out last vertical spacing because we are adding one ourselves. - group_bb.Max = ImMax(group_bb.Min, group_bb.Max); - - window->DC.CursorPos = group_data.BackupCursorPos; - window->DC.CursorMaxPos = ImMax(group_data.BackupCursorMaxPos, window->DC.CursorMaxPos); - window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = group_data.BackupCurrentLineHeight; - window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = group_data.BackupCurrentLineTextBaseOffset; - window->DC.IndentX = group_data.BackupIndentX; - window->DC.GroupOffsetX = group_data.BackupGroupOffsetX; - window->DC.LogLinePosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y - 9999.0f; - - if (group_data.AdvanceCursor) - { - window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = ImMax(window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset, group_data.BackupCurrentLineTextBaseOffset); // FIXME: Incorrect, we should grab the base offset from the *first line* of the group but it is hard to obtain now. - ItemSize(group_bb.GetSize(), group_data.BackupCurrentLineTextBaseOffset); - ItemAdd(group_bb, NULL); - } - - // If the current ActiveId was declared within the boundary of our group, we copy it to LastItemId so IsItemActive() will function on the entire group. - // It would be be neater if we replaced window.DC.LastItemId by e.g. 'bool LastItemIsActive', but if you search for LastItemId you'll notice it is only used in that context. - const bool active_id_within_group = (!group_data.BackupActiveIdIsAlive && g.ActiveIdIsAlive && g.ActiveId && g.ActiveIdWindow->RootWindow == window->RootWindow); - if (active_id_within_group) - window->DC.LastItemId = g.ActiveId; - if (active_id_within_group && g.HoveredId == g.ActiveId) - window->DC.LastItemHoveredAndUsable = window->DC.LastItemHoveredRect = true; - - window->DC.GroupStack.pop_back(); - - //window->DrawList->AddRect(group_bb.Min, group_bb.Max, IM_COL32(255,0,255,255)); // Debug -} - -// Gets back to previous line and continue with horizontal layout -// pos_x == 0 : follow right after previous item -// pos_x != 0 : align to specified x position (relative to window/group left) -// spacing_w < 0 : use default spacing if pos_x == 0, no spacing if pos_x != 0 -// spacing_w >= 0 : enforce spacing amount -void ImGui::SameLine(float pos_x, float spacing_w) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (pos_x != 0.0f) - { - if (spacing_w < 0.0f) spacing_w = 0.0f; - window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->Pos.x - window->Scroll.x + pos_x + spacing_w + window->DC.GroupOffsetX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX; - window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y; - } - else - { - if (spacing_w < 0.0f) spacing_w = g.Style.ItemSpacing.x; - window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.x + spacing_w; - window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->DC.CursorPosPrevLine.y; - } - window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = window->DC.PrevLineHeight; - window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = window->DC.PrevLineTextBaseOffset; -} - -void ImGui::NewLine() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems) - return; - if (window->DC.CurrentLineHeight > 0.0f) // In the event that we are on a line with items that is smaller that FontSize high, we will preserve its height. - ItemSize(ImVec2(0,0)); - else - ItemSize(ImVec2(0.0f, GImGui->FontSize)); -} - -void ImGui::NextColumn() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (window->SkipItems || window->DC.ColumnsCount <= 1) - return; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - PopItemWidth(); - PopClipRect(); - - window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY = ImMax(window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY, window->DC.CursorPos.y); - if (++window->DC.ColumnsCurrent < window->DC.ColumnsCount) - { - // Columns 1+ cancel out IndentX - window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX = GetColumnOffset(window->DC.ColumnsCurrent) - window->DC.IndentX + g.Style.ItemSpacing.x; - window->DrawList->ChannelsSetCurrent(window->DC.ColumnsCurrent); - } - else - { - window->DC.ColumnsCurrent = 0; - window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX = 0.0f; - window->DC.ColumnsCellMinY = window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY; - window->DrawList->ChannelsSetCurrent(0); - } - window->DC.CursorPos.x = (float)(int)(window->Pos.x + window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX); - window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->DC.ColumnsCellMinY; - window->DC.CurrentLineHeight = 0.0f; - window->DC.CurrentLineTextBaseOffset = 0.0f; - - PushColumnClipRect(); - PushItemWidth(GetColumnWidth() * 0.65f); // FIXME: Move on columns setup -} - -int ImGui::GetColumnIndex() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.ColumnsCurrent; -} - -int ImGui::GetColumnsCount() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - return window->DC.ColumnsCount; -} - -static float GetDraggedColumnOffset(int column_index) -{ - // Active (dragged) column always follow mouse. The reason we need this is that dragging a column to the right edge of an auto-resizing - // window creates a feedback loop because we store normalized positions. So while dragging we enforce absolute positioning. - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = ImGui::GetCurrentWindowRead(); - IM_ASSERT(column_index > 0); // We cannot drag column 0. If you get this assert you may have a conflict between the ID of your columns and another widgets. - IM_ASSERT(g.ActiveId == window->DC.ColumnsSetId + ImGuiID(column_index)); - - float x = g.IO.MousePos.x - g.ActiveIdClickOffset.x - window->Pos.x; - x = ImClamp(x, ImGui::GetColumnOffset(column_index-1)+g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing, ImGui::GetColumnOffset(column_index+1)-g.Style.ColumnsMinSpacing); - - return (float)(int)x; -} - -float ImGui::GetColumnOffset(int column_index) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - if (column_index < 0) - column_index = window->DC.ColumnsCurrent; - - if (g.ActiveId) - { - const ImGuiID column_id = window->DC.ColumnsSetId + ImGuiID(column_index); - if (g.ActiveId == column_id) - return GetDraggedColumnOffset(column_index); - } - - IM_ASSERT(column_index < window->DC.ColumnsData.Size); - const float t = window->DC.ColumnsData[column_index].OffsetNorm; - const float x_offset = window->DC.ColumnsMinX + t * (window->DC.ColumnsMaxX - window->DC.ColumnsMinX); - return (float)(int)x_offset; -} - -void ImGui::SetColumnOffset(int column_index, float offset) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - if (column_index < 0) - column_index = window->DC.ColumnsCurrent; - - IM_ASSERT(column_index < window->DC.ColumnsData.Size); - const float t = (offset - window->DC.ColumnsMinX) / (window->DC.ColumnsMaxX - window->DC.ColumnsMinX); - window->DC.ColumnsData[column_index].OffsetNorm = t; - - const ImGuiID column_id = window->DC.ColumnsSetId + ImGuiID(column_index); - window->DC.StateStorage->SetFloat(column_id, t); -} - -float ImGui::GetColumnWidth(int column_index) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindowRead(); - if (column_index < 0) - column_index = window->DC.ColumnsCurrent; - - float w = GetColumnOffset(column_index+1) - GetColumnOffset(column_index); - return w; -} - -static void PushColumnClipRect(int column_index) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = ImGui::GetCurrentWindow(); - if (column_index < 0) - column_index = window->DC.ColumnsCurrent; - - float x1 = ImFloor(0.5f + window->Pos.x + ImGui::GetColumnOffset(column_index) - 1.0f); - float x2 = ImFloor(0.5f + window->Pos.x + ImGui::GetColumnOffset(column_index+1) - 1.0f); - ImGui::PushClipRect(ImVec2(x1,-FLT_MAX), ImVec2(x2,+FLT_MAX), true); -} - -void ImGui::Columns(int columns_count, const char* id, bool border) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - IM_ASSERT(columns_count >= 1); - - if (window->DC.ColumnsCount != 1) - { - if (window->DC.ColumnsCurrent != 0) - ItemSize(ImVec2(0,0)); // Advance to column 0 - PopItemWidth(); - PopClipRect(); - window->DrawList->ChannelsMerge(); - - window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY = ImMax(window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY, window->DC.CursorPos.y); - window->DC.CursorPos.y = window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY; - } - - // Draw columns borders and handle resize at the time of "closing" a columns set - if (window->DC.ColumnsCount != columns_count && window->DC.ColumnsCount != 1 && window->DC.ColumnsShowBorders && !window->SkipItems) - { - const float y1 = window->DC.ColumnsStartPosY; - const float y2 = window->DC.CursorPos.y; - for (int i = 1; i < window->DC.ColumnsCount; i++) - { - float x = window->Pos.x + GetColumnOffset(i); - const ImGuiID column_id = window->DC.ColumnsSetId + ImGuiID(i); - const ImRect column_rect(ImVec2(x-4,y1),ImVec2(x+4,y2)); - if (IsClippedEx(column_rect, &column_id, false)) - continue; - - bool hovered, held; - ButtonBehavior(column_rect, column_id, &hovered, &held); - if (hovered || held) - g.MouseCursor = ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW; - - // Draw before resize so our items positioning are in sync with the line being drawn - const ImU32 col = GetColorU32(held ? ImGuiCol_ColumnActive : hovered ? ImGuiCol_ColumnHovered : ImGuiCol_Column); - const float xi = (float)(int)x; - window->DrawList->AddLine(ImVec2(xi, y1+1.0f), ImVec2(xi, y2), col); - - if (held) - { - if (g.ActiveIdIsJustActivated) - g.ActiveIdClickOffset.x -= 4; // Store from center of column line (we used a 8 wide rect for columns clicking) - x = GetDraggedColumnOffset(i); - SetColumnOffset(i, x); - } - } - } - - // Differentiate column ID with an arbitrary prefix for cases where users name their columns set the same as another widget. - // In addition, when an identifier isn't explicitly provided we include the number of columns in the hash to make it uniquer. - PushID(0x11223347 + (id ? 0 : columns_count)); - window->DC.ColumnsSetId = window->GetID(id ? id : "columns"); - PopID(); - - // Set state for first column - window->DC.ColumnsCurrent = 0; - window->DC.ColumnsCount = columns_count; - window->DC.ColumnsShowBorders = border; - - const float content_region_width = (window->SizeContentsExplicit.x != 0.0f) ? window->SizeContentsExplicit.x : window->Size.x; - window->DC.ColumnsMinX = window->DC.IndentX; // Lock our horizontal range - window->DC.ColumnsMaxX = content_region_width - window->Scroll.x - ((window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar) ? 0 : g.Style.ScrollbarSize);// - window->WindowPadding().x; - window->DC.ColumnsStartPosY = window->DC.CursorPos.y; - window->DC.ColumnsCellMinY = window->DC.ColumnsCellMaxY = window->DC.CursorPos.y; - window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX = 0.0f; - window->DC.CursorPos.x = (float)(int)(window->Pos.x + window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX); - - if (window->DC.ColumnsCount != 1) - { - // Cache column offsets - window->DC.ColumnsData.resize(columns_count + 1); - for (int column_index = 0; column_index < columns_count + 1; column_index++) - { - const ImGuiID column_id = window->DC.ColumnsSetId + ImGuiID(column_index); - KeepAliveID(column_id); - const float default_t = column_index / (float)window->DC.ColumnsCount; - const float t = window->DC.StateStorage->GetFloat(column_id, default_t); // Cheaply store our floating point value inside the integer (could store a union into the map?) - window->DC.ColumnsData[column_index].OffsetNorm = t; - } - window->DrawList->ChannelsSplit(window->DC.ColumnsCount); - PushColumnClipRect(); - PushItemWidth(GetColumnWidth() * 0.65f); - } - else - { - window->DC.ColumnsData.resize(0); - } -} - -void ImGui::Indent(float indent_w) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.IndentX += (indent_w > 0.0f) ? indent_w : g.Style.IndentSpacing; - window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->Pos.x + window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX; -} - -void ImGui::Unindent(float indent_w) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - window->DC.IndentX -= (indent_w > 0.0f) ? indent_w : g.Style.IndentSpacing; - window->DC.CursorPos.x = window->Pos.x + window->DC.IndentX + window->DC.ColumnsOffsetX; -} - -void ImGui::TreePush(const char* str_id) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - Indent(); - window->DC.TreeDepth++; - PushID(str_id ? str_id : "#TreePush"); -} - -void ImGui::TreePush(const void* ptr_id) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - Indent(); - window->DC.TreeDepth++; - PushID(ptr_id ? ptr_id : (const void*)"#TreePush"); -} - -void ImGui::TreePushRawID(ImGuiID id) -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - Indent(); - window->DC.TreeDepth++; - window->IDStack.push_back(id); -} - -void ImGui::TreePop() -{ - ImGuiWindow* window = GetCurrentWindow(); - Unindent(); - window->DC.TreeDepth--; - PopID(); -} - -void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, bool b) -{ - Text("%s: %s", prefix, (b ? "true" : "false")); -} - -void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, int v) -{ - Text("%s: %d", prefix, v); -} - -void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, unsigned int v) -{ - Text("%s: %d", prefix, v); -} - -void ImGui::Value(const char* prefix, float v, const char* float_format) -{ - if (float_format) - { - char fmt[64]; - ImFormatString(fmt, IM_ARRAYSIZE(fmt), "%%s: %s", float_format); - Text(fmt, prefix, v); - } - else - { - Text("%s: %.3f", prefix, v); - } -} - -// FIXME: May want to remove those helpers? -void ImGui::ValueColor(const char* prefix, const ImVec4& v) -{ - Text("%s: (%.2f,%.2f,%.2f,%.2f)", prefix, v.x, v.y, v.z, v.w); - SameLine(); - ColorButton(v, true); -} - -void ImGui::ValueColor(const char* prefix, ImU32 v) -{ - Text("%s: %08X", prefix, v); - SameLine(); - ColorButton(ColorConvertU32ToFloat4(v), true); -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// PLATFORM DEPENDENT HELPERS -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(_WINDOWS_) && (!defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCS) || !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCS)) -#undef WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN -#define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN -#include -#endif - -// Win32 API clipboard implementation -#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_CLIPBOARD_FUNCS) - -#ifdef _MSC_VER -#pragma comment(lib, "user32") -#endif - -static const char* GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*) -{ - static ImVector buf_local; - buf_local.clear(); - if (!OpenClipboard(NULL)) - return NULL; - HANDLE wbuf_handle = GetClipboardData(CF_UNICODETEXT); - if (wbuf_handle == NULL) - return NULL; - if (ImWchar* wbuf_global = (ImWchar*)GlobalLock(wbuf_handle)) - { - int buf_len = ImTextCountUtf8BytesFromStr(wbuf_global, NULL) + 1; - buf_local.resize(buf_len); - ImTextStrToUtf8(buf_local.Data, buf_len, wbuf_global, NULL); - } - GlobalUnlock(wbuf_handle); - CloseClipboard(); - return buf_local.Data; -} - -static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*, const char* text) -{ - if (!OpenClipboard(NULL)) - return; - const int wbuf_length = ImTextCountCharsFromUtf8(text, NULL) + 1; - HGLOBAL wbuf_handle = GlobalAlloc(GMEM_MOVEABLE, (SIZE_T)wbuf_length * sizeof(ImWchar)); - if (wbuf_handle == NULL) - return; - ImWchar* wbuf_global = (ImWchar*)GlobalLock(wbuf_handle); - ImTextStrFromUtf8(wbuf_global, wbuf_length, text, NULL); - GlobalUnlock(wbuf_handle); - EmptyClipboard(); - SetClipboardData(CF_UNICODETEXT, wbuf_handle); - CloseClipboard(); -} - -#else - -// Local ImGui-only clipboard implementation, if user hasn't defined better clipboard handlers -static const char* GetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*) -{ - return GImGui->PrivateClipboard; -} - -// Local ImGui-only clipboard implementation, if user hasn't defined better clipboard handlers -static void SetClipboardTextFn_DefaultImpl(void*, const char* text) -{ - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.PrivateClipboard) - { - ImGui::MemFree(g.PrivateClipboard); - g.PrivateClipboard = NULL; - } - const char* text_end = text + strlen(text); - g.PrivateClipboard = (char*)ImGui::MemAlloc((size_t)(text_end - text) + 1); - memcpy(g.PrivateClipboard, text, (size_t)(text_end - text)); - g.PrivateClipboard[(int)(text_end - text)] = 0; -} - -#endif - -// Win32 API IME support (for Asian languages, etc.) -#if defined(_WIN32) && !defined(__GNUC__) && !defined(IMGUI_DISABLE_WIN32_DEFAULT_IME_FUNCS) - -#include -#ifdef _MSC_VER -#pragma comment(lib, "imm32") -#endif - -static void ImeSetInputScreenPosFn_DefaultImpl(int x, int y) -{ - // Notify OS Input Method Editor of text input position - if (HWND hwnd = (HWND)GImGui->IO.ImeWindowHandle) - if (HIMC himc = ImmGetContext(hwnd)) - { - COMPOSITIONFORM cf; - cf.ptCurrentPos.x = x; - cf.ptCurrentPos.y = y; - cf.dwStyle = CFS_FORCE_POSITION; - ImmSetCompositionWindow(himc, &cf); - } -} - -#else - -static void ImeSetInputScreenPosFn_DefaultImpl(int, int) {} - -#endif - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// HELP -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -void ImGui::ShowMetricsWindow(bool* p_open) -{ - if (ImGui::Begin("ImGui Metrics", p_open)) - { - ImGui::Text("ImGui %s", ImGui::GetVersion()); - ImGui::Text("Application average %.3f ms/frame (%.1f FPS)", 1000.0f / ImGui::GetIO().Framerate, ImGui::GetIO().Framerate); - ImGui::Text("%d vertices, %d indices (%d triangles)", ImGui::GetIO().MetricsRenderVertices, ImGui::GetIO().MetricsRenderIndices, ImGui::GetIO().MetricsRenderIndices / 3); - ImGui::Text("%d allocations", ImGui::GetIO().MetricsAllocs); - static bool show_clip_rects = true; - ImGui::Checkbox("Show clipping rectangles when hovering a ImDrawCmd", &show_clip_rects); - ImGui::Separator(); - - struct Funcs - { - static void NodeDrawList(ImDrawList* draw_list, const char* label) - { - bool node_open = ImGui::TreeNode(draw_list, "%s: '%s' %d vtx, %d indices, %d cmds", label, draw_list->_OwnerName ? draw_list->_OwnerName : "", draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size, draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size, draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size); - if (draw_list == ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()) - { - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::TextColored(ImColor(255,100,100), "CURRENTLY APPENDING"); // Can't display stats for active draw list! (we don't have the data double-buffered) - if (node_open) ImGui::TreePop(); - return; - } - if (!node_open) - return; - - ImDrawList* overlay_draw_list = &GImGui->OverlayDrawList; // Render additional visuals into the top-most draw list - overlay_draw_list->PushClipRectFullScreen(); - int elem_offset = 0; - for (const ImDrawCmd* pcmd = draw_list->CmdBuffer.begin(); pcmd < draw_list->CmdBuffer.end(); elem_offset += pcmd->ElemCount, pcmd++) - { - if (pcmd->UserCallback) - { - ImGui::BulletText("Callback %p, user_data %p", pcmd->UserCallback, pcmd->UserCallbackData); - continue; - } - ImDrawIdx* idx_buffer = (draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size > 0) ? draw_list->IdxBuffer.Data : NULL; - bool pcmd_node_open = ImGui::TreeNode((void*)(pcmd - draw_list->CmdBuffer.begin()), "Draw %-4d %s vtx, tex = %p, clip_rect = (%.0f,%.0f)..(%.0f,%.0f)", pcmd->ElemCount, draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size > 0 ? "indexed" : "non-indexed", pcmd->TextureId, pcmd->ClipRect.x, pcmd->ClipRect.y, pcmd->ClipRect.z, pcmd->ClipRect.w); - if (show_clip_rects && ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - { - ImRect clip_rect = pcmd->ClipRect; - ImRect vtxs_rect; - for (int i = elem_offset; i < elem_offset + (int)pcmd->ElemCount; i++) - vtxs_rect.Add(draw_list->VtxBuffer[idx_buffer ? idx_buffer[i] : i].pos); - clip_rect.Floor(); overlay_draw_list->AddRect(clip_rect.Min, clip_rect.Max, IM_COL32(255,255,0,255)); - vtxs_rect.Floor(); overlay_draw_list->AddRect(vtxs_rect.Min, vtxs_rect.Max, IM_COL32(255,0,255,255)); - } - if (!pcmd_node_open) - continue; - ImGuiListClipper clipper(pcmd->ElemCount/3); // Manually coarse clip our print out of individual vertices to save CPU, only items that may be visible. - while (clipper.Step()) - for (int prim = clipper.DisplayStart, vtx_i = elem_offset + clipper.DisplayStart*3; prim < clipper.DisplayEnd; prim++) - { - char buf[300], *buf_p = buf; - ImVec2 triangles_pos[3]; - for (int n = 0; n < 3; n++, vtx_i++) - { - ImDrawVert& v = draw_list->VtxBuffer[idx_buffer ? idx_buffer[vtx_i] : vtx_i]; - triangles_pos[n] = v.pos; - buf_p += sprintf(buf_p, "%s %04d { pos = (%8.2f,%8.2f), uv = (%.6f,%.6f), col = %08X }\n", (n == 0) ? "vtx" : " ", vtx_i, v.pos.x, v.pos.y, v.uv.x, v.uv.y, v.col); - } - ImGui::Selectable(buf, false); - if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - overlay_draw_list->AddPolyline(triangles_pos, 3, IM_COL32(255,255,0,255), true, 1.0f, false); // Add triangle without AA, more readable for large-thin triangle - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - overlay_draw_list->PopClipRect(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - static void NodeWindows(ImVector& windows, const char* label) - { - if (!ImGui::TreeNode(label, "%s (%d)", label, windows.Size)) - return; - for (int i = 0; i < windows.Size; i++) - Funcs::NodeWindow(windows[i], "Window"); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - static void NodeWindow(ImGuiWindow* window, const char* label) - { - if (!ImGui::TreeNode(window, "%s '%s', %d @ 0x%p", label, window->Name, window->Active || window->WasActive, window)) - return; - NodeDrawList(window->DrawList, "DrawList"); - ImGui::BulletText("Pos: (%.1f,%.1f)", window->Pos.x, window->Pos.y); - ImGui::BulletText("Size: (%.1f,%.1f), SizeContents (%.1f,%.1f)", window->Size.x, window->Size.y, window->SizeContents.x, window->SizeContents.y); - ImGui::BulletText("Scroll: (%.2f,%.2f)", window->Scroll.x, window->Scroll.y); - if (window->RootWindow != window) NodeWindow(window->RootWindow, "RootWindow"); - if (window->DC.ChildWindows.Size > 0) NodeWindows(window->DC.ChildWindows, "ChildWindows"); - ImGui::BulletText("Storage: %d bytes", window->StateStorage.Data.Size * (int)sizeof(ImGuiStorage::Pair)); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - }; - - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; // Access private state - Funcs::NodeWindows(g.Windows, "Windows"); - if (ImGui::TreeNode("DrawList", "Active DrawLists (%d)", g.RenderDrawLists[0].Size)) - { - for (int i = 0; i < g.RenderDrawLists[0].Size; i++) - Funcs::NodeDrawList(g.RenderDrawLists[0][i], "DrawList"); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Popups", "Open Popups Stack (%d)", g.OpenPopupStack.Size)) - { - for (int i = 0; i < g.OpenPopupStack.Size; i++) - { - ImGuiWindow* window = g.OpenPopupStack[i].Window; - ImGui::BulletText("PopupID: %08x, Window: '%s'%s%s", g.OpenPopupStack[i].PopupId, window ? window->Name : "NULL", window && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildWindow) ? " ChildWindow" : "", window && (window->Flags & ImGuiWindowFlags_ChildMenu) ? " ChildMenu" : ""); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic state")) - { - ImGui::Text("FocusedWindow: '%s'", g.FocusedWindow ? g.FocusedWindow->Name : "NULL"); - ImGui::Text("HoveredWindow: '%s'", g.HoveredWindow ? g.HoveredWindow->Name : "NULL"); - ImGui::Text("HoveredRootWindow: '%s'", g.HoveredRootWindow ? g.HoveredRootWindow->Name : "NULL"); - ImGui::Text("HoveredID: 0x%08X/0x%08X", g.HoveredId, g.HoveredIdPreviousFrame); // Data is "in-flight" so depending on when the Metrics window is called we may see current frame information or not - ImGui::Text("ActiveID: 0x%08X/0x%08X", g.ActiveId, g.ActiveIdPreviousFrame); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - } - ImGui::End(); -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -// Include imgui_user.inl at the end of imgui.cpp to access private data/functions that aren't exposed. -// Prefer just including imgui_internal.h from your code rather than using this define. If a declaration is missing from imgui_internal.h add it or request it on the github. -#ifdef IMGUI_INCLUDE_IMGUI_USER_INL -#include "imgui_user.inl" -#endif - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- diff --git a/src/imgui/imgui_demo.cpp b/src/imgui/imgui_demo.cpp deleted file mode 100644 index 971706b..0000000 --- a/src/imgui/imgui_demo.cpp +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2638 +0,0 @@ -// dear imgui, v1.50 WIP -// (demo code) - -// Don't remove this file from your project! It is useful reference code that you can execute. -// You can call ImGui::ShowTestWindow() in your code to learn about various features of ImGui. -// Everything in this file will be stripped out by the linker if you don't call ImGui::ShowTestWindow(). - -#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS) -#define _CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS -#endif - -#include -#include // toupper, isprint -#include // sqrtf, powf, cosf, sinf, floorf, ceilf -#include // vsnprintf, sscanf, printf -#include // NULL, malloc, free, qsort, atoi -#if defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER <= 1500 // MSVC 2008 or earlier -#include // intptr_t -#else -#include // intptr_t -#endif - -#ifdef _MSC_VER -#pragma warning (disable: 4996) // 'This function or variable may be unsafe': strcpy, strdup, sprintf, vsnprintf, sscanf, fopen -#define snprintf _snprintf -#endif -#ifdef __clang__ -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" // warning : use of old-style cast // yes, they are more terse. -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wdeprecated-declarations" // warning : 'xx' is deprecated: The POSIX name for this item.. // for strdup used in demo code (so user can copy & paste the code) -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wint-to-void-pointer-cast" // warning : cast to 'void *' from smaller integer type 'int' -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-security" // warning : warning: format string is not a string literal -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wexit-time-destructors" // warning : declaration requires an exit-time destructor // exit-time destruction order is undefined. if MemFree() leads to users code that has been disabled before exit it might cause problems. ImGui coding style welcomes static/globals. -#if __has_warning("-Wreserved-id-macro") -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wreserved-id-macro" // warning : macro name is a reserved identifier // -#endif -#elif defined(__GNUC__) -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wint-to-pointer-cast" // warning: cast to pointer from integer of different size -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wformat-security" // warning : format string is not a string literal (potentially insecure) -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wconversion" // warning: conversion to 'xxxx' from 'xxxx' may alter its value -#if (__GNUC__ >= 6) -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wmisleading-indentation" // warning: this 'if' clause does not guard this statement // GCC 6.0+ only. See #883 on github. -#endif -#endif - -// Play it nice with Windows users. Notepad in 2015 still doesn't display text data with Unix-style \n. -#ifdef _WIN32 -#define IM_NEWLINE "\r\n" -#else -#define IM_NEWLINE "\n" -#endif - -#define IM_ARRAYSIZE(_ARR) ((int)(sizeof(_ARR)/sizeof(*_ARR))) -#define IM_MAX(_A,_B) (((_A) >= (_B)) ? (_A) : (_B)) - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// DEMO CODE -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_TEST_WINDOWS - -static void ShowExampleAppConsole(bool* p_open); -static void ShowExampleAppLog(bool* p_open); -static void ShowExampleAppLayout(bool* p_open); -static void ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor(bool* p_open); -static void ShowExampleAppLongText(bool* p_open); -static void ShowExampleAppAutoResize(bool* p_open); -static void ShowExampleAppConstrainedResize(bool* p_open); -static void ShowExampleAppFixedOverlay(bool* p_open); -static void ShowExampleAppManipulatingWindowTitle(bool* p_open); -static void ShowExampleAppCustomRendering(bool* p_open); -static void ShowExampleAppMainMenuBar(); -static void ShowExampleMenuFile(); - -static void ShowHelpMarker(const char* desc) -{ - ImGui::TextDisabled("(?)"); - if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - { - ImGui::BeginTooltip(); - ImGui::PushTextWrapPos(450.0f); - ImGui::TextUnformatted(desc); - ImGui::PopTextWrapPos(); - ImGui::EndTooltip(); - } -} - -void ImGui::ShowUserGuide() -{ - ImGui::BulletText("Double-click on title bar to collapse window."); - ImGui::BulletText("Click and drag on lower right corner to resize window."); - ImGui::BulletText("Click and drag on any empty space to move window."); - ImGui::BulletText("Mouse Wheel to scroll."); - if (ImGui::GetIO().FontAllowUserScaling) - ImGui::BulletText("CTRL+Mouse Wheel to zoom window contents."); - ImGui::BulletText("TAB/SHIFT+TAB to cycle through keyboard editable fields."); - ImGui::BulletText("CTRL+Click on a slider or drag box to input text."); - ImGui::BulletText( - "While editing text:\n" - "- Hold SHIFT or use mouse to select text\n" - "- CTRL+Left/Right to word jump\n" - "- CTRL+A or double-click to select all\n" - "- CTRL+X,CTRL+C,CTRL+V clipboard\n" - "- CTRL+Z,CTRL+Y undo/redo\n" - "- ESCAPE to revert\n" - "- You can apply arithmetic operators +,*,/ on numerical values.\n" - " Use +- to subtract.\n"); -} - -// Demonstrate most ImGui features (big function!) -void ImGui::ShowTestWindow(bool* p_open) -{ - // Examples apps - static bool show_app_main_menu_bar = false; - static bool show_app_console = false; - static bool show_app_log = false; - static bool show_app_layout = false; - static bool show_app_property_editor = false; - static bool show_app_long_text = false; - static bool show_app_auto_resize = false; - static bool show_app_constrained_resize = false; - static bool show_app_fixed_overlay = false; - static bool show_app_manipulating_window_title = false; - static bool show_app_custom_rendering = false; - static bool show_app_style_editor = false; - - static bool show_app_metrics = false; - static bool show_app_about = false; - - if (show_app_main_menu_bar) ShowExampleAppMainMenuBar(); - if (show_app_console) ShowExampleAppConsole(&show_app_console); - if (show_app_log) ShowExampleAppLog(&show_app_log); - if (show_app_layout) ShowExampleAppLayout(&show_app_layout); - if (show_app_property_editor) ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor(&show_app_property_editor); - if (show_app_long_text) ShowExampleAppLongText(&show_app_long_text); - if (show_app_auto_resize) ShowExampleAppAutoResize(&show_app_auto_resize); - if (show_app_constrained_resize) ShowExampleAppConstrainedResize(&show_app_constrained_resize); - if (show_app_fixed_overlay) ShowExampleAppFixedOverlay(&show_app_fixed_overlay); - if (show_app_manipulating_window_title) ShowExampleAppManipulatingWindowTitle(&show_app_manipulating_window_title); - if (show_app_custom_rendering) ShowExampleAppCustomRendering(&show_app_custom_rendering); - - if (show_app_metrics) ImGui::ShowMetricsWindow(&show_app_metrics); - if (show_app_style_editor) { ImGui::Begin("Style Editor", &show_app_style_editor); ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(); ImGui::End(); } - if (show_app_about) - { - ImGui::Begin("About ImGui", &show_app_about, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize); - ImGui::Text("dear imgui, %s", ImGui::GetVersion()); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::Text("By Omar Cornut and all github contributors."); - ImGui::Text("ImGui is licensed under the MIT License, see LICENSE for more information."); - ImGui::End(); - } - - static bool no_titlebar = false; - static bool no_border = true; - static bool no_resize = false; - static bool no_move = false; - static bool no_scrollbar = false; - static bool no_collapse = false; - static bool no_menu = false; - - // Demonstrate the various window flags. Typically you would just use the default. - ImGuiWindowFlags window_flags = 0; - if (no_titlebar) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar; - if (!no_border) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_ShowBorders; - if (no_resize) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize; - if (no_move) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove; - if (no_scrollbar) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoScrollbar; - if (no_collapse) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_NoCollapse; - if (!no_menu) window_flags |= ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar; - ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(550,680), ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver); - if (!ImGui::Begin("ImGui Demo", p_open, window_flags)) - { - // Early out if the window is collapsed, as an optimization. - ImGui::End(); - return; - } - - //ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetWindowWidth() * 0.65f); // 2/3 of the space for widget and 1/3 for labels - ImGui::PushItemWidth(-140); // Right align, keep 140 pixels for labels - - ImGui::Text("Dear ImGui says hello."); - - // Menu - if (ImGui::BeginMenuBar()) - { - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Menu")) - { - ShowExampleMenuFile(); - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Examples")) - { - ImGui::MenuItem("Main menu bar", NULL, &show_app_main_menu_bar); - ImGui::MenuItem("Console", NULL, &show_app_console); - ImGui::MenuItem("Log", NULL, &show_app_log); - ImGui::MenuItem("Simple layout", NULL, &show_app_layout); - ImGui::MenuItem("Property editor", NULL, &show_app_property_editor); - ImGui::MenuItem("Long text display", NULL, &show_app_long_text); - ImGui::MenuItem("Auto-resizing window", NULL, &show_app_auto_resize); - ImGui::MenuItem("Constrained-resizing window", NULL, &show_app_constrained_resize); - ImGui::MenuItem("Simple overlay", NULL, &show_app_fixed_overlay); - ImGui::MenuItem("Manipulating window title", NULL, &show_app_manipulating_window_title); - ImGui::MenuItem("Custom rendering", NULL, &show_app_custom_rendering); - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Help")) - { - ImGui::MenuItem("Metrics", NULL, &show_app_metrics); - ImGui::MenuItem("Style Editor", NULL, &show_app_style_editor); - ImGui::MenuItem("About ImGui", NULL, &show_app_about); - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - ImGui::EndMenuBar(); - } - - ImGui::Spacing(); - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Help")) - { - ImGui::TextWrapped("This window is being created by the ShowTestWindow() function. Please refer to the code for programming reference.\n\nUser Guide:"); - ImGui::ShowUserGuide(); - } - - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Window options")) - { - ImGui::Checkbox("No titlebar", &no_titlebar); ImGui::SameLine(150); - ImGui::Checkbox("No border", &no_border); ImGui::SameLine(300); - ImGui::Checkbox("No resize", &no_resize); - ImGui::Checkbox("No move", &no_move); ImGui::SameLine(150); - ImGui::Checkbox("No scrollbar", &no_scrollbar); ImGui::SameLine(300); - ImGui::Checkbox("No collapse", &no_collapse); - ImGui::Checkbox("No menu", &no_menu); - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Style")) - { - ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Logging")) - { - ImGui::TextWrapped("The logging API redirects all text output so you can easily capture the content of a window or a block. Tree nodes can be automatically expanded. You can also call ImGui::LogText() to output directly to the log without a visual output."); - ImGui::LogButtons(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - } - - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Widgets")) - { - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Trees")) - { - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic trees")) - { - for (int i = 0; i < 5; i++) - if (ImGui::TreeNode((void*)(intptr_t)i, "Child %d", i)) - { - ImGui::Text("blah blah"); - ImGui::SameLine(); - if (ImGui::SmallButton("print")) printf("Child %d pressed", i); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Advanced, with Selectable nodes")) - { - ShowHelpMarker("This is a more standard looking tree with selectable nodes.\nClick to select, CTRL+Click to toggle, click on arrows or double-click to open."); - static bool align_label_with_current_x_position = false; - ImGui::Checkbox("Align label with current X position)", &align_label_with_current_x_position); - ImGui::Text("Hello!"); - if (align_label_with_current_x_position) - ImGui::Unindent(ImGui::GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing()); - - static int selection_mask = (1 << 2); // Dumb representation of what may be user-side selection state. You may carry selection state inside or outside your objects in whatever format you see fit. - int node_clicked = -1; // Temporary storage of what node we have clicked to process selection at the end of the loop. May be a pointer to your own node type, etc. - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_IndentSpacing, ImGui::GetFontSize()*3); // Increase spacing to differentiate leaves from expanded contents. - for (int i = 0; i < 6; i++) - { - // Disable the default open on single-click behavior and pass in Selected flag according to our selection state. - ImGuiTreeNodeFlags node_flags = ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnArrow | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_OpenOnDoubleClick | ((selection_mask & (1 << i)) ? ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Selected : 0); - if (i < 3) - { - // Node - bool node_open = ImGui::TreeNodeEx((void*)(intptr_t)i, node_flags, "Selectable Node %d", i); - if (ImGui::IsItemClicked()) - node_clicked = i; - if (node_open) - { - ImGui::Text("Blah blah\nBlah Blah"); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - } - else - { - // Leaf: The only reason we have a TreeNode at all is to allow selection of the leaf. Otherwise we can use BulletText() or TreeAdvanceToLabelPos()+Text(). - ImGui::TreeNodeEx((void*)(intptr_t)i, node_flags | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_Leaf | ImGuiTreeNodeFlags_NoTreePushOnOpen, "Selectable Leaf %d", i); - if (ImGui::IsItemClicked()) - node_clicked = i; - } - } - if (node_clicked != -1) - { - // Update selection state. Process outside of tree loop to avoid visual inconsistencies during the clicking-frame. - if (ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl) - selection_mask ^= (1 << node_clicked); // CTRL+click to toggle - else //if (!(selection_mask & (1 << node_clicked))) // Depending on selection behavior you want, this commented bit preserve selection when clicking on item that is part of the selection - selection_mask = (1 << node_clicked); // Click to single-select - } - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); - if (align_label_with_current_x_position) - ImGui::Indent(ImGui::GetTreeNodeToLabelSpacing()); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Collapsing Headers")) - { - static bool closable_group = true; - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Header")) - { - ImGui::Checkbox("Enable extra group", &closable_group); - for (int i = 0; i < 5; i++) - ImGui::Text("Some content %d", i); - } - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Header with a close button", &closable_group)) - { - for (int i = 0; i < 5; i++) - ImGui::Text("More content %d", i); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Bullets")) - { - ImGui::BulletText("Bullet point 1"); - ImGui::BulletText("Bullet point 2\nOn multiple lines"); - ImGui::Bullet(); ImGui::Text("Bullet point 3 (two calls)"); - ImGui::Bullet(); ImGui::SmallButton("Button"); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Colored Text")) - { - // Using shortcut. You can use PushStyleColor()/PopStyleColor() for more flexibility. - ImGui::TextColored(ImVec4(1.0f,0.0f,1.0f,1.0f), "Pink"); - ImGui::TextColored(ImVec4(1.0f,1.0f,0.0f,1.0f), "Yellow"); - ImGui::TextDisabled("Disabled"); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Word Wrapping")) - { - // Using shortcut. You can use PushTextWrapPos()/PopTextWrapPos() for more flexibility. - ImGui::TextWrapped("This text should automatically wrap on the edge of the window. The current implementation for text wrapping follows simple rules suitable for English and possibly other languages."); - ImGui::Spacing(); - - static float wrap_width = 200.0f; - ImGui::SliderFloat("Wrap width", &wrap_width, -20, 600, "%.0f"); - - ImGui::Text("Test paragraph 1:"); - ImVec2 pos = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); - ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(pos.x + wrap_width, pos.y), ImVec2(pos.x + wrap_width + 10, pos.y + ImGui::GetTextLineHeight()), IM_COL32(255,0,255,255)); - ImGui::PushTextWrapPos(ImGui::GetCursorPos().x + wrap_width); - ImGui::Text("The lazy dog is a good dog. This paragraph is made to fit within %.0f pixels. Testing a 1 character word. The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog.", wrap_width); - ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()->AddRect(ImGui::GetItemRectMin(), ImGui::GetItemRectMax(), IM_COL32(255,255,0,255)); - ImGui::PopTextWrapPos(); - - ImGui::Text("Test paragraph 2:"); - pos = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); - ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(pos.x + wrap_width, pos.y), ImVec2(pos.x + wrap_width + 10, pos.y + ImGui::GetTextLineHeight()), IM_COL32(255,0,255,255)); - ImGui::PushTextWrapPos(ImGui::GetCursorPos().x + wrap_width); - ImGui::Text("aaaaaaaa bbbbbbbb, c cccccccc,dddddddd. d eeeeeeee ffffffff. gggggggg!hhhhhhhh"); - ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()->AddRect(ImGui::GetItemRectMin(), ImGui::GetItemRectMax(), IM_COL32(255,255,0,255)); - ImGui::PopTextWrapPos(); - - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("UTF-8 Text")) - { - // UTF-8 test with Japanese characters - // (needs a suitable font, try Arial Unicode or M+ fonts http://mplus-fonts.sourceforge.jp/mplus-outline-fonts/index-en.html) - // Most compiler appears to support UTF-8 in source code (with Visual Studio you need to save your file as 'UTF-8 without signature') - // However for the sake for maximum portability here we are *not* including raw UTF-8 character in this source file, instead we encode the string with hexadecimal constants. - // In your own application be reasonable and use UTF-8 in source or retrieve the data from file system! - // Note that characters values are preserved even if the font cannot be displayed, so you can safely copy & paste garbled characters into another application. - ImGui::TextWrapped("CJK text will only appears if the font was loaded with the appropriate CJK character ranges. Call io.Font->LoadFromFileTTF() manually to load extra character ranges."); - ImGui::Text("Hiragana: \xe3\x81\x8b\xe3\x81\x8d\xe3\x81\x8f\xe3\x81\x91\xe3\x81\x93 (kakikukeko)"); - ImGui::Text("Kanjis: \xe6\x97\xa5\xe6\x9c\xac\xe8\xaa\x9e (nihongo)"); - static char buf[32] = "\xe6\x97\xa5\xe6\x9c\xac\xe8\xaa\x9e"; - ImGui::InputText("UTF-8 input", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Images")) - { - ImGui::TextWrapped("Below we are displaying the font texture (which is the only texture we have access to in this demo). Use the 'ImTextureID' type as storage to pass pointers or identifier to your own texture data. Hover the texture for a zoomed view!"); - ImVec2 tex_screen_pos = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); - float tex_w = (float)ImGui::GetIO().Fonts->TexWidth; - float tex_h = (float)ImGui::GetIO().Fonts->TexHeight; - ImTextureID tex_id = ImGui::GetIO().Fonts->TexID; - ImGui::Text("%.0fx%.0f", tex_w, tex_h); - ImGui::Image(tex_id, ImVec2(tex_w, tex_h), ImVec2(0,0), ImVec2(1,1), ImColor(255,255,255,255), ImColor(255,255,255,128)); - if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - { - ImGui::BeginTooltip(); - float focus_sz = 32.0f; - float focus_x = ImGui::GetMousePos().x - tex_screen_pos.x - focus_sz * 0.5f; if (focus_x < 0.0f) focus_x = 0.0f; else if (focus_x > tex_w - focus_sz) focus_x = tex_w - focus_sz; - float focus_y = ImGui::GetMousePos().y - tex_screen_pos.y - focus_sz * 0.5f; if (focus_y < 0.0f) focus_y = 0.0f; else if (focus_y > tex_h - focus_sz) focus_y = tex_h - focus_sz; - ImGui::Text("Min: (%.2f, %.2f)", focus_x, focus_y); - ImGui::Text("Max: (%.2f, %.2f)", focus_x + focus_sz, focus_y + focus_sz); - ImVec2 uv0 = ImVec2((focus_x) / tex_w, (focus_y) / tex_h); - ImVec2 uv1 = ImVec2((focus_x + focus_sz) / tex_w, (focus_y + focus_sz) / tex_h); - ImGui::Image(tex_id, ImVec2(128,128), uv0, uv1, ImColor(255,255,255,255), ImColor(255,255,255,128)); - ImGui::EndTooltip(); - } - ImGui::TextWrapped("And now some textured buttons.."); - static int pressed_count = 0; - for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++) - { - ImGui::PushID(i); - int frame_padding = -1 + i; // -1 = uses default padding - if (ImGui::ImageButton(tex_id, ImVec2(32,32), ImVec2(0,0), ImVec2(32.0f/tex_w,32/tex_h), frame_padding, ImColor(0,0,0,255))) - pressed_count += 1; - ImGui::PopID(); - ImGui::SameLine(); - } - ImGui::NewLine(); - ImGui::Text("Pressed %d times.", pressed_count); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Selectables")) - { - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic")) - { - static bool selected[4] = { false, true, false, false }; - ImGui::Selectable("1. I am selectable", &selected[0]); - ImGui::Selectable("2. I am selectable", &selected[1]); - ImGui::Text("3. I am not selectable"); - ImGui::Selectable("4. I am selectable", &selected[2]); - if (ImGui::Selectable("5. I am double clickable", selected[3], ImGuiSelectableFlags_AllowDoubleClick)) - if (ImGui::IsMouseDoubleClicked(0)) - selected[3] = !selected[3]; - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Rendering more text into the same block")) - { - static bool selected[3] = { false, false, false }; - ImGui::Selectable("main.c", &selected[0]); ImGui::SameLine(300); ImGui::Text(" 2,345 bytes"); - ImGui::Selectable("Hello.cpp", &selected[1]); ImGui::SameLine(300); ImGui::Text("12,345 bytes"); - ImGui::Selectable("Hello.h", &selected[2]); ImGui::SameLine(300); ImGui::Text(" 2,345 bytes"); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - if (ImGui::TreeNode("In columns")) - { - ImGui::Columns(3, NULL, false); - static bool selected[16] = { 0 }; - for (int i = 0; i < 16; i++) - { - char label[32]; sprintf(label, "Item %d", i); - if (ImGui::Selectable(label, &selected[i])) {} - ImGui::NextColumn(); - } - ImGui::Columns(1); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Grid")) - { - static bool selected[16] = { true, false, false, false, false, true, false, false, false, false, true, false, false, false, false, true }; - for (int i = 0; i < 16; i++) - { - ImGui::PushID(i); - if (ImGui::Selectable("Sailor", &selected[i], 0, ImVec2(50,50))) - { - int x = i % 4, y = i / 4; - if (x > 0) selected[i - 1] ^= 1; - if (x < 3) selected[i + 1] ^= 1; - if (y > 0) selected[i - 4] ^= 1; - if (y < 3) selected[i + 4] ^= 1; - } - if ((i % 4) < 3) ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::PopID(); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Filtered Text Input")) - { - static char buf1[64] = ""; ImGui::InputText("default", buf1, 64); - static char buf2[64] = ""; ImGui::InputText("decimal", buf2, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsDecimal); - static char buf3[64] = ""; ImGui::InputText("hexadecimal", buf3, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsHexadecimal | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase); - static char buf4[64] = ""; ImGui::InputText("uppercase", buf4, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsUppercase); - static char buf5[64] = ""; ImGui::InputText("no blank", buf5, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank); - struct TextFilters { static int FilterImGuiLetters(ImGuiTextEditCallbackData* data) { if (data->EventChar < 256 && strchr("imgui", (char)data->EventChar)) return 0; return 1; } }; - static char buf6[64] = ""; ImGui::InputText("\"imgui\" letters", buf6, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCharFilter, TextFilters::FilterImGuiLetters); - - ImGui::Text("Password input"); - static char bufpass[64] = "password123"; - ImGui::InputText("password", bufpass, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_Password | ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank); - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("Display all characters as '*'.\nDisable clipboard cut and copy.\nDisable logging.\n"); - ImGui::InputText("password (clear)", bufpass, 64, ImGuiInputTextFlags_CharsNoBlank); - - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-line Text Input")) - { - static bool read_only = false; - static char text[1024*16] = - "/*\n" - " The Pentium F00F bug, shorthand for F0 0F C7 C8,\n" - " the hexadecimal encoding of one offending instruction,\n" - " more formally, the invalid operand with locked CMPXCHG8B\n" - " instruction bug, is a design flaw in the majority of\n" - " Intel Pentium, Pentium MMX, and Pentium OverDrive\n" - " processors (all in the P5 microarchitecture).\n" - "*/\n\n" - "label:\n" - "\tlock cmpxchg8b eax\n"; - - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(0,0)); - ImGui::Checkbox("Read-only", &read_only); - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); - ImGui::InputTextMultiline("##source", text, IM_ARRAYSIZE(text), ImVec2(-1.0f, ImGui::GetTextLineHeight() * 16), ImGuiInputTextFlags_AllowTabInput | (read_only ? ImGuiInputTextFlags_ReadOnly : 0)); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - static bool a=false; - if (ImGui::Button("Button")) { printf("Clicked\n"); a ^= 1; } - if (a) - { - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("Thanks for clicking me!"); - } - - static bool check = true; - ImGui::Checkbox("checkbox", &check); - - static int e = 0; - ImGui::RadioButton("radio a", &e, 0); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::RadioButton("radio b", &e, 1); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::RadioButton("radio c", &e, 2); - - // Color buttons, demonstrate using PushID() to add unique identifier in the ID stack, and changing style. - for (int i = 0; i < 7; i++) - { - if (i > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::PushID(i); - ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Button, ImColor::HSV(i/7.0f, 0.6f, 0.6f)); - ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered, ImColor::HSV(i/7.0f, 0.7f, 0.7f)); - ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ButtonActive, ImColor::HSV(i/7.0f, 0.8f, 0.8f)); - ImGui::Button("Click"); - ImGui::PopStyleColor(3); - ImGui::PopID(); - } - - ImGui::Text("Hover over me"); - if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - ImGui::SetTooltip("I am a tooltip"); - - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("- or me"); - if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - { - ImGui::BeginTooltip(); - ImGui::Text("I am a fancy tooltip"); - static float arr[] = { 0.6f, 0.1f, 1.0f, 0.5f, 0.92f, 0.1f, 0.2f }; - ImGui::PlotLines("Curve", arr, IM_ARRAYSIZE(arr)); - ImGui::EndTooltip(); - } - - // Testing IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME macro - //for (int i = 0; i < 5; i++) - //{ - // IMGUI_ONCE_UPON_A_FRAME - // { - // ImGui::Text("This will be displayed only once."); - // } - //} - - ImGui::Separator(); - - ImGui::LabelText("label", "Value"); - - static int item = 1; - ImGui::Combo("combo", &item, "aaaa\0bbbb\0cccc\0dddd\0eeee\0\0"); // Combo using values packed in a single constant string (for really quick combo) - - const char* items[] = { "AAAA", "BBBB", "CCCC", "DDDD", "EEEE", "FFFF", "GGGG", "HHHH", "IIII", "JJJJ", "KKKK" }; - static int item2 = -1; - ImGui::Combo("combo scroll", &item2, items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(items)); // Combo using proper array. You can also pass a callback to retrieve array value, no need to create/copy an array just for that. - - { - static char str0[128] = "Hello, world!"; - static int i0=123; - static float f0=0.001f; - ImGui::InputText("input text", str0, IM_ARRAYSIZE(str0)); - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("Hold SHIFT or use mouse to select text.\n" "CTRL+Left/Right to word jump.\n" "CTRL+A or double-click to select all.\n" "CTRL+X,CTRL+C,CTRL+V clipboard.\n" "CTRL+Z,CTRL+Y undo/redo.\n" "ESCAPE to revert.\n"); - - ImGui::InputInt("input int", &i0); - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("You can apply arithmetic operators +,*,/ on numerical values.\n e.g. [ 100 ], input \'*2\', result becomes [ 200 ]\nUse +- to subtract.\n"); - - ImGui::InputFloat("input float", &f0, 0.01f, 1.0f); - - static float vec4a[4] = { 0.10f, 0.20f, 0.30f, 0.44f }; - ImGui::InputFloat3("input float3", vec4a); - } - - { - static int i1=50, i2=42; - ImGui::DragInt("drag int", &i1, 1); - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("Click and drag to edit value.\nHold SHIFT/ALT for faster/slower edit.\nDouble-click or CTRL+click to input value."); - - ImGui::DragInt("drag int 0..100", &i2, 1, 0, 100, "%.0f%%"); - - static float f1=1.00f, f2=0.0067f; - ImGui::DragFloat("drag float", &f1, 0.005f); - ImGui::DragFloat("drag small float", &f2, 0.0001f, 0.0f, 0.0f, "%.06f ns"); - } - - { - static int i1=0; - ImGui::SliderInt("slider int", &i1, -1, 3); - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("CTRL+click to input value."); - - static float f1=0.123f, f2=0.0f; - ImGui::SliderFloat("slider float", &f1, 0.0f, 1.0f, "ratio = %.3f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat("slider log float", &f2, -10.0f, 10.0f, "%.4f", 3.0f); - static float angle = 0.0f; - ImGui::SliderAngle("slider angle", &angle); - } - - static float col1[3] = { 1.0f,0.0f,0.2f }; - static float col2[4] = { 0.4f,0.7f,0.0f,0.5f }; - ImGui::ColorEdit3("color 1", col1); - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("Click on the colored square to change edit mode.\nCTRL+click on individual component to input value.\n"); - - ImGui::ColorEdit4("color 2", col2); - - const char* listbox_items[] = { "Apple", "Banana", "Cherry", "Kiwi", "Mango", "Orange", "Pineapple", "Strawberry", "Watermelon" }; - static int listbox_item_current = 1; - ImGui::ListBox("listbox\n(single select)", &listbox_item_current, listbox_items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(listbox_items), 4); - - //static int listbox_item_current2 = 2; - //ImGui::PushItemWidth(-1); - //ImGui::ListBox("##listbox2", &listbox_item_current2, listbox_items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(listbox_items), 4); - //ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Range Widgets")) - { - ImGui::Unindent(); - - static float begin = 10, end = 90; - static int begin_i = 100, end_i = 1000; - ImGui::DragFloatRange2("range", &begin, &end, 0.25f, 0.0f, 100.0f, "Min: %.1f %%", "Max: %.1f %%"); - ImGui::DragIntRange2("range int (no bounds)", &begin_i, &end_i, 5, 0, 0, "Min: %.0f units", "Max: %.0f units"); - - ImGui::Indent(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Multi-component Widgets")) - { - ImGui::Unindent(); - - static float vec4f[4] = { 0.10f, 0.20f, 0.30f, 0.44f }; - static int vec4i[4] = { 1, 5, 100, 255 }; - - ImGui::InputFloat2("input float2", vec4f); - ImGui::DragFloat2("drag float2", vec4f, 0.01f, 0.0f, 1.0f); - ImGui::SliderFloat2("slider float2", vec4f, 0.0f, 1.0f); - ImGui::DragInt2("drag int2", vec4i, 1, 0, 255); - ImGui::InputInt2("input int2", vec4i); - ImGui::SliderInt2("slider int2", vec4i, 0, 255); - ImGui::Spacing(); - - ImGui::InputFloat3("input float3", vec4f); - ImGui::DragFloat3("drag float3", vec4f, 0.01f, 0.0f, 1.0f); - ImGui::SliderFloat3("slider float3", vec4f, 0.0f, 1.0f); - ImGui::DragInt3("drag int3", vec4i, 1, 0, 255); - ImGui::InputInt3("input int3", vec4i); - ImGui::SliderInt3("slider int3", vec4i, 0, 255); - ImGui::Spacing(); - - ImGui::InputFloat4("input float4", vec4f); - ImGui::DragFloat4("drag float4", vec4f, 0.01f, 0.0f, 1.0f); - ImGui::SliderFloat4("slider float4", vec4f, 0.0f, 1.0f); - ImGui::InputInt4("input int4", vec4i); - ImGui::DragInt4("drag int4", vec4i, 1, 0, 255); - ImGui::SliderInt4("slider int4", vec4i, 0, 255); - - ImGui::Indent(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Vertical Sliders")) - { - ImGui::Unindent(); - const float spacing = 4; - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(spacing, spacing)); - - static int int_value = 0; - ImGui::VSliderInt("##int", ImVec2(18,160), &int_value, 0, 5); - ImGui::SameLine(); - - static float values[7] = { 0.0f, 0.60f, 0.35f, 0.9f, 0.70f, 0.20f, 0.0f }; - ImGui::PushID("set1"); - for (int i = 0; i < 7; i++) - { - if (i > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::PushID(i); - ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_FrameBg, ImColor::HSV(i/7.0f, 0.5f, 0.5f)); - ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_FrameBgHovered, ImColor::HSV(i/7.0f, 0.6f, 0.5f)); - ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_FrameBgActive, ImColor::HSV(i/7.0f, 0.7f, 0.5f)); - ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_SliderGrab, ImColor::HSV(i/7.0f, 0.9f, 0.9f)); - ImGui::VSliderFloat("##v", ImVec2(18,160), &values[i], 0.0f, 1.0f, ""); - if (ImGui::IsItemActive() || ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - ImGui::SetTooltip("%.3f", values[i]); - ImGui::PopStyleColor(4); - ImGui::PopID(); - } - ImGui::PopID(); - - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::PushID("set2"); - static float values2[4] = { 0.20f, 0.80f, 0.40f, 0.25f }; - const int rows = 3; - const ImVec2 small_slider_size(18, (160.0f-(rows-1)*spacing)/rows); - for (int nx = 0; nx < 4; nx++) - { - if (nx > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::BeginGroup(); - for (int ny = 0; ny < rows; ny++) - { - ImGui::PushID(nx*rows+ny); - ImGui::VSliderFloat("##v", small_slider_size, &values2[nx], 0.0f, 1.0f, ""); - if (ImGui::IsItemActive() || ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - ImGui::SetTooltip("%.3f", values2[nx]); - ImGui::PopID(); - } - ImGui::EndGroup(); - } - ImGui::PopID(); - - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::PushID("set3"); - for (int i = 0; i < 4; i++) - { - if (i > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::PushID(i); - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_GrabMinSize, 40); - ImGui::VSliderFloat("##v", ImVec2(40,160), &values[i], 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.2f\nsec"); - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); - ImGui::PopID(); - } - ImGui::PopID(); - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); - - ImGui::Indent(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - } - - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Graphs widgets")) - { - static bool animate = true; - ImGui::Checkbox("Animate", &animate); - - static float arr[] = { 0.6f, 0.1f, 1.0f, 0.5f, 0.92f, 0.1f, 0.2f }; - ImGui::PlotLines("Frame Times", arr, IM_ARRAYSIZE(arr)); - - // Create a dummy array of contiguous float values to plot - // Tip: If your float aren't contiguous but part of a structure, you can pass a pointer to your first float and the sizeof() of your structure in the Stride parameter. - static float values[90] = { 0 }; - static int values_offset = 0; - if (animate) - { - static float refresh_time = ImGui::GetTime(); // Create dummy data at fixed 60 hz rate for the demo - for (; ImGui::GetTime() > refresh_time + 1.0f/60.0f; refresh_time += 1.0f/60.0f) - { - static float phase = 0.0f; - values[values_offset] = cosf(phase); - values_offset = (values_offset+1) % IM_ARRAYSIZE(values); - phase += 0.10f*values_offset; - } - } - ImGui::PlotLines("Lines", values, IM_ARRAYSIZE(values), values_offset, "avg 0.0", -1.0f, 1.0f, ImVec2(0,80)); - ImGui::PlotHistogram("Histogram", arr, IM_ARRAYSIZE(arr), 0, NULL, 0.0f, 1.0f, ImVec2(0,80)); - - // Use functions to generate output - // FIXME: This is rather awkward because current plot API only pass in indices. We probably want an API passing floats and user provide sample rate/count. - struct Funcs - { - static float Sin(void*, int i) { return sinf(i * 0.1f); } - static float Saw(void*, int i) { return (i & 1) ? 1.0f : 0.0f; } - }; - static int func_type = 0, display_count = 70; - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::PushItemWidth(100); ImGui::Combo("func", &func_type, "Sin\0Saw\0"); ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::SliderInt("Sample count", &display_count, 1, 400); - float (*func)(void*, int) = (func_type == 0) ? Funcs::Sin : Funcs::Saw; - ImGui::PlotLines("Lines", func, NULL, display_count, 0, NULL, -1.0f, 1.0f, ImVec2(0,80)); - ImGui::PlotHistogram("Histogram", func, NULL, display_count, 0, NULL, -1.0f, 1.0f, ImVec2(0,80)); - ImGui::Separator(); - - // Animate a simple progress bar - static float progress = 0.0f, progress_dir = 1.0f; - if (animate) - { - progress += progress_dir * 0.4f * ImGui::GetIO().DeltaTime; - if (progress >= +1.1f) { progress = +1.1f; progress_dir *= -1.0f; } - if (progress <= -0.1f) { progress = -0.1f; progress_dir *= -1.0f; } - } - - // Typically we would use ImVec2(-1.0f,0.0f) to use all available width, or ImVec2(width,0.0f) for a specified width. ImVec2(0.0f,0.0f) uses ItemWidth. - ImGui::ProgressBar(progress, ImVec2(0.0f,0.0f)); - ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, ImGui::GetStyle().ItemInnerSpacing.x); - ImGui::Text("Progress Bar"); - - float progress_saturated = (progress < 0.0f) ? 0.0f : (progress > 1.0f) ? 1.0f : progress; - char buf[32]; - sprintf(buf, "%d/%d", (int)(progress_saturated*1753), 1753); - ImGui::ProgressBar(progress, ImVec2(0.f,0.f), buf); - } - - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Layout")) - { - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Child regions")) - { - ImGui::Text("Without border"); - static int line = 50; - bool goto_line = ImGui::Button("Goto"); - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::PushItemWidth(100); - goto_line |= ImGui::InputInt("##Line", &line, 0, 0, ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue); - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - ImGui::BeginChild("Sub1", ImVec2(ImGui::GetWindowContentRegionWidth() * 0.5f,300), false, ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar); - for (int i = 0; i < 100; i++) - { - ImGui::Text("%04d: scrollable region", i); - if (goto_line && line == i) - ImGui::SetScrollHere(); - } - if (goto_line && line >= 100) - ImGui::SetScrollHere(); - ImGui::EndChild(); - - ImGui::SameLine(); - - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ChildWindowRounding, 5.0f); - ImGui::BeginChild("Sub2", ImVec2(0,300), true); - ImGui::Text("With border"); - ImGui::Columns(2); - for (int i = 0; i < 100; i++) - { - if (i == 50) - ImGui::NextColumn(); - char buf[32]; - sprintf(buf, "%08x", i*5731); - ImGui::Button(buf, ImVec2(-1.0f, 0.0f)); - } - ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); - - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Widgets Width")) - { - static float f = 0.0f; - ImGui::Text("PushItemWidth(100)"); - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("Fixed width."); - ImGui::PushItemWidth(100); - ImGui::DragFloat("float##1", &f); - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - - ImGui::Text("PushItemWidth(GetWindowWidth() * 0.5f)"); - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("Half of window width."); - ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetWindowWidth() * 0.5f); - ImGui::DragFloat("float##2", &f); - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - - ImGui::Text("PushItemWidth(GetContentRegionAvailWidth() * 0.5f)"); - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("Half of available width.\n(~ right-cursor_pos)\n(works within a column set)"); - ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetContentRegionAvailWidth() * 0.5f); - ImGui::DragFloat("float##3", &f); - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - - ImGui::Text("PushItemWidth(-100)"); - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("Align to right edge minus 100"); - ImGui::PushItemWidth(-100); - ImGui::DragFloat("float##4", &f); - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - - ImGui::Text("PushItemWidth(-1)"); - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("Align to right edge"); - ImGui::PushItemWidth(-1); - ImGui::DragFloat("float##5", &f); - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic Horizontal Layout")) - { - ImGui::TextWrapped("(Use ImGui::SameLine() to keep adding items to the right of the preceding item)"); - - // Text - ImGui::Text("Two items: Hello"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::TextColored(ImVec4(1,1,0,1), "Sailor"); - - // Adjust spacing - ImGui::Text("More spacing: Hello"); ImGui::SameLine(0, 20); - ImGui::TextColored(ImVec4(1,1,0,1), "Sailor"); - - // Button - ImGui::AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets(); - ImGui::Text("Normal buttons"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Button("Banana"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Button("Apple"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Button("Corniflower"); - - // Button - ImGui::Text("Small buttons"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::SmallButton("Like this one"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("can fit within a text block."); - - // Aligned to arbitrary position. Easy/cheap column. - ImGui::Text("Aligned"); - ImGui::SameLine(150); ImGui::Text("x=150"); - ImGui::SameLine(300); ImGui::Text("x=300"); - ImGui::Text("Aligned"); - ImGui::SameLine(150); ImGui::SmallButton("x=150"); - ImGui::SameLine(300); ImGui::SmallButton("x=300"); - - // Checkbox - static bool c1=false,c2=false,c3=false,c4=false; - ImGui::Checkbox("My", &c1); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Checkbox("Tailor", &c2); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Checkbox("Is", &c3); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Checkbox("Rich", &c4); - - // Various - static float f0=1.0f, f1=2.0f, f2=3.0f; - ImGui::PushItemWidth(80); - const char* items[] = { "AAAA", "BBBB", "CCCC", "DDDD" }; - static int item = -1; - ImGui::Combo("Combo", &item, items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(items)); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::SliderFloat("X", &f0, 0.0f,5.0f); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::SliderFloat("Y", &f1, 0.0f,5.0f); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::SliderFloat("Z", &f2, 0.0f,5.0f); - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - - ImGui::PushItemWidth(80); - ImGui::Text("Lists:"); - static int selection[4] = { 0, 1, 2, 3 }; - for (int i = 0; i < 4; i++) - { - if (i > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::PushID(i); - ImGui::ListBox("", &selection[i], items, IM_ARRAYSIZE(items)); - ImGui::PopID(); - //if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) ImGui::SetTooltip("ListBox %d hovered", i); - } - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - - // Dummy - ImVec2 sz(30,30); - ImGui::Button("A", sz); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Dummy(sz); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Button("B", sz); - - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Groups")) - { - ImGui::TextWrapped("(Using ImGui::BeginGroup()/EndGroup() to layout items. BeginGroup() basically locks the horizontal position. EndGroup() bundles the whole group so that you can use functions such as IsItemHovered() on it.)"); - ImGui::BeginGroup(); - { - ImGui::BeginGroup(); - ImGui::Button("AAA"); - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Button("BBB"); - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::BeginGroup(); - ImGui::Button("CCC"); - ImGui::Button("DDD"); - ImGui::EndGroup(); - if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - ImGui::SetTooltip("Group hovered"); - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Button("EEE"); - ImGui::EndGroup(); - } - // Capture the group size and create widgets using the same size - ImVec2 size = ImGui::GetItemRectSize(); - const float values[5] = { 0.5f, 0.20f, 0.80f, 0.60f, 0.25f }; - ImGui::PlotHistogram("##values", values, IM_ARRAYSIZE(values), 0, NULL, 0.0f, 1.0f, size); - - ImGui::Button("ACTION", ImVec2((size.x - ImGui::GetStyle().ItemSpacing.x)*0.5f,size.y)); - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Button("REACTION", ImVec2((size.x - ImGui::GetStyle().ItemSpacing.x)*0.5f,size.y)); - ImGui::EndGroup(); - ImGui::SameLine(); - - ImGui::Button("LEVERAGE\nBUZZWORD", size); - ImGui::SameLine(); - - ImGui::ListBoxHeader("List", size); - ImGui::Selectable("Selected", true); - ImGui::Selectable("Not Selected", false); - ImGui::ListBoxFooter(); - - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Text Baseline Alignment")) - { - ImGui::TextWrapped("(This is testing the vertical alignment that occurs on text to keep it at the same baseline as widgets. Lines only composed of text or \"small\" widgets fit in less vertical spaces than lines with normal widgets)"); - - ImGui::Text("One\nTwo\nThree"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("Hello\nWorld"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("Banana"); - - ImGui::Text("Banana"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("Hello\nWorld"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("One\nTwo\nThree"); - - ImGui::Button("HOP##1"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("Banana"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("Hello\nWorld"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("Banana"); - - ImGui::Button("HOP##2"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("Hello\nWorld"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("Banana"); - - ImGui::Button("TEST##1"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("TEST"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::SmallButton("TEST##2"); - - ImGui::AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets(); // If your line starts with text, call this to align it to upcoming widgets. - ImGui::Text("Text aligned to Widget"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Button("Widget##1"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text("Widget"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::SmallButton("Widget##2"); - - // Tree - const float spacing = ImGui::GetStyle().ItemInnerSpacing.x; - ImGui::Button("Button##1"); - ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, spacing); - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Node##1")) { for (int i = 0; i < 6; i++) ImGui::BulletText("Item %d..", i); ImGui::TreePop(); } // Dummy tree data - - ImGui::AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets(); // Vertically align text node a bit lower so it'll be vertically centered with upcoming widget. Otherwise you can use SmallButton (smaller fit). - bool node_open = ImGui::TreeNode("Node##2"); // Common mistake to avoid: if we want to SameLine after TreeNode we need to do it before we add child content. - ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, spacing); ImGui::Button("Button##2"); - if (node_open) { for (int i = 0; i < 6; i++) ImGui::BulletText("Item %d..", i); ImGui::TreePop(); } // Dummy tree data - - // Bullet - ImGui::Button("Button##3"); - ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, spacing); - ImGui::BulletText("Bullet text"); - - ImGui::AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets(); - ImGui::BulletText("Node"); - ImGui::SameLine(0.0f, spacing); ImGui::Button("Button##4"); - - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Scrolling")) - { - ImGui::TextWrapped("(Use SetScrollHere() or SetScrollFromPosY() to scroll to a given position.)"); - static bool track = true; - static int track_line = 50, scroll_to_px = 200; - ImGui::Checkbox("Track", &track); - ImGui::PushItemWidth(100); - ImGui::SameLine(130); track |= ImGui::DragInt("##line", &track_line, 0.25f, 0, 99, "Line %.0f"); - bool scroll_to = ImGui::Button("Scroll To"); - ImGui::SameLine(130); scroll_to |= ImGui::DragInt("##pos_y", &scroll_to_px, 1.00f, 0, 9999, "y = %.0f px"); - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - if (scroll_to) track = false; - - for (int i = 0; i < 5; i++) - { - if (i > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::BeginGroup(); - ImGui::Text("%s", i == 0 ? "Top" : i == 1 ? "25%" : i == 2 ? "Center" : i == 3 ? "75%" : "Bottom"); - ImGui::BeginChild(ImGui::GetID((void*)(intptr_t)i), ImVec2(ImGui::GetWindowWidth() * 0.17f, 200.0f), true); - if (scroll_to) - ImGui::SetScrollFromPosY(ImGui::GetCursorStartPos().y + scroll_to_px, i * 0.25f); - for (int line = 0; line < 100; line++) - { - if (track && line == track_line) - { - ImGui::TextColored(ImColor(255,255,0), "Line %d", line); - ImGui::SetScrollHere(i * 0.25f); // 0.0f:top, 0.5f:center, 1.0f:bottom - } - else - { - ImGui::Text("Line %d", line); - } - } - ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::EndGroup(); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Horizontal Scrolling")) - { - ImGui::Bullet(); ImGui::TextWrapped("Horizontal scrolling for a window has to be enabled explicitly via the ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar flag."); - ImGui::Bullet(); ImGui::TextWrapped("You may want to explicitly specify content width by calling SetNextWindowContentWidth() before Begin()."); - static int lines = 7; - ImGui::SliderInt("Lines", &lines, 1, 15); - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FrameRounding, 3.0f); - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(2.0f, 1.0f)); - ImGui::BeginChild("scrolling", ImVec2(0, ImGui::GetItemsLineHeightWithSpacing()*7 + 30), true, ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar); - for (int line = 0; line < lines; line++) - { - // Display random stuff (for the sake of this trivial demo we are using basic Button+SameLine. If you want to create your own time line for a real application you may be better off - // manipulating the cursor position yourself, aka using SetCursorPos/SetCursorScreenPos to position the widgets yourself. You may also want to use the lower-level ImDrawList API) - int num_buttons = 10 + ((line & 1) ? line * 9 : line * 3); - for (int n = 0; n < num_buttons; n++) - { - if (n > 0) ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::PushID(n + line * 1000); - char num_buf[16]; - const char* label = (!(n%15)) ? "FizzBuzz" : (!(n%3)) ? "Fizz" : (!(n%5)) ? "Buzz" : (sprintf(num_buf, "%d", n), num_buf); - float hue = n*0.05f; - ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Button, ImColor::HSV(hue, 0.6f, 0.6f)); - ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ButtonHovered, ImColor::HSV(hue, 0.7f, 0.7f)); - ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_ButtonActive, ImColor::HSV(hue, 0.8f, 0.8f)); - ImGui::Button(label, ImVec2(40.0f + sinf((float)(line + n)) * 20.0f, 0.0f)); - ImGui::PopStyleColor(3); - ImGui::PopID(); - } - } - ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::PopStyleVar(2); - float scroll_x_delta = 0.0f; - ImGui::SmallButton("<<"); if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) scroll_x_delta = -ImGui::GetIO().DeltaTime * 1000.0f; - ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("Scroll from code"); ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::SmallButton(">>"); if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) scroll_x_delta = +ImGui::GetIO().DeltaTime * 1000.0f; - if (scroll_x_delta != 0.0f) - { - ImGui::BeginChild("scrolling"); // Demonstrate a trick: you can use Begin to set yourself in the context of another window (here we are already out of your child window) - ImGui::SetScrollX(ImGui::GetScrollX() + scroll_x_delta); - ImGui::End(); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Clipping")) - { - static ImVec2 size(100, 100), offset(50, 20); - ImGui::TextWrapped("On a per-widget basis we are occasionally clipping text CPU-side if it won't fit in its frame. Otherwise we are doing coarser clipping + passing a scissor rectangle to the renderer. The system is designed to try minimizing both execution and CPU/GPU rendering cost."); - ImGui::DragFloat2("size", (float*)&size, 0.5f, 0.0f, 200.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::TextWrapped("(Click and drag)"); - ImVec2 pos = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); - ImVec4 clip_rect(pos.x, pos.y, pos.x+size.x, pos.y+size.y); - ImGui::InvisibleButton("##dummy", size); - if (ImGui::IsItemActive() && ImGui::IsMouseDragging()) { offset.x += ImGui::GetIO().MouseDelta.x; offset.y += ImGui::GetIO().MouseDelta.y; } - ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()->AddRectFilled(pos, ImVec2(pos.x+size.x,pos.y+size.y), ImColor(90,90,120,255)); - ImGui::GetWindowDrawList()->AddText(ImGui::GetFont(), ImGui::GetFontSize()*2.0f, ImVec2(pos.x+offset.x,pos.y+offset.y), ImColor(255,255,255,255), "Line 1 hello\nLine 2 clip me!", NULL, 0.0f, &clip_rect); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - } - - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Popups & Modal windows")) - { - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Popups")) - { - ImGui::TextWrapped("When a popup is active, it inhibits interacting with windows that are behind the popup. Clicking outside the popup closes it."); - - static int selected_fish = -1; - const char* names[] = { "Bream", "Haddock", "Mackerel", "Pollock", "Tilefish" }; - static bool toggles[] = { true, false, false, false, false }; - - // Simple selection popup - // (If you want to show the current selection inside the Button itself, you may want to build a string using the "###" operator to preserve a constant ID with a variable label) - if (ImGui::Button("Select..")) - ImGui::OpenPopup("select"); - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Text(selected_fish == -1 ? "" : names[selected_fish]); - if (ImGui::BeginPopup("select")) - { - ImGui::Text("Aquarium"); - ImGui::Separator(); - for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(names); i++) - if (ImGui::Selectable(names[i])) - selected_fish = i; - ImGui::EndPopup(); - } - - // Showing a menu with toggles - if (ImGui::Button("Toggle..")) - ImGui::OpenPopup("toggle"); - if (ImGui::BeginPopup("toggle")) - { - for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(names); i++) - ImGui::MenuItem(names[i], "", &toggles[i]); - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Sub-menu")) - { - ImGui::MenuItem("Click me"); - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::Text("Tooltip here"); - if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - ImGui::SetTooltip("I am a tooltip over a popup"); - - if (ImGui::Button("Stacked Popup")) - ImGui::OpenPopup("another popup"); - if (ImGui::BeginPopup("another popup")) - { - for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(names); i++) - ImGui::MenuItem(names[i], "", &toggles[i]); - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Sub-menu")) - { - ImGui::MenuItem("Click me"); - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - ImGui::EndPopup(); - } - ImGui::EndPopup(); - } - - if (ImGui::Button("Popup Menu..")) - ImGui::OpenPopup("FilePopup"); - if (ImGui::BeginPopup("FilePopup")) - { - ShowExampleMenuFile(); - ImGui::EndPopup(); - } - - ImGui::Spacing(); - ImGui::TextWrapped("Below we are testing adding menu items to a regular window. It's rather unusual but should work!"); - ImGui::Separator(); - // NB: As a quirk in this very specific example, we want to differentiate the parent of this menu from the parent of the various popup menus above. - // To do so we are encloding the items in a PushID()/PopID() block to make them two different menusets. If we don't, opening any popup above and hovering our menu here - // would open it. This is because once a menu is active, we allow to switch to a sibling menu by just hovering on it, which is the desired behavior for regular menus. - ImGui::PushID("foo"); - ImGui::MenuItem("Menu item", "CTRL+M"); - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Menu inside a regular window")) - { - ShowExampleMenuFile(); - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - ImGui::PopID(); - ImGui::Separator(); - - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Context menus")) - { - static float value = 0.5f; - ImGui::Text("Value = %.3f (<-- right-click here)", value); - if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem("item context menu")) - { - if (ImGui::Selectable("Set to zero")) value = 0.0f; - if (ImGui::Selectable("Set to PI")) value = 3.1415f; - ImGui::EndPopup(); - } - - static ImVec4 color = ImColor(0.8f, 0.5f, 1.0f, 1.0f); - ImGui::ColorButton(color); - if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextItem("color context menu")) - { - ImGui::Text("Edit color"); - ImGui::ColorEdit3("##edit", (float*)&color); - if (ImGui::Button("Close")) - ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); - ImGui::EndPopup(); - } - ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("(<-- right-click here)"); - - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Modals")) - { - ImGui::TextWrapped("Modal windows are like popups but the user cannot close them by clicking outside the window."); - - if (ImGui::Button("Delete..")) - ImGui::OpenPopup("Delete?"); - if (ImGui::BeginPopupModal("Delete?", NULL, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)) - { - ImGui::Text("All those beautiful files will be deleted.\nThis operation cannot be undone!\n\n"); - ImGui::Separator(); - - //static int dummy_i = 0; - //ImGui::Combo("Combo", &dummy_i, "Delete\0Delete harder\0"); - - static bool dont_ask_me_next_time = false; - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(0,0)); - ImGui::Checkbox("Don't ask me next time", &dont_ask_me_next_time); - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); - - if (ImGui::Button("OK", ImVec2(120,0))) { ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); } - ImGui::SameLine(); - if (ImGui::Button("Cancel", ImVec2(120,0))) { ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); } - ImGui::EndPopup(); - } - - if (ImGui::Button("Stacked modals..")) - ImGui::OpenPopup("Stacked 1"); - if (ImGui::BeginPopupModal("Stacked 1")) - { - ImGui::Text("Hello from Stacked The First"); - - if (ImGui::Button("Another one..")) - ImGui::OpenPopup("Stacked 2"); - if (ImGui::BeginPopupModal("Stacked 2")) - { - ImGui::Text("Hello from Stacked The Second"); - if (ImGui::Button("Close")) - ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); - ImGui::EndPopup(); - } - - if (ImGui::Button("Close")) - ImGui::CloseCurrentPopup(); - ImGui::EndPopup(); - } - - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - } - - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Columns")) - { - // Basic columns - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Basic")) - { - ImGui::Text("Without border:"); - ImGui::Columns(3, "mycolumns3", false); // 3-ways, no border - ImGui::Separator(); - for (int n = 0; n < 14; n++) - { - char label[32]; - sprintf(label, "Item %d", n); - if (ImGui::Selectable(label)) {} - //if (ImGui::Button(label, ImVec2(-1,0))) {} - ImGui::NextColumn(); - } - ImGui::Columns(1); - ImGui::Separator(); - - ImGui::Text("With border:"); - ImGui::Columns(4, "mycolumns"); // 4-ways, with border - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::Text("ID"); ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Text("Name"); ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Text("Path"); ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Text("Flags"); ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Separator(); - const char* names[3] = { "One", "Two", "Three" }; - const char* paths[3] = { "/path/one", "/path/two", "/path/three" }; - static int selected = -1; - for (int i = 0; i < 3; i++) - { - char label[32]; - sprintf(label, "%04d", i); - if (ImGui::Selectable(label, selected == i, ImGuiSelectableFlags_SpanAllColumns)) - selected = i; - ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Text(names[i]); ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Text(paths[i]); ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Text("...."); ImGui::NextColumn(); - } - ImGui::Columns(1); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - // Scrolling columns - /* - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Scrolling")) - { - ImGui::BeginChild("##header", ImVec2(0, ImGui::GetTextLineHeightWithSpacing()+ImGui::GetStyle().ItemSpacing.y)); - ImGui::Columns(3); - ImGui::Text("ID"); ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Text("Name"); ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Text("Path"); ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Columns(1); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::BeginChild("##scrollingregion", ImVec2(0, 60)); - ImGui::Columns(3); - for (int i = 0; i < 10; i++) - { - ImGui::Text("%04d", i); ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Text("Foobar"); ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Text("/path/foobar/%04d/", i); ImGui::NextColumn(); - } - ImGui::Columns(1); - ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - */ - - // Create multiple items in a same cell before switching to next column - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Mixed items")) - { - ImGui::Columns(3, "mixed"); - ImGui::Separator(); - - ImGui::Text("Hello"); - ImGui::Button("Banana"); - ImGui::NextColumn(); - - ImGui::Text("ImGui"); - ImGui::Button("Apple"); - static float foo = 1.0f; - ImGui::InputFloat("red", &foo, 0.05f, 0, 3); - ImGui::Text("An extra line here."); - ImGui::NextColumn(); - - ImGui::Text("Sailor"); - ImGui::Button("Corniflower"); - static float bar = 1.0f; - ImGui::InputFloat("blue", &bar, 0.05f, 0, 3); - ImGui::NextColumn(); - - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Category A")) ImGui::Text("Blah blah blah"); ImGui::NextColumn(); - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Category B")) ImGui::Text("Blah blah blah"); ImGui::NextColumn(); - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Category C")) ImGui::Text("Blah blah blah"); ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Columns(1); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - // Word wrapping - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Word-wrapping")) - { - ImGui::Columns(2, "word-wrapping"); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::TextWrapped("The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog."); - ImGui::TextWrapped("Hello Left"); - ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::TextWrapped("The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog."); - ImGui::TextWrapped("Hello Right"); - ImGui::Columns(1); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Borders")) - { - static bool h_borders = true; - static bool v_borders = true; - ImGui::Checkbox("horizontal", &h_borders); - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Checkbox("vertical", &v_borders); - ImGui::Columns(4, NULL, v_borders); - if (h_borders) ImGui::Separator(); - for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++) - { - ImGui::Text("%c%c%c", 'a'+i, 'a'+i, 'a'+i); - ImGui::NextColumn(); - } - ImGui::Columns(1); - if (h_borders) ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - bool node_open = ImGui::TreeNode("Tree within single cell"); - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("NB: Tree node must be poped before ending the cell.\nThere's no storage of state per-cell."); - if (node_open) - { - ImGui::Columns(2, "tree items"); - ImGui::Separator(); - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Hello")) { ImGui::BulletText("Sailor"); ImGui::TreePop(); } ImGui::NextColumn(); - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Bonjour")) { ImGui::BulletText("Marin"); ImGui::TreePop(); } ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::Columns(1); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - } - - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Filtering")) - { - static ImGuiTextFilter filter; - ImGui::Text("Filter usage:\n" - " \"\" display all lines\n" - " \"xxx\" display lines containing \"xxx\"\n" - " \"xxx,yyy\" display lines containing \"xxx\" or \"yyy\"\n" - " \"-xxx\" hide lines containing \"xxx\""); - filter.Draw(); - const char* lines[] = { "aaa1.c", "bbb1.c", "ccc1.c", "aaa2.cpp", "bbb2.cpp", "ccc2.cpp", "abc.h", "hello, world" }; - for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(lines); i++) - if (filter.PassFilter(lines[i])) - ImGui::BulletText("%s", lines[i]); - } - - if (ImGui::CollapsingHeader("Keyboard, Mouse & Focus")) - { - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Tabbing")) - { - ImGui::Text("Use TAB/SHIFT+TAB to cycle through keyboard editable fields."); - static char buf[32] = "dummy"; - ImGui::InputText("1", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); - ImGui::InputText("2", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); - ImGui::InputText("3", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); - ImGui::PushAllowKeyboardFocus(false); - ImGui::InputText("4 (tab skip)", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); - //ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelperMarker("Use ImGui::PushAllowKeyboardFocus(bool)\nto disable tabbing through certain widgets."); - ImGui::PopAllowKeyboardFocus(); - ImGui::InputText("5", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Focus from code")) - { - bool focus_1 = ImGui::Button("Focus on 1"); ImGui::SameLine(); - bool focus_2 = ImGui::Button("Focus on 2"); ImGui::SameLine(); - bool focus_3 = ImGui::Button("Focus on 3"); - int has_focus = 0; - static char buf[128] = "click on a button to set focus"; - - if (focus_1) ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(); - ImGui::InputText("1", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); - if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) has_focus = 1; - - if (focus_2) ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(); - ImGui::InputText("2", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); - if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) has_focus = 2; - - ImGui::PushAllowKeyboardFocus(false); - if (focus_3) ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(); - ImGui::InputText("3 (tab skip)", buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)); - if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) has_focus = 3; - ImGui::PopAllowKeyboardFocus(); - if (has_focus) - ImGui::Text("Item with focus: %d", has_focus); - else - ImGui::Text("Item with focus: "); - ImGui::TextWrapped("Cursor & selection are preserved when refocusing last used item in code."); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Dragging")) - { - ImGui::TextWrapped("You can use ImGui::GetMouseDragDelta(0) to query for the dragged amount on any widget."); - ImGui::Button("Drag Me"); - if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) - { - // Draw a line between the button and the mouse cursor - ImDrawList* draw_list = ImGui::GetWindowDrawList(); - draw_list->PushClipRectFullScreen(); - draw_list->AddLine(ImGui::CalcItemRectClosestPoint(ImGui::GetIO().MousePos, true, -2.0f), ImGui::GetIO().MousePos, ImColor(ImGui::GetStyle().Colors[ImGuiCol_Button]), 4.0f); - draw_list->PopClipRect(); - ImVec2 value_raw = ImGui::GetMouseDragDelta(0, 0.0f); - ImVec2 value_with_lock_threshold = ImGui::GetMouseDragDelta(0); - ImVec2 mouse_delta = ImGui::GetIO().MouseDelta; - ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("Raw (%.1f, %.1f), WithLockThresold (%.1f, %.1f), MouseDelta (%.1f, %.1f)", value_raw.x, value_raw.y, value_with_lock_threshold.x, value_with_lock_threshold.y, mouse_delta.x, mouse_delta.y); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Keyboard & Mouse State")) - { - ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); - - ImGui::Text("MousePos: (%g, %g)", io.MousePos.x, io.MousePos.y); - ImGui::Text("Mouse down:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.MouseDown); i++) if (io.MouseDownDuration[i] >= 0.0f) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("b%d (%.02f secs)", i, io.MouseDownDuration[i]); } - ImGui::Text("Mouse clicked:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.MouseDown); i++) if (ImGui::IsMouseClicked(i)) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("b%d", i); } - ImGui::Text("Mouse dbl-clicked:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.MouseDown); i++) if (ImGui::IsMouseDoubleClicked(i)) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("b%d", i); } - ImGui::Text("Mouse released:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.MouseDown); i++) if (ImGui::IsMouseReleased(i)) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("b%d", i); } - ImGui::Text("MouseWheel: %.1f", io.MouseWheel); - - ImGui::Text("Keys down:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.KeysDown); i++) if (io.KeysDownDuration[i] >= 0.0f) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("%d (%.02f secs)", i, io.KeysDownDuration[i]); } - ImGui::Text("Keys pressed:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.KeysDown); i++) if (ImGui::IsKeyPressed(i)) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("%d", i); } - ImGui::Text("Keys release:"); for (int i = 0; i < IM_ARRAYSIZE(io.KeysDown); i++) if (ImGui::IsKeyReleased(i)) { ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Text("%d", i); } - ImGui::Text("KeyMods: %s%s%s%s", io.KeyCtrl ? "CTRL " : "", io.KeyShift ? "SHIFT " : "", io.KeyAlt ? "ALT " : "", io.KeySuper ? "SUPER " : ""); - - ImGui::Text("WantCaptureMouse: %s", io.WantCaptureMouse ? "true" : "false"); - ImGui::Text("WantCaptureKeyboard: %s", io.WantCaptureKeyboard ? "true" : "false"); - ImGui::Text("WantTextInput: %s", io.WantTextInput ? "true" : "false"); - - ImGui::Button("Hovering me sets the\nkeyboard capture flag"); - if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - ImGui::CaptureKeyboardFromApp(true); - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::Button("Holding me clears the\nthe keyboard capture flag"); - if (ImGui::IsItemActive()) - ImGui::CaptureKeyboardFromApp(false); - - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Mouse cursors")) - { - ImGui::TextWrapped("Your application can render a different mouse cursor based on what ImGui::GetMouseCursor() returns. You can also set io.MouseDrawCursor to ask ImGui to render the cursor for you in software."); - ImGui::Checkbox("io.MouseDrawCursor", &ImGui::GetIO().MouseDrawCursor); - ImGui::Text("Hover to see mouse cursors:"); - for (int i = 0; i < ImGuiMouseCursor_Count_; i++) - { - char label[32]; - sprintf(label, "Mouse cursor %d", i); - ImGui::Bullet(); ImGui::Selectable(label, false); - if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - ImGui::SetMouseCursor(i); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - } - - ImGui::End(); -} - -void ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(ImGuiStyle* ref) -{ - ImGuiStyle& style = ImGui::GetStyle(); - - // You can pass in a reference ImGuiStyle structure to compare to, revert to and save to (else it compares to the default style) - const ImGuiStyle default_style; // Default style - if (ImGui::Button("Revert Style")) - style = ref ? *ref : default_style; - - if (ref) - { - ImGui::SameLine(); - if (ImGui::Button("Save Style")) - *ref = style; - } - - ImGui::PushItemWidth(ImGui::GetWindowWidth() * 0.55f); - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Rendering")) - { - ImGui::Checkbox("Anti-aliased lines", &style.AntiAliasedLines); - ImGui::Checkbox("Anti-aliased shapes", &style.AntiAliasedShapes); - ImGui::PushItemWidth(100); - ImGui::DragFloat("Curve Tessellation Tolerance", &style.CurveTessellationTol, 0.02f, 0.10f, FLT_MAX, NULL, 2.0f); - if (style.CurveTessellationTol < 0.0f) style.CurveTessellationTol = 0.10f; - ImGui::DragFloat("Global Alpha", &style.Alpha, 0.005f, 0.20f, 1.0f, "%.2f"); // Not exposing zero here so user doesn't "lose" the UI (zero alpha clips all widgets). But application code could have a toggle to switch between zero and non-zero. - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Settings")) - { - ImGui::SliderFloat2("WindowPadding", (float*)&style.WindowPadding, 0.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat("WindowRounding", &style.WindowRounding, 0.0f, 16.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat("ChildWindowRounding", &style.ChildWindowRounding, 0.0f, 16.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat2("FramePadding", (float*)&style.FramePadding, 0.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat("FrameRounding", &style.FrameRounding, 0.0f, 16.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat2("ItemSpacing", (float*)&style.ItemSpacing, 0.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat2("ItemInnerSpacing", (float*)&style.ItemInnerSpacing, 0.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat2("TouchExtraPadding", (float*)&style.TouchExtraPadding, 0.0f, 10.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat("IndentSpacing", &style.IndentSpacing, 0.0f, 30.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat("ScrollbarSize", &style.ScrollbarSize, 1.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat("ScrollbarRounding", &style.ScrollbarRounding, 0.0f, 16.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat("GrabMinSize", &style.GrabMinSize, 1.0f, 20.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat("GrabRounding", &style.GrabRounding, 0.0f, 16.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::Text("Alignment"); - ImGui::SliderFloat2("WindowTitleAlign", (float*)&style.WindowTitleAlign, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.2f"); - ImGui::SliderFloat2("ButtonTextAlign", (float*)&style.ButtonTextAlign, 0.0f, 1.0f, "%.2f"); ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("Alignment applies when a button is larger than its text content."); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Colors")) - { - static int output_dest = 0; - static bool output_only_modified = false; - if (ImGui::Button("Copy Colors")) - { - if (output_dest == 0) - ImGui::LogToClipboard(); - else - ImGui::LogToTTY(); - ImGui::LogText("ImGuiStyle& style = ImGui::GetStyle();" IM_NEWLINE); - for (int i = 0; i < ImGuiCol_COUNT; i++) - { - const ImVec4& col = style.Colors[i]; - const char* name = ImGui::GetStyleColName(i); - if (!output_only_modified || memcmp(&col, (ref ? &ref->Colors[i] : &default_style.Colors[i]), sizeof(ImVec4)) != 0) - ImGui::LogText("style.Colors[ImGuiCol_%s]%*s= ImVec4(%.2ff, %.2ff, %.2ff, %.2ff);" IM_NEWLINE, name, 22 - (int)strlen(name), "", col.x, col.y, col.z, col.w); - } - ImGui::LogFinish(); - } - ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::PushItemWidth(120); ImGui::Combo("##output_type", &output_dest, "To Clipboard\0To TTY\0"); ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - ImGui::SameLine(); ImGui::Checkbox("Only Modified Fields", &output_only_modified); - - static ImGuiColorEditMode edit_mode = ImGuiColorEditMode_RGB; - ImGui::RadioButton("RGB", &edit_mode, ImGuiColorEditMode_RGB); - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::RadioButton("HSV", &edit_mode, ImGuiColorEditMode_HSV); - ImGui::SameLine(); - ImGui::RadioButton("HEX", &edit_mode, ImGuiColorEditMode_HEX); - //ImGui::Text("Tip: Click on colored square to change edit mode."); - - static ImGuiTextFilter filter; - filter.Draw("Filter colors", 200); - - ImGui::BeginChild("#colors", ImVec2(0, 300), true, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysVerticalScrollbar); - ImGui::PushItemWidth(-160); - ImGui::ColorEditMode(edit_mode); - for (int i = 0; i < ImGuiCol_COUNT; i++) - { - const char* name = ImGui::GetStyleColName(i); - if (!filter.PassFilter(name)) - continue; - ImGui::PushID(i); - ImGui::ColorEdit4(name, (float*)&style.Colors[i], true); - if (memcmp(&style.Colors[i], (ref ? &ref->Colors[i] : &default_style.Colors[i]), sizeof(ImVec4)) != 0) - { - ImGui::SameLine(); if (ImGui::Button("Revert")) style.Colors[i] = ref ? ref->Colors[i] : default_style.Colors[i]; - if (ref) { ImGui::SameLine(); if (ImGui::Button("Save")) ref->Colors[i] = style.Colors[i]; } - } - ImGui::PopID(); - } - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - ImGui::EndChild(); - - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Fonts", "Fonts (%d)", ImGui::GetIO().Fonts->Fonts.Size)) - { - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("Tip: Load fonts with io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF()\nbefore calling io.Fonts->GetTex* functions."); - ImFontAtlas* atlas = ImGui::GetIO().Fonts; - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Atlas texture", "Atlas texture (%dx%d pixels)", atlas->TexWidth, atlas->TexHeight)) - { - ImGui::Image(atlas->TexID, ImVec2((float)atlas->TexWidth, (float)atlas->TexHeight), ImVec2(0,0), ImVec2(1,1), ImColor(255,255,255,255), ImColor(255,255,255,128)); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - ImGui::PushItemWidth(100); - for (int i = 0; i < atlas->Fonts.Size; i++) - { - ImFont* font = atlas->Fonts[i]; - ImGui::BulletText("Font %d: \'%s\', %.2f px, %d glyphs", i, font->ConfigData ? font->ConfigData[0].Name : "", font->FontSize, font->Glyphs.Size); - ImGui::TreePush((void*)(intptr_t)i); - ImGui::SameLine(); if (ImGui::SmallButton("Set as default")) ImGui::GetIO().FontDefault = font; - ImGui::PushFont(font); - ImGui::Text("The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog"); - ImGui::PopFont(); - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Details")) - { - ImGui::DragFloat("Font scale", &font->Scale, 0.005f, 0.3f, 2.0f, "%.1f"); // Scale only this font - ImGui::SameLine(); ShowHelpMarker("Note than the default embedded font is NOT meant to be scaled.\n\nFont are currently rendered into bitmaps at a given size at the time of building the atlas. You may oversample them to get some flexibility with scaling. You can also render at multiple sizes and select which one to use at runtime.\n\n(Glimmer of hope: the atlas system should hopefully be rewritten in the future to make scaling more natural and automatic.)"); - ImGui::Text("Ascent: %f, Descent: %f, Height: %f", font->Ascent, font->Descent, font->Ascent - font->Descent); - ImGui::Text("Fallback character: '%c' (%d)", font->FallbackChar, font->FallbackChar); - for (int config_i = 0; config_i < font->ConfigDataCount; config_i++) - { - ImFontConfig* cfg = &font->ConfigData[config_i]; - ImGui::BulletText("Input %d: \'%s\'\nOversample: (%d,%d), PixelSnapH: %d", config_i, cfg->Name, cfg->OversampleH, cfg->OversampleV, cfg->PixelSnapH); - } - if (ImGui::TreeNode("Glyphs", "Glyphs (%d)", font->Glyphs.Size)) - { - // Display all glyphs of the fonts in separate pages of 256 characters - const ImFont::Glyph* glyph_fallback = font->FallbackGlyph; // Forcefully/dodgily make FindGlyph() return NULL on fallback, which isn't the default behavior. - font->FallbackGlyph = NULL; - for (int base = 0; base < 0x10000; base += 256) - { - int count = 0; - for (int n = 0; n < 256; n++) - count += font->FindGlyph((ImWchar)(base + n)) ? 1 : 0; - if (count > 0 && ImGui::TreeNode((void*)(intptr_t)base, "U+%04X..U+%04X (%d %s)", base, base+255, count, count > 1 ? "glyphs" : "glyph")) - { - float cell_spacing = style.ItemSpacing.y; - ImVec2 cell_size(font->FontSize * 1, font->FontSize * 1); - ImVec2 base_pos = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); - ImDrawList* draw_list = ImGui::GetWindowDrawList(); - for (int n = 0; n < 256; n++) - { - ImVec2 cell_p1(base_pos.x + (n % 16) * (cell_size.x + cell_spacing), base_pos.y + (n / 16) * (cell_size.y + cell_spacing)); - ImVec2 cell_p2(cell_p1.x + cell_size.x, cell_p1.y + cell_size.y); - const ImFont::Glyph* glyph = font->FindGlyph((ImWchar)(base+n));; - draw_list->AddRect(cell_p1, cell_p2, glyph ? IM_COL32(255,255,255,100) : IM_COL32(255,255,255,50)); - font->RenderChar(draw_list, cell_size.x, cell_p1, ImGui::GetColorU32(ImGuiCol_Text), (ImWchar)(base+n)); // We use ImFont::RenderChar as a shortcut because we don't have UTF-8 conversion functions available to generate a string. - if (glyph && ImGui::IsMouseHoveringRect(cell_p1, cell_p2)) - { - ImGui::BeginTooltip(); - ImGui::Text("Codepoint: U+%04X", base+n); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::Text("XAdvance+1: %.1f", glyph->XAdvance); - ImGui::Text("Pos: (%.2f,%.2f)->(%.2f,%.2f)", glyph->X0, glyph->Y0, glyph->X1, glyph->Y1); - ImGui::Text("UV: (%.3f,%.3f)->(%.3f,%.3f)", glyph->U0, glyph->V0, glyph->U1, glyph->V1); - ImGui::EndTooltip(); - } - } - ImGui::Dummy(ImVec2((cell_size.x + cell_spacing) * 16, (cell_size.y + cell_spacing) * 16)); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - } - font->FallbackGlyph = glyph_fallback; - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - static float window_scale = 1.0f; - ImGui::DragFloat("this window scale", &window_scale, 0.005f, 0.3f, 2.0f, "%.1f"); // scale only this window - ImGui::DragFloat("global scale", &ImGui::GetIO().FontGlobalScale, 0.005f, 0.3f, 2.0f, "%.1f"); // scale everything - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - ImGui::SetWindowFontScale(window_scale); - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); -} - -// Demonstrate creating a fullscreen menu bar and populating it. -static void ShowExampleAppMainMenuBar() -{ - if (ImGui::BeginMainMenuBar()) - { - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("File")) - { - ShowExampleMenuFile(); - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Edit")) - { - if (ImGui::MenuItem("Undo", "CTRL+Z")) {} - if (ImGui::MenuItem("Redo", "CTRL+Y", false, false)) {} // Disabled item - ImGui::Separator(); - if (ImGui::MenuItem("Cut", "CTRL+X")) {} - if (ImGui::MenuItem("Copy", "CTRL+C")) {} - if (ImGui::MenuItem("Paste", "CTRL+V")) {} - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - ImGui::EndMainMenuBar(); - } -} - -static void ShowExampleMenuFile() -{ - ImGui::MenuItem("(dummy menu)", NULL, false, false); - if (ImGui::MenuItem("New")) {} - if (ImGui::MenuItem("Open", "Ctrl+O")) {} - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Open Recent")) - { - ImGui::MenuItem("fish_hat.c"); - ImGui::MenuItem("fish_hat.inl"); - ImGui::MenuItem("fish_hat.h"); - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("More..")) - { - ImGui::MenuItem("Hello"); - ImGui::MenuItem("Sailor"); - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Recurse..")) - { - ShowExampleMenuFile(); - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - if (ImGui::MenuItem("Save", "Ctrl+S")) {} - if (ImGui::MenuItem("Save As..")) {} - ImGui::Separator(); - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Options")) - { - static bool enabled = true; - ImGui::MenuItem("Enabled", "", &enabled); - ImGui::BeginChild("child", ImVec2(0, 60), true); - for (int i = 0; i < 10; i++) - ImGui::Text("Scrolling Text %d", i); - ImGui::EndChild(); - static float f = 0.5f; - static int n = 0; - ImGui::SliderFloat("Value", &f, 0.0f, 1.0f); - ImGui::InputFloat("Input", &f, 0.1f); - ImGui::Combo("Combo", &n, "Yes\0No\0Maybe\0\0"); - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Colors")) - { - for (int i = 0; i < ImGuiCol_COUNT; i++) - ImGui::MenuItem(ImGui::GetStyleColName((ImGuiCol)i)); - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("Disabled", false)) // Disabled - { - IM_ASSERT(0); - } - if (ImGui::MenuItem("Checked", NULL, true)) {} - if (ImGui::MenuItem("Quit", "Alt+F4")) {} -} - -// Demonstrate creating a window which gets auto-resized according to its content. -static void ShowExampleAppAutoResize(bool* p_open) -{ - if (!ImGui::Begin("Example: Auto-resizing window", p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags_AlwaysAutoResize)) - { - ImGui::End(); - return; - } - - static int lines = 10; - ImGui::Text("Window will resize every-frame to the size of its content.\nNote that you probably don't want to query the window size to\noutput your content because that would create a feedback loop."); - ImGui::SliderInt("Number of lines", &lines, 1, 20); - for (int i = 0; i < lines; i++) - ImGui::Text("%*sThis is line %d", i*4, "", i); // Pad with space to extend size horizontally - ImGui::End(); -} - -// Demonstrate creating a window with custom resize constraints. -static void ShowExampleAppConstrainedResize(bool* p_open) -{ - struct CustomConstraints // Helper functions to demonstrate programmatic constraints - { - static void Square(ImGuiSizeConstraintCallbackData* data) { data->DesiredSize = ImVec2(IM_MAX(data->DesiredSize.x, data->DesiredSize.y), IM_MAX(data->DesiredSize.x, data->DesiredSize.y)); } - static void Step(ImGuiSizeConstraintCallbackData* data) { float step = (float)(int)(intptr_t)data->UserData; data->DesiredSize = ImVec2((int)(data->DesiredSize.x / step + 0.5f) * step, (int)(data->DesiredSize.y / step + 0.5f) * step); } - }; - - static int type = 0; - if (type == 0) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(-1, 0), ImVec2(-1, FLT_MAX)); // Vertical only - if (type == 1) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(0, -1), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, -1)); // Horizontal only - if (type == 2) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(100, 100), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX)); // Width > 100, Height > 100 - if (type == 3) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(300, 0), ImVec2(400, FLT_MAX)); // Width 300-400 - if (type == 4) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(0, 0), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX), CustomConstraints::Square); // Always Square - if (type == 5) ImGui::SetNextWindowSizeConstraints(ImVec2(0, 0), ImVec2(FLT_MAX, FLT_MAX), CustomConstraints::Step, (void*)100);// Fixed Step - - if (ImGui::Begin("Example: Constrained Resize", p_open)) - { - const char* desc[] = - { - "Resize vertical only", - "Resize horizontal only", - "Width > 100, Height > 100", - "Width 300-400", - "Custom: Always Square", - "Custom: Fixed Steps (100)", - }; - ImGui::Combo("Constraint", &type, desc, IM_ARRAYSIZE(desc)); - if (ImGui::Button("200x200")) ImGui::SetWindowSize(ImVec2(200,200)); ImGui::SameLine(); - if (ImGui::Button("500x500")) ImGui::SetWindowSize(ImVec2(500,500)); ImGui::SameLine(); - if (ImGui::Button("800x200")) ImGui::SetWindowSize(ImVec2(800,200)); - for (int i = 0; i < 10; i++) - ImGui::Text("Hello, sailor! Making this line long enough for the example."); - } - ImGui::End(); -} - -// Demonstrate creating a simple static window with no decoration. -static void ShowExampleAppFixedOverlay(bool* p_open) -{ - ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(10,10)); - if (!ImGui::Begin("Example: Fixed Overlay", p_open, ImVec2(0,0), 0.3f, ImGuiWindowFlags_NoTitleBar|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoResize|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoMove|ImGuiWindowFlags_NoSavedSettings)) - { - ImGui::End(); - return; - } - ImGui::Text("Simple overlay\non the top-left side of the screen."); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::Text("Mouse Position: (%.1f,%.1f)", ImGui::GetIO().MousePos.x, ImGui::GetIO().MousePos.y); - ImGui::End(); -} - -// Demonstrate using "##" and "###" in identifiers to manipulate ID generation. -// Read section "How can I have multiple widgets with the same label? Can I have widget without a label? (Yes). A primer on the purpose of labels/IDs." about ID. -static void ShowExampleAppManipulatingWindowTitle(bool*) -{ - // By default, Windows are uniquely identified by their title. - // You can use the "##" and "###" markers to manipulate the display/ID. - - // Using "##" to display same title but have unique identifier. - ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(100,100), ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver); - ImGui::Begin("Same title as another window##1"); - ImGui::Text("This is window 1.\nMy title is the same as window 2, but my identifier is unique."); - ImGui::End(); - - ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(100,200), ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver); - ImGui::Begin("Same title as another window##2"); - ImGui::Text("This is window 2.\nMy title is the same as window 1, but my identifier is unique."); - ImGui::End(); - - // Using "###" to display a changing title but keep a static identifier "AnimatedTitle" - char buf[128]; - sprintf(buf, "Animated title %c %d###AnimatedTitle", "|/-\\"[(int)(ImGui::GetTime()/0.25f)&3], rand()); - ImGui::SetNextWindowPos(ImVec2(100,300), ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver); - ImGui::Begin(buf); - ImGui::Text("This window has a changing title."); - ImGui::End(); -} - -// Demonstrate using the low-level ImDrawList to draw custom shapes. -static void ShowExampleAppCustomRendering(bool* p_open) -{ - ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(350,560), ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver); - if (!ImGui::Begin("Example: Custom rendering", p_open)) - { - ImGui::End(); - return; - } - - // Tip: If you do a lot of custom rendering, you probably want to use your own geometrical types and benefit of overloaded operators, etc. - // Define IM_VEC2_CLASS_EXTRA in imconfig.h to create implicit conversions between your types and ImVec2/ImVec4. - // ImGui defines overloaded operators but they are internal to imgui.cpp and not exposed outside (to avoid messing with your types) - // In this example we are not using the maths operators! - ImDrawList* draw_list = ImGui::GetWindowDrawList(); - - // Primitives - ImGui::Text("Primitives"); - static float sz = 36.0f; - static ImVec4 col = ImVec4(1.0f,1.0f,0.4f,1.0f); - ImGui::DragFloat("Size", &sz, 0.2f, 2.0f, 72.0f, "%.0f"); - ImGui::ColorEdit3("Color", &col.x); - { - const ImVec2 p = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); - const ImU32 col32 = ImColor(col); - float x = p.x + 4.0f, y = p.y + 4.0f, spacing = 8.0f; - for (int n = 0; n < 2; n++) - { - float thickness = (n == 0) ? 1.0f : 4.0f; - draw_list->AddCircle(ImVec2(x+sz*0.5f, y+sz*0.5f), sz*0.5f, col32, 20, thickness); x += sz+spacing; - draw_list->AddRect(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x+sz, y+sz), col32, 0.0f, ~0, thickness); x += sz+spacing; - draw_list->AddRect(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x+sz, y+sz), col32, 10.0f, ~0, thickness); x += sz+spacing; - draw_list->AddTriangle(ImVec2(x+sz*0.5f, y), ImVec2(x+sz,y+sz-0.5f), ImVec2(x,y+sz-0.5f), col32, thickness); x += sz+spacing; - draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x+sz, y ), col32, thickness); x += sz+spacing; - draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x+sz, y+sz), col32, thickness); x += sz+spacing; - draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x, y+sz), col32, thickness); x += spacing; - draw_list->AddBezierCurve(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x+sz*1.3f,y+sz*0.3f), ImVec2(x+sz-sz*1.3f,y+sz-sz*0.3f), ImVec2(x+sz, y+sz), col32, thickness); - x = p.x + 4; - y += sz+spacing; - } - draw_list->AddCircleFilled(ImVec2(x+sz*0.5f, y+sz*0.5f), sz*0.5f, col32, 32); x += sz+spacing; - draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x+sz, y+sz), col32); x += sz+spacing; - draw_list->AddRectFilled(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x+sz, y+sz), col32, 10.0f); x += sz+spacing; - draw_list->AddTriangleFilled(ImVec2(x+sz*0.5f, y), ImVec2(x+sz,y+sz-0.5f), ImVec2(x,y+sz-0.5f), col32); x += sz+spacing; - draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(ImVec2(x, y), ImVec2(x+sz, y+sz), ImColor(0,0,0), ImColor(255,0,0), ImColor(255,255,0), ImColor(0,255,0)); - ImGui::Dummy(ImVec2((sz+spacing)*8, (sz+spacing)*3)); - } - ImGui::Separator(); - { - static ImVector points; - static bool adding_line = false; - ImGui::Text("Canvas example"); - if (ImGui::Button("Clear")) points.clear(); - if (points.Size >= 2) { ImGui::SameLine(); if (ImGui::Button("Undo")) { points.pop_back(); points.pop_back(); } } - ImGui::Text("Left-click and drag to add lines,\nRight-click to undo"); - - // Here we are using InvisibleButton() as a convenience to 1) advance the cursor and 2) allows us to use IsItemHovered() - // However you can draw directly and poll mouse/keyboard by yourself. You can manipulate the cursor using GetCursorPos() and SetCursorPos(). - // If you only use the ImDrawList API, you can notify the owner window of its extends by using SetCursorPos(max). - ImVec2 canvas_pos = ImGui::GetCursorScreenPos(); // ImDrawList API uses screen coordinates! - ImVec2 canvas_size = ImGui::GetContentRegionAvail(); // Resize canvas to what's available - if (canvas_size.x < 50.0f) canvas_size.x = 50.0f; - if (canvas_size.y < 50.0f) canvas_size.y = 50.0f; - draw_list->AddRectFilledMultiColor(canvas_pos, ImVec2(canvas_pos.x + canvas_size.x, canvas_pos.y + canvas_size.y), ImColor(50,50,50), ImColor(50,50,60), ImColor(60,60,70), ImColor(50,50,60)); - draw_list->AddRect(canvas_pos, ImVec2(canvas_pos.x + canvas_size.x, canvas_pos.y + canvas_size.y), ImColor(255,255,255)); - - bool adding_preview = false; - ImGui::InvisibleButton("canvas", canvas_size); - ImVec2 mouse_pos_in_canvas = ImVec2(ImGui::GetIO().MousePos.x - canvas_pos.x, ImGui::GetIO().MousePos.y - canvas_pos.y); - if (adding_line) - { - adding_preview = true; - points.push_back(mouse_pos_in_canvas); - if (!ImGui::GetIO().MouseDown[0]) - adding_line = adding_preview = false; - } - if (ImGui::IsItemHovered()) - { - if (!adding_line && ImGui::IsMouseClicked(0)) - { - points.push_back(mouse_pos_in_canvas); - adding_line = true; - } - if (ImGui::IsMouseClicked(1) && !points.empty()) - { - adding_line = adding_preview = false; - points.pop_back(); - points.pop_back(); - } - } - draw_list->PushClipRect(canvas_pos, ImVec2(canvas_pos.x+canvas_size.x, canvas_pos.y+canvas_size.y)); // clip lines within the canvas (if we resize it, etc.) - for (int i = 0; i < points.Size - 1; i += 2) - draw_list->AddLine(ImVec2(canvas_pos.x + points[i].x, canvas_pos.y + points[i].y), ImVec2(canvas_pos.x + points[i+1].x, canvas_pos.y + points[i+1].y), IM_COL32(255,255,0,255), 2.0f); - draw_list->PopClipRect(); - if (adding_preview) - points.pop_back(); - } - ImGui::End(); -} - -// Demonstrating creating a simple console window, with scrolling, filtering, completion and history. -// For the console example, here we are using a more C++ like approach of declaring a class to hold the data and the functions. -struct ExampleAppConsole -{ - char InputBuf[256]; - ImVector Items; - bool ScrollToBottom; - ImVector History; - int HistoryPos; // -1: new line, 0..History.Size-1 browsing history. - ImVector Commands; - - ExampleAppConsole() - { - ClearLog(); - memset(InputBuf, 0, sizeof(InputBuf)); - HistoryPos = -1; - Commands.push_back("HELP"); - Commands.push_back("HISTORY"); - Commands.push_back("CLEAR"); - Commands.push_back("CLASSIFY"); // "classify" is here to provide an example of "C"+[tab] completing to "CL" and displaying matches. - AddLog("Welcome to ImGui!"); - } - ~ExampleAppConsole() - { - ClearLog(); - for (int i = 0; i < History.Size; i++) - free(History[i]); - } - - // Portable helpers - static int Stricmp(const char* str1, const char* str2) { int d; while ((d = toupper(*str2) - toupper(*str1)) == 0 && *str1) { str1++; str2++; } return d; } - static int Strnicmp(const char* str1, const char* str2, int n) { int d = 0; while (n > 0 && (d = toupper(*str2) - toupper(*str1)) == 0 && *str1) { str1++; str2++; n--; } return d; } - static char* Strdup(const char *str) { size_t len = strlen(str) + 1; void* buff = malloc(len); return (char*)memcpy(buff, (const void*)str, len); } - - void ClearLog() - { - for (int i = 0; i < Items.Size; i++) - free(Items[i]); - Items.clear(); - ScrollToBottom = true; - } - - void AddLog(const char* fmt, ...) IM_PRINTFARGS(2) - { - char buf[1024]; - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - vsnprintf(buf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf), fmt, args); - buf[IM_ARRAYSIZE(buf)-1] = 0; - va_end(args); - Items.push_back(Strdup(buf)); - ScrollToBottom = true; - } - - void Draw(const char* title, bool* p_open) - { - ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(520,600), ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver); - if (!ImGui::Begin(title, p_open)) - { - ImGui::End(); - return; - } - - ImGui::TextWrapped("This example implements a console with basic coloring, completion and history. A more elaborate implementation may want to store entries along with extra data such as timestamp, emitter, etc."); - ImGui::TextWrapped("Enter 'HELP' for help, press TAB to use text completion."); - - // TODO: display items starting from the bottom - - if (ImGui::SmallButton("Add Dummy Text")) { AddLog("%d some text", Items.Size); AddLog("some more text"); AddLog("display very important message here!"); } ImGui::SameLine(); - if (ImGui::SmallButton("Add Dummy Error")) AddLog("[error] something went wrong"); ImGui::SameLine(); - if (ImGui::SmallButton("Clear")) ClearLog(); ImGui::SameLine(); - if (ImGui::SmallButton("Scroll to bottom")) ScrollToBottom = true; - //static float t = 0.0f; if (ImGui::GetTime() - t > 0.02f) { t = ImGui::GetTime(); AddLog("Spam %f", t); } - - ImGui::Separator(); - - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(0,0)); - static ImGuiTextFilter filter; - filter.Draw("Filter (\"incl,-excl\") (\"error\")", 180); - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); - ImGui::Separator(); - - ImGui::BeginChild("ScrollingRegion", ImVec2(0,-ImGui::GetItemsLineHeightWithSpacing()), false, ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar); - if (ImGui::BeginPopupContextWindow()) - { - if (ImGui::Selectable("Clear")) ClearLog(); - ImGui::EndPopup(); - } - - // Display every line as a separate entry so we can change their color or add custom widgets. If you only want raw text you can use ImGui::TextUnformatted(log.begin(), log.end()); - // NB- if you have thousands of entries this approach may be too inefficient and may require user-side clipping to only process visible items. - // You can seek and display only the lines that are visible using the ImGuiListClipper helper, if your elements are evenly spaced and you have cheap random access to the elements. - // To use the clipper we could replace the 'for (int i = 0; i < Items.Size; i++)' loop with: - // ImGuiListClipper clipper(Items.Size); - // while (clipper.Step()) - // for (int i = clipper.DisplayStart; i < clipper.DisplayEnd; i++) - // However take note that you can not use this code as is if a filter is active because it breaks the 'cheap random-access' property. We would need random-access on the post-filtered list. - // A typical application wanting coarse clipping and filtering may want to pre-compute an array of indices that passed the filtering test, recomputing this array when user changes the filter, - // and appending newly elements as they are inserted. This is left as a task to the user until we can manage to improve this example code! - // If your items are of variable size you may want to implement code similar to what ImGuiListClipper does. Or split your data into fixed height items to allow random-seeking into your list. - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(4,1)); // Tighten spacing - for (int i = 0; i < Items.Size; i++) - { - const char* item = Items[i]; - if (!filter.PassFilter(item)) - continue; - ImVec4 col = ImVec4(1.0f,1.0f,1.0f,1.0f); // A better implementation may store a type per-item. For the sample let's just parse the text. - if (strstr(item, "[error]")) col = ImColor(1.0f,0.4f,0.4f,1.0f); - else if (strncmp(item, "# ", 2) == 0) col = ImColor(1.0f,0.78f,0.58f,1.0f); - ImGui::PushStyleColor(ImGuiCol_Text, col); - ImGui::TextUnformatted(item); - ImGui::PopStyleColor(); - } - if (ScrollToBottom) - ImGui::SetScrollHere(); - ScrollToBottom = false; - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); - ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::Separator(); - - // Command-line - if (ImGui::InputText("Input", InputBuf, IM_ARRAYSIZE(InputBuf), ImGuiInputTextFlags_EnterReturnsTrue|ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion|ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory, &TextEditCallbackStub, (void*)this)) - { - char* input_end = InputBuf+strlen(InputBuf); - while (input_end > InputBuf && input_end[-1] == ' ') input_end--; *input_end = 0; - if (InputBuf[0]) - ExecCommand(InputBuf); - strcpy(InputBuf, ""); - } - - // Demonstrate keeping auto focus on the input box - if (ImGui::IsItemHovered() || (ImGui::IsRootWindowOrAnyChildFocused() && !ImGui::IsAnyItemActive() && !ImGui::IsMouseClicked(0))) - ImGui::SetKeyboardFocusHere(-1); // Auto focus previous widget - - ImGui::End(); - } - - void ExecCommand(const char* command_line) - { - AddLog("# %s\n", command_line); - - // Insert into history. First find match and delete it so it can be pushed to the back. This isn't trying to be smart or optimal. - HistoryPos = -1; - for (int i = History.Size-1; i >= 0; i--) - if (Stricmp(History[i], command_line) == 0) - { - free(History[i]); - History.erase(History.begin() + i); - break; - } - History.push_back(Strdup(command_line)); - - // Process command - if (Stricmp(command_line, "CLEAR") == 0) - { - ClearLog(); - } - else if (Stricmp(command_line, "HELP") == 0) - { - AddLog("Commands:"); - for (int i = 0; i < Commands.Size; i++) - AddLog("- %s", Commands[i]); - } - else if (Stricmp(command_line, "HISTORY") == 0) - { - for (int i = History.Size >= 10 ? History.Size - 10 : 0; i < History.Size; i++) - AddLog("%3d: %s\n", i, History[i]); - } - else - { - AddLog("Unknown command: '%s'\n", command_line); - } - } - - static int TextEditCallbackStub(ImGuiTextEditCallbackData* data) // In C++11 you are better off using lambdas for this sort of forwarding callbacks - { - ExampleAppConsole* console = (ExampleAppConsole*)data->UserData; - return console->TextEditCallback(data); - } - - int TextEditCallback(ImGuiTextEditCallbackData* data) - { - //AddLog("cursor: %d, selection: %d-%d", data->CursorPos, data->SelectionStart, data->SelectionEnd); - switch (data->EventFlag) - { - case ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackCompletion: - { - // Example of TEXT COMPLETION - - // Locate beginning of current word - const char* word_end = data->Buf + data->CursorPos; - const char* word_start = word_end; - while (word_start > data->Buf) - { - const char c = word_start[-1]; - if (c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == ',' || c == ';') - break; - word_start--; - } - - // Build a list of candidates - ImVector candidates; - for (int i = 0; i < Commands.Size; i++) - if (Strnicmp(Commands[i], word_start, (int)(word_end-word_start)) == 0) - candidates.push_back(Commands[i]); - - if (candidates.Size == 0) - { - // No match - AddLog("No match for \"%.*s\"!\n", (int)(word_end-word_start), word_start); - } - else if (candidates.Size == 1) - { - // Single match. Delete the beginning of the word and replace it entirely so we've got nice casing - data->DeleteChars((int)(word_start-data->Buf), (int)(word_end-word_start)); - data->InsertChars(data->CursorPos, candidates[0]); - data->InsertChars(data->CursorPos, " "); - } - else - { - // Multiple matches. Complete as much as we can, so inputing "C" will complete to "CL" and display "CLEAR" and "CLASSIFY" - int match_len = (int)(word_end - word_start); - for (;;) - { - int c = 0; - bool all_candidates_matches = true; - for (int i = 0; i < candidates.Size && all_candidates_matches; i++) - if (i == 0) - c = toupper(candidates[i][match_len]); - else if (c == 0 || c != toupper(candidates[i][match_len])) - all_candidates_matches = false; - if (!all_candidates_matches) - break; - match_len++; - } - - if (match_len > 0) - { - data->DeleteChars((int)(word_start - data->Buf), (int)(word_end-word_start)); - data->InsertChars(data->CursorPos, candidates[0], candidates[0] + match_len); - } - - // List matches - AddLog("Possible matches:\n"); - for (int i = 0; i < candidates.Size; i++) - AddLog("- %s\n", candidates[i]); - } - - break; - } - case ImGuiInputTextFlags_CallbackHistory: - { - // Example of HISTORY - const int prev_history_pos = HistoryPos; - if (data->EventKey == ImGuiKey_UpArrow) - { - if (HistoryPos == -1) - HistoryPos = History.Size - 1; - else if (HistoryPos > 0) - HistoryPos--; - } - else if (data->EventKey == ImGuiKey_DownArrow) - { - if (HistoryPos != -1) - if (++HistoryPos >= History.Size) - HistoryPos = -1; - } - - // A better implementation would preserve the data on the current input line along with cursor position. - if (prev_history_pos != HistoryPos) - { - data->CursorPos = data->SelectionStart = data->SelectionEnd = data->BufTextLen = (int)snprintf(data->Buf, (size_t)data->BufSize, "%s", (HistoryPos >= 0) ? History[HistoryPos] : ""); - data->BufDirty = true; - } - } - } - return 0; - } -}; - -static void ShowExampleAppConsole(bool* p_open) -{ - static ExampleAppConsole console; - console.Draw("Example: Console", p_open); -} - -// Usage: -// static ExampleAppLog my_log; -// my_log.AddLog("Hello %d world\n", 123); -// my_log.Draw("title"); -struct ExampleAppLog -{ - ImGuiTextBuffer Buf; - ImGuiTextFilter Filter; - ImVector LineOffsets; // Index to lines offset - bool ScrollToBottom; - - void Clear() { Buf.clear(); LineOffsets.clear(); } - - void AddLog(const char* fmt, ...) IM_PRINTFARGS(2) - { - int old_size = Buf.size(); - va_list args; - va_start(args, fmt); - Buf.appendv(fmt, args); - va_end(args); - for (int new_size = Buf.size(); old_size < new_size; old_size++) - if (Buf[old_size] == '\n') - LineOffsets.push_back(old_size); - ScrollToBottom = true; - } - - void Draw(const char* title, bool* p_open = NULL) - { - ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(500,400), ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver); - ImGui::Begin(title, p_open); - if (ImGui::Button("Clear")) Clear(); - ImGui::SameLine(); - bool copy = ImGui::Button("Copy"); - ImGui::SameLine(); - Filter.Draw("Filter", -100.0f); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::BeginChild("scrolling", ImVec2(0,0), false, ImGuiWindowFlags_HorizontalScrollbar); - if (copy) ImGui::LogToClipboard(); - - if (Filter.IsActive()) - { - const char* buf_begin = Buf.begin(); - const char* line = buf_begin; - for (int line_no = 0; line != NULL; line_no++) - { - const char* line_end = (line_no < LineOffsets.Size) ? buf_begin + LineOffsets[line_no] : NULL; - if (Filter.PassFilter(line, line_end)) - ImGui::TextUnformatted(line, line_end); - line = line_end && line_end[1] ? line_end + 1 : NULL; - } - } - else - { - ImGui::TextUnformatted(Buf.begin()); - } - - if (ScrollToBottom) - ImGui::SetScrollHere(1.0f); - ScrollToBottom = false; - ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::End(); - } -}; - -// Demonstrate creating a simple log window with basic filtering. -static void ShowExampleAppLog(bool* p_open) -{ - static ExampleAppLog log; - - // Demo fill - static float last_time = -1.0f; - float time = ImGui::GetTime(); - if (time - last_time >= 0.3f) - { - const char* random_words[] = { "system", "info", "warning", "error", "fatal", "notice", "log" }; - log.AddLog("[%s] Hello, time is %.1f, rand() %d\n", random_words[rand() % IM_ARRAYSIZE(random_words)], time, (int)rand()); - last_time = time; - } - - log.Draw("Example: Log", p_open); -} - -// Demonstrate create a window with multiple child windows. -static void ShowExampleAppLayout(bool* p_open) -{ - ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(500, 440), ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver); - if (ImGui::Begin("Example: Layout", p_open, ImGuiWindowFlags_MenuBar)) - { - if (ImGui::BeginMenuBar()) - { - if (ImGui::BeginMenu("File")) - { - if (ImGui::MenuItem("Close")) *p_open = false; - ImGui::EndMenu(); - } - ImGui::EndMenuBar(); - } - - // left - static int selected = 0; - ImGui::BeginChild("left pane", ImVec2(150, 0), true); - for (int i = 0; i < 100; i++) - { - char label[128]; - sprintf(label, "MyObject %d", i); - if (ImGui::Selectable(label, selected == i)) - selected = i; - } - ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::SameLine(); - - // right - ImGui::BeginGroup(); - ImGui::BeginChild("item view", ImVec2(0, -ImGui::GetItemsLineHeightWithSpacing())); // Leave room for 1 line below us - ImGui::Text("MyObject: %d", selected); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::TextWrapped("Lorem ipsum dolor sit amet, consectetur adipiscing elit, sed do eiusmod tempor incididunt ut labore et dolore magna aliqua. "); - ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::BeginChild("buttons"); - if (ImGui::Button("Revert")) {} - ImGui::SameLine(); - if (ImGui::Button("Save")) {} - ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::EndGroup(); - } - ImGui::End(); -} - -// Demonstrate create a simple property editor. -static void ShowExampleAppPropertyEditor(bool* p_open) -{ - ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(430,450), ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver); - if (!ImGui::Begin("Example: Property editor", p_open)) - { - ImGui::End(); - return; - } - - ShowHelpMarker("This example shows how you may implement a property editor using two columns.\nAll objects/fields data are dummies here.\nRemember that in many simple cases, you can use ImGui::SameLine(xxx) to position\nyour cursor horizontally instead of using the Columns() API."); - - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_FramePadding, ImVec2(2,2)); - ImGui::Columns(2); - ImGui::Separator(); - - struct funcs - { - static void ShowDummyObject(const char* prefix, int uid) - { - ImGui::PushID(uid); // Use object uid as identifier. Most commonly you could also use the object pointer as a base ID. - ImGui::AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets(); // Text and Tree nodes are less high than regular widgets, here we add vertical spacing to make the tree lines equal high. - bool node_open = ImGui::TreeNode("Object", "%s_%u", prefix, uid); - ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets(); - ImGui::Text("my sailor is rich"); - ImGui::NextColumn(); - if (node_open) - { - static float dummy_members[8] = { 0.0f,0.0f,1.0f,3.1416f,100.0f,999.0f }; - for (int i = 0; i < 8; i++) - { - ImGui::PushID(i); // Use field index as identifier. - if (i < 2) - { - ShowDummyObject("Child", 424242); - } - else - { - ImGui::AlignFirstTextHeightToWidgets(); - // Here we use a Selectable (instead of Text) to highlight on hover - //ImGui::Text("Field_%d", i); - char label[32]; - sprintf(label, "Field_%d", i); - ImGui::Bullet(); - ImGui::Selectable(label); - ImGui::NextColumn(); - ImGui::PushItemWidth(-1); - if (i >= 5) - ImGui::InputFloat("##value", &dummy_members[i], 1.0f); - else - ImGui::DragFloat("##value", &dummy_members[i], 0.01f); - ImGui::PopItemWidth(); - ImGui::NextColumn(); - } - ImGui::PopID(); - } - ImGui::TreePop(); - } - ImGui::PopID(); - } - }; - - // Iterate dummy objects with dummy members (all the same data) - for (int obj_i = 0; obj_i < 3; obj_i++) - funcs::ShowDummyObject("Object", obj_i); - - ImGui::Columns(1); - ImGui::Separator(); - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); - ImGui::End(); -} - -// Demonstrate/test rendering huge amount of text, and the incidence of clipping. -static void ShowExampleAppLongText(bool* p_open) -{ - ImGui::SetNextWindowSize(ImVec2(520,600), ImGuiSetCond_FirstUseEver); - if (!ImGui::Begin("Example: Long text display", p_open)) - { - ImGui::End(); - return; - } - - static int test_type = 0; - static ImGuiTextBuffer log; - static int lines = 0; - ImGui::Text("Printing unusually long amount of text."); - ImGui::Combo("Test type", &test_type, "Single call to TextUnformatted()\0Multiple calls to Text(), clipped manually\0Multiple calls to Text(), not clipped\0"); - ImGui::Text("Buffer contents: %d lines, %d bytes", lines, log.size()); - if (ImGui::Button("Clear")) { log.clear(); lines = 0; } - ImGui::SameLine(); - if (ImGui::Button("Add 1000 lines")) - { - for (int i = 0; i < 1000; i++) - log.append("%i The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog\n", lines+i); - lines += 1000; - } - ImGui::BeginChild("Log"); - switch (test_type) - { - case 0: - // Single call to TextUnformatted() with a big buffer - ImGui::TextUnformatted(log.begin(), log.end()); - break; - case 1: - { - // Multiple calls to Text(), manually coarsely clipped - demonstrate how to use the ImGuiListClipper helper. - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(0,0)); - ImGuiListClipper clipper(lines); - while (clipper.Step()) - for (int i = clipper.DisplayStart; i < clipper.DisplayEnd; i++) - ImGui::Text("%i The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog", i); - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); - break; - } - case 2: - // Multiple calls to Text(), not clipped (slow) - ImGui::PushStyleVar(ImGuiStyleVar_ItemSpacing, ImVec2(0,0)); - for (int i = 0; i < lines; i++) - ImGui::Text("%i The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog", i); - ImGui::PopStyleVar(); - break; - } - ImGui::EndChild(); - ImGui::End(); -} - -// End of Demo code -#else - -void ImGui::ShowTestWindow(bool*) {} -void ImGui::ShowUserGuide() {} -void ImGui::ShowStyleEditor(ImGuiStyle*) {} - -#endif \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/src/imgui/imgui_draw.cpp b/src/imgui/imgui_draw.cpp deleted file mode 100644 index 14afae7..0000000 --- a/src/imgui/imgui_draw.cpp +++ /dev/null @@ -1,2394 +0,0 @@ -// dear imgui, v1.50 WIP -// (drawing and font code) - -// Contains implementation for -// - ImDrawList -// - ImDrawData -// - ImFontAtlas -// - ImFont -// - Default font data - -#if defined(_MSC_VER) && !defined(_CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS) -#define _CRT_SECURE_NO_WARNINGS -#endif - -#include -#define IMGUI_DEFINE_MATH_OPERATORS -#define IMGUI_DEFINE_PLACEMENT_NEW -#include - -#include // vsnprintf, sscanf, printf -#if !defined(alloca) -#ifdef _WIN32 -#include // alloca -#elif (defined(__FreeBSD__) || defined(FreeBSD_kernel) || defined(__DragonFly__)) && !defined(__GLIBC__) -#include // alloca. FreeBSD uses stdlib.h unless GLIBC -#else -#include // alloca -#endif -#endif - -#ifdef _MSC_VER -#pragma warning (disable: 4505) // unreferenced local function has been removed (stb stuff) -#pragma warning (disable: 4996) // 'This function or variable may be unsafe': strcpy, strdup, sprintf, vsnprintf, sscanf, fopen -#define snprintf _snprintf -#endif - -#ifdef __clang__ -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" // warning : use of old-style cast // yes, they are more terse. -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wfloat-equal" // warning : comparing floating point with == or != is unsafe // storing and comparing against same constants ok. -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wglobal-constructors" // warning : declaration requires a global destructor // similar to above, not sure what the exact difference it. -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wsign-conversion" // warning : implicit conversion changes signedness // -#if __has_warning("-Wreserved-id-macro") -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wreserved-id-macro" // warning : macro name is a reserved identifier // -#endif -#elif defined(__GNUC__) -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-function" // warning: 'xxxx' defined but not used -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wdouble-promotion" // warning: implicit conversion from 'float' to 'double' when passing argument to function -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wconversion" // warning: conversion to 'xxxx' from 'xxxx' may alter its value -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wcast-qual" // warning: cast from type 'xxxx' to type 'xxxx' casts away qualifiers -#endif - -//------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// STB libraries implementation -//------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -//#define IMGUI_STB_NAMESPACE ImGuiStb -//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_STB_RECT_PACK_IMPLEMENTATION -//#define IMGUI_DISABLE_STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION - -#ifdef IMGUI_STB_NAMESPACE -namespace IMGUI_STB_NAMESPACE -{ -#endif - -#ifdef _MSC_VER -#pragma warning (push) -#pragma warning (disable: 4456) // declaration of 'xx' hides previous local declaration -#endif - -#ifdef __clang__ -#pragma clang diagnostic push -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wold-style-cast" // warning : use of old-style cast // yes, they are more terse. -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wunused-function" -#pragma clang diagnostic ignored "-Wmissing-prototypes" -#endif - -#ifdef __GNUC__ -#pragma GCC diagnostic push -#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wtype-limits" // warning: comparison is always true due to limited range of data type [-Wtype-limits] -#endif - -#define STBRP_ASSERT(x) IM_ASSERT(x) -#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_STB_RECT_PACK_IMPLEMENTATION -#define STBRP_STATIC -#define STB_RECT_PACK_IMPLEMENTATION -#endif -#include - -#define STBTT_malloc(x,u) ((void)(u), ImGui::MemAlloc(x)) -#define STBTT_free(x,u) ((void)(u), ImGui::MemFree(x)) -#define STBTT_assert(x) IM_ASSERT(x) -#ifndef IMGUI_DISABLE_STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION -#define STBTT_STATIC -#define STB_TRUETYPE_IMPLEMENTATION -#else -#define STBTT_DEF extern -#endif -#include - -#ifdef __GNUC__ -#pragma GCC diagnostic pop -#endif - -#ifdef __clang__ -#pragma clang diagnostic pop -#endif - -#ifdef _MSC_VER -#pragma warning (pop) -#endif - -#ifdef IMGUI_STB_NAMESPACE -} // namespace ImGuiStb -using namespace IMGUI_STB_NAMESPACE; -#endif - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// ImDrawList -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -static const ImVec4 GNullClipRect(-8192.0f, -8192.0f, +8192.0f, +8192.0f); // Large values that are easy to encode in a few bits+shift - -void ImDrawList::Clear() -{ - CmdBuffer.resize(0); - IdxBuffer.resize(0); - VtxBuffer.resize(0); - _VtxCurrentIdx = 0; - _VtxWritePtr = NULL; - _IdxWritePtr = NULL; - _ClipRectStack.resize(0); - _TextureIdStack.resize(0); - _Path.resize(0); - _ChannelsCurrent = 0; - _ChannelsCount = 1; - // NB: Do not clear channels so our allocations are re-used after the first frame. -} - -void ImDrawList::ClearFreeMemory() -{ - CmdBuffer.clear(); - IdxBuffer.clear(); - VtxBuffer.clear(); - _VtxCurrentIdx = 0; - _VtxWritePtr = NULL; - _IdxWritePtr = NULL; - _ClipRectStack.clear(); - _TextureIdStack.clear(); - _Path.clear(); - _ChannelsCurrent = 0; - _ChannelsCount = 1; - for (int i = 0; i < _Channels.Size; i++) - { - if (i == 0) memset(&_Channels[0], 0, sizeof(_Channels[0])); // channel 0 is a copy of CmdBuffer/IdxBuffer, don't destruct again - _Channels[i].CmdBuffer.clear(); - _Channels[i].IdxBuffer.clear(); - } - _Channels.clear(); -} - -// Use macros because C++ is a terrible language, we want guaranteed inline, no code in header, and no overhead in Debug mode -#define GetCurrentClipRect() (_ClipRectStack.Size ? _ClipRectStack.Data[_ClipRectStack.Size-1] : GNullClipRect) -#define GetCurrentTextureId() (_TextureIdStack.Size ? _TextureIdStack.Data[_TextureIdStack.Size-1] : NULL) - -void ImDrawList::AddDrawCmd() -{ - ImDrawCmd draw_cmd; - draw_cmd.ClipRect = GetCurrentClipRect(); - draw_cmd.TextureId = GetCurrentTextureId(); - - IM_ASSERT(draw_cmd.ClipRect.x <= draw_cmd.ClipRect.z && draw_cmd.ClipRect.y <= draw_cmd.ClipRect.w); - CmdBuffer.push_back(draw_cmd); -} - -void ImDrawList::AddCallback(ImDrawCallback callback, void* callback_data) -{ - ImDrawCmd* current_cmd = CmdBuffer.Size ? &CmdBuffer.back() : NULL; - if (!current_cmd || current_cmd->ElemCount != 0 || current_cmd->UserCallback != NULL) - { - AddDrawCmd(); - current_cmd = &CmdBuffer.back(); - } - current_cmd->UserCallback = callback; - current_cmd->UserCallbackData = callback_data; - - AddDrawCmd(); // Force a new command after us (see comment below) -} - -// Our scheme may appears a bit unusual, basically we want the most-common calls AddLine AddRect etc. to not have to perform any check so we always have a command ready in the stack. -// The cost of figuring out if a new command has to be added or if we can merge is paid in those Update** functions only. -void ImDrawList::UpdateClipRect() -{ - // If current command is used with different settings we need to add a new command - const ImVec4 curr_clip_rect = GetCurrentClipRect(); - ImDrawCmd* curr_cmd = CmdBuffer.Size > 0 ? &CmdBuffer.Data[CmdBuffer.Size-1] : NULL; - if (!curr_cmd || (curr_cmd->ElemCount != 0 && memcmp(&curr_cmd->ClipRect, &curr_clip_rect, sizeof(ImVec4)) != 0) || curr_cmd->UserCallback != NULL) - { - AddDrawCmd(); - return; - } - - // Try to merge with previous command if it matches, else use current command - ImDrawCmd* prev_cmd = CmdBuffer.Size > 1 ? curr_cmd - 1 : NULL; - if (curr_cmd->ElemCount == 0 && prev_cmd && memcmp(&prev_cmd->ClipRect, &curr_clip_rect, sizeof(ImVec4)) == 0 && prev_cmd->TextureId == GetCurrentTextureId() && prev_cmd->UserCallback == NULL) - CmdBuffer.pop_back(); - else - curr_cmd->ClipRect = curr_clip_rect; -} - -void ImDrawList::UpdateTextureID() -{ - // If current command is used with different settings we need to add a new command - const ImTextureID curr_texture_id = GetCurrentTextureId(); - ImDrawCmd* curr_cmd = CmdBuffer.Size ? &CmdBuffer.back() : NULL; - if (!curr_cmd || (curr_cmd->ElemCount != 0 && curr_cmd->TextureId != curr_texture_id) || curr_cmd->UserCallback != NULL) - { - AddDrawCmd(); - return; - } - - // Try to merge with previous command if it matches, else use current command - ImDrawCmd* prev_cmd = CmdBuffer.Size > 1 ? curr_cmd - 1 : NULL; - if (prev_cmd && prev_cmd->TextureId == curr_texture_id && memcmp(&prev_cmd->ClipRect, &GetCurrentClipRect(), sizeof(ImVec4)) == 0 && prev_cmd->UserCallback == NULL) - CmdBuffer.pop_back(); - else - curr_cmd->TextureId = curr_texture_id; -} - -#undef GetCurrentClipRect -#undef GetCurrentTextureId - -// Render-level scissoring. This is passed down to your render function but not used for CPU-side coarse clipping. Prefer using higher-level ImGui::PushClipRect() to affect logic (hit-testing and widget culling) -void ImDrawList::PushClipRect(ImVec2 cr_min, ImVec2 cr_max, bool intersect_with_current_clip_rect) -{ - ImVec4 cr(cr_min.x, cr_min.y, cr_max.x, cr_max.y); - if (intersect_with_current_clip_rect && _ClipRectStack.Size) - { - ImVec4 current = _ClipRectStack.Data[_ClipRectStack.Size-1]; - if (cr.x < current.x) cr.x = current.x; - if (cr.y < current.y) cr.y = current.y; - if (cr.z > current.z) cr.z = current.z; - if (cr.w > current.w) cr.w = current.w; - } - cr.z = ImMax(cr.x, cr.z); - cr.w = ImMax(cr.y, cr.w); - - _ClipRectStack.push_back(cr); - UpdateClipRect(); -} - -void ImDrawList::PushClipRectFullScreen() -{ - PushClipRect(ImVec2(GNullClipRect.x, GNullClipRect.y), ImVec2(GNullClipRect.z, GNullClipRect.w)); - //PushClipRect(GetVisibleRect()); // FIXME-OPT: This would be more correct but we're not supposed to access ImGuiContext from here? -} - -void ImDrawList::PopClipRect() -{ - IM_ASSERT(_ClipRectStack.Size > 0); - _ClipRectStack.pop_back(); - UpdateClipRect(); -} - -void ImDrawList::PushTextureID(const ImTextureID& texture_id) -{ - _TextureIdStack.push_back(texture_id); - UpdateTextureID(); -} - -void ImDrawList::PopTextureID() -{ - IM_ASSERT(_TextureIdStack.Size > 0); - _TextureIdStack.pop_back(); - UpdateTextureID(); -} - -void ImDrawList::ChannelsSplit(int channels_count) -{ - IM_ASSERT(_ChannelsCurrent == 0 && _ChannelsCount == 1); - int old_channels_count = _Channels.Size; - if (old_channels_count < channels_count) - _Channels.resize(channels_count); - _ChannelsCount = channels_count; - - // _Channels[] (24 bytes each) hold storage that we'll swap with this->_CmdBuffer/_IdxBuffer - // The content of _Channels[0] at this point doesn't matter. We clear it to make state tidy in a debugger but we don't strictly need to. - // When we switch to the next channel, we'll copy _CmdBuffer/_IdxBuffer into _Channels[0] and then _Channels[1] into _CmdBuffer/_IdxBuffer - memset(&_Channels[0], 0, sizeof(ImDrawChannel)); - for (int i = 1; i < channels_count; i++) - { - if (i >= old_channels_count) - { - IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(&_Channels[i]) ImDrawChannel(); - } - else - { - _Channels[i].CmdBuffer.resize(0); - _Channels[i].IdxBuffer.resize(0); - } - if (_Channels[i].CmdBuffer.Size == 0) - { - ImDrawCmd draw_cmd; - draw_cmd.ClipRect = _ClipRectStack.back(); - draw_cmd.TextureId = _TextureIdStack.back(); - _Channels[i].CmdBuffer.push_back(draw_cmd); - } - } -} - -void ImDrawList::ChannelsMerge() -{ - // Note that we never use or rely on channels.Size because it is merely a buffer that we never shrink back to 0 to keep all sub-buffers ready for use. - if (_ChannelsCount <= 1) - return; - - ChannelsSetCurrent(0); - if (CmdBuffer.Size && CmdBuffer.back().ElemCount == 0) - CmdBuffer.pop_back(); - - int new_cmd_buffer_count = 0, new_idx_buffer_count = 0; - for (int i = 1; i < _ChannelsCount; i++) - { - ImDrawChannel& ch = _Channels[i]; - if (ch.CmdBuffer.Size && ch.CmdBuffer.back().ElemCount == 0) - ch.CmdBuffer.pop_back(); - new_cmd_buffer_count += ch.CmdBuffer.Size; - new_idx_buffer_count += ch.IdxBuffer.Size; - } - CmdBuffer.resize(CmdBuffer.Size + new_cmd_buffer_count); - IdxBuffer.resize(IdxBuffer.Size + new_idx_buffer_count); - - ImDrawCmd* cmd_write = CmdBuffer.Data + CmdBuffer.Size - new_cmd_buffer_count; - _IdxWritePtr = IdxBuffer.Data + IdxBuffer.Size - new_idx_buffer_count; - for (int i = 1; i < _ChannelsCount; i++) - { - ImDrawChannel& ch = _Channels[i]; - if (int sz = ch.CmdBuffer.Size) { memcpy(cmd_write, ch.CmdBuffer.Data, sz * sizeof(ImDrawCmd)); cmd_write += sz; } - if (int sz = ch.IdxBuffer.Size) { memcpy(_IdxWritePtr, ch.IdxBuffer.Data, sz * sizeof(ImDrawIdx)); _IdxWritePtr += sz; } - } - AddDrawCmd(); - _ChannelsCount = 1; -} - -void ImDrawList::ChannelsSetCurrent(int idx) -{ - IM_ASSERT(idx < _ChannelsCount); - if (_ChannelsCurrent == idx) return; - memcpy(&_Channels.Data[_ChannelsCurrent].CmdBuffer, &CmdBuffer, sizeof(CmdBuffer)); // copy 12 bytes, four times - memcpy(&_Channels.Data[_ChannelsCurrent].IdxBuffer, &IdxBuffer, sizeof(IdxBuffer)); - _ChannelsCurrent = idx; - memcpy(&CmdBuffer, &_Channels.Data[_ChannelsCurrent].CmdBuffer, sizeof(CmdBuffer)); - memcpy(&IdxBuffer, &_Channels.Data[_ChannelsCurrent].IdxBuffer, sizeof(IdxBuffer)); - _IdxWritePtr = IdxBuffer.Data + IdxBuffer.Size; -} - -// NB: this can be called with negative count for removing primitives (as long as the result does not underflow) -void ImDrawList::PrimReserve(int idx_count, int vtx_count) -{ - ImDrawCmd& draw_cmd = CmdBuffer.Data[CmdBuffer.Size-1]; - draw_cmd.ElemCount += idx_count; - - int vtx_buffer_size = VtxBuffer.Size; - VtxBuffer.resize(vtx_buffer_size + vtx_count); - _VtxWritePtr = VtxBuffer.Data + vtx_buffer_size; - - int idx_buffer_size = IdxBuffer.Size; - IdxBuffer.resize(idx_buffer_size + idx_count); - _IdxWritePtr = IdxBuffer.Data + idx_buffer_size; -} - -// Fully unrolled with inline call to keep our debug builds decently fast. -void ImDrawList::PrimRect(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& c, ImU32 col) -{ - ImVec2 b(c.x, a.y), d(a.x, c.y), uv(GImGui->FontTexUvWhitePixel); - ImDrawIdx idx = (ImDrawIdx)_VtxCurrentIdx; - _IdxWritePtr[0] = idx; _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+1); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+2); - _IdxWritePtr[3] = idx; _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+2); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+3); - _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = a; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[1].pos = b; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[2].pos = c; _VtxWritePtr[2].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[2].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[3].pos = d; _VtxWritePtr[3].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[3].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr += 4; - _VtxCurrentIdx += 4; - _IdxWritePtr += 6; -} - -void ImDrawList::PrimRectUV(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& uv_a, const ImVec2& uv_c, ImU32 col) -{ - ImVec2 b(c.x, a.y), d(a.x, c.y), uv_b(uv_c.x, uv_a.y), uv_d(uv_a.x, uv_c.y); - ImDrawIdx idx = (ImDrawIdx)_VtxCurrentIdx; - _IdxWritePtr[0] = idx; _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+1); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+2); - _IdxWritePtr[3] = idx; _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+2); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+3); - _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = a; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv_a; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[1].pos = b; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = uv_b; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[2].pos = c; _VtxWritePtr[2].uv = uv_c; _VtxWritePtr[2].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[3].pos = d; _VtxWritePtr[3].uv = uv_d; _VtxWritePtr[3].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr += 4; - _VtxCurrentIdx += 4; - _IdxWritePtr += 6; -} - -void ImDrawList::PrimQuadUV(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& d, const ImVec2& uv_a, const ImVec2& uv_b, const ImVec2& uv_c, const ImVec2& uv_d, ImU32 col) -{ - ImDrawIdx idx = (ImDrawIdx)_VtxCurrentIdx; - _IdxWritePtr[0] = idx; _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+1); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+2); - _IdxWritePtr[3] = idx; _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+2); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx+3); - _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = a; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv_a; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[1].pos = b; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = uv_b; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[2].pos = c; _VtxWritePtr[2].uv = uv_c; _VtxWritePtr[2].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[3].pos = d; _VtxWritePtr[3].uv = uv_d; _VtxWritePtr[3].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr += 4; - _VtxCurrentIdx += 4; - _IdxWritePtr += 6; -} - -// TODO: Thickness anti-aliased lines cap are missing their AA fringe. -void ImDrawList::AddPolyline(const ImVec2* points, const int points_count, ImU32 col, bool closed, float thickness, bool anti_aliased) -{ - if (points_count < 2) - return; - - const ImVec2 uv = GImGui->FontTexUvWhitePixel; - anti_aliased &= GImGui->Style.AntiAliasedLines; - //if (ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl) anti_aliased = false; // Debug - - int count = points_count; - if (!closed) - count = points_count-1; - - const bool thick_line = thickness > 1.0f; - if (anti_aliased) - { - // Anti-aliased stroke - const float AA_SIZE = 1.0f; - const ImU32 col_trans = col & IM_COL32(255,255,255,0); - - const int idx_count = thick_line ? count*18 : count*12; - const int vtx_count = thick_line ? points_count*4 : points_count*3; - PrimReserve(idx_count, vtx_count); - - // Temporary buffer - ImVec2* temp_normals = (ImVec2*)alloca(points_count * (thick_line ? 5 : 3) * sizeof(ImVec2)); - ImVec2* temp_points = temp_normals + points_count; - - for (int i1 = 0; i1 < count; i1++) - { - const int i2 = (i1+1) == points_count ? 0 : i1+1; - ImVec2 diff = points[i2] - points[i1]; - diff *= ImInvLength(diff, 1.0f); - temp_normals[i1].x = diff.y; - temp_normals[i1].y = -diff.x; - } - if (!closed) - temp_normals[points_count-1] = temp_normals[points_count-2]; - - if (!thick_line) - { - if (!closed) - { - temp_points[0] = points[0] + temp_normals[0] * AA_SIZE; - temp_points[1] = points[0] - temp_normals[0] * AA_SIZE; - temp_points[(points_count-1)*2+0] = points[points_count-1] + temp_normals[points_count-1] * AA_SIZE; - temp_points[(points_count-1)*2+1] = points[points_count-1] - temp_normals[points_count-1] * AA_SIZE; - } - - // FIXME-OPT: Merge the different loops, possibly remove the temporary buffer. - unsigned int idx1 = _VtxCurrentIdx; - for (int i1 = 0; i1 < count; i1++) - { - const int i2 = (i1+1) == points_count ? 0 : i1+1; - unsigned int idx2 = (i1+1) == points_count ? _VtxCurrentIdx : idx1+3; - - // Average normals - ImVec2 dm = (temp_normals[i1] + temp_normals[i2]) * 0.5f; - float dmr2 = dm.x*dm.x + dm.y*dm.y; - if (dmr2 > 0.000001f) - { - float scale = 1.0f / dmr2; - if (scale > 100.0f) scale = 100.0f; - dm *= scale; - } - dm *= AA_SIZE; - temp_points[i2*2+0] = points[i2] + dm; - temp_points[i2*2+1] = points[i2] - dm; - - // Add indexes - _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+0); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+0); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+2); - _IdxWritePtr[3] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+2); _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+2); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+0); - _IdxWritePtr[6] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+1); _IdxWritePtr[7] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+1); _IdxWritePtr[8] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+0); - _IdxWritePtr[9] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+0); _IdxWritePtr[10]= (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+0); _IdxWritePtr[11]= (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+1); - _IdxWritePtr += 12; - - idx1 = idx2; - } - - // Add vertexes - for (int i = 0; i < points_count; i++) - { - _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = points[i]; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[1].pos = temp_points[i*2+0]; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col_trans; - _VtxWritePtr[2].pos = temp_points[i*2+1]; _VtxWritePtr[2].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[2].col = col_trans; - _VtxWritePtr += 3; - } - } - else - { - const float half_inner_thickness = (thickness - AA_SIZE) * 0.5f; - if (!closed) - { - temp_points[0] = points[0] + temp_normals[0] * (half_inner_thickness + AA_SIZE); - temp_points[1] = points[0] + temp_normals[0] * (half_inner_thickness); - temp_points[2] = points[0] - temp_normals[0] * (half_inner_thickness); - temp_points[3] = points[0] - temp_normals[0] * (half_inner_thickness + AA_SIZE); - temp_points[(points_count-1)*4+0] = points[points_count-1] + temp_normals[points_count-1] * (half_inner_thickness + AA_SIZE); - temp_points[(points_count-1)*4+1] = points[points_count-1] + temp_normals[points_count-1] * (half_inner_thickness); - temp_points[(points_count-1)*4+2] = points[points_count-1] - temp_normals[points_count-1] * (half_inner_thickness); - temp_points[(points_count-1)*4+3] = points[points_count-1] - temp_normals[points_count-1] * (half_inner_thickness + AA_SIZE); - } - - // FIXME-OPT: Merge the different loops, possibly remove the temporary buffer. - unsigned int idx1 = _VtxCurrentIdx; - for (int i1 = 0; i1 < count; i1++) - { - const int i2 = (i1+1) == points_count ? 0 : i1+1; - unsigned int idx2 = (i1+1) == points_count ? _VtxCurrentIdx : idx1+4; - - // Average normals - ImVec2 dm = (temp_normals[i1] + temp_normals[i2]) * 0.5f; - float dmr2 = dm.x*dm.x + dm.y*dm.y; - if (dmr2 > 0.000001f) - { - float scale = 1.0f / dmr2; - if (scale > 100.0f) scale = 100.0f; - dm *= scale; - } - ImVec2 dm_out = dm * (half_inner_thickness + AA_SIZE); - ImVec2 dm_in = dm * half_inner_thickness; - temp_points[i2*4+0] = points[i2] + dm_out; - temp_points[i2*4+1] = points[i2] + dm_in; - temp_points[i2*4+2] = points[i2] - dm_in; - temp_points[i2*4+3] = points[i2] - dm_out; - - // Add indexes - _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+1); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+1); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+2); - _IdxWritePtr[3] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+2); _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+2); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+1); - _IdxWritePtr[6] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+1); _IdxWritePtr[7] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+1); _IdxWritePtr[8] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+0); - _IdxWritePtr[9] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+0); _IdxWritePtr[10] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+0); _IdxWritePtr[11] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+1); - _IdxWritePtr[12] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+2); _IdxWritePtr[13] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+2); _IdxWritePtr[14] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+3); - _IdxWritePtr[15] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx1+3); _IdxWritePtr[16] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+3); _IdxWritePtr[17] = (ImDrawIdx)(idx2+2); - _IdxWritePtr += 18; - - idx1 = idx2; - } - - // Add vertexes - for (int i = 0; i < points_count; i++) - { - _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = temp_points[i*4+0]; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col_trans; - _VtxWritePtr[1].pos = temp_points[i*4+1]; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[2].pos = temp_points[i*4+2]; _VtxWritePtr[2].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[2].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[3].pos = temp_points[i*4+3]; _VtxWritePtr[3].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[3].col = col_trans; - _VtxWritePtr += 4; - } - } - _VtxCurrentIdx += (ImDrawIdx)vtx_count; - } - else - { - // Non Anti-aliased Stroke - const int idx_count = count*6; - const int vtx_count = count*4; // FIXME-OPT: Not sharing edges - PrimReserve(idx_count, vtx_count); - - for (int i1 = 0; i1 < count; i1++) - { - const int i2 = (i1+1) == points_count ? 0 : i1+1; - const ImVec2& p1 = points[i1]; - const ImVec2& p2 = points[i2]; - ImVec2 diff = p2 - p1; - diff *= ImInvLength(diff, 1.0f); - - const float dx = diff.x * (thickness * 0.5f); - const float dy = diff.y * (thickness * 0.5f); - _VtxWritePtr[0].pos.x = p1.x + dy; _VtxWritePtr[0].pos.y = p1.y - dx; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[1].pos.x = p2.x + dy; _VtxWritePtr[1].pos.y = p2.y - dx; _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[2].pos.x = p2.x - dy; _VtxWritePtr[2].pos.y = p2.y + dx; _VtxWritePtr[2].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[2].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr[3].pos.x = p1.x - dy; _VtxWritePtr[3].pos.y = p1.y + dx; _VtxWritePtr[3].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[3].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr += 4; - - _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx+1); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx+2); - _IdxWritePtr[3] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx); _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx+2); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx+3); - _IdxWritePtr += 6; - _VtxCurrentIdx += 4; - } - } -} - -void ImDrawList::AddConvexPolyFilled(const ImVec2* points, const int points_count, ImU32 col, bool anti_aliased) -{ - const ImVec2 uv = GImGui->FontTexUvWhitePixel; - anti_aliased &= GImGui->Style.AntiAliasedShapes; - //if (ImGui::GetIO().KeyCtrl) anti_aliased = false; // Debug - - if (anti_aliased) - { - // Anti-aliased Fill - const float AA_SIZE = 1.0f; - const ImU32 col_trans = col & IM_COL32(255,255,255,0); - const int idx_count = (points_count-2)*3 + points_count*6; - const int vtx_count = (points_count*2); - PrimReserve(idx_count, vtx_count); - - // Add indexes for fill - unsigned int vtx_inner_idx = _VtxCurrentIdx; - unsigned int vtx_outer_idx = _VtxCurrentIdx+1; - for (int i = 2; i < points_count; i++) - { - _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_inner_idx); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_inner_idx+((i-1)<<1)); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_inner_idx+(i<<1)); - _IdxWritePtr += 3; - } - - // Compute normals - ImVec2* temp_normals = (ImVec2*)alloca(points_count * sizeof(ImVec2)); - for (int i0 = points_count-1, i1 = 0; i1 < points_count; i0 = i1++) - { - const ImVec2& p0 = points[i0]; - const ImVec2& p1 = points[i1]; - ImVec2 diff = p1 - p0; - diff *= ImInvLength(diff, 1.0f); - temp_normals[i0].x = diff.y; - temp_normals[i0].y = -diff.x; - } - - for (int i0 = points_count-1, i1 = 0; i1 < points_count; i0 = i1++) - { - // Average normals - const ImVec2& n0 = temp_normals[i0]; - const ImVec2& n1 = temp_normals[i1]; - ImVec2 dm = (n0 + n1) * 0.5f; - float dmr2 = dm.x*dm.x + dm.y*dm.y; - if (dmr2 > 0.000001f) - { - float scale = 1.0f / dmr2; - if (scale > 100.0f) scale = 100.0f; - dm *= scale; - } - dm *= AA_SIZE * 0.5f; - - // Add vertices - _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = (points[i1] - dm); _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; // Inner - _VtxWritePtr[1].pos = (points[i1] + dm); _VtxWritePtr[1].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[1].col = col_trans; // Outer - _VtxWritePtr += 2; - - // Add indexes for fringes - _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_inner_idx+(i1<<1)); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_inner_idx+(i0<<1)); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_outer_idx+(i0<<1)); - _IdxWritePtr[3] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_outer_idx+(i0<<1)); _IdxWritePtr[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_outer_idx+(i1<<1)); _IdxWritePtr[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_inner_idx+(i1<<1)); - _IdxWritePtr += 6; - } - _VtxCurrentIdx += (ImDrawIdx)vtx_count; - } - else - { - // Non Anti-aliased Fill - const int idx_count = (points_count-2)*3; - const int vtx_count = points_count; - PrimReserve(idx_count, vtx_count); - for (int i = 0; i < vtx_count; i++) - { - _VtxWritePtr[0].pos = points[i]; _VtxWritePtr[0].uv = uv; _VtxWritePtr[0].col = col; - _VtxWritePtr++; - } - for (int i = 2; i < points_count; i++) - { - _IdxWritePtr[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx); _IdxWritePtr[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx+i-1); _IdxWritePtr[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx+i); - _IdxWritePtr += 3; - } - _VtxCurrentIdx += (ImDrawIdx)vtx_count; - } -} - -void ImDrawList::PathArcToFast(const ImVec2& centre, float radius, int amin, int amax) -{ - static ImVec2 circle_vtx[12]; - static bool circle_vtx_builds = false; - const int circle_vtx_count = IM_ARRAYSIZE(circle_vtx); - if (!circle_vtx_builds) - { - for (int i = 0; i < circle_vtx_count; i++) - { - const float a = ((float)i / (float)circle_vtx_count) * 2*IM_PI; - circle_vtx[i].x = cosf(a); - circle_vtx[i].y = sinf(a); - } - circle_vtx_builds = true; - } - - if (amin > amax) return; - if (radius == 0.0f) - { - _Path.push_back(centre); - } - else - { - _Path.reserve(_Path.Size + (amax - amin + 1)); - for (int a = amin; a <= amax; a++) - { - const ImVec2& c = circle_vtx[a % circle_vtx_count]; - _Path.push_back(ImVec2(centre.x + c.x * radius, centre.y + c.y * radius)); - } - } -} - -void ImDrawList::PathArcTo(const ImVec2& centre, float radius, float amin, float amax, int num_segments) -{ - if (radius == 0.0f) - _Path.push_back(centre); - _Path.reserve(_Path.Size + (num_segments + 1)); - for (int i = 0; i <= num_segments; i++) - { - const float a = amin + ((float)i / (float)num_segments) * (amax - amin); - _Path.push_back(ImVec2(centre.x + cosf(a) * radius, centre.y + sinf(a) * radius)); - } -} - -static void PathBezierToCasteljau(ImVector* path, float x1, float y1, float x2, float y2, float x3, float y3, float x4, float y4, float tess_tol, int level) -{ - float dx = x4 - x1; - float dy = y4 - y1; - float d2 = ((x2 - x4) * dy - (y2 - y4) * dx); - float d3 = ((x3 - x4) * dy - (y3 - y4) * dx); - d2 = (d2 >= 0) ? d2 : -d2; - d3 = (d3 >= 0) ? d3 : -d3; - if ((d2+d3) * (d2+d3) < tess_tol * (dx*dx + dy*dy)) - { - path->push_back(ImVec2(x4, y4)); - } - else if (level < 10) - { - float x12 = (x1+x2)*0.5f, y12 = (y1+y2)*0.5f; - float x23 = (x2+x3)*0.5f, y23 = (y2+y3)*0.5f; - float x34 = (x3+x4)*0.5f, y34 = (y3+y4)*0.5f; - float x123 = (x12+x23)*0.5f, y123 = (y12+y23)*0.5f; - float x234 = (x23+x34)*0.5f, y234 = (y23+y34)*0.5f; - float x1234 = (x123+x234)*0.5f, y1234 = (y123+y234)*0.5f; - - PathBezierToCasteljau(path, x1,y1, x12,y12, x123,y123, x1234,y1234, tess_tol, level+1); - PathBezierToCasteljau(path, x1234,y1234, x234,y234, x34,y34, x4,y4, tess_tol, level+1); - } -} - -void ImDrawList::PathBezierCurveTo(const ImVec2& p2, const ImVec2& p3, const ImVec2& p4, int num_segments) -{ - ImVec2 p1 = _Path.back(); - if (num_segments == 0) - { - // Auto-tessellated - PathBezierToCasteljau(&_Path, p1.x, p1.y, p2.x, p2.y, p3.x, p3.y, p4.x, p4.y, GImGui->Style.CurveTessellationTol, 0); - } - else - { - float t_step = 1.0f / (float)num_segments; - for (int i_step = 1; i_step <= num_segments; i_step++) - { - float t = t_step * i_step; - float u = 1.0f - t; - float w1 = u*u*u; - float w2 = 3*u*u*t; - float w3 = 3*u*t*t; - float w4 = t*t*t; - _Path.push_back(ImVec2(w1*p1.x + w2*p2.x + w3*p3.x + w4*p4.x, w1*p1.y + w2*p2.y + w3*p3.y + w4*p4.y)); - } - } -} - -void ImDrawList::PathRect(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, float rounding, int rounding_corners) -{ - float r = rounding; - r = ImMin(r, fabsf(b.x-a.x) * ( ((rounding_corners&(1|2))==(1|2)) || ((rounding_corners&(4|8))==(4|8)) ? 0.5f : 1.0f ) - 1.0f); - r = ImMin(r, fabsf(b.y-a.y) * ( ((rounding_corners&(1|8))==(1|8)) || ((rounding_corners&(2|4))==(2|4)) ? 0.5f : 1.0f ) - 1.0f); - - if (r <= 0.0f || rounding_corners == 0) - { - PathLineTo(a); - PathLineTo(ImVec2(b.x,a.y)); - PathLineTo(b); - PathLineTo(ImVec2(a.x,b.y)); - } - else - { - const float r0 = (rounding_corners & 1) ? r : 0.0f; - const float r1 = (rounding_corners & 2) ? r : 0.0f; - const float r2 = (rounding_corners & 4) ? r : 0.0f; - const float r3 = (rounding_corners & 8) ? r : 0.0f; - PathArcToFast(ImVec2(a.x+r0,a.y+r0), r0, 6, 9); - PathArcToFast(ImVec2(b.x-r1,a.y+r1), r1, 9, 12); - PathArcToFast(ImVec2(b.x-r2,b.y-r2), r2, 0, 3); - PathArcToFast(ImVec2(a.x+r3,b.y-r3), r3, 3, 6); - } -} - -void ImDrawList::AddLine(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, ImU32 col, float thickness) -{ - if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - PathLineTo(a + ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f)); - PathLineTo(b + ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f)); - PathStroke(col, false, thickness); -} - -// a: upper-left, b: lower-right. we don't render 1 px sized rectangles properly. -void ImDrawList::AddRect(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, ImU32 col, float rounding, int rounding_corners_flags, float thickness) -{ - if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - PathRect(a + ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f), b - ImVec2(0.5f,0.5f), rounding, rounding_corners_flags); - PathStroke(col, true, thickness); -} - -void ImDrawList::AddRectFilled(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, ImU32 col, float rounding, int rounding_corners_flags) -{ - if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - if (rounding > 0.0f) - { - PathRect(a, b, rounding, rounding_corners_flags); - PathFill(col); - } - else - { - PrimReserve(6, 4); - PrimRect(a, b, col); - } -} - -void ImDrawList::AddRectFilledMultiColor(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& c, ImU32 col_upr_left, ImU32 col_upr_right, ImU32 col_bot_right, ImU32 col_bot_left) -{ - if (((col_upr_left | col_upr_right | col_bot_right | col_bot_left) & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - - const ImVec2 uv = GImGui->FontTexUvWhitePixel; - PrimReserve(6, 4); - PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx)); PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx+1)); PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx+2)); - PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx)); PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx+2)); PrimWriteIdx((ImDrawIdx)(_VtxCurrentIdx+3)); - PrimWriteVtx(a, uv, col_upr_left); - PrimWriteVtx(ImVec2(c.x, a.y), uv, col_upr_right); - PrimWriteVtx(c, uv, col_bot_right); - PrimWriteVtx(ImVec2(a.x, c.y), uv, col_bot_left); -} - -void ImDrawList::AddQuad(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& d, ImU32 col, float thickness) -{ - if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - - PathLineTo(a); - PathLineTo(b); - PathLineTo(c); - PathLineTo(d); - PathStroke(col, true, thickness); -} - -void ImDrawList::AddQuadFilled(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, const ImVec2& d, ImU32 col) -{ - if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - - PathLineTo(a); - PathLineTo(b); - PathLineTo(c); - PathLineTo(d); - PathFill(col); -} - -void ImDrawList::AddTriangle(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, ImU32 col, float thickness) -{ - if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - - PathLineTo(a); - PathLineTo(b); - PathLineTo(c); - PathStroke(col, true, thickness); -} - -void ImDrawList::AddTriangleFilled(const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& c, ImU32 col) -{ - if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - - PathLineTo(a); - PathLineTo(b); - PathLineTo(c); - PathFill(col); -} - -void ImDrawList::AddCircle(const ImVec2& centre, float radius, ImU32 col, int num_segments, float thickness) -{ - if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - - const float a_max = IM_PI*2.0f * ((float)num_segments - 1.0f) / (float)num_segments; - PathArcTo(centre, radius-0.5f, 0.0f, a_max, num_segments); - PathStroke(col, true, thickness); -} - -void ImDrawList::AddCircleFilled(const ImVec2& centre, float radius, ImU32 col, int num_segments) -{ - if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - - const float a_max = IM_PI*2.0f * ((float)num_segments - 1.0f) / (float)num_segments; - PathArcTo(centre, radius, 0.0f, a_max, num_segments); - PathFill(col); -} - -void ImDrawList::AddBezierCurve(const ImVec2& pos0, const ImVec2& cp0, const ImVec2& cp1, const ImVec2& pos1, ImU32 col, float thickness, int num_segments) -{ - if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - - PathLineTo(pos0); - PathBezierCurveTo(cp0, cp1, pos1, num_segments); - PathStroke(col, false, thickness); -} - -void ImDrawList::AddText(const ImFont* font, float font_size, const ImVec2& pos, ImU32 col, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end, float wrap_width, const ImVec4* cpu_fine_clip_rect) -{ - if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - - if (text_end == NULL) - text_end = text_begin + strlen(text_begin); - if (text_begin == text_end) - return; - - // Note: This is one of the few instance of breaking the encapsulation of ImDrawList, as we pull this from ImGui state, but it is just SO useful. - // Might just move Font/FontSize to ImDrawList? - if (font == NULL) - font = GImGui->Font; - if (font_size == 0.0f) - font_size = GImGui->FontSize; - - IM_ASSERT(font->ContainerAtlas->TexID == _TextureIdStack.back()); // Use high-level ImGui::PushFont() or low-level ImDrawList::PushTextureId() to change font. - - ImVec4 clip_rect = _ClipRectStack.back(); - if (cpu_fine_clip_rect) - { - clip_rect.x = ImMax(clip_rect.x, cpu_fine_clip_rect->x); - clip_rect.y = ImMax(clip_rect.y, cpu_fine_clip_rect->y); - clip_rect.z = ImMin(clip_rect.z, cpu_fine_clip_rect->z); - clip_rect.w = ImMin(clip_rect.w, cpu_fine_clip_rect->w); - } - font->RenderText(this, font_size, pos, col, clip_rect, text_begin, text_end, wrap_width, cpu_fine_clip_rect != NULL); -} - -void ImDrawList::AddText(const ImVec2& pos, ImU32 col, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end) -{ - AddText(GImGui->Font, GImGui->FontSize, pos, col, text_begin, text_end); -} - -void ImDrawList::AddImage(ImTextureID user_texture_id, const ImVec2& a, const ImVec2& b, const ImVec2& uv0, const ImVec2& uv1, ImU32 col) -{ - if ((col & IM_COL32_A_MASK) == 0) - return; - - // FIXME-OPT: This is wasting draw calls. - const bool push_texture_id = _TextureIdStack.empty() || user_texture_id != _TextureIdStack.back(); - if (push_texture_id) - PushTextureID(user_texture_id); - - PrimReserve(6, 4); - PrimRectUV(a, b, uv0, uv1, col); - - if (push_texture_id) - PopTextureID(); -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// ImDrawData -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -// For backward compatibility: convert all buffers from indexed to de-indexed, in case you cannot render indexed. Note: this is slow and most likely a waste of resources. Always prefer indexed rendering! -void ImDrawData::DeIndexAllBuffers() -{ - ImVector new_vtx_buffer; - TotalVtxCount = TotalIdxCount = 0; - for (int i = 0; i < CmdListsCount; i++) - { - ImDrawList* cmd_list = CmdLists[i]; - if (cmd_list->IdxBuffer.empty()) - continue; - new_vtx_buffer.resize(cmd_list->IdxBuffer.Size); - for (int j = 0; j < cmd_list->IdxBuffer.Size; j++) - new_vtx_buffer[j] = cmd_list->VtxBuffer[cmd_list->IdxBuffer[j]]; - cmd_list->VtxBuffer.swap(new_vtx_buffer); - cmd_list->IdxBuffer.resize(0); - TotalVtxCount += cmd_list->VtxBuffer.Size; - } -} - -// Helper to scale the ClipRect field of each ImDrawCmd. Use if your final output buffer is at a different scale than ImGui expects, or if there is a difference between your window resolution and framebuffer resolution. -void ImDrawData::ScaleClipRects(const ImVec2& scale) -{ - for (int i = 0; i < CmdListsCount; i++) - { - ImDrawList* cmd_list = CmdLists[i]; - for (int cmd_i = 0; cmd_i < cmd_list->CmdBuffer.Size; cmd_i++) - { - ImDrawCmd* cmd = &cmd_list->CmdBuffer[cmd_i]; - cmd->ClipRect = ImVec4(cmd->ClipRect.x * scale.x, cmd->ClipRect.y * scale.y, cmd->ClipRect.z * scale.x, cmd->ClipRect.w * scale.y); - } - } -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// ImFontAtlas -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -ImFontConfig::ImFontConfig() -{ - FontData = NULL; - FontDataSize = 0; - FontDataOwnedByAtlas = true; - FontNo = 0; - SizePixels = 0.0f; - OversampleH = 3; - OversampleV = 1; - PixelSnapH = false; - GlyphExtraSpacing = ImVec2(0.0f, 0.0f); - GlyphRanges = NULL; - MergeMode = false; - MergeGlyphCenterV = false; - DstFont = NULL; - memset(Name, 0, sizeof(Name)); -} - -ImFontAtlas::ImFontAtlas() -{ - TexID = NULL; - TexPixelsAlpha8 = NULL; - TexPixelsRGBA32 = NULL; - TexWidth = TexHeight = TexDesiredWidth = 0; - TexUvWhitePixel = ImVec2(0, 0); -} - -ImFontAtlas::~ImFontAtlas() -{ - Clear(); -} - -void ImFontAtlas::ClearInputData() -{ - for (int i = 0; i < ConfigData.Size; i++) - if (ConfigData[i].FontData && ConfigData[i].FontDataOwnedByAtlas) - { - ImGui::MemFree(ConfigData[i].FontData); - ConfigData[i].FontData = NULL; - } - - // When clearing this we lose access to the font name and other information used to build the font. - for (int i = 0; i < Fonts.Size; i++) - if (Fonts[i]->ConfigData >= ConfigData.Data && Fonts[i]->ConfigData < ConfigData.Data + ConfigData.Size) - { - Fonts[i]->ConfigData = NULL; - Fonts[i]->ConfigDataCount = 0; - } - ConfigData.clear(); -} - -void ImFontAtlas::ClearTexData() -{ - if (TexPixelsAlpha8) - ImGui::MemFree(TexPixelsAlpha8); - if (TexPixelsRGBA32) - ImGui::MemFree(TexPixelsRGBA32); - TexPixelsAlpha8 = NULL; - TexPixelsRGBA32 = NULL; -} - -void ImFontAtlas::ClearFonts() -{ - for (int i = 0; i < Fonts.Size; i++) - { - Fonts[i]->~ImFont(); - ImGui::MemFree(Fonts[i]); - } - Fonts.clear(); -} - -void ImFontAtlas::Clear() -{ - ClearInputData(); - ClearTexData(); - ClearFonts(); -} - -void ImFontAtlas::GetTexDataAsAlpha8(unsigned char** out_pixels, int* out_width, int* out_height, int* out_bytes_per_pixel) -{ - // Build atlas on demand - if (TexPixelsAlpha8 == NULL) - { - if (ConfigData.empty()) - AddFontDefault(); - Build(); - } - - *out_pixels = TexPixelsAlpha8; - if (out_width) *out_width = TexWidth; - if (out_height) *out_height = TexHeight; - if (out_bytes_per_pixel) *out_bytes_per_pixel = 1; -} - -void ImFontAtlas::GetTexDataAsRGBA32(unsigned char** out_pixels, int* out_width, int* out_height, int* out_bytes_per_pixel) -{ - // Convert to RGBA32 format on demand - // Although it is likely to be the most commonly used format, our font rendering is 1 channel / 8 bpp - if (!TexPixelsRGBA32) - { - unsigned char* pixels; - GetTexDataAsAlpha8(&pixels, NULL, NULL); - TexPixelsRGBA32 = (unsigned int*)ImGui::MemAlloc((size_t)(TexWidth * TexHeight * 4)); - const unsigned char* src = pixels; - unsigned int* dst = TexPixelsRGBA32; - for (int n = TexWidth * TexHeight; n > 0; n--) - *dst++ = IM_COL32(255, 255, 255, (unsigned int)(*src++)); - } - - *out_pixels = (unsigned char*)TexPixelsRGBA32; - if (out_width) *out_width = TexWidth; - if (out_height) *out_height = TexHeight; - if (out_bytes_per_pixel) *out_bytes_per_pixel = 4; -} - -ImFont* ImFontAtlas::AddFont(const ImFontConfig* font_cfg) -{ - IM_ASSERT(font_cfg->FontData != NULL && font_cfg->FontDataSize > 0); - IM_ASSERT(font_cfg->SizePixels > 0.0f); - - // Create new font - if (!font_cfg->MergeMode) - { - ImFont* font = (ImFont*)ImGui::MemAlloc(sizeof(ImFont)); - IM_PLACEMENT_NEW(font) ImFont(); - Fonts.push_back(font); - } - - ConfigData.push_back(*font_cfg); - ImFontConfig& new_font_cfg = ConfigData.back(); - if (!new_font_cfg.DstFont) - new_font_cfg.DstFont = Fonts.back(); - if (!new_font_cfg.FontDataOwnedByAtlas) - { - new_font_cfg.FontData = ImGui::MemAlloc(new_font_cfg.FontDataSize); - new_font_cfg.FontDataOwnedByAtlas = true; - memcpy(new_font_cfg.FontData, font_cfg->FontData, (size_t)new_font_cfg.FontDataSize); - } - - // Invalidate texture - ClearTexData(); - return new_font_cfg.DstFont; -} - -// Default font TTF is compressed with stb_compress then base85 encoded (see extra_fonts/binary_to_compressed_c.cpp for encoder) -static unsigned int stb_decompress_length(unsigned char *input); -static unsigned int stb_decompress(unsigned char *output, unsigned char *i, unsigned int length); -static const char* GetDefaultCompressedFontDataTTFBase85(); -static unsigned int Decode85Byte(char c) { return c >= '\\' ? c-36 : c-35; } -static void Decode85(const unsigned char* src, unsigned char* dst) -{ - while (*src) - { - unsigned int tmp = Decode85Byte(src[0]) + 85*(Decode85Byte(src[1]) + 85*(Decode85Byte(src[2]) + 85*(Decode85Byte(src[3]) + 85*Decode85Byte(src[4])))); - dst[0] = ((tmp >> 0) & 0xFF); dst[1] = ((tmp >> 8) & 0xFF); dst[2] = ((tmp >> 16) & 0xFF); dst[3] = ((tmp >> 24) & 0xFF); // We can't assume little-endianness. - src += 5; - dst += 4; - } -} - -// Load embedded ProggyClean.ttf at size 13, disable oversampling -ImFont* ImFontAtlas::AddFontDefault(const ImFontConfig* font_cfg_template) -{ - ImFontConfig font_cfg = font_cfg_template ? *font_cfg_template : ImFontConfig(); - if (!font_cfg_template) - { - font_cfg.OversampleH = font_cfg.OversampleV = 1; - font_cfg.PixelSnapH = true; - } - if (font_cfg.Name[0] == '\0') strcpy(font_cfg.Name, "ProggyClean.ttf, 13px"); - - const char* ttf_compressed_base85 = GetDefaultCompressedFontDataTTFBase85(); - ImFont* font = AddFontFromMemoryCompressedBase85TTF(ttf_compressed_base85, 13.0f, &font_cfg, GetGlyphRangesDefault()); - return font; -} - -ImFont* ImFontAtlas::AddFontFromFileTTF(const char* filename, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg_template, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges) -{ - int data_size = 0; - void* data = ImFileLoadToMemory(filename, "rb", &data_size, 0); - if (!data) - { - IM_ASSERT(0); // Could not load file. - return NULL; - } - ImFontConfig font_cfg = font_cfg_template ? *font_cfg_template : ImFontConfig(); - if (font_cfg.Name[0] == '\0') - { - // Store a short copy of filename into into the font name for convenience - const char* p; - for (p = filename + strlen(filename); p > filename && p[-1] != '/' && p[-1] != '\\'; p--) {} - snprintf(font_cfg.Name, IM_ARRAYSIZE(font_cfg.Name), "%s, %.0fpx", p, size_pixels); - } - return AddFontFromMemoryTTF(data, data_size, size_pixels, &font_cfg, glyph_ranges); -} - -// NBM Transfer ownership of 'ttf_data' to ImFontAtlas, unless font_cfg_template->FontDataOwnedByAtlas == false. Owned TTF buffer will be deleted after Build(). -ImFont* ImFontAtlas::AddFontFromMemoryTTF(void* ttf_data, int ttf_size, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg_template, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges) -{ - ImFontConfig font_cfg = font_cfg_template ? *font_cfg_template : ImFontConfig(); - IM_ASSERT(font_cfg.FontData == NULL); - font_cfg.FontData = ttf_data; - font_cfg.FontDataSize = ttf_size; - font_cfg.SizePixels = size_pixels; - if (glyph_ranges) - font_cfg.GlyphRanges = glyph_ranges; - return AddFont(&font_cfg); -} - -ImFont* ImFontAtlas::AddFontFromMemoryCompressedTTF(const void* compressed_ttf_data, int compressed_ttf_size, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg_template, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges) -{ - const unsigned int buf_decompressed_size = stb_decompress_length((unsigned char*)compressed_ttf_data); - unsigned char* buf_decompressed_data = (unsigned char *)ImGui::MemAlloc(buf_decompressed_size); - stb_decompress(buf_decompressed_data, (unsigned char*)compressed_ttf_data, (unsigned int)compressed_ttf_size); - - ImFontConfig font_cfg = font_cfg_template ? *font_cfg_template : ImFontConfig(); - IM_ASSERT(font_cfg.FontData == NULL); - font_cfg.FontDataOwnedByAtlas = true; - return AddFontFromMemoryTTF(buf_decompressed_data, (int)buf_decompressed_size, size_pixels, &font_cfg, glyph_ranges); -} - -ImFont* ImFontAtlas::AddFontFromMemoryCompressedBase85TTF(const char* compressed_ttf_data_base85, float size_pixels, const ImFontConfig* font_cfg, const ImWchar* glyph_ranges) -{ - int compressed_ttf_size = (((int)strlen(compressed_ttf_data_base85) + 4) / 5) * 4; - void* compressed_ttf = ImGui::MemAlloc((size_t)compressed_ttf_size); - Decode85((const unsigned char*)compressed_ttf_data_base85, (unsigned char*)compressed_ttf); - ImFont* font = AddFontFromMemoryCompressedTTF(compressed_ttf, compressed_ttf_size, size_pixels, font_cfg, glyph_ranges); - ImGui::MemFree(compressed_ttf); - return font; -} - -bool ImFontAtlas::Build() -{ - IM_ASSERT(ConfigData.Size > 0); - - TexID = NULL; - TexWidth = TexHeight = 0; - TexUvWhitePixel = ImVec2(0, 0); - ClearTexData(); - - struct ImFontTempBuildData - { - stbtt_fontinfo FontInfo; - stbrp_rect* Rects; - stbtt_pack_range* Ranges; - int RangesCount; - }; - ImFontTempBuildData* tmp_array = (ImFontTempBuildData*)ImGui::MemAlloc((size_t)ConfigData.Size * sizeof(ImFontTempBuildData)); - - // Initialize font information early (so we can error without any cleanup) + count glyphs - int total_glyph_count = 0; - int total_glyph_range_count = 0; - for (int input_i = 0; input_i < ConfigData.Size; input_i++) - { - ImFontConfig& cfg = ConfigData[input_i]; - ImFontTempBuildData& tmp = tmp_array[input_i]; - - IM_ASSERT(cfg.DstFont && (!cfg.DstFont->IsLoaded() || cfg.DstFont->ContainerAtlas == this)); - const int font_offset = stbtt_GetFontOffsetForIndex((unsigned char*)cfg.FontData, cfg.FontNo); - IM_ASSERT(font_offset >= 0); - if (!stbtt_InitFont(&tmp.FontInfo, (unsigned char*)cfg.FontData, font_offset)) - return false; - - // Count glyphs - if (!cfg.GlyphRanges) - cfg.GlyphRanges = GetGlyphRangesDefault(); - for (const ImWchar* in_range = cfg.GlyphRanges; in_range[0] && in_range[1]; in_range += 2) - { - total_glyph_count += (in_range[1] - in_range[0]) + 1; - total_glyph_range_count++; - } - } - - // Start packing. We need a known width for the skyline algorithm. Using a cheap heuristic here to decide of width. User can override TexDesiredWidth if they wish. - // After packing is done, width shouldn't matter much, but some API/GPU have texture size limitations and increasing width can decrease height. - TexWidth = (TexDesiredWidth > 0) ? TexDesiredWidth : (total_glyph_count > 4000) ? 4096 : (total_glyph_count > 2000) ? 2048 : (total_glyph_count > 1000) ? 1024 : 512; - TexHeight = 0; - const int max_tex_height = 1024*32; - stbtt_pack_context spc; - stbtt_PackBegin(&spc, NULL, TexWidth, max_tex_height, 0, 1, NULL); - - // Pack our extra data rectangles first, so it will be on the upper-left corner of our texture (UV will have small values). - ImVector extra_rects; - RenderCustomTexData(0, &extra_rects); - stbtt_PackSetOversampling(&spc, 1, 1); - stbrp_pack_rects((stbrp_context*)spc.pack_info, &extra_rects[0], extra_rects.Size); - for (int i = 0; i < extra_rects.Size; i++) - if (extra_rects[i].was_packed) - TexHeight = ImMax(TexHeight, extra_rects[i].y + extra_rects[i].h); - - // Allocate packing character data and flag packed characters buffer as non-packed (x0=y0=x1=y1=0) - int buf_packedchars_n = 0, buf_rects_n = 0, buf_ranges_n = 0; - stbtt_packedchar* buf_packedchars = (stbtt_packedchar*)ImGui::MemAlloc(total_glyph_count * sizeof(stbtt_packedchar)); - stbrp_rect* buf_rects = (stbrp_rect*)ImGui::MemAlloc(total_glyph_count * sizeof(stbrp_rect)); - stbtt_pack_range* buf_ranges = (stbtt_pack_range*)ImGui::MemAlloc(total_glyph_range_count * sizeof(stbtt_pack_range)); - memset(buf_packedchars, 0, total_glyph_count * sizeof(stbtt_packedchar)); - memset(buf_rects, 0, total_glyph_count * sizeof(stbrp_rect)); // Unnecessary but let's clear this for the sake of sanity. - memset(buf_ranges, 0, total_glyph_range_count * sizeof(stbtt_pack_range)); - - // First font pass: pack all glyphs (no rendering at this point, we are working with rectangles in an infinitely tall texture at this point) - for (int input_i = 0; input_i < ConfigData.Size; input_i++) - { - ImFontConfig& cfg = ConfigData[input_i]; - ImFontTempBuildData& tmp = tmp_array[input_i]; - - // Setup ranges - int glyph_count = 0; - int glyph_ranges_count = 0; - for (const ImWchar* in_range = cfg.GlyphRanges; in_range[0] && in_range[1]; in_range += 2) - { - glyph_count += (in_range[1] - in_range[0]) + 1; - glyph_ranges_count++; - } - tmp.Ranges = buf_ranges + buf_ranges_n; - tmp.RangesCount = glyph_ranges_count; - buf_ranges_n += glyph_ranges_count; - for (int i = 0; i < glyph_ranges_count; i++) - { - const ImWchar* in_range = &cfg.GlyphRanges[i * 2]; - stbtt_pack_range& range = tmp.Ranges[i]; - range.font_size = cfg.SizePixels; - range.first_unicode_codepoint_in_range = in_range[0]; - range.num_chars = (in_range[1] - in_range[0]) + 1; - range.chardata_for_range = buf_packedchars + buf_packedchars_n; - buf_packedchars_n += range.num_chars; - } - - // Pack - tmp.Rects = buf_rects + buf_rects_n; - buf_rects_n += glyph_count; - stbtt_PackSetOversampling(&spc, cfg.OversampleH, cfg.OversampleV); - int n = stbtt_PackFontRangesGatherRects(&spc, &tmp.FontInfo, tmp.Ranges, tmp.RangesCount, tmp.Rects); - stbrp_pack_rects((stbrp_context*)spc.pack_info, tmp.Rects, n); - - // Extend texture height - for (int i = 0; i < n; i++) - if (tmp.Rects[i].was_packed) - TexHeight = ImMax(TexHeight, tmp.Rects[i].y + tmp.Rects[i].h); - } - IM_ASSERT(buf_rects_n == total_glyph_count); - IM_ASSERT(buf_packedchars_n == total_glyph_count); - IM_ASSERT(buf_ranges_n == total_glyph_range_count); - - // Create texture - TexHeight = ImUpperPowerOfTwo(TexHeight); - TexPixelsAlpha8 = (unsigned char*)ImGui::MemAlloc(TexWidth * TexHeight); - memset(TexPixelsAlpha8, 0, TexWidth * TexHeight); - spc.pixels = TexPixelsAlpha8; - spc.height = TexHeight; - - // Second pass: render characters - for (int input_i = 0; input_i < ConfigData.Size; input_i++) - { - ImFontConfig& cfg = ConfigData[input_i]; - ImFontTempBuildData& tmp = tmp_array[input_i]; - stbtt_PackSetOversampling(&spc, cfg.OversampleH, cfg.OversampleV); - stbtt_PackFontRangesRenderIntoRects(&spc, &tmp.FontInfo, tmp.Ranges, tmp.RangesCount, tmp.Rects); - tmp.Rects = NULL; - } - - // End packing - stbtt_PackEnd(&spc); - ImGui::MemFree(buf_rects); - buf_rects = NULL; - - // Third pass: setup ImFont and glyphs for runtime - for (int input_i = 0; input_i < ConfigData.Size; input_i++) - { - ImFontConfig& cfg = ConfigData[input_i]; - ImFontTempBuildData& tmp = tmp_array[input_i]; - ImFont* dst_font = cfg.DstFont; - - float font_scale = stbtt_ScaleForPixelHeight(&tmp.FontInfo, cfg.SizePixels); - int unscaled_ascent, unscaled_descent, unscaled_line_gap; - stbtt_GetFontVMetrics(&tmp.FontInfo, &unscaled_ascent, &unscaled_descent, &unscaled_line_gap); - - float ascent = unscaled_ascent * font_scale; - float descent = unscaled_descent * font_scale; - if (!cfg.MergeMode) - { - dst_font->ContainerAtlas = this; - dst_font->ConfigData = &cfg; - dst_font->ConfigDataCount = 0; - dst_font->FontSize = cfg.SizePixels; - dst_font->Ascent = ascent; - dst_font->Descent = descent; - dst_font->Glyphs.resize(0); - } - dst_font->ConfigDataCount++; - float off_y = (cfg.MergeMode && cfg.MergeGlyphCenterV) ? (ascent - dst_font->Ascent) * 0.5f : 0.0f; - - dst_font->FallbackGlyph = NULL; // Always clear fallback so FindGlyph can return NULL. It will be set again in BuildLookupTable() - for (int i = 0; i < tmp.RangesCount; i++) - { - stbtt_pack_range& range = tmp.Ranges[i]; - for (int char_idx = 0; char_idx < range.num_chars; char_idx += 1) - { - const stbtt_packedchar& pc = range.chardata_for_range[char_idx]; - if (!pc.x0 && !pc.x1 && !pc.y0 && !pc.y1) - continue; - - const int codepoint = range.first_unicode_codepoint_in_range + char_idx; - if (cfg.MergeMode && dst_font->FindGlyph((unsigned short)codepoint)) - continue; - - stbtt_aligned_quad q; - float dummy_x = 0.0f, dummy_y = 0.0f; - stbtt_GetPackedQuad(range.chardata_for_range, TexWidth, TexHeight, char_idx, &dummy_x, &dummy_y, &q, 0); - - dst_font->Glyphs.resize(dst_font->Glyphs.Size + 1); - ImFont::Glyph& glyph = dst_font->Glyphs.back(); - glyph.Codepoint = (ImWchar)codepoint; - glyph.X0 = q.x0; glyph.Y0 = q.y0; glyph.X1 = q.x1; glyph.Y1 = q.y1; - glyph.U0 = q.s0; glyph.V0 = q.t0; glyph.U1 = q.s1; glyph.V1 = q.t1; - glyph.Y0 += (float)(int)(dst_font->Ascent + off_y + 0.5f); - glyph.Y1 += (float)(int)(dst_font->Ascent + off_y + 0.5f); - glyph.XAdvance = (pc.xadvance + cfg.GlyphExtraSpacing.x); // Bake spacing into XAdvance - if (cfg.PixelSnapH) - glyph.XAdvance = (float)(int)(glyph.XAdvance + 0.5f); - } - } - cfg.DstFont->BuildLookupTable(); - } - - // Cleanup temporaries - ImGui::MemFree(buf_packedchars); - ImGui::MemFree(buf_ranges); - ImGui::MemFree(tmp_array); - - // Render into our custom data block - RenderCustomTexData(1, &extra_rects); - - return true; -} - -void ImFontAtlas::RenderCustomTexData(int pass, void* p_rects) -{ - // A work of art lies ahead! (. = white layer, X = black layer, others are blank) - // The white texels on the top left are the ones we'll use everywhere in ImGui to render filled shapes. - const int TEX_DATA_W = 90; - const int TEX_DATA_H = 27; - const char texture_data[TEX_DATA_W*TEX_DATA_H+1] = - { - "..- -XXXXXXX- X - X -XXXXXXX - XXXXXXX" - "..- -X.....X- X.X - X.X -X.....X - X.....X" - "--- -XXX.XXX- X...X - X...X -X....X - X....X" - "X - X.X - X.....X - X.....X -X...X - X...X" - "XX - X.X -X.......X- X.......X -X..X.X - X.X..X" - "X.X - X.X -XXXX.XXXX- XXXX.XXXX -X.X X.X - X.X X.X" - "X..X - X.X - X.X - X.X -XX X.X - X.X XX" - "X...X - X.X - X.X - XX X.X XX - X.X - X.X " - "X....X - X.X - X.X - X.X X.X X.X - X.X - X.X " - "X.....X - X.X - X.X - X..X X.X X..X - X.X - X.X " - "X......X - X.X - X.X - X...XXXXXX.XXXXXX...X - X.X XX-XX X.X " - "X.......X - X.X - X.X -X.....................X- X.X X.X-X.X X.X " - "X........X - X.X - X.X - X...XXXXXX.XXXXXX...X - X.X..X-X..X.X " - "X.........X -XXX.XXX- X.X - X..X X.X X..X - X...X-X...X " - "X..........X-X.....X- X.X - X.X X.X X.X - X....X-X....X " - "X......XXXXX-XXXXXXX- X.X - XX X.X XX - X.....X-X.....X " - "X...X..X --------- X.X - X.X - XXXXXXX-XXXXXXX " - "X..X X..X - -XXXX.XXXX- XXXX.XXXX ------------------------------------" - "X.X X..X - -X.......X- X.......X - XX XX - " - "XX X..X - - X.....X - X.....X - X.X X.X - " - " X..X - X...X - X...X - X..X X..X - " - " XX - X.X - X.X - X...XXXXXXXXXXXXX...X - " - "------------ - X - X -X.....................X- " - " ----------------------------------- X...XXXXXXXXXXXXX...X - " - " - X..X X..X - " - " - X.X X.X - " - " - XX XX - " - }; - - ImVector& rects = *(ImVector*)p_rects; - if (pass == 0) - { - // Request rectangles - stbrp_rect r; - memset(&r, 0, sizeof(r)); - r.w = (TEX_DATA_W*2)+1; - r.h = TEX_DATA_H+1; - rects.push_back(r); - } - else if (pass == 1) - { - // Render/copy pixels - const stbrp_rect& r = rects[0]; - for (int y = 0, n = 0; y < TEX_DATA_H; y++) - for (int x = 0; x < TEX_DATA_W; x++, n++) - { - const int offset0 = (int)(r.x + x) + (int)(r.y + y) * TexWidth; - const int offset1 = offset0 + 1 + TEX_DATA_W; - TexPixelsAlpha8[offset0] = texture_data[n] == '.' ? 0xFF : 0x00; - TexPixelsAlpha8[offset1] = texture_data[n] == 'X' ? 0xFF : 0x00; - } - const ImVec2 tex_uv_scale(1.0f / TexWidth, 1.0f / TexHeight); - TexUvWhitePixel = ImVec2((r.x + 0.5f) * tex_uv_scale.x, (r.y + 0.5f) * tex_uv_scale.y); - - // Setup mouse cursors - const ImVec2 cursor_datas[ImGuiMouseCursor_Count_][3] = - { - // Pos ........ Size ......... Offset ...... - { ImVec2(0,3), ImVec2(12,19), ImVec2( 0, 0) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_Arrow - { ImVec2(13,0), ImVec2(7,16), ImVec2( 4, 8) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_TextInput - { ImVec2(31,0), ImVec2(23,23), ImVec2(11,11) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_Move - { ImVec2(21,0), ImVec2( 9,23), ImVec2( 5,11) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNS - { ImVec2(55,18),ImVec2(23, 9), ImVec2(11, 5) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeEW - { ImVec2(73,0), ImVec2(17,17), ImVec2( 9, 9) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNESW - { ImVec2(55,0), ImVec2(17,17), ImVec2( 9, 9) }, // ImGuiMouseCursor_ResizeNWSE - }; - - for (int type = 0; type < ImGuiMouseCursor_Count_; type++) - { - ImGuiMouseCursorData& cursor_data = GImGui->MouseCursorData[type]; - ImVec2 pos = cursor_datas[type][0] + ImVec2((float)r.x, (float)r.y); - const ImVec2 size = cursor_datas[type][1]; - cursor_data.Type = type; - cursor_data.Size = size; - cursor_data.HotOffset = cursor_datas[type][2]; - cursor_data.TexUvMin[0] = (pos) * tex_uv_scale; - cursor_data.TexUvMax[0] = (pos + size) * tex_uv_scale; - pos.x += TEX_DATA_W+1; - cursor_data.TexUvMin[1] = (pos) * tex_uv_scale; - cursor_data.TexUvMax[1] = (pos + size) * tex_uv_scale; - } - } -} - -// Retrieve list of range (2 int per range, values are inclusive) -const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesDefault() -{ - static const ImWchar ranges[] = - { - 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + Latin Supplement - 0, - }; - return &ranges[0]; -} - -const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesKorean() -{ - static const ImWchar ranges[] = - { - 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + Latin Supplement - 0x3131, 0x3163, // Korean alphabets - 0xAC00, 0xD79D, // Korean characters - 0, - }; - return &ranges[0]; -} - -const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesChinese() -{ - static const ImWchar ranges[] = - { - 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + Latin Supplement - 0x3000, 0x30FF, // Punctuations, Hiragana, Katakana - 0x31F0, 0x31FF, // Katakana Phonetic Extensions - 0xFF00, 0xFFEF, // Half-width characters - 0x4e00, 0x9FAF, // CJK Ideograms - 0, - }; - return &ranges[0]; -} - -const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesJapanese() -{ - // Store the 1946 ideograms code points as successive offsets from the initial unicode codepoint 0x4E00. Each offset has an implicit +1. - // This encoding helps us reduce the source code size. - static const short offsets_from_0x4E00[] = - { - -1,0,1,3,0,0,0,0,1,0,5,1,1,0,7,4,6,10,0,1,9,9,7,1,3,19,1,10,7,1,0,1,0,5,1,0,6,4,2,6,0,0,12,6,8,0,3,5,0,1,0,9,0,0,8,1,1,3,4,5,13,0,0,8,2,17, - 4,3,1,1,9,6,0,0,0,2,1,3,2,22,1,9,11,1,13,1,3,12,0,5,9,2,0,6,12,5,3,12,4,1,2,16,1,1,4,6,5,3,0,6,13,15,5,12,8,14,0,0,6,15,3,6,0,18,8,1,6,14,1, - 5,4,12,24,3,13,12,10,24,0,0,0,1,0,1,1,2,9,10,2,2,0,0,3,3,1,0,3,8,0,3,2,4,4,1,6,11,10,14,6,15,3,4,15,1,0,0,5,2,2,0,0,1,6,5,5,6,0,3,6,5,0,0,1,0, - 11,2,2,8,4,7,0,10,0,1,2,17,19,3,0,2,5,0,6,2,4,4,6,1,1,11,2,0,3,1,2,1,2,10,7,6,3,16,0,8,24,0,0,3,1,1,3,0,1,6,0,0,0,2,0,1,5,15,0,1,0,0,2,11,19, - 1,4,19,7,6,5,1,0,0,0,0,5,1,0,1,9,0,0,5,0,2,0,1,0,3,0,11,3,0,2,0,0,0,0,0,9,3,6,4,12,0,14,0,0,29,10,8,0,14,37,13,0,31,16,19,0,8,30,1,20,8,3,48, - 21,1,0,12,0,10,44,34,42,54,11,18,82,0,2,1,2,12,1,0,6,2,17,2,12,7,0,7,17,4,2,6,24,23,8,23,39,2,16,23,1,0,5,1,2,15,14,5,6,2,11,0,8,6,2,2,2,14, - 20,4,15,3,4,11,10,10,2,5,2,1,30,2,1,0,0,22,5,5,0,3,1,5,4,1,0,0,2,2,21,1,5,1,2,16,2,1,3,4,0,8,4,0,0,5,14,11,2,16,1,13,1,7,0,22,15,3,1,22,7,14, - 22,19,11,24,18,46,10,20,64,45,3,2,0,4,5,0,1,4,25,1,0,0,2,10,0,0,0,1,0,1,2,0,0,9,1,2,0,0,0,2,5,2,1,1,5,5,8,1,1,1,5,1,4,9,1,3,0,1,0,1,1,2,0,0, - 2,0,1,8,22,8,1,0,0,0,0,4,2,1,0,9,8,5,0,9,1,30,24,2,6,4,39,0,14,5,16,6,26,179,0,2,1,1,0,0,0,5,2,9,6,0,2,5,16,7,5,1,1,0,2,4,4,7,15,13,14,0,0, - 3,0,1,0,0,0,2,1,6,4,5,1,4,9,0,3,1,8,0,0,10,5,0,43,0,2,6,8,4,0,2,0,0,9,6,0,9,3,1,6,20,14,6,1,4,0,7,2,3,0,2,0,5,0,3,1,0,3,9,7,0,3,4,0,4,9,1,6,0, - 9,0,0,2,3,10,9,28,3,6,2,4,1,2,32,4,1,18,2,0,3,1,5,30,10,0,2,2,2,0,7,9,8,11,10,11,7,2,13,7,5,10,0,3,40,2,0,1,6,12,0,4,5,1,5,11,11,21,4,8,3,7, - 8,8,33,5,23,0,0,19,8,8,2,3,0,6,1,1,1,5,1,27,4,2,5,0,3,5,6,3,1,0,3,1,12,5,3,3,2,0,7,7,2,1,0,4,0,1,1,2,0,10,10,6,2,5,9,7,5,15,15,21,6,11,5,20, - 4,3,5,5,2,5,0,2,1,0,1,7,28,0,9,0,5,12,5,5,18,30,0,12,3,3,21,16,25,32,9,3,14,11,24,5,66,9,1,2,0,5,9,1,5,1,8,0,8,3,3,0,1,15,1,4,8,1,2,7,0,7,2, - 8,3,7,5,3,7,10,2,1,0,0,2,25,0,6,4,0,10,0,4,2,4,1,12,5,38,4,0,4,1,10,5,9,4,0,14,4,2,5,18,20,21,1,3,0,5,0,7,0,3,7,1,3,1,1,8,1,0,0,0,3,2,5,2,11, - 6,0,13,1,3,9,1,12,0,16,6,2,1,0,2,1,12,6,13,11,2,0,28,1,7,8,14,13,8,13,0,2,0,5,4,8,10,2,37,42,19,6,6,7,4,14,11,18,14,80,7,6,0,4,72,12,36,27, - 7,7,0,14,17,19,164,27,0,5,10,7,3,13,6,14,0,2,2,5,3,0,6,13,0,0,10,29,0,4,0,3,13,0,3,1,6,51,1,5,28,2,0,8,0,20,2,4,0,25,2,10,13,10,0,16,4,0,1,0, - 2,1,7,0,1,8,11,0,0,1,2,7,2,23,11,6,6,4,16,2,2,2,0,22,9,3,3,5,2,0,15,16,21,2,9,20,15,15,5,3,9,1,0,0,1,7,7,5,4,2,2,2,38,24,14,0,0,15,5,6,24,14, - 5,5,11,0,21,12,0,3,8,4,11,1,8,0,11,27,7,2,4,9,21,59,0,1,39,3,60,62,3,0,12,11,0,3,30,11,0,13,88,4,15,5,28,13,1,4,48,17,17,4,28,32,46,0,16,0, - 18,11,1,8,6,38,11,2,6,11,38,2,0,45,3,11,2,7,8,4,30,14,17,2,1,1,65,18,12,16,4,2,45,123,12,56,33,1,4,3,4,7,0,0,0,3,2,0,16,4,2,4,2,0,7,4,5,2,26, - 2,25,6,11,6,1,16,2,6,17,77,15,3,35,0,1,0,5,1,0,38,16,6,3,12,3,3,3,0,9,3,1,3,5,2,9,0,18,0,25,1,3,32,1,72,46,6,2,7,1,3,14,17,0,28,1,40,13,0,20, - 15,40,6,38,24,12,43,1,1,9,0,12,6,0,6,2,4,19,3,7,1,48,0,9,5,0,5,6,9,6,10,15,2,11,19,3,9,2,0,1,10,1,27,8,1,3,6,1,14,0,26,0,27,16,3,4,9,6,2,23, - 9,10,5,25,2,1,6,1,1,48,15,9,15,14,3,4,26,60,29,13,37,21,1,6,4,0,2,11,22,23,16,16,2,2,1,3,0,5,1,6,4,0,0,4,0,0,8,3,0,2,5,0,7,1,7,3,13,2,4,10, - 3,0,2,31,0,18,3,0,12,10,4,1,0,7,5,7,0,5,4,12,2,22,10,4,2,15,2,8,9,0,23,2,197,51,3,1,1,4,13,4,3,21,4,19,3,10,5,40,0,4,1,1,10,4,1,27,34,7,21, - 2,17,2,9,6,4,2,3,0,4,2,7,8,2,5,1,15,21,3,4,4,2,2,17,22,1,5,22,4,26,7,0,32,1,11,42,15,4,1,2,5,0,19,3,1,8,6,0,10,1,9,2,13,30,8,2,24,17,19,1,4, - 4,25,13,0,10,16,11,39,18,8,5,30,82,1,6,8,18,77,11,13,20,75,11,112,78,33,3,0,0,60,17,84,9,1,1,12,30,10,49,5,32,158,178,5,5,6,3,3,1,3,1,4,7,6, - 19,31,21,0,2,9,5,6,27,4,9,8,1,76,18,12,1,4,0,3,3,6,3,12,2,8,30,16,2,25,1,5,5,4,3,0,6,10,2,3,1,0,5,1,19,3,0,8,1,5,2,6,0,0,0,19,1,2,0,5,1,2,5, - 1,3,7,0,4,12,7,3,10,22,0,9,5,1,0,2,20,1,1,3,23,30,3,9,9,1,4,191,14,3,15,6,8,50,0,1,0,0,4,0,0,1,0,2,4,2,0,2,3,0,2,0,2,2,8,7,0,1,1,1,3,3,17,11, - 91,1,9,3,2,13,4,24,15,41,3,13,3,1,20,4,125,29,30,1,0,4,12,2,21,4,5,5,19,11,0,13,11,86,2,18,0,7,1,8,8,2,2,22,1,2,6,5,2,0,1,2,8,0,2,0,5,2,1,0, - 2,10,2,0,5,9,2,1,2,0,1,0,4,0,0,10,2,5,3,0,6,1,0,1,4,4,33,3,13,17,3,18,6,4,7,1,5,78,0,4,1,13,7,1,8,1,0,35,27,15,3,0,0,0,1,11,5,41,38,15,22,6, - 14,14,2,1,11,6,20,63,5,8,27,7,11,2,2,40,58,23,50,54,56,293,8,8,1,5,1,14,0,1,12,37,89,8,8,8,2,10,6,0,0,0,4,5,2,1,0,1,1,2,7,0,3,3,0,4,6,0,3,2, - 19,3,8,0,0,0,4,4,16,0,4,1,5,1,3,0,3,4,6,2,17,10,10,31,6,4,3,6,10,126,7,3,2,2,0,9,0,0,5,20,13,0,15,0,6,0,2,5,8,64,50,3,2,12,2,9,0,0,11,8,20, - 109,2,18,23,0,0,9,61,3,0,28,41,77,27,19,17,81,5,2,14,5,83,57,252,14,154,263,14,20,8,13,6,57,39,38, - }; - static ImWchar base_ranges[] = - { - 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + Latin Supplement - 0x3000, 0x30FF, // Punctuations, Hiragana, Katakana - 0x31F0, 0x31FF, // Katakana Phonetic Extensions - 0xFF00, 0xFFEF, // Half-width characters - }; - static bool full_ranges_unpacked = false; - static ImWchar full_ranges[IM_ARRAYSIZE(base_ranges) + IM_ARRAYSIZE(offsets_from_0x4E00)*2 + 1]; - if (!full_ranges_unpacked) - { - // Unpack - int codepoint = 0x4e00; - memcpy(full_ranges, base_ranges, sizeof(base_ranges)); - ImWchar* dst = full_ranges + IM_ARRAYSIZE(base_ranges);; - for (int n = 0; n < IM_ARRAYSIZE(offsets_from_0x4E00); n++, dst += 2) - dst[0] = dst[1] = (ImWchar)(codepoint += (offsets_from_0x4E00[n] + 1)); - dst[0] = 0; - full_ranges_unpacked = true; - } - return &full_ranges[0]; -} - -const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesCyrillic() -{ - static const ImWchar ranges[] = - { - 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin + Latin Supplement - 0x0400, 0x052F, // Cyrillic + Cyrillic Supplement - 0x2DE0, 0x2DFF, // Cyrillic Extended-A - 0xA640, 0xA69F, // Cyrillic Extended-B - 0, - }; - return &ranges[0]; -} - -const ImWchar* ImFontAtlas::GetGlyphRangesThai() -{ - static const ImWchar ranges[] = - { - 0x0020, 0x00FF, // Basic Latin - 0x0E00, 0x0E7F, // Thai - 0, - }; - return &ranges[0]; -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// ImFont -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -ImFont::ImFont() -{ - Scale = 1.0f; - FallbackChar = (ImWchar)'?'; - Clear(); -} - -ImFont::~ImFont() -{ - // Invalidate active font so that the user gets a clear crash instead of a dangling pointer. - // If you want to delete fonts you need to do it between Render() and NewFrame(). - // FIXME-CLEANUP - /* - ImGuiContext& g = *GImGui; - if (g.Font == this) - g.Font = NULL; - */ - Clear(); -} - -void ImFont::Clear() -{ - FontSize = 0.0f; - DisplayOffset = ImVec2(0.0f, 1.0f); - ConfigData = NULL; - ConfigDataCount = 0; - Ascent = Descent = 0.0f; - ContainerAtlas = NULL; - Glyphs.clear(); - FallbackGlyph = NULL; - FallbackXAdvance = 0.0f; - IndexXAdvance.clear(); - IndexLookup.clear(); -} - -void ImFont::BuildLookupTable() -{ - int max_codepoint = 0; - for (int i = 0; i != Glyphs.Size; i++) - max_codepoint = ImMax(max_codepoint, (int)Glyphs[i].Codepoint); - - IM_ASSERT(Glyphs.Size < 0xFFFF); // -1 is reserved - IndexXAdvance.clear(); - IndexLookup.clear(); - GrowIndex(max_codepoint + 1); - for (int i = 0; i < Glyphs.Size; i++) - { - int codepoint = (int)Glyphs[i].Codepoint; - IndexXAdvance[codepoint] = Glyphs[i].XAdvance; - IndexLookup[codepoint] = (unsigned short)i; - } - - // Create a glyph to handle TAB - // FIXME: Needs proper TAB handling but it needs to be contextualized (or we could arbitrary say that each string starts at "column 0" ?) - if (FindGlyph((unsigned short)' ')) - { - if (Glyphs.back().Codepoint != '\t') // So we can call this function multiple times - Glyphs.resize(Glyphs.Size + 1); - ImFont::Glyph& tab_glyph = Glyphs.back(); - tab_glyph = *FindGlyph((unsigned short)' '); - tab_glyph.Codepoint = '\t'; - tab_glyph.XAdvance *= 4; - IndexXAdvance[(int)tab_glyph.Codepoint] = (float)tab_glyph.XAdvance; - IndexLookup[(int)tab_glyph.Codepoint] = (unsigned short)(Glyphs.Size-1); - } - - FallbackGlyph = NULL; - FallbackGlyph = FindGlyph(FallbackChar); - FallbackXAdvance = FallbackGlyph ? FallbackGlyph->XAdvance : 0.0f; - for (int i = 0; i < max_codepoint + 1; i++) - if (IndexXAdvance[i] < 0.0f) - IndexXAdvance[i] = FallbackXAdvance; -} - -void ImFont::SetFallbackChar(ImWchar c) -{ - FallbackChar = c; - BuildLookupTable(); -} - -void ImFont::GrowIndex(int new_size) -{ - IM_ASSERT(IndexXAdvance.Size == IndexLookup.Size); - int old_size = IndexLookup.Size; - if (new_size <= old_size) - return; - IndexXAdvance.resize(new_size); - IndexLookup.resize(new_size); - for (int i = old_size; i < new_size; i++) - { - IndexXAdvance[i] = -1.0f; - IndexLookup[i] = (unsigned short)-1; - } -} - -void ImFont::AddRemapChar(ImWchar dst, ImWchar src, bool overwrite_dst) -{ - IM_ASSERT(IndexLookup.Size > 0); // Currently this can only be called AFTER the font has been built, aka after calling ImFontAtlas::GetTexDataAs*() function. - int index_size = IndexLookup.Size; - - if (dst < index_size && IndexLookup.Data[dst] == (unsigned short)-1 && !overwrite_dst) // 'dst' already exists - return; - if (src >= index_size && dst >= index_size) // both 'dst' and 'src' don't exist -> no-op - return; - - GrowIndex(dst + 1); - IndexLookup[dst] = (src < index_size) ? IndexLookup.Data[src] : (unsigned short)-1; - IndexXAdvance[dst] = (src < index_size) ? IndexXAdvance.Data[src] : 1.0f; -} - -const ImFont::Glyph* ImFont::FindGlyph(unsigned short c) const -{ - if (c < IndexLookup.Size) - { - const unsigned short i = IndexLookup[c]; - if (i != (unsigned short)-1) - return &Glyphs.Data[i]; - } - return FallbackGlyph; -} - -const char* ImFont::CalcWordWrapPositionA(float scale, const char* text, const char* text_end, float wrap_width) const -{ - // Simple word-wrapping for English, not full-featured. Please submit failing cases! - // FIXME: Much possible improvements (don't cut things like "word !", "word!!!" but cut within "word,,,,", more sensible support for punctuations, support for Unicode punctuations, etc.) - - // For references, possible wrap point marked with ^ - // "aaa bbb, ccc,ddd. eee fff. ggg!" - // ^ ^ ^ ^ ^__ ^ ^ - - // List of hardcoded separators: .,;!?'" - - // Skip extra blanks after a line returns (that includes not counting them in width computation) - // e.g. "Hello world" --> "Hello" "World" - - // Cut words that cannot possibly fit within one line. - // e.g.: "The tropical fish" with ~5 characters worth of width --> "The tr" "opical" "fish" - - float line_width = 0.0f; - float word_width = 0.0f; - float blank_width = 0.0f; - - const char* word_end = text; - const char* prev_word_end = NULL; - bool inside_word = true; - - const char* s = text; - while (s < text_end) - { - unsigned int c = (unsigned int)*s; - const char* next_s; - if (c < 0x80) - next_s = s + 1; - else - next_s = s + ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, s, text_end); - if (c == 0) - break; - - if (c < 32) - { - if (c == '\n') - { - line_width = word_width = blank_width = 0.0f; - inside_word = true; - s = next_s; - continue; - } - if (c == '\r') - { - s = next_s; - continue; - } - } - - const float char_width = ((int)c < IndexXAdvance.Size ? IndexXAdvance[(int)c] : FallbackXAdvance) * scale; - if (ImCharIsSpace(c)) - { - if (inside_word) - { - line_width += blank_width; - blank_width = 0.0f; - word_end = s; - } - blank_width += char_width; - inside_word = false; - } - else - { - word_width += char_width; - if (inside_word) - { - word_end = next_s; - } - else - { - prev_word_end = word_end; - line_width += word_width + blank_width; - word_width = blank_width = 0.0f; - } - - // Allow wrapping after punctuation. - inside_word = !(c == '.' || c == ',' || c == ';' || c == '!' || c == '?' || c == '\"'); - } - - // We ignore blank width at the end of the line (they can be skipped) - if (line_width + word_width >= wrap_width) - { - // Words that cannot possibly fit within an entire line will be cut anywhere. - if (word_width < wrap_width) - s = prev_word_end ? prev_word_end : word_end; - break; - } - - s = next_s; - } - - return s; -} - -ImVec2 ImFont::CalcTextSizeA(float size, float max_width, float wrap_width, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end, const char** remaining) const -{ - if (!text_end) - text_end = text_begin + strlen(text_begin); // FIXME-OPT: Need to avoid this. - - const float line_height = size; - const float scale = size / FontSize; - - ImVec2 text_size = ImVec2(0,0); - float line_width = 0.0f; - - const bool word_wrap_enabled = (wrap_width > 0.0f); - const char* word_wrap_eol = NULL; - - const char* s = text_begin; - while (s < text_end) - { - if (word_wrap_enabled) - { - // Calculate how far we can render. Requires two passes on the string data but keeps the code simple and not intrusive for what's essentially an uncommon feature. - if (!word_wrap_eol) - { - word_wrap_eol = CalcWordWrapPositionA(scale, s, text_end, wrap_width - line_width); - if (word_wrap_eol == s) // Wrap_width is too small to fit anything. Force displaying 1 character to minimize the height discontinuity. - word_wrap_eol++; // +1 may not be a character start point in UTF-8 but it's ok because we use s >= word_wrap_eol below - } - - if (s >= word_wrap_eol) - { - if (text_size.x < line_width) - text_size.x = line_width; - text_size.y += line_height; - line_width = 0.0f; - word_wrap_eol = NULL; - - // Wrapping skips upcoming blanks - while (s < text_end) - { - const char c = *s; - if (ImCharIsSpace(c)) { s++; } else if (c == '\n') { s++; break; } else { break; } - } - continue; - } - } - - // Decode and advance source - const char* prev_s = s; - unsigned int c = (unsigned int)*s; - if (c < 0x80) - { - s += 1; - } - else - { - s += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, s, text_end); - if (c == 0) // Malformed UTF-8? - break; - } - - if (c < 32) - { - if (c == '\n') - { - text_size.x = ImMax(text_size.x, line_width); - text_size.y += line_height; - line_width = 0.0f; - continue; - } - if (c == '\r') - continue; - } - - const float char_width = ((int)c < IndexXAdvance.Size ? IndexXAdvance[(int)c] : FallbackXAdvance) * scale; - if (line_width + char_width >= max_width) - { - s = prev_s; - break; - } - - line_width += char_width; - } - - if (text_size.x < line_width) - text_size.x = line_width; - - if (line_width > 0 || text_size.y == 0.0f) - text_size.y += line_height; - - if (remaining) - *remaining = s; - - return text_size; -} - -void ImFont::RenderChar(ImDrawList* draw_list, float size, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, unsigned short c) const -{ - if (c == ' ' || c == '\t' || c == '\n' || c == '\r') // Match behavior of RenderText(), those 4 codepoints are hard-coded. - return; - if (const Glyph* glyph = FindGlyph(c)) - { - float scale = (size >= 0.0f) ? (size / FontSize) : 1.0f; - pos.x = (float)(int)pos.x + DisplayOffset.x; - pos.y = (float)(int)pos.y + DisplayOffset.y; - ImVec2 pos_tl(pos.x + glyph->X0 * scale, pos.y + glyph->Y0 * scale); - ImVec2 pos_br(pos.x + glyph->X1 * scale, pos.y + glyph->Y1 * scale); - draw_list->PrimReserve(6, 4); - draw_list->PrimRectUV(pos_tl, pos_br, ImVec2(glyph->U0, glyph->V0), ImVec2(glyph->U1, glyph->V1), col); - } -} - -void ImFont::RenderText(ImDrawList* draw_list, float size, ImVec2 pos, ImU32 col, const ImVec4& clip_rect, const char* text_begin, const char* text_end, float wrap_width, bool cpu_fine_clip) const -{ - if (!text_end) - text_end = text_begin + strlen(text_begin); // ImGui functions generally already provides a valid text_end, so this is merely to handle direct calls. - - // Align to be pixel perfect - pos.x = (float)(int)pos.x + DisplayOffset.x; - pos.y = (float)(int)pos.y + DisplayOffset.y; - float x = pos.x; - float y = pos.y; - if (y > clip_rect.w) - return; - - const float scale = size / FontSize; - const float line_height = FontSize * scale; - const bool word_wrap_enabled = (wrap_width > 0.0f); - const char* word_wrap_eol = NULL; - - // Skip non-visible lines - const char* s = text_begin; - if (!word_wrap_enabled && y + line_height < clip_rect.y) - while (s < text_end && *s != '\n') // Fast-forward to next line - s++; - - // Reserve vertices for remaining worse case (over-reserving is useful and easily amortized) - const int vtx_count_max = (int)(text_end - s) * 4; - const int idx_count_max = (int)(text_end - s) * 6; - const int idx_expected_size = draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size + idx_count_max; - draw_list->PrimReserve(idx_count_max, vtx_count_max); - - ImDrawVert* vtx_write = draw_list->_VtxWritePtr; - ImDrawIdx* idx_write = draw_list->_IdxWritePtr; - unsigned int vtx_current_idx = draw_list->_VtxCurrentIdx; - - while (s < text_end) - { - if (word_wrap_enabled) - { - // Calculate how far we can render. Requires two passes on the string data but keeps the code simple and not intrusive for what's essentially an uncommon feature. - if (!word_wrap_eol) - { - word_wrap_eol = CalcWordWrapPositionA(scale, s, text_end, wrap_width - (x - pos.x)); - if (word_wrap_eol == s) // Wrap_width is too small to fit anything. Force displaying 1 character to minimize the height discontinuity. - word_wrap_eol++; // +1 may not be a character start point in UTF-8 but it's ok because we use s >= word_wrap_eol below - } - - if (s >= word_wrap_eol) - { - x = pos.x; - y += line_height; - word_wrap_eol = NULL; - - // Wrapping skips upcoming blanks - while (s < text_end) - { - const char c = *s; - if (ImCharIsSpace(c)) { s++; } else if (c == '\n') { s++; break; } else { break; } - } - continue; - } - } - - // Decode and advance source - unsigned int c = (unsigned int)*s; - if (c < 0x80) - { - s += 1; - } - else - { - s += ImTextCharFromUtf8(&c, s, text_end); - if (c == 0) // Malformed UTF-8? - break; - } - - if (c < 32) - { - if (c == '\n') - { - x = pos.x; - y += line_height; - - if (y > clip_rect.w) - break; - if (!word_wrap_enabled && y + line_height < clip_rect.y) - while (s < text_end && *s != '\n') // Fast-forward to next line - s++; - continue; - } - if (c == '\r') - continue; - } - - float char_width = 0.0f; - if (const Glyph* glyph = FindGlyph((unsigned short)c)) - { - char_width = glyph->XAdvance * scale; - - // Arbitrarily assume that both space and tabs are empty glyphs as an optimization - if (c != ' ' && c != '\t') - { - // We don't do a second finer clipping test on the Y axis as we've already skipped anything before clip_rect.y and exit once we pass clip_rect.w - float x1 = x + glyph->X0 * scale; - float x2 = x + glyph->X1 * scale; - float y1 = y + glyph->Y0 * scale; - float y2 = y + glyph->Y1 * scale; - if (x1 <= clip_rect.z && x2 >= clip_rect.x) - { - // Render a character - float u1 = glyph->U0; - float v1 = glyph->V0; - float u2 = glyph->U1; - float v2 = glyph->V1; - - // CPU side clipping used to fit text in their frame when the frame is too small. Only does clipping for axis aligned quads. - if (cpu_fine_clip) - { - if (x1 < clip_rect.x) - { - u1 = u1 + (1.0f - (x2 - clip_rect.x) / (x2 - x1)) * (u2 - u1); - x1 = clip_rect.x; - } - if (y1 < clip_rect.y) - { - v1 = v1 + (1.0f - (y2 - clip_rect.y) / (y2 - y1)) * (v2 - v1); - y1 = clip_rect.y; - } - if (x2 > clip_rect.z) - { - u2 = u1 + ((clip_rect.z - x1) / (x2 - x1)) * (u2 - u1); - x2 = clip_rect.z; - } - if (y2 > clip_rect.w) - { - v2 = v1 + ((clip_rect.w - y1) / (y2 - y1)) * (v2 - v1); - y2 = clip_rect.w; - } - if (y1 >= y2) - { - x += char_width; - continue; - } - } - - // We are NOT calling PrimRectUV() here because non-inlined causes too much overhead in a debug build. - // Inlined here: - { - idx_write[0] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_current_idx); idx_write[1] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_current_idx+1); idx_write[2] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_current_idx+2); - idx_write[3] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_current_idx); idx_write[4] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_current_idx+2); idx_write[5] = (ImDrawIdx)(vtx_current_idx+3); - vtx_write[0].pos.x = x1; vtx_write[0].pos.y = y1; vtx_write[0].col = col; vtx_write[0].uv.x = u1; vtx_write[0].uv.y = v1; - vtx_write[1].pos.x = x2; vtx_write[1].pos.y = y1; vtx_write[1].col = col; vtx_write[1].uv.x = u2; vtx_write[1].uv.y = v1; - vtx_write[2].pos.x = x2; vtx_write[2].pos.y = y2; vtx_write[2].col = col; vtx_write[2].uv.x = u2; vtx_write[2].uv.y = v2; - vtx_write[3].pos.x = x1; vtx_write[3].pos.y = y2; vtx_write[3].col = col; vtx_write[3].uv.x = u1; vtx_write[3].uv.y = v2; - vtx_write += 4; - vtx_current_idx += 4; - idx_write += 6; - } - } - } - } - - x += char_width; - } - - // Give back unused vertices - draw_list->VtxBuffer.resize((int)(vtx_write - draw_list->VtxBuffer.Data)); - draw_list->IdxBuffer.resize((int)(idx_write - draw_list->IdxBuffer.Data)); - draw_list->CmdBuffer[draw_list->CmdBuffer.Size-1].ElemCount -= (idx_expected_size - draw_list->IdxBuffer.Size); - draw_list->_VtxWritePtr = vtx_write; - draw_list->_IdxWritePtr = idx_write; - draw_list->_VtxCurrentIdx = (unsigned int)draw_list->VtxBuffer.Size; -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// DEFAULT FONT DATA -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// Compressed with stb_compress() then converted to a C array. -// Use the program in extra_fonts/binary_to_compressed_c.cpp to create the array from a TTF file. -// Decompression from stb.h (public domain) by Sean Barrett https://github.com/nothings/stb/blob/master/stb.h -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- - -static unsigned int stb_decompress_length(unsigned char *input) -{ - return (input[8] << 24) + (input[9] << 16) + (input[10] << 8) + input[11]; -} - -static unsigned char *stb__barrier, *stb__barrier2, *stb__barrier3, *stb__barrier4; -static unsigned char *stb__dout; -static void stb__match(unsigned char *data, unsigned int length) -{ - // INVERSE of memmove... write each byte before copying the next... - IM_ASSERT (stb__dout + length <= stb__barrier); - if (stb__dout + length > stb__barrier) { stb__dout += length; return; } - if (data < stb__barrier4) { stb__dout = stb__barrier+1; return; } - while (length--) *stb__dout++ = *data++; -} - -static void stb__lit(unsigned char *data, unsigned int length) -{ - IM_ASSERT (stb__dout + length <= stb__barrier); - if (stb__dout + length > stb__barrier) { stb__dout += length; return; } - if (data < stb__barrier2) { stb__dout = stb__barrier+1; return; } - memcpy(stb__dout, data, length); - stb__dout += length; -} - -#define stb__in2(x) ((i[x] << 8) + i[(x)+1]) -#define stb__in3(x) ((i[x] << 16) + stb__in2((x)+1)) -#define stb__in4(x) ((i[x] << 24) + stb__in3((x)+1)) - -static unsigned char *stb_decompress_token(unsigned char *i) -{ - if (*i >= 0x20) { // use fewer if's for cases that expand small - if (*i >= 0x80) stb__match(stb__dout-i[1]-1, i[0] - 0x80 + 1), i += 2; - else if (*i >= 0x40) stb__match(stb__dout-(stb__in2(0) - 0x4000 + 1), i[2]+1), i += 3; - else /* *i >= 0x20 */ stb__lit(i+1, i[0] - 0x20 + 1), i += 1 + (i[0] - 0x20 + 1); - } else { // more ifs for cases that expand large, since overhead is amortized - if (*i >= 0x18) stb__match(stb__dout-(stb__in3(0) - 0x180000 + 1), i[3]+1), i += 4; - else if (*i >= 0x10) stb__match(stb__dout-(stb__in3(0) - 0x100000 + 1), stb__in2(3)+1), i += 5; - else if (*i >= 0x08) stb__lit(i+2, stb__in2(0) - 0x0800 + 1), i += 2 + (stb__in2(0) - 0x0800 + 1); - else if (*i == 0x07) stb__lit(i+3, stb__in2(1) + 1), i += 3 + (stb__in2(1) + 1); - else if (*i == 0x06) stb__match(stb__dout-(stb__in3(1)+1), i[4]+1), i += 5; - else if (*i == 0x04) stb__match(stb__dout-(stb__in3(1)+1), stb__in2(4)+1), i += 6; - } - return i; -} - -static unsigned int stb_adler32(unsigned int adler32, unsigned char *buffer, unsigned int buflen) -{ - const unsigned long ADLER_MOD = 65521; - unsigned long s1 = adler32 & 0xffff, s2 = adler32 >> 16; - unsigned long blocklen, i; - - blocklen = buflen % 5552; - while (buflen) { - for (i=0; i + 7 < blocklen; i += 8) { - s1 += buffer[0], s2 += s1; - s1 += buffer[1], s2 += s1; - s1 += buffer[2], s2 += s1; - s1 += buffer[3], s2 += s1; - s1 += buffer[4], s2 += s1; - s1 += buffer[5], s2 += s1; - s1 += buffer[6], s2 += s1; - s1 += buffer[7], s2 += s1; - - buffer += 8; - } - - for (; i < blocklen; ++i) - s1 += *buffer++, s2 += s1; - - s1 %= ADLER_MOD, s2 %= ADLER_MOD; - buflen -= blocklen; - blocklen = 5552; - } - return (unsigned int)(s2 << 16) + (unsigned int)s1; -} - -static unsigned int stb_decompress(unsigned char *output, unsigned char *i, unsigned int length) -{ - unsigned int olen; - if (stb__in4(0) != 0x57bC0000) return 0; - if (stb__in4(4) != 0) return 0; // error! stream is > 4GB - olen = stb_decompress_length(i); - stb__barrier2 = i; - stb__barrier3 = i+length; - stb__barrier = output + olen; - stb__barrier4 = output; - i += 16; - - stb__dout = output; - for (;;) { - unsigned char *old_i = i; - i = stb_decompress_token(i); - if (i == old_i) { - if (*i == 0x05 && i[1] == 0xfa) { - IM_ASSERT(stb__dout == output + olen); - if (stb__dout != output + olen) return 0; - if (stb_adler32(1, output, olen) != (unsigned int) stb__in4(2)) - return 0; - return olen; - } else { - IM_ASSERT(0); /* NOTREACHED */ - return 0; - } - } - IM_ASSERT(stb__dout <= output + olen); - if (stb__dout > output + olen) - return 0; - } -} - -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// ProggyClean.ttf -// Copyright (c) 2004, 2005 Tristan Grimmer -// MIT license (see License.txt in http://www.upperbounds.net/download/ProggyClean.ttf.zip) -// Download and more information at http://upperbounds.net -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -// File: 'ProggyClean.ttf' (41208 bytes) -// Exported using binary_to_compressed_c.cpp -//----------------------------------------------------------------------------- -static const char proggy_clean_ttf_compressed_data_base85[11980+1] = - "7])#######hV0qs'/###[),##/l:$#Q6>##5[n42>c-TH`->>#/e>11NNV=Bv(*:.F?uu#(gRU.o0XGH`$vhLG1hxt9?W`#,5LsCp#-i>.r$<$6pD>Lb';9Crc6tgXmKVeU2cD4Eo3R/" - "2*>]b(MC;$jPfY.;h^`IWM9Qo#t'X#(v#Y9w0#1D$CIf;W'#pWUPXOuxXuU(H9M(1=Ke$$'5F%)]0^#0X@U.a$FBjVQTSDgEKnIS7EM9>ZY9w0#L;>>#Mx&4Mvt//L[MkA#W@lK.N'[0#7RL_&#w+F%HtG9M#XL`N&.,GM4Pg;--VsM.M0rJfLH2eTM`*oJMHRC`N" - "kfimM2J,W-jXS:)r0wK#@Fge$U>`w'N7G#$#fB#$E^$#:9:hk+eOe--6x)F7*E%?76%^GMHePW-Z5l'&GiF#$956:rS?dA#fiK:)Yr+`�j@'DbG&#^$PG.Ll+DNa&VZ>1i%h1S9u5o@YaaW$e+bROPOpxTO7Stwi1::iB1q)C_=dV26J;2,]7op$]uQr@_V7$q^%lQwtuHY]=DX,n3L#0PHDO4f9>dC@O>HBuKPpP*E,N+b3L#lpR/MrTEH.IAQk.a>D[.e;mc." - "x]Ip.PH^'/aqUO/$1WxLoW0[iLAw=4h(9.`G" - "CRUxHPeR`5Mjol(dUWxZa(>STrPkrJiWx`5U7F#.g*jrohGg`cg:lSTvEY/EV_7H4Q9[Z%cnv;JQYZ5q.l7Zeas:HOIZOB?Ggv:[7MI2k).'2($5FNP&EQ(,)" - "U]W]+fh18.vsai00);D3@4ku5P?DP8aJt+;qUM]=+b'8@;mViBKx0DE[-auGl8:PJ&Dj+M6OC]O^((##]`0i)drT;-7X`=-H3[igUnPG-NZlo.#k@h#=Ork$m>a>$-?Tm$UV(?#P6YY#" - "'/###xe7q.73rI3*pP/$1>s9)W,JrM7SN]'/4C#v$U`0#V.[0>xQsH$fEmPMgY2u7Kh(G%siIfLSoS+MK2eTM$=5,M8p`A.;_R%#u[K#$x4AG8.kK/HSB==-'Ie/QTtG?-.*^N-4B/ZM" - "_3YlQC7(p7q)&](`6_c)$/*JL(L-^(]$wIM`dPtOdGA,U3:w2M-0+WomX2u7lqM2iEumMTcsF?-aT=Z-97UEnXglEn1K-bnEO`gu" - "Ft(c%=;Am_Qs@jLooI&NX;]0#j4#F14;gl8-GQpgwhrq8'=l_f-b49'UOqkLu7-##oDY2L(te+Mch&gLYtJ,MEtJfLh'x'M=$CS-ZZ%P]8bZ>#S?YY#%Q&q'3^Fw&?D)UDNrocM3A76/" - "/oL?#h7gl85[qW/NDOk%16ij;+:1a'iNIdb-ou8.P*w,v5#EI$TWS>Pot-R*H'-SEpA:g)f+O$%%`kA#G=8RMmG1&O`>to8bC]T&$,n.LoO>29sp3dt-52U%VM#q7'DHpg+#Z9%H[Ket`e;)f#Km8&+DC$I46>#Kr]]u-[=99tts1.qb#q72g1WJO81q+eN'03'eM>&1XxY-caEnO" - "j%2n8)),?ILR5^.Ibn<-X-Mq7[a82Lq:F&#ce+S9wsCK*x`569E8ew'He]h:sI[2LM$[guka3ZRd6:t%IG:;$%YiJ:Nq=?eAw;/:nnDq0(CYcMpG)qLN4$##&J-XTt,%OVU4)S1+R-#dg0/Nn?Ku1^0f$B*P:Rowwm-`0PKjYDDM'3]d39VZHEl4,.j']Pk-M.h^&:0FACm$maq-&sgw0t7/6(^xtk%" - "LuH88Fj-ekm>GA#_>568x6(OFRl-IZp`&b,_P'$MhLbxfc$mj`,O;&%W2m`Zh:/)Uetw:aJ%]K9h:TcF]u_-Sj9,VK3M.*'&0D[Ca]J9gp8,kAW]" - "%(?A%R$f<->Zts'^kn=-^@c4%-pY6qI%J%1IGxfLU9CP8cbPlXv);C=b),<2mOvP8up,UVf3839acAWAW-W?#ao/^#%KYo8fRULNd2.>%m]UK:n%r$'sw]J;5pAoO_#2mO3n,'=H5(et" - "Hg*`+RLgv>=4U8guD$I%D:W>-r5V*%j*W:Kvej.Lp$'?;++O'>()jLR-^u68PHm8ZFWe+ej8h:9r6L*0//c&iH&R8pRbA#Kjm%upV1g:" - "a_#Ur7FuA#(tRh#.Y5K+@?3<-8m0$PEn;J:rh6?I6uG<-`wMU'ircp0LaE_OtlMb&1#6T.#FDKu#1Lw%u%+GM+X'e?YLfjM[VO0MbuFp7;>Q&#WIo)0@F%q7c#4XAXN-U&VBpqB>0ie&jhZ[?iLR@@_AvA-iQC(=ksRZRVp7`.=+NpBC%rh&3]R:8XDmE5^V8O(x<-+k?'(^](H.aREZSi,#1:[IXaZFOm<-ui#qUq2$##Ri;u75OK#(RtaW-K-F`S+cF]uN`-KMQ%rP/Xri.LRcB##=YL3BgM/3M" - "D?@f&1'BW-)Ju#bmmWCMkk&#TR`C,5d>g)F;t,4:@_l8G/5h4vUd%&%950:VXD'QdWoY-F$BtUwmfe$YqL'8(PWX(" - "P?^@Po3$##`MSs?DWBZ/S>+4%>fX,VWv/w'KD`LP5IbH;rTV>n3cEK8U#bX]l-/V+^lj3;vlMb&[5YQ8#pekX9JP3XUC72L,,?+Ni&co7ApnO*5NK,((W-i:$,kp'UDAO(G0Sq7MVjJs" - "bIu)'Z,*[>br5fX^:FPAWr-m2KgLQ_nN6'8uTGT5g)uLv:873UpTLgH+#FgpH'_o1780Ph8KmxQJ8#H72L4@768@Tm&Q" - "h4CB/5OvmA&,Q&QbUoi$a_%3M01H)4x7I^&KQVgtFnV+;[Pc>[m4k//,]1?#`VY[Jr*3&&slRfLiVZJ:]?=K3Sw=[$=uRB?3xk48@aege0jT6'N#(q%.O=?2S]u*(m<-" - "V8J'(1)G][68hW$5'q[GC&5j`TE?m'esFGNRM)j,ffZ?-qx8;->g4t*:CIP/[Qap7/9'#(1sao7w-.qNUdkJ)tCF&#B^;xGvn2r9FEPFFFcL@.iFNkTve$m%#QvQS8U@)2Z+3K:AKM5i" - "sZ88+dKQ)W6>J%CL`.d*(B`-n8D9oK-XV1q['-5k'cAZ69e;D_?$ZPP&s^+7])$*$#@QYi9,5P r+$%CE=68>K8r0=dSC%%(@p7" - ".m7jilQ02'0-VWAgTlGW'b)Tq7VT9q^*^$$.:&N@@" - "$&)WHtPm*5_rO0&e%K&#-30j(E4#'Zb.o/(Tpm$>K'f@[PvFl,hfINTNU6u'0pao7%XUp9]5.>%h`8_=VYbxuel.NTSsJfLacFu3B'lQSu/m6-Oqem8T+oE--$0a/k]uj9EwsG>%veR*" - "hv^BFpQj:K'#SJ,sB-'#](j.Lg92rTw-*n%@/;39rrJF,l#qV%OrtBeC6/,;qB3ebNW[?,Hqj2L.1NP&GjUR=1D8QaS3Up&@*9wP?+lo7b?@%'k4`p0Z$22%K3+iCZj?XJN4Nm&+YF]u" - "@-W$U%VEQ/,,>>#)D#%8cY#YZ?=,`Wdxu/ae&#" - "w6)R89tI#6@s'(6Bf7a&?S=^ZI_kS&ai`&=tE72L_D,;^R)7[$so8lKN%5/$(vdfq7+ebA#" - "u1p]ovUKW&Y%q]'>$1@-[xfn$7ZTp7mM,G,Ko7a&Gu%G[RMxJs[0MM%wci.LFDK)(%:_i2B5CsR8&9Z&#=mPEnm0f`<&c)QL5uJ#%u%lJj+D-r;BoFDoS97h5g)E#o:&S4weDF,9^Hoe`h*L+_a*NrLW-1pG_&2UdB8" - "6e%B/:=>)N4xeW.*wft-;$'58-ESqr#U`'6AQ]m&6/`Z>#S?YY#Vc;r7U2&326d=w&H####?TZ`*4?&.MK?LP8Vxg>$[QXc%QJv92.(Db*B)gb*BM9dM*hJMAo*c&#" - "b0v=Pjer]$gG&JXDf->'StvU7505l9$AFvgYRI^&<^b68?j#q9QX4SM'RO#&sL1IM.rJfLUAj221]d##DW=m83u5;'bYx,*Sl0hL(W;;$doB&O/TQ:(Z^xBdLjLV#*8U_72Lh+2Q8Cj0i:6hp&$C/:p(HK>T8Y[gHQ4`4)'$Ab(Nof%V'8hL&#SfD07&6D@M.*J:;$-rv29'M]8qMv-tLp,'886iaC=Hb*YJoKJ,(j%K=H`K.v9HggqBIiZu'QvBT.#=)0ukruV&.)3=(^1`o*Pj4<-#MJ+gLq9-##@HuZPN0]u:h7.T..G:;$/Usj(T7`Q8tT72LnYl<-qx8;-HV7Q-&Xdx%1a,hC=0u+HlsV>nuIQL-5" - "_>@kXQtMacfD.m-VAb8;IReM3$wf0''hra*so568'Ip&vRs849'MRYSp%:t:h5qSgwpEr$B>Q,;s(C#$)`svQuF$##-D,##,g68@2[T;.XSdN9Qe)rpt._K-#5wF)sP'##p#C0c%-Gb%" - "hd+<-j'Ai*x&&HMkT]C'OSl##5RG[JXaHN;d'uA#x._U;.`PU@(Z3dt4r152@:v,'R.Sj'w#0<-;kPI)FfJ&#AYJ&#//)>-k=m=*XnK$>=)72L]0I%>.G690a:$##<,);?;72#?x9+d;" - "^V'9;jY@;)br#q^YQpx:X#Te$Z^'=-=bGhLf:D6&bNwZ9-ZD#n^9HhLMr5G;']d&6'wYmTFmLq9wI>P(9mI[>kC-ekLC/R&CH+s'B;K-M6$EB%is00:" - "+A4[7xks.LrNk0&E)wILYF@2L'0Nb$+pv<(2.768/FrY&h$^3i&@+G%JT'<-,v`3;_)I9M^AE]CN?Cl2AZg+%4iTpT3$U4O]GKx'm9)b@p7YsvK3w^YR-" - "CdQ*:Ir<($u&)#(&?L9Rg3H)4fiEp^iI9O8KnTj,]H?D*r7'M;PwZ9K0E^k&-cpI;.p/6_vwoFMV<->#%Xi.LxVnrU(4&8/P+:hLSKj$#U%]49t'I:rgMi'FL@a:0Y-uA[39',(vbma*" - "hU%<-SRF`Tt:542R_VV$p@[p8DV[A,?1839FWdFTi1O*H&#(AL8[_P%.M>v^-))qOT*F5Cq0`Ye%+$B6i:7@0IXSsDiWP,##P`%/L-" - "S(qw%sf/@%#B6;/U7K]uZbi^Oc^2n%t<)'mEVE''n`WnJra$^TKvX5B>;_aSEK',(hwa0:i4G?.Bci.(X[?b*($,=-n<.Q%`(X=?+@Am*Js0&=3bh8K]mL69=Lb,OcZV/);TTm8VI;?%OtJ<(b4mq7M6:u?KRdFl*:xP?Yb.5)%w_I?7uk5JC+FS(m#i'k.'a0i)9<7b'fs'59hq$*5Uhv##pi^8+hIEBF`nvo`;'l0.^S1<-wUK2/Coh58KKhLj" - "M=SO*rfO`+qC`W-On.=AJ56>>i2@2LH6A:&5q`?9I3@@'04&p2/LVa*T-4<-i3;M9UvZd+N7>b*eIwg:CC)c<>nO&#$(>.Z-I&J(Q0Hd5Q%7Co-b`-cP)hI;*_F]u`Rb[.j8_Q/<&>uu+VsH$sM9TA%?)(vmJ80),P7E>)tjD%2L=-t#fK[%`v=Q8WlA2);Sa" - ">gXm8YB`1d@K#n]76-a$U,mF%Ul:#/'xoFM9QX-$.QN'>" - "[%$Z$uF6pA6Ki2O5:8w*vP1<-1`[G,)-m#>0`P&#eb#.3i)rtB61(o'$?X3B2Qft^ae_5tKL9MUe9b*sLEQ95C&`=G?@Mj=wh*'3E>=-<)Gt*Iw)'QG:`@I" - "wOf7&]1i'S01B+Ev/Nac#9S;=;YQpg_6U`*kVY39xK,[/6Aj7:'1Bm-_1EYfa1+o&o4hp7KN_Q(OlIo@S%;jVdn0'1h19w,WQhLI)3S#f$2(eb,jr*b;3Vw]*7NH%$c4Vs,eD9>XW8?N]o+(*pgC%/72LV-uW%iewS8W6m2rtCpo'RS1R84=@paTKt)>=%&1[)*vp'u+x,VrwN;&]kuO9JDbg=pO$J*.jVe;u'm0dr9l,<*wMK*Oe=g8lV_KEBFkO'oU]^=[-792#ok,)" - "i]lR8qQ2oA8wcRCZ^7w/Njh;?.stX?Q1>S1q4Bn$)K1<-rGdO'$Wr.Lc.CG)$/*JL4tNR/,SVO3,aUw'DJN:)Ss;wGn9A32ijw%FL+Z0Fn.U9;reSq)bmI32U==5ALuG&#Vf1398/pVo" - "1*c-(aY168o<`JsSbk-,1N;$>0:OUas(3:8Z972LSfF8eb=c-;>SPw7.6hn3m`9^Xkn(r.qS[0;T%&Qc=+STRxX'q1BNk3&*eu2;&8q$&x>Q#Q7^Tf+6<(d%ZVmj2bDi%.3L2n+4W'$P" - "iDDG)g,r%+?,$@?uou5tSe2aN_AQU*'IAO" - "URQ##V^Fv-XFbGM7Fl(N<3DhLGF%q.1rC$#:T__&Pi68%0xi_&[qFJ(77j_&JWoF.V735&T,[R*:xFR*K5>>#`bW-?4Ne_&6Ne_&6Ne_&n`kr-#GJcM6X;uM6X;uM(.a..^2TkL%oR(#" - ";u.T%fAr%4tJ8&><1=GHZ_+m9/#H1F^R#SC#*N=BA9(D?v[UiFY>>^8p,KKF.W]L29uLkLlu/+4T" - "w$)F./^n3+rlo+DB;5sIYGNk+i1t-69Jg--0pao7Sm#K)pdHW&;LuDNH@H>#/X-TI(;P>#,Gc>#0Su>#4`1?#8lC?#xL$#B.`$#F:r$#JF.%#NR@%#R_R%#Vke%#Zww%#_-4^Rh%Sflr-k'MS.o?.5/sWel/wpEM0%3'/1)K^f1-d>G21&v(35>V`39V7A4=onx4" - "A1OY5EI0;6Ibgr6M$HS7Q<)58C5w,;WoA*#[%T*#`1g*#d=#+#hI5+#lUG+#pbY+#tnl+#x$),#&1;,#*=M,#.I`,#2Ur,#6b.-#;w[H#iQtA#m^0B#qjBB#uvTB##-hB#'9$C#+E6C#" - "/QHC#3^ZC#7jmC#;v)D#?,)4kMYD4lVu`4m`:&5niUA5@(A5BA1]PBB:xlBCC=2CDLXMCEUtiCf&0g2'tN?PGT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CP" - "GT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CPGT4CP-qekC`.9kEg^+F$kwViFJTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5KTB&5o,^<-28ZI'O?;xp" - "O?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xpO?;xp;7q-#lLYI:xvD=#"; - -static const char* GetDefaultCompressedFontDataTTFBase85() -{ - return proggy_clean_ttf_compressed_data_base85; -} diff --git a/src/ini.cpp b/src/ini.cpp index 8286247..fe1f005 100644 --- a/src/ini.cpp +++ b/src/ini.cpp @@ -1,4 +1,4 @@ -/** +fr/** * This file is part of Tales of Berseria "Fix". * * Tales of Berseria "Fix" is free software : you can redistribute it diff --git a/src/input.cpp b/src/input.cpp index ee5fce6..de98c97 100644 --- a/src/input.cpp +++ b/src/input.cpp @@ -205,9 +205,6 @@ typedef LRESULT (CALLBACK *DetourWindowProc_pfn)( DetourWindowProc_pfn DetourWindowProc_Original = nullptr; -LRESULT -ImGui_ImplDX9_WndProcHandler ( HWND hWnd, UINT msg, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam ); - LRESULT CALLBACK DetourWindowProc ( _In_ HWND hWnd, diff --git a/src/render.cpp b/src/render.cpp index e48703f..91b46f1 100644 --- a/src/render.cpp +++ b/src/render.cpp @@ -33,9 +33,6 @@ #include #include -#include -#include "tbt/imgui_impl_dx9.h" - tbf::RenderFix::tbf_draw_states_s tbf::RenderFix::draw_state; @@ -152,11 +149,8 @@ D3D9SetSamplerState_Detour (IDirect3DDevice9* This, if (Value != D3DTEXF_POINT) Value = D3DTEXF_ANISOTROPIC; - // Clamp [0, oo) if (Type == D3DSAMP_MIPMAPLODBIAS) { float fMax = config.textures.lod_bias; - //float fMax = - //max (0.0f, *reinterpret_cast (&Value)); Value = *reinterpret_cast (&fMax); } @@ -614,10 +608,10 @@ D3D9EndScene_Detour (IDirect3DDevice9* This) if (SUCCEEDED (hr)) { extern void - TBFix_DrawConfigUI(LPDIRECT3DDEVICE9 pDev = nullptr); + TBFix_DrawConfigUI (void); if (config.input.ui.visible) { - TBFix_DrawConfigUI (This); + TBFix_DrawConfigUI (); } } diff --git a/src/tbt/control_panel.cpp b/src/tbt/control_panel.cpp index d99b874..7060369 100644 --- a/src/tbt/control_panel.cpp +++ b/src/tbt/control_panel.cpp @@ -2,7 +2,6 @@ // If you are new to ImGui, see examples/README.txt and documentation at the top of imgui.cpp. #include -#include "imgui_impl_dx9.h" #include #define DIRECTINPUT_VERSION 0x0800 #include @@ -13,58 +12,6 @@ #include "framerate.h" #include "hook.h" -// Data -static LPDIRECT3DDEVICE9 g_pd3dDevice = NULL; -static D3DPRESENT_PARAMETERS g_d3dpp; - -IMGUI_API -LRESULT -WINAPI -ImGui_WndProcHandler ( HWND, UINT msg, - WPARAM wParam, - LPARAM lParam ); - -LRESULT -WINAPI -WndProc ( HWND hWnd, - UINT msg, - WPARAM wParam, - LPARAM lParam ) -{ - if (ImGui_WndProcHandler (hWnd, msg, wParam, lParam)) - return TRUE; - - switch (msg) - { - case WM_SIZE: - if (g_pd3dDevice != NULL && wParam != SIZE_MINIMIZED) - { - ImGui_ImplDX9_InvalidateDeviceObjects (); - g_d3dpp.BackBufferWidth = LOWORD (lParam); - g_d3dpp.BackBufferHeight = HIWORD (lParam); - - HRESULT hr = - g_pd3dDevice->Reset (&g_d3dpp); - - if (hr == D3DERR_INVALIDCALL) - IM_ASSERT (0); - - ImGui_ImplDX9_CreateDeviceObjects (); - } - return 0; - - case WM_SYSCOMMAND: - if ((wParam & 0xfff0) == SC_KEYMENU) // Disable ALT application menu - return 0; - break; - - case WM_DESTROY: - PostQuitMessage (0); - return 0; - } - - return DefWindowProc (hWnd, msg, wParam, lParam); -} #include #include @@ -126,10 +73,10 @@ TBFix_ToggleConfigUI (void) config.input.ui.visible = (! config.input.ui.visible); - if (config.input.ui.visible) - SK_GetCommandProcessor ()->ProcessCommandLine ("ImGui.Visible 1"); - else - SK_GetCommandProcessor ()->ProcessCommandLine ("ImGui.Visible 0"); + SK_GetCommandProcessor ()->ProcessCommandLine ( + config.input.ui.visible ? "ImGui.Visible 1" : + "ImGui.Visible 0" + ); if (config.input.ui.pause) TBFix_PauseGame (config.input.ui.visible); @@ -208,12 +155,14 @@ TBFix_GamepadConfigDlg (void) #define IM_ARRAYSIZE(_ARR) ((int)(sizeof(_ARR)/sizeof(*_ARR))) +IMGUI_API void -TBFix_DrawConfigUI (LPDIRECT3DDEVICE9 pDev = nullptr) -{ - if (pDev != nullptr) - g_pd3dDevice = pDev; +ImGui_ImplDX9_NewFrame (void); + +void +TBFix_DrawConfigUI (void) +{ ImGui_ImplDX9_NewFrame (); ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO (); @@ -342,6 +291,9 @@ TBFix_DrawConfigUI (LPDIRECT3DDEVICE9 pDev = nullptr) ImGui::Text ("Controls texture sharpness; -3 = Sharpest (WILL shimmer), 0 = Neutral, 16 = Laughably blurry"); ImGui::EndTooltip (); } + + + ImGui::Checkbox ("Display Texture Resampling Indicator in OSD", &config.textures.show_loading_text); } #if 0 @@ -429,145 +381,16 @@ TBFix_DrawConfigUI (LPDIRECT3DDEVICE9 pDev = nullptr) } // Rendering - g_pd3dDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_ZENABLE, false); - g_pd3dDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_ALPHABLENDENABLE, false); - g_pd3dDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_SCISSORTESTENABLE, false); - - if (pDev == nullptr) { - D3DCOLOR clear_col_dx = - D3DCOLOR_RGBA ( (int)(clear_col.x * 255.0f), - (int)(clear_col.y * 255.0f), - (int)(clear_col.z * 255.0f), - (int)(clear_col.w * 255.0f) ); - - g_pd3dDevice->Clear ( - 0, - NULL, - D3DCLEAR_TARGET | D3DCLEAR_ZBUFFER, - clear_col_dx, - 1.0f, - 0 ); - - - } - - if (SUCCEEDED (g_pd3dDevice->BeginScene ())) { - ImGui::Render (); - g_pd3dDevice->EndScene (); - } -} - -#if 0 -__declspec (dllexport) -void -CALLBACK -tbt_main (HWND hwnd, HINSTANCE hinst, LPSTR lpszCmdLine, int nCmdShow) -{ - // Create application window - WNDCLASSEX wc = - { - sizeof (WNDCLASSEX), - CS_CLASSDC, - WndProc, - 0L, 0L, - GetModuleHandle (nullptr), - nullptr, - LoadCursor (nullptr, IDC_ARROW), - nullptr, nullptr, - L"Tales of Berseria Tweak", - nullptr - }; - - RegisterClassEx (&wc); - hwnd = - CreateWindow ( L"Tales of Berseria Tweak", L"Tales of Berseria Tweak", - WS_OVERLAPPEDWINDOW, - 100, 100, - 1280, 800, - NULL, NULL, - wc.hInstance, - NULL ); - - typedef IDirect3D9* - (STDMETHODCALLTYPE *Direct3DCreate9_pfn)(UINT SDKVersion); - - extern HMODULE hInjectorDLL; // Handle to Special K - - hInjectorDLL = LoadLibrary (L"d3d9.dll"); - - Direct3DCreate9_pfn SK_Direct3DCreate9 = - (Direct3DCreate9_pfn) - GetProcAddress (hInjectorDLL, "Direct3DCreate9"); - - // Initialize Direct3D - LPDIRECT3D9 pD3D; - if ((pD3D = SK_Direct3DCreate9 (D3D_SDK_VERSION)) == NULL) - UnregisterClass (L"Tales of Berseria Tweak", wc.hInstance); - - ZeroMemory (&g_d3dpp, sizeof (g_d3dpp)); - g_d3dpp.Windowed = TRUE; - g_d3dpp.SwapEffect = D3DSWAPEFFECT_DISCARD; - g_d3dpp.BackBufferFormat = D3DFMT_UNKNOWN; - g_d3dpp.EnableAutoDepthStencil = TRUE; - g_d3dpp.AutoDepthStencilFormat = D3DFMT_D16; - g_d3dpp.PresentationInterval = D3DPRESENT_INTERVAL_IMMEDIATE; - - // Create the D3DDevice - if ( pD3D->CreateDevice ( D3DADAPTER_DEFAULT, - D3DDEVTYPE_HAL, - hwnd, - D3DCREATE_HARDWARE_VERTEXPROCESSING, - &g_d3dpp, - &g_pd3dDevice ) < 0 ) - { - pD3D->Release (); - UnregisterClass (L"Tales of Berseria Tweak", wc.hInstance); - } - - // Setup ImGui binding - ImGui_ImplDX9_Init (hwnd, g_pd3dDevice); - - // Load Fonts - // (there is a default font, this is only if you want to change it. see extra_fonts/README.txt for more details) - //ImGuiIO& io = ImGui::GetIO(); - //io.Fonts->AddFontDefault(); - //io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("../../extra_fonts/Cousine-Regular.ttf", 15.0f); - //io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("../../extra_fonts/DroidSans.ttf", 16.0f); - //io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("../../extra_fonts/ProggyClean.ttf", 13.0f); - //io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("../../extra_fonts/ProggyTiny.ttf", 10.0f); - //io.Fonts->AddFontFromFileTTF("c:\\Windows\\Fonts\\ArialUni.ttf", 18.0f, NULL, io.Fonts->GetGlyphRangesJapanese()); - - // Main loop - MSG msg; - ZeroMemory (&msg, sizeof (msg)); - - ShowWindow (hwnd, SW_SHOWDEFAULT); - UpdateWindow (hwnd); - - //TBF_LoadConfig(); - - while (msg.message != WM_QUIT) + tbf::RenderFix::pDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_ZENABLE, false); + tbf::RenderFix::pDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_ALPHABLENDENABLE, false); + tbf::RenderFix::pDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_SCISSORTESTENABLE, false); + + if ( SUCCEEDED ( + tbf::RenderFix::pDevice->BeginScene () + ) + ) { - if (PeekMessage (&msg, NULL, 0U, 0U, PM_REMOVE)) - { - TranslateMessage (&msg); - DispatchMessage (&msg); - continue; - } - - TBFix_DrawConfigUI (); - - g_pd3dDevice->Present (NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL); + ImGui::Render (); + tbf::RenderFix::pDevice->EndScene (); } - - ImGui_ImplDX9_Shutdown (); - - if (g_pd3dDevice) - g_pd3dDevice->Release (); - - if (pD3D) - pD3D->Release (); - - UnregisterClass (L"Tales of Berseria Tweak", wc.hInstance); -} -#endif \ No newline at end of file +} \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/src/tbt/imgui_impl_dx9.cpp b/src/tbt/imgui_impl_dx9.cpp deleted file mode 100644 index fa97417..0000000 --- a/src/tbt/imgui_impl_dx9.cpp +++ /dev/null @@ -1,567 +0,0 @@ -#if 0 -// ImGui Win32 + DirectX9 binding -// In this binding, ImTextureID is used to store a 'LPDIRECT3DTEXTURE9' texture identifier. Read the FAQ about ImTextureID in imgui.cpp. - -// You can copy and use unmodified imgui_impl_* files in your project. See main.cpp for an example of using this. -// If you use this binding you'll need to call 4 functions: ImGui_ImplXXXX_Init(), ImGui_ImplXXXX_NewFrame(), ImGui::Render() and ImGui_ImplXXXX_Shutdown(). -// If you are new to ImGui, see examples/README.txt and documentation at the top of imgui.cpp. -// https://github.com/ocornut/imgui - -#include -#include "imgui_impl_dx9.h" - -// DirectX -#include -#define DIRECTINPUT_VERSION 0x0800 -#include - -#include "config.h" -#include "render.h" - - -// Data -static HWND g_hWnd = 0; -static INT64 g_Time = 0; -static INT64 g_TicksPerSecond = 0; -static LPDIRECT3DDEVICE9 g_pd3dDevice = nullptr; -static LPDIRECT3DVERTEXBUFFER9 g_pVB = nullptr; -static LPDIRECT3DINDEXBUFFER9 g_pIB = nullptr; -static LPDIRECT3DTEXTURE9 g_FontTexture = nullptr; -static int g_VertexBufferSize = 5000, - g_IndexBufferSize = 10000; - -struct CUSTOMVERTEX -{ - float pos [3]; - D3DCOLOR col; - float uv [2]; -}; -#define D3DFVF_CUSTOMVERTEX (D3DFVF_XYZ|D3DFVF_DIFFUSE|D3DFVF_TEX1) - -// This is the main rendering function that you have to implement and provide to ImGui (via setting up 'RenderDrawListsFn' in the ImGuiIO structure) -// If text or lines are blurry when integrating ImGui in your engine: -// - in your Render function, try translating your projection matrix by (0.5f,0.5f) or (0.375f,0.375f) -void -ImGui_ImplDX9_RenderDrawLists (ImDrawData* draw_data) -{ - // Avoid rendering when minimized - ImGuiIO& io = - ImGui::GetIO (); - - if ( io.DisplaySize.x <= 0.0f || io.DisplaySize.y <= 0.0f ) - return; - - // Create and grow buffers if needed - if ((! g_pVB) || g_VertexBufferSize < draw_data->TotalVtxCount ) - { - if (g_pVB) { - g_pVB->Release (); - g_pVB = nullptr; - } - - g_VertexBufferSize = - draw_data->TotalVtxCount + 5000; - - if ( g_pd3dDevice->CreateVertexBuffer ( g_VertexBufferSize * sizeof CUSTOMVERTEX, - D3DUSAGE_DYNAMIC | D3DUSAGE_WRITEONLY, - D3DFVF_CUSTOMVERTEX, - D3DPOOL_DEFAULT, - &g_pVB, - nullptr ) < 0 ) { - return; - } - } - - if ((! g_pIB) || g_IndexBufferSize < draw_data->TotalIdxCount) - { - if (g_pIB) { - g_pIB->Release (); - g_pIB = NULL; - } - - g_IndexBufferSize = draw_data->TotalIdxCount + 10000; - - if ( g_pd3dDevice->CreateIndexBuffer ( g_IndexBufferSize * sizeof ImDrawIdx, - D3DUSAGE_DYNAMIC | D3DUSAGE_WRITEONLY, - sizeof (ImDrawIdx) == 2 ? - D3DFMT_INDEX16 : - D3DFMT_INDEX32, - D3DPOOL_DEFAULT, - &g_pIB, - nullptr ) < 0 ) { - return; - } - } - - // Backup the DX9 state - IDirect3DStateBlock9* d3d9_state_block = nullptr; - - if (g_pd3dDevice->CreateStateBlock ( D3DSBT_ALL, &d3d9_state_block ) < 0 ) - return; - - // Copy and convert all vertices into a single contiguous buffer - CUSTOMVERTEX* vtx_dst; - ImDrawIdx* idx_dst; - - if ( g_pVB->Lock ( 0, - (UINT)(draw_data->TotalVtxCount * sizeof CUSTOMVERTEX), - (void **)&vtx_dst, - D3DLOCK_DISCARD ) < 0 ) - return; - - if ( g_pIB->Lock ( 0, - (UINT)(draw_data->TotalIdxCount * sizeof ImDrawIdx), - (void **)&idx_dst, - D3DLOCK_DISCARD ) < 0 ) - return; - - for ( int n = 0; - n < draw_data->CmdListsCount; - n++ ) - { - const ImDrawList* cmd_list = draw_data->CmdLists [n]; - const ImDrawVert* vtx_src = cmd_list->VtxBuffer.Data; - - for (int i = 0; i < cmd_list->VtxBuffer.Size; i++) - { - vtx_dst->pos [0] = vtx_src->pos.x; - vtx_dst->pos [1] = vtx_src->pos.y; - vtx_dst->pos [2] = 0.0f; - vtx_dst->col = (vtx_src->col & 0xFF00FF00) | - ((vtx_src->col & 0xFF0000) >> 16) | - ((vtx_src->col & 0xFF) << 16); // RGBA --> ARGB for DirectX9 - vtx_dst->uv [0] = vtx_src->uv.x; - vtx_dst->uv [1] = vtx_src->uv.y; - vtx_dst++; - vtx_src++; - } - - memcpy ( idx_dst, - cmd_list->IdxBuffer.Data, - cmd_list->IdxBuffer.Size * sizeof ImDrawIdx); - - idx_dst += cmd_list->IdxBuffer.Size; - } - - g_pVB->Unlock (); - g_pIB->Unlock (); - - g_pd3dDevice->SetStreamSource (0, g_pVB, 0, sizeof CUSTOMVERTEX); - g_pd3dDevice->SetIndices (g_pIB); - g_pd3dDevice->SetFVF (D3DFVF_CUSTOMVERTEX); - - // Setup viewport - D3DVIEWPORT9 vp; - - vp.X = vp.Y = 0; - vp.Width = (DWORD)io.DisplaySize.x; - vp.Height = (DWORD)io.DisplaySize.y; - vp.MinZ = 0.0f; - vp.MaxZ = 1.0f; - g_pd3dDevice->SetViewport (&vp); - - // Setup render state: fixed-pipeline, alpha-blending, no face culling, no depth testing - g_pd3dDevice->SetPixelShader (NULL); - g_pd3dDevice->SetVertexShader (NULL); - - g_pd3dDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_CULLMODE, D3DCULL_NONE); - g_pd3dDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_LIGHTING, false); - g_pd3dDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_ZENABLE, false); - g_pd3dDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_ALPHABLENDENABLE, true); - g_pd3dDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_ALPHATESTENABLE, false); - g_pd3dDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_BLENDOP, D3DBLENDOP_ADD); - g_pd3dDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_SRCBLEND, D3DBLEND_SRCALPHA); - g_pd3dDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_DESTBLEND, D3DBLEND_INVSRCALPHA); - g_pd3dDevice->SetRenderState (D3DRS_SCISSORTESTENABLE, true); - - g_pd3dDevice->SetTextureStageState (0, D3DTSS_COLOROP, D3DTOP_MODULATE); - g_pd3dDevice->SetTextureStageState (0, D3DTSS_COLORARG1, D3DTA_TEXTURE); - g_pd3dDevice->SetTextureStageState (0, D3DTSS_COLORARG2, D3DTA_DIFFUSE); - g_pd3dDevice->SetTextureStageState (0, D3DTSS_ALPHAOP, D3DTOP_MODULATE); - g_pd3dDevice->SetTextureStageState (0, D3DTSS_ALPHAARG1, D3DTA_TEXTURE); - g_pd3dDevice->SetTextureStageState (0, D3DTSS_ALPHAARG2, D3DTA_DIFFUSE); - g_pd3dDevice->SetSamplerState (0, D3DSAMP_MINFILTER, D3DTEXF_LINEAR); - g_pd3dDevice->SetSamplerState (0, D3DSAMP_MAGFILTER, D3DTEXF_LINEAR); - - // Setup orthographic projection matrix - // Being agnostic of whether or can be used, we aren't relying on D3DXMatrixIdentity()/D3DXMatrixOrthoOffCenterLH() or DirectX::XMMatrixIdentity()/DirectX::XMMatrixOrthographicOffCenterLH() - { - const float L = 0.5f, - R = io.DisplaySize.x + 0.5f, - T = 0.5f, - B = io.DisplaySize.y + 0.5f; - - D3DMATRIX mat_identity = - { - 1.0f, 0.0f, 0.0f, 0.0f, - 0.0f, 1.0f, 0.0f, 0.0f, - 0.0f, 0.0f, 1.0f, 0.0f, - 0.0f, 0.0f, 0.0f, 1.0f - }; - - D3DMATRIX mat_projection = - { - 2.0f/(R-L), 0.0f, 0.0f, 0.0f, - 0.0f, 2.0f/(T-B), 0.0f, 0.0f, - 0.0f, 0.0f, 0.5f, 0.0f, - (L+R)/(L-R), (T+B)/(B-T), 0.5f, 1.0f, - }; - - g_pd3dDevice->SetTransform (D3DTS_WORLD, &mat_identity); - g_pd3dDevice->SetTransform (D3DTS_VIEW, &mat_identity); - g_pd3dDevice->SetTransform (D3DTS_PROJECTION, &mat_projection); - } - - // Render command lists - int vtx_offset = 0; - int idx_offset = 0; - - for (int n = 0; n < draw_data->CmdListsCount; n++) - { - const ImDrawList* cmd_list = - draw_data->CmdLists [n]; - - for (int cmd_i = 0; cmd_i < cmd_list->CmdBuffer.Size; cmd_i++) - { - const ImDrawCmd* pcmd = - &cmd_list->CmdBuffer [cmd_i]; - - if (pcmd->UserCallback) - { - pcmd->UserCallback (cmd_list, pcmd); - } - - else - { - const RECT r = { - (LONG)pcmd->ClipRect.x, (LONG)pcmd->ClipRect.y, - (LONG)pcmd->ClipRect.z, (LONG)pcmd->ClipRect.w - }; - - g_pd3dDevice->SetTexture ( 0, (LPDIRECT3DTEXTURE9)pcmd->TextureId ); - g_pd3dDevice->SetScissorRect ( &r ); - g_pd3dDevice->DrawIndexedPrimitive ( D3DPT_TRIANGLELIST, - vtx_offset, - 0, - (UINT)cmd_list->VtxBuffer.Size, - idx_offset, - pcmd->ElemCount / 3 ); - } - - idx_offset += pcmd->ElemCount; - } - - vtx_offset += cmd_list->VtxBuffer.Size; - } - - // Restore the DX9 state - d3d9_state_block->Apply (); - d3d9_state_block->Release (); -} - -LRESULT -ImGui_ImplDX9_WndProcHandler ( HWND hWnd, UINT msg, - WPARAM wParam, - LPARAM lParam ) -{ - static bool window_active = true; - - ImGuiIO& io = - ImGui::GetIO (); - - auto ActivateWindow = [&](bool active = false)-> - void - { - window_active = active; - - for (int i = 0; i < 5; i++) io.MouseDown [i] = false; - for (int i = 0; i < 512; i++) io.KeysDown [i] = false; - }; - - //if (msg >= WM_MOUSEFIRST && msg <= WM_MOUSELAST) { - //io.MousePos.x = (signed short)(lParam); - //io.MousePos.y = (signed short)(lParam >> 16); - //} - - switch (msg) - { - case WM_MOUSEACTIVATE: - ActivateWindow (((HWND)wParam == hWnd)); - break; - - case WM_ACTIVATEAPP: - case WM_ACTIVATE: - case WM_NCACTIVATE: - { - if (msg == WM_NCACTIVATE) - { - ActivateWindow ((bool)wParam); - } - - else if (msg == WM_ACTIVATEAPP || msg == WM_ACTIVATE) - { - switch (wParam) - { - case 1: // WA_ACTIVE / TRUE - case 2: // WA_CLICKACTIVE - default: // Unknown - { - ActivateWindow (TRUE); - } break; - - case 0: // WA_INACTIVE / FALSE - { - ActivateWindow (FALSE); - } break; - } - } - } break; - - case WM_LBUTTONDOWN: - //case WM_LBUTTONDBLCLK: // Sent on receipt of the second click - io.MouseDown [0] = true; - return true; - - case WM_LBUTTONUP: - io.MouseDown [0] = false; - return true; - - case WM_RBUTTONDOWN: - //case WM_RBUTTONDBLCLK: // Sent on receipt of the second click - io.MouseDown [1] = true; - return true; - - case WM_RBUTTONUP: - io.MouseDown [1] = false; - return true; - - case WM_MBUTTONDOWN: - //case WM_MBUTTONDBLCLK: // Sent on receipt of the second click - io.MouseDown [2] = true; - return true; - - case WM_MBUTTONUP: - io.MouseDown [2] = false; - return true; - - case WM_MOUSEWHEEL: - io.MouseWheel += GET_WHEEL_DELTA_WPARAM(wParam) > 0 ? +1.0f : -1.0f; - return true; - - case WM_MOUSEMOVE: - io.MousePos.x = (signed short)(lParam); - io.MousePos.y = (signed short)(lParam >> 16); - return false; - - case WM_KEYDOWN: - if (wParam < 256) { - io.KeysDown [wParam] = 1; - } - - extern void TBFix_ToggleConfigUI (void); - if (io.KeyCtrl && io.KeyShift && io.KeysDown [VK_BACK] && config.input.ui.visible) - TBFix_ToggleConfigUI (); - - return true; - - case WM_KEYUP: - if (wParam < 256) - io.KeysDown [wParam] = 0; - return true; - - case WM_CHAR: - // You can also use ToAscii()+GetKeyboardState() to retrieve characters. - if (wParam > 0 && wParam < 0x10000) - io.AddInputCharacter((unsigned short)wParam); - return true; - } - - return 0; -} - -bool -ImGui_ImplDX9_Init (void* hwnd, IDirect3DDevice9* device) -{ - g_hWnd = (HWND)hwnd; - g_pd3dDevice = device; - - if (! QueryPerformanceFrequency ((LARGE_INTEGER *)&g_TicksPerSecond)) - return false; - - if (! QueryPerformanceCounter ((LARGE_INTEGER *)&g_Time)) - return false; - - ImGuiIO& io = - ImGui::GetIO (); - - - // Keyboard mapping. ImGui will use those indices to peek into the io.KeyDown[] array that we will update during the application lifetime. - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_Tab] = VK_TAB; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_LeftArrow] = VK_LEFT; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_RightArrow] = VK_RIGHT; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_UpArrow] = VK_UP; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_DownArrow] = VK_DOWN; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_PageUp] = VK_PRIOR; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_PageDown] = VK_NEXT; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_Home] = VK_HOME; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_End] = VK_END; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_Delete] = VK_DELETE; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_Backspace] = VK_BACK; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_Enter] = VK_RETURN; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_Escape] = VK_ESCAPE; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_A] = 'A'; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_C] = 'C'; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_V] = 'V'; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_X] = 'X'; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_Y] = 'Y'; - io.KeyMap [ImGuiKey_Z] = 'Z'; - - // Alternatively you can set this to NULL and call ImGui::GetDrawData() after ImGui::Render() to get the same ImDrawData pointer. - io.RenderDrawListsFn = ImGui_ImplDX9_RenderDrawLists; - io.ImeWindowHandle = g_hWnd; - - return true; -} - -void -ImGui_ImplDX9_Shutdown (void) -{ - ImGui_ImplDX9_InvalidateDeviceObjects (); - ImGui::Shutdown (); - - g_pd3dDevice = nullptr; - g_hWnd = 0; -} - -static bool -ImGui_ImplDX9_CreateFontsTexture (void) -{ - // Build texture atlas - ImGuiIO& io = - ImGui::GetIO (); - - unsigned char* pixels; - int width, - height, - bytes_per_pixel; - - io.Fonts->GetTexDataAsRGBA32 ( &pixels, - &width, &height, - &bytes_per_pixel ); - - // Upload texture to graphics system - g_FontTexture = nullptr; - - if ( g_pd3dDevice->CreateTexture ( width, height, - 1, D3DUSAGE_DYNAMIC, - D3DFMT_A8R8G8B8, - D3DPOOL_DEFAULT, - &g_FontTexture, - nullptr ) < 0 ) - return false; - - D3DLOCKED_RECT tex_locked_rect; - - if ( g_FontTexture->LockRect ( 0, &tex_locked_rect, - nullptr, 0 ) != D3D_OK ) - return false; - - for (int y = 0; y < height; y++) { - memcpy ( (unsigned char *)tex_locked_rect.pBits + tex_locked_rect.Pitch * y, - pixels + (width * bytes_per_pixel) * y, - (width * bytes_per_pixel) ); - } - - g_FontTexture->UnlockRect (0); - - // Store our identifier - io.Fonts->TexID = - (void *)g_FontTexture; - - return true; -} - -bool -ImGui_ImplDX9_CreateDeviceObjects (void) -{ - if (! g_pd3dDevice) - return false; - - if (! ImGui_ImplDX9_CreateFontsTexture ()) - return false; - - return true; -} - -void -ImGui_ImplDX9_InvalidateDeviceObjects (void) -{ - if (! g_pd3dDevice) - return; - - if (g_pVB) - { - g_pVB->Release (); - g_pVB = NULL; - } - - - if (g_pIB) - { - g_pIB->Release (); - g_pIB = NULL; - } - - if ( LPDIRECT3DTEXTURE9 tex = (LPDIRECT3DTEXTURE9)ImGui::GetIO ().Fonts->TexID ) - { - tex->Release (); - ImGui::GetIO ().Fonts->TexID = 0; - } - - g_FontTexture = NULL; -} - -void -ImGui_ImplDX9_NewFrame (void) -{ - ImGuiIO& io = - ImGui::GetIO (); - - if (! g_FontTexture) { - ImGui_ImplDX9_CreateDeviceObjects (); - } - - io.MouseDrawCursor = true; - - // Setup display size (every frame to accommodate for window resizing) - RECT rect; - GetClientRect (g_hWnd, &rect); - - io.DisplaySize = - ImVec2 ( (float)(rect.right - rect.left), - (float)(rect.bottom - rect.top) ); - - // Setup time step - INT64 current_time; - - QueryPerformanceCounter ((LARGE_INTEGER *)¤t_time); - - io.DeltaTime = (float)(current_time - g_Time) / g_TicksPerSecond; - g_Time = current_time; - - // Read keyboard modifiers inputs - io.KeyCtrl = (GetKeyState (VK_CONTROL) & 0x8000) != 0; - io.KeyShift = (GetKeyState (VK_SHIFT) & 0x8000) != 0; - io.KeyAlt = (GetKeyState (VK_MENU) & 0x8000) != 0; - - io.KeySuper = false; - - // io.KeysDown : filled by WM_KEYDOWN/WM_KEYUP events - // io.MousePos : filled by WM_MOUSEMOVE events - // io.MouseDown : filled by WM_*BUTTON* events - // io.MouseWheel : filled by WM_MOUSEWHEEL events - - // Start the frame - ImGui::NewFrame (); -} -#endif \ No newline at end of file diff --git a/src/tbt/imgui_impl_dx9.h b/src/tbt/imgui_impl_dx9.h deleted file mode 100644 index f65d656..0000000 --- a/src/tbt/imgui_impl_dx9.h +++ /dev/null @@ -1,24 +0,0 @@ -// ImGui Win32 + DirectX9 binding -// In this binding, ImTextureID is used to store a 'LPDIRECT3DTEXTURE9' texture identifier. Read the FAQ about ImTextureID in imgui.cpp. - -// You can copy and use unmodified imgui_impl_* files in your project. See main.cpp for an example of using this. -// If you use this binding you'll need to call 4 functions: ImGui_ImplXXXX_Init(), ImGui_ImplXXXX_NewFrame(), ImGui::Render() and ImGui_ImplXXXX_Shutdown(). -// If you are new to ImGui, see examples/README.txt and documentation at the top of imgui.cpp. -// https://github.com/ocornut/imgui - -struct IDirect3DDevice9; - -IMGUI_API bool ImGui_ImplDX9_Init (void* hwnd, IDirect3DDevice9* device); -IMGUI_API void ImGui_ImplDX9_Shutdown (); -IMGUI_API void ImGui_ImplDX9_NewFrame (); - -// Use if you want to reset your rendering device without losing ImGui state. -IMGUI_API void ImGui_ImplDX9_InvalidateDeviceObjects (); -IMGUI_API bool ImGui_ImplDX9_CreateDeviceObjects (); - -// Handler for Win32 messages, update mouse/keyboard data. -// You may or not need this for your implementation, but it can serve as reference for handling inputs. -// Commented out to avoid dragging dependencies on types. You can copy the extern declaration in your code. -/* -IMGUI_API LRESULT ImGui_ImplDX9_WndProcHandler(HWND hWnd, UINT msg, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam); -*/ diff --git a/src/textures.cpp b/src/textures.cpp index ee449a0..c3a4f40 100644 --- a/src/textures.cpp +++ b/src/textures.cpp @@ -1533,44 +1533,48 @@ TBFix_LoadQueuedTextures (void) if (spin > 199) spin = 193; - if (InterlockedExchangeAdd (&resampling, 0)) { - mod_text += spin; + if (config.textures.show_loading_text) { + if (InterlockedExchangeAdd (&resampling, 0)) { + mod_text += spin; - char szFormatted [64]; - sprintf (szFormatted, " Resampling: %li texture", InterlockedExchangeAdd (&resampling, 0)); + char szFormatted [64]; + sprintf (szFormatted, " Resampling: %li texture", InterlockedExchangeAdd (&resampling, 0)); - mod_text += szFormatted; - - if (InterlockedExchangeAdd (&resampling, 0) > 1) - mod_text += 's'; - - size_t queue_len = resample_pool->queueLength (); - - if (queue_len) { - sprintf (szFormatted, " (%lu queued)", queue_len); mod_text += szFormatted; - } - mod_text += "\n\n"; - } + if (InterlockedExchangeAdd (&resampling, 0) > 1) + mod_text += 's'; + + size_t queue_len = resample_pool->queueLength (); - if (InterlockedExchangeAdd (&streaming, 0)) { - mod_text += spin; + if (queue_len) { + sprintf (szFormatted, " (%lu queued)", queue_len); + mod_text += szFormatted; + } - char szFormatted [64]; - sprintf (szFormatted, " Streaming: %li texture", InterlockedExchangeAdd (&streaming, 0)); + mod_text += "\n\n"; + } + + if (InterlockedExchangeAdd (&streaming, 0)) { + mod_text += spin; - mod_text += szFormatted; + char szFormatted [64]; + sprintf (szFormatted, " Streaming: %li texture", InterlockedExchangeAdd (&streaming, 0)); - if (InterlockedExchangeAdd (&streaming, 0) > 1) - mod_text += 's'; + mod_text += szFormatted; - sprintf (szFormatted, " [%7.2f MiB]", (double)InterlockedExchangeAdd (&streaming_bytes, 0) / (1024.0f * 1024.0f)); - mod_text += szFormatted; + if (InterlockedExchangeAdd (&streaming, 0) > 1) + mod_text += 's'; - if (textures_to_stream.size ()) { - sprintf (szFormatted, " (%lu outstanding)", textures_to_stream.size ()); + sprintf (szFormatted, " [%7.2f MiB]", (double)InterlockedExchangeAdd (&streaming_bytes, 0) / (1024.0f * 1024.0f)); mod_text += szFormatted; + + if (config.textures.show_loading_text) { + if (textures_to_stream.size ()) { + sprintf (szFormatted, " (%lu outstanding)", textures_to_stream.size ()); + mod_text += szFormatted; + } + } } } diff --git a/tbf.vcxproj b/tbf.vcxproj index 65e6c1d..a0cf249 100644 --- a/tbf.vcxproj +++ b/tbf.vcxproj @@ -209,21 +209,16 @@ - - - - - @@ -246,7 +241,6 @@ - diff --git a/tbf.vcxproj.filters b/tbf.vcxproj.filters index 71babf2..7acdf43 100644 --- a/tbf.vcxproj.filters +++ b/tbf.vcxproj.filters @@ -43,9 +43,6 @@ Source Files - - Source Files\Tales of Berseria Tweak - Source Files\Tales of Berseria Tweak @@ -99,27 +96,12 @@ Header Files - - Header Files\Tales of Berseria Tweak - Header Files\imgui Header Files\imgui - - Header Files\imgui - - - Header Files\stb - - - Header Files\stb - - - Header Files\stb - @@ -144,21 +126,12 @@ {75d25c58-9b48-45cc-948e-40de7eb119d7} - - {9210efff-0c00-41e1-b760-d0a76b632352} - {7614fb09-0ecb-419e-9843-a7a83f8f3521} {9a0b79ba-cdc0-45eb-8818-c78ab4eab12c} - - {a385dfec-22b1-46dc-b1ea-a8ffa2f7c2ba} - - - {5c26b66a-640f-414a-a4b6-23e2e2fa03d2} - diff --git a/version.ini b/version.ini index 6eed149..2cf0337 100644 Binary files a/version.ini and b/version.ini differ